10-K


 
 
 
 
 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
(Mark One)
þ
 
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2015
or
o
 
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from                      to                     
Commission file number 001-13958
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
 
13-3317783
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
One Hartford Plaza, Hartford, Connecticut 06155
(Address of principal executive offices) (Zip Code)
(860) 547-5000
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12 (b) OF THE ACT
(ALL OF WHICH ARE LISTED ON THE NEW YORK STOCK EXCHANGE INC.):
Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share
Warrants (expiring June 26, 2019)
6.10% Notes due October 1, 2041
7.875% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Junior Subordinated Debentures due 2042
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12 (g) OF THE ACT:
None
Indicate by check mark:
Yes
No
if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
þ
 
if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act.
 
þ
whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.
þ
 
whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).
þ
 
if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.
þ
 
whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
 
 
Large accelerated filer þ       Accelerated filer o      Non-accelerated filer o       Smaller reporting company o
 
 
whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.)
 
þ
The aggregate market value of the shares of Common Stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant as of June 30, 2015 was approximately $17 billion, based on the closing price of $41.57 per share of the Common Stock on the New York Stock Exchange on June 30, 2015.
As of February 24, 2016, there were outstanding 396,675,884 shares of Common Stock, $0.01 par value per share, of the registrant.
Documents Incorporated by Reference
Portions of the registrant’s definitive proxy statement for its 2016 annual meeting of shareholders are incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K.




THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K
FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2015
TABLE OF CONTENTS

Item
Description
Page
 
 
1
1A.
1B.
2
3
4
 
 
5
6
7
7A.
8
9
9A.
9B.
 
 
10
11
12
13
14
 
 
15
 
 

2



Forward-Looking Statements
Certain of the statements contained herein are forward-looking statements made pursuant to the safe harbor provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements can be identified by words such as “anticipates,” “intends,” “plans,” “seeks,” “believes,” “estimates,” “expects,” “projects,” and similar references to future periods.
Forward-looking statements are based on our current expectations and assumptions regarding economic, competitive, legislative and other developments. Because forward-looking statements relate to the future, they are subject to inherent uncertainties, risks and changes in circumstances that are difficult to predict. They have been made based upon management’s expectations and beliefs concerning future developments and their potential effect upon The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company” or “The Hartford”). Future developments may not be in line with management’s expectations or may have unanticipated effects. Actual results could differ materially from expectations, depending on the evolution of various factors, including the risks and uncertainties identified below, as well as factors described in such forward-looking statements or in Part I, Item 1A. Risk Factors, in Part II, Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, and those identified from time to time in our other filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission.
Risks Relating to Economic, Market and Political Conditions:
challenges related to the Company’s current operating environment, including global political, economic and market conditions, and the effect of financial market disruptions, economic downturns or other potentially adverse macroeconomic developments on the attractiveness of our products, the returns in our investment portfolios and the hedging costs associated with our runoff annuity block;
financial risk related to the continued reinvestment of our investment portfolios and performance of our hedge program for our runoff annuity block;
market risks associated with our business, including changes in interest rates, credit spreads, equity prices, market volatility and foreign exchange rates, commodities prices and implied volatility levels.
the impact on our investment portfolio if our investment portfolio is concentrated in any particular segment of the economy;
Risks Relating to Estimates, Assumptions and Valuations:
risk associated with the use of analytical models in making decisions in key areas such as underwriting, capital management, hedging, reserving, and catastrophe risk management;
the potential for differing interpretations of the methodologies, estimations and assumptions that underlie the valuation of the Company’s financial instruments that could result in changes to investment valuations;
the subjective determinations that underlie the Company’s evaluation of other-than-temporary impairments on available-for-sale securities;
the potential for further acceleration of deferred policy acquisition cost amortization;
the potential for further impairments of our goodwill or the potential for changes in valuation allowances against deferred tax assets;
the significant uncertainties that limit our ability to estimate the ultimate reserves necessary for asbestos and environmental claims;
Financial Strength, Credit and Counterparty Risks:
the impact on our statutory capital of various factors, including many that are outside the Company’s control, which can in turn affect our credit and financial strength ratings, cost of capital, regulatory compliance and other aspects of our business and results;
risks to our business, financial position, prospects and results associated with negative rating actions or downgrades in the Company’s financial strength and credit ratings or negative rating actions or downgrades relating to our investments;
losses due to nonperformance or defaults by others, including sourcing partners, derivative counterparties and other third parties;
the potential for losses due to our reinsurers' unwillingness or inability to meet their obligations under reinsurance contracts and the availability, pricing and adequacy of reinsurance to protect the Company against losses;
Insurance Industry and Product-Related Risks:
the possibility of unfavorable loss development, including with respect to long-tailed exposures;
the possibility of a pandemic, earthquake, or other natural or man-made disaster that may adversely affect our businesses;

3



weather and other natural physical events, including the severity and frequency of storms, hail, winter storms, hurricanes and tropical storms, as well as climate change and its potential impact on weather patterns;
the possible occurrence of terrorist attacks and the Company’s inability to contain its exposure as a result of, among other factors, the inability to exclude coverage for terrorist attacks from workers' compensation policies and limitations on reinsurance coverage from the federal government under applicable laws;
the uncertain effects of emerging claim and coverage issues;
actions by competitors that may be larger or have greater financial resources than we do;
technological changes, such as usage-based methods of determining premiums, advancements in automotive safety features, the development of autonomous vehicles, and platforms that facilitate ride sharing, which may alter demand for the Company's products, impact the frequency or severity of losses, and/or impact the way the Company markets, distributes and underwrites its products;
the Company's ability to market, distribute and provide insurance products and investment advisory services through current and future distribution channels and advisory firms;
the Company’s ability to effectively price its property and casualty policies, including its ability to obtain regulatory consents to pricing actions or to non-renewal or withdrawal of certain product lines;
volatility in our statutory and United States ("U.S.") GAAP earnings and potential material changes to our results resulting from our risk management program to emphasize protection of economic value;
Regulatory and Legal Risks:
the cost and other effects of increased regulation as a result of the implementation of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010, and the potential effect of other domestic and foreign regulatory developments, including those that could adversely impact the demand for the Company’s products, operating costs and required capital levels;
unfavorable judicial or legislative developments;
regulatory limitations on the ability of the Company and certain of its subsidiaries to declare and pay dividends;
the impact of changes in federal or state tax laws;
regulatory requirements that could delay, deter or prevent a takeover attempt that shareholders might consider in their best interests;
the impact of potential changes in accounting principles and related financial reporting requirements;
Other Strategic and Operational Risks:
risks associated with the runoff of our Talcott Resolution business;
the risks, challenges and uncertainties associated with our capital management plan, including as a result of changes in our financial position and earnings, share price, capital position, legal restrictions, other investment opportunities, and other factors;
the risks, challenges and uncertainties associated with our expense reduction initiatives and other actions, which may include acquisitions, divestitures or restructurings;
the Company’s ability to maintain the availability of its systems and safeguard the security of its data in the event of a disaster, cyber or other information security incident or other unanticipated event;
the risk that our framework for managing operational risks may not be effective in mitigating material risk and loss to the Company;
the potential for difficulties arising from outsourcing and similar third-party relationships; and
the Company’s ability to protect its intellectual property and defend against claims of infringement.

Any forward-looking statement made by the Company in this document speaks only as of the date of the filing of this Form 10-K. Factors or events that could cause the Company’s actual results to differ may emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for the Company to predict all of them. The Company undertakes no obligation to publicly update any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise.

4



PART I
Item 1.
BUSINESS
(Dollar amounts in millions, except for per share data, unless otherwise stated)
General
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. (together with its subsidiaries, “The Hartford”, the “Company”, “we”, or “our”) is a holding company for a group of subsidiaries that provide property and casualty insurance, group benefits and mutual funds to individual and business customers in the United States and continues to administer life and annuity products previously sold. The Hartford is headquartered in Connecticut and its oldest subsidiary, Hartford Fire Insurance Company, dates to 1810. At December 31, 2015, total assets and total stockholders’ equity of The Hartford were $228 billion and $17.6 billion, respectively.
Organization
The Hartford strives to maintain and enhance its position as a market leader within the financial services industry. The Company sells diverse and innovative products through multiple distribution channels to individuals and businesses. The Company seeks on an ongoing basis to develop and expand its distribution channels, achieving cost efficiencies through economies of scale and investments in technology, and capitalize on the strength of its brand, including The Hartford Stag logo, one of the most recognized symbols in the financial services industry.
As a holding company, The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. is separate and distinct from its subsidiaries and has no significant business operations of its own. Therefore, it relies on the dividends from its insurance companies and other subsidiaries as the principal source of cash flow to meet its obligations, pay dividends and repurchase common stock. Information regarding the cash flow and liquidity needs of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. may be found in Part II, Item 7, Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (“MD&A”) — Capital Resources and Liquidity.
Reporting Segments
The Hartford conducts business principally in six reporting segments including Commercial Lines, Personal Lines, Property & Casualty Other Operations, Group Benefits, Mutual Funds and Talcott Resolution, as well as a Corporate category. The Hartford includes in its Corporate category the Company’s capital raising activities (including debt financing and related interest expense), purchase accounting adjustments related to goodwill and other expenses not allocated to the reporting segments.
The following discussion describes the principal products and services, marketing and distribution, and competition of The Hartford's reporting segments. For further discussion of the reporting segments, including financial disclosures of revenues by product line, net income (loss), and assets for each reporting segment, see Note 3 - Segment Information of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Commercial Lines
Principal Products and Services
Commercial Lines provides workers’ compensation, property, automobile, liability, umbrella, marine and livestock insurance products to businesses, primarily throughout the United States. The Commercial Lines segment includes three lines of business: small commercial; middle market; and specialty. The majority of Commercial Lines written premium is generated by small commercial and middle market, which provide coverage options and customized pricing based on the policyholder’s individualized risk characteristics. Specialty provides a variety of customized insurance products and services including workers’ compensation, automobile, general liability, professional liability, bond, and specialty casualty coverages.
Small commercial provides workers' compensation, automobile, property and liability coverages for small businesses. The Company considers small businesses those with annual payroll under $12, revenues under $25 and property values less than $20 per location. Property and liability coverages are offered as part of a single package policy, marketed under the Spectrum name. Middle market provides medium-sized businesses, which are companies whose payroll, revenue and property values exceed the small business definition, with workers’ compensation, property, automobile, liability, umbrella, marine and livestock coverages.
Within specialty, a significant portion of the business is written through large deductible programs for national accounts. The business also provides retrospectively-rated programs where the premiums are adjustable based on loss experience. The financial products business provides management and professional liability products including D&O (directors and officers) and E&O (errors and omissions) insurance. The bond business provides businesses with contract surety bonds, commercial surety and fidelity coverage. The captive programs business provides tailored programs primarily to customers with common risk characteristics and those seeking a loss sensitive solution.

5



Marketing and Distribution
Commercial Lines provide insurance products and services through the Company’s domestic offices and insurance centers. The products are marketed nationally utilizing independent agents, brokers and wholesalers. The independent agent and broker distribution channel is consolidating and this trend is expected to continue. This will likely result in a larger proportion of written premium being concentrated among fewer agents and brokers. In addition, the Company offers insurance products to customers of payroll service providers through its relationships with major national payroll companies and to members of affinity organizations.
Competition
In small commercial, The Hartford competes against large national carriers, as well as regional carriers in certain territories. Competitors include stock companies, mutual companies and other underwriting organizations. The small commercial market is competitive as carriers seek to differentiate themselves through product expansion, price reduction, enhanced service and cutting-edge technology. Larger carriers such as The Hartford have improved their pricing sophistication and ease of doing business with agents and customers through the use of technology, analytics and other capabilities that improve the process of evaluating a risk, quoting new business and servicing customers. The Company is also adding to its digital capabilities as customers and distributors demand more access and convenience, and expanding product and underwriting capabilities to accommodate both larger accounts and a broader risk appetite.
Written premium growth rates have been low for the insurance industry in the small commercial market due to weak economic conditions. This has put pressure on underwriting margins as competitors seek new business by increasing their underwriting appetite, and deepening their relationships with distribution partners. Also, carriers serving middle market-sized accounts are more aggressively competing for small commercial accounts, which are generally less price-sensitive.
Middle market business is considered “high touch” and involves individualized underwriting and pricing decisions. The pricing of middle market accounts is prone to significant variation or cyclicality over time due to changes in individual account characteristics and exposure, as well as legislative and macro-economic forces. In addition, various state legislative reforms in recent years designed to control workers compensation indemnity costs have led to rate reductions in many states. These factors, characterized by highly competitive pricing on new business, have resulted in more customers shopping their policies for a lower price. In the face of this competitive environment, The Hartford is working to deepen its product and underwriting capabilities, and leverage its sales and underwriting talent with tools it has introduced in recent years. Through advanced training and analytics, the Company’s field underwriters are working to improve risk selection and pricing decisions. In product development, and related areas such as claims and risk engineering, the Company is extending its capabilities in industry verticals, such as construction, auto parts manufacturing and hospitality. The Company has also added new middle market underwriters into the Midwest and Western U.S. to deepen relationships with its distribution partners.
Specialty competes on an account- by-account basis due to the complex nature of each transaction. Competition in this market includes stock companies, mutual companies, alternative risk sharing groups and other underwriting organizations. The Hartford’s relatively large size and underwriting capacity is a competitive advantage over smaller insurance companies.
For specialty casualty businesses, written pricing competition continues to be significant, particularly for the larger individual accounts. Carriers are aggressively negotiating renewals with customers by initiating the process in advance of the policy renewal date to improve retention and reduce new business opportunities for competitors. As written pricing increases, more insureds may opt for the loss-sensitive products offered in our national accounts segment, including retrospectively rated contracts, in lieu of guaranteed cost policies. Within national accounts, the Company is planning to introduce a new risk management platform, allowing customers better access to claim data and other information needed by corporate risk managers. This investment will allow the Company to work more closely with customers to improve long-term account performance.
In the bond business, favorable underwriting results in recent years have led to increased competition for market share, setting the stage for potential written price decreases. Public construction project work has slowed, resulting in only modest growth for Contract Surety business.
In professional liability, large and medium-sized businesses are in differing competitive environments. Large public D&O, specifically excess layers, is under significant competitive price pressure.  The middle market private management liability segment is in a more stable competitive and pricing environment.


6



Personal Lines
Principal Products and Services
Personal Lines provides automobile, homeowners and personal umbrella coverages to individuals across the United States, including a program designed exclusively for members of AARP (“AARP Program”). The Hartford's auto and homeowners products provide coverage options and pricing tailored to a customer's individual risk. The Hartford has individual customer relationships with AARP Program policyholders and, as a group, they represent a significant portion of the total Personal Lines' business. Business sold to AARP members, either direct or through independent agents, amounted to earned premiums of $3.2 billion, $3.0 billion and $2.9 billion in 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
During 2015, Personal Lines completed the rollout of its new auto product, Open Road, which is now available in 44 states. The Open Road product increases pricing flexibility and market responsiveness, and continues to be refined based on experience. In addition, Personal Lines has rolled out its telematics program, TrueLane, to more states, and the program is currently available to customers in 44 states in both the direct and independent agent channels.
Marketing and Distribution
Personal Lines reaches diverse customers through multiple distribution channels, including direct-to-consumer and independent agents. In direct-to-consumer, Personal Lines markets its products through a mix of media, including direct mail, digital marketing, television and advertising, both digitally and in publications. Through the agency channel, Personal Lines provides products and services to customers through a network of independent agents in the standard personal lines market, primarily serving mature, preferred consumers. These independent agents are not employees of the Company.
Personal Lines has made significant investments in offering direct and agency-based customers the opportunity to interact with the company online, including via mobile devices. In addition, its technology platform for telephone sales centers enables sales representatives to provide an enhanced customer experience, positioning The Hartford to offer unique capabilities to AARP’s member base.
Most of Personal Lines' sales are associated with its exclusive licensing arrangement with AARP, with the current agreement in place through January 1, 2023, to market automobile, homeowners and personal umbrella coverages to AARP's nearly 38 million members, either direct or through independent agents. This agreement provides Personal Lines with an important competitive advantage given the expected growth of the population of those over age 50 and the strength of the AARP brand. The Company has expanded its relationship with AARP to provide its industry-leading small business products offered by Commercial Lines to AARP members who are small business owners.
In addition to selling product through its relationship with AARP, Personal Lines sells products to non-AARP customers, primarily through the independent agent channel and within select underwriting markets where we believe we have a competitive advantage.
Competition
The personal lines automobile and homeowners insurance markets are highly competitive. Personal lines insurance is written by insurance companies of varying sizes that compete on the basis of price, product, service (including claims handling), stability of the insurer and brand recognition. Companies with recognized brands, direct sales capability and economies of scale will have a competitive advantage. In recent years, a number of carriers have increased their advertising in an effort to gain new business and retain profitable business. This has been particularly true of carriers that sell directly to the consumer. Industry sales of personal lines insurance direct to the consumer have been growing faster than sales through agents, particularly for auto insurance.
Carriers that distribute products mainly through agents compete by offering agents commissions and additional incentives to attract new business. To distinguish themselves in the marketplace, top tier carriers are offering online and self service capabilities to agents and consumers. A large majority of agents have been using “comparative rater” tools that allow the agent to compare premium quotes among several insurance companies. The use of comparative rater tools increases price competition. Carriers that are able to differentiate their offering and work with agents to identify value beyond price are more likely to be successful in this market.
The use of data mining and predictive modeling is used by more and more carriers to target the most profitable business, and carriers have further segmented their pricing plans to expand market share in what they believe to be the most profitable segments. Some companies, such as The Hartford, have written a greater percentage of their new business in preferred market segments. Such segments tend to have better loss experience but also have lower average premiums. Also, new auto technology advancements — including lane departure warnings, backup cameras, automatic braking and active collision alerts — are being deployed rapidly and are expected to improve driver safety and reduce the likelihood of vehicle collisions. The Hartford is one of the first companies to introduce a vehicle safety discount to consumers whose vehicle is equipped with new safety-promoting technology.

7



In Personal Lines, the Company is investing in capabilities to better utilize data and analytics, and thereby, refine and manage underwriting and pricing. The Company is also working to maximize the value of its long-term partnership with AARP. Investments in digital tools, contact center capabilities and direct marketing efficiencies are designed to attract and retain more AARP members. The Hartford will leverage its agency channel to target AARP members and other customer segments that value the expertise of agents who actively seek the benefits of The Hartford's product suite and who value its service model.
Group Benefits
Principal Products and Services
Group Benefits provides group life, accident and disability coverage and group retiree health benefits to members of employer groups, associations, and affinity groups. In addition to employer paid coverages, Group Benefits offers voluntary product coverages including accident, life, disability and critical illness coverages through employee payroll deductions. Group Benefits also offers disability underwriting, administration, claims processing and reinsurance to other insurers and self-funded employer plans. In addition, Group Benefits offers a single-company leave management solution, The Hartford Productivity Advantage, which integrates work absence data from the insurer’s short-term and long-term group disability and workers’ compensation insurance with its leave management administration services.
Group Benefits generally offers term insurance policies, allowing for the adjustment of rates or policy terms in order to minimize the adverse effect of market trends, declining interest rates, and other factors. Policies are typically sold with one, two or three-year rate guarantees depending upon the product and market segment.
Marketing and Distribution
The Group Benefits distribution network is managed through a regional sales office system, to distribute its group insurance products and services through a variety of distribution outlets including brokers, consultants, third-party administrators and trade associations. Additionally, Group Benefits has relationships with several private exchanges which offer Group Benefits products to employer groups.
Competition
Group Benefits competes with numerous insurance companies and financial intermediaries marketing insurance products. This line of business focuses on both its risk management expertise and economies of scale to derive a competitive advantage. Competitive factors affecting Group Benefits include the variety and quality of products and services offered, the price quoted for coverage and services, the Company’s relationships with its third-party distributors and private exchanges, and the quality of customer service. In addition, active price competition continues in the marketplace resulting in multi-year rate guarantees being offered to customers. Top tier carriers in the marketplace also offer on-line and self service capabilities to agents and consumers. The relatively large size and underwriting capacity of the Group Benefits business provides a competitive advantage over smaller companies. Additionally, as employers continue to focus on reducing the cost of employee benefits, the shift to employee paid products will become greater. Competitive factors affecting the sale of voluntary products include the breadth of products, product education, enrollment capabilities, and overall customer service.
In Group Benefits, the Company is working to grow revenue from both its employer group product offerings as well as its voluntary product suite, which includes Disability FLEX, critical illness, and accident coverages. The Company's enhanced enrollment and marketing tools help individual participants make sound decisions for their unique benefit needs.
Mutual Funds
Principal Products and Services
Mutual Funds provides investment management, administration, distribution and related services to investors through investment products in both domestic and international markets, and is separated into two distinct asset categories referred to as Mutual Fund assets under management and Talcott assets under management. Mutual Fund assets under management includes equity, fixed income, alternative and asset allocation investment products that are actively sold primarily through retail, bank trust and registered investment advisor channels. Talcott assets under management represents those assets held in separate accounts supporting legacy runoff Hartford variable insurance products.
Marketing and Distribution
The Mutual Funds distribution team is organized to sell across a variety of channels including national and regional broker-dealer organizations, independent financial advisors, defined contribution plans, consultants, record keepers, bank trust groups, and registered investment advisors.
Competition
Mutual Funds competes with other mutual fund companies and investment brokerage companies and differentiates itself through fund performance, product innovation and solutions, and service.

8



Talcott Resolution
Talcott Resolution is comprised of the runoff of the Company's U.S. annuity, institutional and private-placement life insurance businesses, and the retained yen denominated fixed payout annuity liabilities. Talcott Resolution's mission is to efficiently manage the runoff of the business while honoring the Company's obligations to its contractholders.  Talcott Resolution manages approximately 852 thousand annuity contracts with account value of approximately $67 billion and private placement life insurance with account value of approximately $40 billion as of December 31, 2015.
The Talcott Resolution business segment also includes our Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses sold in 2013 through reinsurance agreements with the respective buyers. In 2014, the Company completed the sale of Hartford Life Insurance KK, a Japanese company ("HLIKK"). In addition, the Company completed the sale of its U.K. annuity business in 2013. For further discussion of these transactions, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Reserves
The Hartford establishes and carries as liabilities reserves for its insurance products to estimate for the following:
a liability for unpaid losses, including those that have been incurred but not yet reported, as well as estimates of all expenses associated with processing and settling these claims;
a liability equal to the balance that accrues to the benefit of the life and annuity insurance policyholder as of the consolidated financial statement date, otherwise known as the account value;
a liability for future policy benefits, representing the present value of future benefits to be paid to or on behalf of policyholders less the present value of future net premiums;
fair value reserves for living benefits embedded derivative guarantees; and
death and living benefit reserves which are computed based on a percentage of revenues less actual claim costs.
Further discussion of The Hartford’s property and casualty insurance product reserves, including asbestos and environmental claims reserves, may be found in Part II, Item 7, MD&A — Critical Accounting Estimates — Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance. Additional discussion may be found in the Company’s accounting policies for insurance product reserves within Note 1 - Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Reinsurance
The Hartford cedes insurance to affiliated and unaffiliated insurers for both its property and casualty and life insurance products. Such arrangements do not relieve The Hartford of its primary liability to policyholders. Failure of reinsurers to honor their obligations could result in losses to The Hartford. For further discussion of reinsurance, see Part II, Item 7, MD&A — Enterprise Risk Management and Note 5 - Reinsurance of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
For property and casualty insurance products, reinsurance arrangements are intended to provide greater diversification of business and limit The Hartford’s maximum net loss arising from large risks or catastrophes. A major portion of The Hartford’s property and casualty insurance product reinsurance is effected under general reinsurance contracts known as treaties, or, in some instances, is negotiated on an individual risk basis, known as facultative reinsurance. The Hartford also has in-force excess of loss contracts with reinsurers that protect it against a specified part or all of a layer of losses over stipulated amounts.
For life insurance products, The Hartford is involved in both the cession and assumption of insurance with other insurance and reinsurance companies. The Company has ceded reinsurance in connection with the sales of its Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses in 2013. For further discussion of these transactions, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. In addition, the Company has reinsured to third parties a portion of the risk associated with U.S. individual variable annuities and the associated guaranteed minimum death benefit (“GMDB”) and guaranteed minimum withdrawal benefit (“GMWB”) riders.

9



Investment Operations
The majority of the Company’s investment portfolios are managed by Hartford Investment Management Company (“HIMCO”). HIMCO manages the portfolios to maximize economic value, and generate the returns necessary to support the Company’s various product obligations, within internally established objectives, guidelines and risk tolerances. The portfolio objectives and guidelines are developed based upon the asset/liability profile, including duration, convexity and other characteristics within specified risk tolerances. The risk tolerances considered include, for example, asset sector, credit issuer allocation limits, and maximum portfolio limits for below investment grade holdings. The Company attempts to minimize adverse impacts to the portfolio and the Company’s results of operations from changes in economic conditions through asset diversification, asset allocation limits, asset/liability duration matching and through the use of derivatives. For further discussion of HIMCO’s portfolio management approach, see Part II, Item 7, MD&A — Enterprise Risk Management.
In addition to managing the general account assets of the Company, HIMCO is also a SEC registered investment adviser for a variable insurance trust and third party institutional clients, a sub-advisor for certain mutual funds and serves as the sponsor and collateral manager for capital markets transactions. HIMCO specializes in investment management that incorporates proprietary research and active portfolio management within a disciplined risk framework that seeks to provide value added returns versus peers and benchmarks. In January 2016, HIMCO announced the decision to no longer pursue new business in institutional separate accounts. The change is not expected to have a significant impact on the Company's financial position or results of operations. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the fair value of HIMCO’s total assets under management was approximately $102.9 billion and $109.5 billion, respectively, of which $5.4 billion and $6.2 billion, respectively, were held in HIMCO managed third party accounts.
Enterprise Risk Management
The Company has an enterprise risk management function (“ERM”) that is charged with providing analysis of the Company's risks on an individual and aggregated basis and with ensuring that the Company's risks remain within its risk appetite and tolerances. ERM plays an integral role at The Hartford by fostering a strong risk management culture and discipline. The mission of ERM is to support the Company in achieving its strategic priorities by:
Providing a comprehensive view of the risks facing the Company, including risk concentrations and correlations;
Helping management define the Company's overall capacity and appetite for risk by evaluating the risk/return profile of the business relative to the Company's strategic intent and financial underpinning;
Assisting management in setting specific risk tolerances and limits that are measurable, actionable, and comply with the Company's overall risk philosophy;
Communicating and monitoring the Company's risk exposures relative to set limits and recommending, or implementing as appropriate, mitigating strategies; and
Providing insight to assist leaders in growing the businesses and achieving optimal risk-adjusted returns within established guidelines.
Enterprise Risk Management Structure and Governance
At The Hartford, the Board of Directors (“the Board”) has ultimate responsibility for risk oversight. It exercises its oversight function through its standing committees, each of which has primary risk oversight responsibility with respect to all matters within the scope of its duties as contemplated by its charter. In addition, the Finance, Investment and Risk Management Committee (“FIRMCo”), which is comprised of all members of the Board, has responsibility for the oversight of the investment, financial, and risk management activities of the Company, except as otherwise provided in the Company Governance Guidelines. The oversight of all risk exposures includes, but is not limited to:
Market risk, including credit, interest rate, equity market, and foreign exchange;
Liquidity and capital requirements of the Company;
Insurance risks, including those arising out of catastrophes and acts of terrorism;
Cybersecurity risk; and
Any other risk that poses a material threat to the strategic viability of the Company.
The Audit Committee is responsible for, among other things, discussing with management policies with respect to risk assessment and risk management.

10



At the corporate level, the Company's Enterprise Chief Risk Officer (“Chief Risk Officer”) leads ERM. The Chief Risk Officer reports directly to the Company's Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”). The Company has established the Enterprise Risk and Capital Committee (“ERCC”) that includes the Company’s CEO, President, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Investment Officer, Chief Risk Officer, General Counsel and others as deemed necessary by the committee chair. The ERCC oversees the risk profile and risk management practices of the Company. The ERCC also oversees capital management and the allocation of capital to the lines of business. The ERCC is responsible for significant company-wide risk exposures including, but not limited to, financial risk, liquidity and capital requirements, insurance risk, operational risks, and any other risk deemed significant. The ERCC reports to the Board primarily through the FIRMCo and through interactions with the Audit Committee.
The Company also has committees that manage specific risks and recommend risk mitigation strategies to the ERCC. These committees include, but are not limited to, Asset Liability Committees, Catastrophe Risk Committee, Emerging Risk Committees, Model Oversight Committees and the Operational Risk Committee.
Risk Management Framework
At the Company, risk is managed at multiple levels. The Hartford utilizes three lines of defense in risk management to integrate its risk management strategy and appetite into all areas of the Company. The first line of defense in risk management is generally the responsibility of the lines of business. Senior business leaders are responsible for managing risks specific to their business objectives and business environment. The second line of defense in risk management is generally owned by ERM. ERM has the responsibility to ensure that the Company has insight into its aggregate risk and that risks are managed within the Company's overall risk appetite. Legal and Compliance also commonly act as a second line of defense in risk management. The third line of defense in risk management is owned by Internal Audit. Internal Audit provides independent assurance that each business unit’s controls are present, compliant, and effective, informs the risk identification process and provides audit and consultative support to the Company.
The Company's Risk Management Framework consists of five core elements:
1.
Risk Culture and Governance: The Company has established policies for its major risks and a formal governance structure with leadership oversight and an assignment of accountability and authority. The governance structure starts at the Board and cascades to the ERCC and then to individual risk committees across the Company. In addition, the Company promotes a strong risk management culture and high expectations around ethical behavior.
2.
Risk Identification and Assessment: Through its ERM organization, the Company has developed processes for the identification, assessment, and, when appropriate, response to internal and external risks to the Company's operations and business objectives. Risk identification and prioritization has been established within each risk area, including processes around emerging risks.
3.
Risk Appetite, Tolerances, and Limits: The Company has a formal enterprise risk appetite framework and policy that is approved by the ERCC and reviewed by the Board. The risk appetite framework includes an enterprise risk appetite statement, risk preferences, risk tolerances and enterprise risk limits. Enterprise risk limits which quantify tolerances into specific limits by risk category are defined in underlying enterprise risk policies.
4.
Risk Management and Controls: While the Company utilizes the committee structure to elevate risk discussions and decision-making, there are a variety of working groups that provide decisioning and management of risk within determined tolerances and limits. ERM and the appropriate governing risk committees regularly monitor the Company's risk exposure as compared to defined limits and tolerances and provide regular reporting to the ERCC and FIRMCo.
5.
Risk Reporting and Communication: The Company monitors its major risks at the enterprise level through a number of enterprise reports, including but not limited to, a monthly risk dashboard, and regular stress testing. ERM communicates the Company's risk exposures to senior and executive management and the Board, and reviews key business performance metrics, risk indicators, audit reports, risk/control self-assessments and risk event data.
Risk Exposures and Quantification
The Company quantifies its enterprise insurance and financial risk exposures using multiple lenses including statutory, economic and, where appropriate, U.S. GAAP. ERM leverages various modeling techniques and metrics to provide a view of the Company's risk exposure in both normal and stressed environments.

11



In order to quantify group capital levels the Company uses an Economic Capital Model (“ECM”) to quantify the value of diversification across the business lines and to advance its risk-based decision-making and optimization across risk and business. The Company also uses the ECM to inform capital attribution across the businesses. The Company categorizes its main risks as follows in order to achieve a consistent and disciplined approach to quantifying, evaluating, and managing risk:
Insurance Risk
Operational Risk
Financial Risk
Additionally, the Company manages its legal and management risks across the enterprise. Management risk includes strategic risk, the risk of ineffective or inefficient execution of the Company's strategy, as well as tax risk and reputational risk.
Insurance Risk
The Company defines insurance risk as its exposure to loss due to property, liability, mortality, morbidity, disability, longevity and other perils and risks covered under its policies, including adverse development on loss reserves supporting its products and geographic accumulations of loss over time due to natural catastrophes, casualty catastrophes, terrorism and pandemic events.
Operational Risk
The Company defines operational risk as the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or from external events.
Financial Risk
Financial risk is broadly defined by the Company to include liquidity, interest rate, equity, foreign exchange, and credit risks, all of which have the potential to materially impact the Company's financial condition. Financial risk also includes exposure to events that may cause correlated movement in the above risk factors.
For further discussion on risk management, see Part II, Item 7, MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management.
Regulation
Insurance companies are subject to comprehensive and detailed regulation and supervision throughout the United States. The extent of such regulation varies, but generally has its source in statutes which delegate regulatory, supervisory and administrative powers to state insurance departments. Such powers relate to, among other things, the standards of solvency that must be met and maintained; the licensing of insurers and their agents; the nature of and limitations on investments; establishing premium rates; claim handling and trade practices; restrictions on the size of risks which may be insured under a single policy; deposits of securities for the benefit of policyholders; approval of policy forms; periodic examinations of the affairs of companies; annual and other reports required to be filed on the financial condition of companies or for other purposes; minimum rates for accumulation of surrender values; and the adequacy of reserves and other necessary provisions for unearned premiums, unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses and other liabilities, both reported and unreported.
Most states have enacted legislation that regulates insurance holding company systems such as The Hartford. This legislation provides that each insurance company in the system is required to register with the insurance department of its state of domicile and furnish information concerning the operations of companies within the holding company system that may materially affect the operations, management or financial condition of the insurers within the system. All transactions within a holding company system affecting insurers must be fair and equitable. Notice to the insurance departments is required prior to the consummation of transactions affecting the ownership or control of an insurer and of certain material transactions between an insurer and any entity in its holding company system. In addition, certain of such transactions cannot be consummated without the applicable insurance department’s prior approval. In the jurisdictions in which the Company’s insurance company subsidiaries are domiciled, the acquisition of more than 10% of The Hartford’s outstanding common stock would require the acquiring party to make various regulatory filings.
Certain of the Company’s life insurance subsidiaries sold variable life insurance, variable annuity, and some fixed guaranteed products that are “securities” registered with the SEC under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. Some of the products have separate accounts that are registered as investment companies under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”), and/or are regulated by state law. Separate account investment products are also subject to state insurance regulation. Moreover, each separate account is generally divided into sub-accounts, each of which invests in an underlying mutual fund that is also registered as an investment company under the 1940 Act (“Underlying Funds”). The Company offers these Underlying Funds and retail mutual funds that are registered with and regulated by the SEC.

12



In addition, other subsidiaries of the Company sold and distributed the Company’s variable insurance products, Underlying Funds and retail mutual funds as broker-dealers and are subject to regulation promulgated and enforced by the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (“FINRA”), the SEC and/or in, some instances, state securities administrators. Other entities operate as investment advisers registered with the SEC under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 and are registered as investment advisers under certain state laws, as applicable. Because federal and state laws and regulations are primarily intended to protect investors in securities markets, they generally grant regulators broad rulemaking and enforcement authority. Some of these regulations include, among other things, regulations impacting sales methods, trading practices, suitability of investments, use and safekeeping of customers’ funds, corporate governance, capital, record keeping, and reporting requirements.
The Hartford operates in limited foreign jurisdictions. The extent of financial services regulation on business outside the United States varies significantly among the countries in which The Hartford operates. Some countries have minimal regulatory requirements, while others regulate financial services providers extensively. Foreign financial services providers in certain countries are faced with greater restrictions than domestic competitors domiciled in that particular jurisdiction.
In addition, as described under “Legislative Developments,” we are subject to a number of Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) provisions. Failure to comply with federal and state laws and regulations may result in censure, fines, the issuance of cease-and-desist orders or suspension, termination or limitation of the activities of our operations and/or our employees. We cannot predict the impact of these actions on our businesses, results of operations or financial condition.
Intellectual Property
We rely on a combination of contractual rights and copyright, trademark, patent and trade secret laws to establish and protect our intellectual property.
We have a trademark portfolio that we consider important in the marketing of our products and services, including, among others, the trademarks of The Hartford name, the Stag Logo and the combination of these two marks. The duration of trademark registrations may be renewed indefinitely subject to country-specific use and registration requirements. We regard our trademarks as extremely valuable assets in marketing our products and services and vigorously seek to protect them against infringement. In addition, we own a number of patents and patent applications relating to on-line quoting, insurance related processing, insurance telematics, proprietary interface platforms, and other matters, some of which may be important to our business operations. Patents are of varying duration depending on filing date, and will typically expire at the end of their natural term.
Employees
The Hartford has approximately 17,400 employees as of December 31, 2015.
Available Information
The Company’s Internet address is www.thehartford.com. Our annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports are available, without charge, on the investor relations section of our website, http://ir.thehartford.com, as soon as reasonably practicable after they are filed electronically with the SEC. Reports filed with the SEC may be viewed at www.sec.gov or obtained at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington D.C. Information regarding the operation of the Public Reference Room may be obtained by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. References in this report to our website address are provided only as a convenience and do not constitute, and should not be viewed as, an incorporation by reference of the information contained on, or available through, the website. Therefore, such information should not be considered part of this report.

13



Item 1A.
RISK FACTORS
Investing in The Hartford involves risk. In deciding whether to invest in The Hartford, you should carefully consider the following risk factors, any of which could have an adverse effect on the business, financial condition, results of operations, or liquidity of The Hartford and could also impact the trading price of our securities. The Hartford may also be subject to other risks and uncertainties that are not specifically described below, which may have an adverse effect on the business, financial condition, results of operations, or liquidity of The Hartford. This information should be considered carefully together with the other information contained in this report and the other reports and materials filed by The Hartford with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). The following risk factors have been organized by category for ease of use, however many of the risks may have impacts in more than one category. These categories, therefore, should be viewed as a starting point for understanding the significant risks facing us and not as a limitation on the potential impact of the matters discussed. Risk factors are not necessarily listed in order of importance.
Risks Relating to Economic, Market and Political Conditions
Unfavorable conditions in our operating environment, including general economic and global capital market conditions, such as changes in interest rates, credit spreads, equity prices, market volatility, foreign exchange rates, commodities prices and real estate market deterioration, may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, and liquidity.
The Company’s investment portfolio and insurance liabilities are sensitive to changes in global capital market conditions. Stressed conditions or disruptions in global capital markets can directly impact our business, financial condition, results of operations, and liquidity as well as impact the economic environment. Weak economic conditions, such as high unemployment, low labor force participation, lower family income, higher tax rates, lower business investment and lower consumer spending may have adversely affected or may in the future adversely affect the demand for insurance and financial products, as well as their profitability in some cases. Global economic conditions may result in the persistence of a low interest rate environment as well as volatility in other global capital market conditions, which will continue to pressure our investment results.
One important exposure to equity risk relates to the potential for lower earnings associated with our operations in Mutual Funds and Talcott Resolution, such as variable annuities, where fee income is earned based upon the fair value of the assets under management. Should equity markets decline from current levels, assets under management and related fee income will be reduced. Certain of our products have guaranteed benefits that increase our potential obligation and statutory capital exposure when equity markets decline. Sustained declines in equity markets may result in the need to utilize significant additional capital to support these products and adversely affect our ability to support our other businesses.
A sustained low interest rate environment would pressure our net investment income and could result in lower margins and lower estimated gross profits on certain products. New and renewal business for our property and casualty and group benefits products is priced based on prevailing interest rates. As interest rates decline, pricing targets will tend to increase to offset the lower anticipated investment income earned on invested premiums. Conversely, as interest rates rise, pricing targets will tend to decrease to reflect higher anticipated investment income. Our ability to effectively react to such changes in pricing may affect our competitiveness in the marketplace, and in turn, written premium and earnings margin achieved. In addition, due to the long-term nature of the liabilities within our Group Benefits and Talcott Resolution operations, such as structured settlements and guaranteed benefits on variable annuities, sustained declines in long-term interest rates subjects us to reinvestment risks, increased hedging costs, spread compression and capital volatility. A rise in interest rates, in the absence of other countervailing changes, will reduce the market value of our investment portfolio and, if long-term interest rates were to rise dramatically certain products within our Talcott Resolution segment might be exposed to disintermediation risk. Disintermediation risk refers to the risk that our policyholders may surrender their contracts in a rising interest rate environment, requiring us to liquidate assets in an unrealized loss position. An increase in interest rates can also impact our tax planning strategies and, in particular, our ability to utilize tax benefits to offset certain previously recognized realized capital losses.
Our exposure to credit spreads primarily relates to changes in market price of fixed income instruments associated with changes in credit spreads. If issuer credit spreads widen significantly and remain at wide levels over an extended period of time, other-than-temporary impairments and decreases in the market value of our investment portfolio will likely result. In addition, losses may also occur due to volatility in credit spreads. When credit spreads widen, we incur losses associated with credit derivatives where the Company assumes exposure. When credit spreads tighten, we incur losses associated with derivatives where the Company has purchased credit protection. If credit spreads tighten significantly, the Company's net investment income associated with new purchases of fixed maturities may be reduced.

14



Our statutory surplus is also affected by widening credit spreads as a result of the accounting for the assets and liabilities on our fixed market value adjusted (“MVA”) annuities. Statutory separate account assets supporting the fixed MVA annuities are recorded at fair value. In determining the statutory reserve for the fixed MVA annuities we are required to use current crediting rates. In many capital market scenarios, current crediting rates are highly correlated with market rates implicit in the fair value of statutory separate account assets. As a result, the change in the statutory reserve from period to period will likely substantially offset the change in the fair value of the statutory separate account assets. However, in periods of volatile credit markets, actual credit spreads on investment assets may increase sharply for certain sub-sectors of the overall credit market, resulting in statutory separate account asset market value losses. As actual credit spreads are not fully reflected in current crediting rates, the calculation of statutory reserves may not substantially offset the change in fair value of the statutory separate account assets, resulting in reductions in statutory surplus. This may result in the need to devote significant additional capital to support the fixed MVA product.
In addition, a reduction in market liquidity can make it difficult to value certain of our securities when trading becomes less frequent. As such, valuations may include assumptions or estimates that may be more susceptible to significant period-to-period changes, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or liquidity.
Our exposure to commodity prices primarily relates to our investment portfolio. Our investment portfolio includes fixed maturities and equity securities issued by companies and sovereigns that derive a portion of their revenues from commodities, including oil, coal, natural gas, and precious and non-precious metals. In periods in which the prices of these and other commodities fall, absent other countervailing changes, decreases in the market value of our investment portfolio will likely result. If these declines in commodities prices are severe and persist over an extended period of time, other-than-temporary impairments may result.
Significant declines in equity prices, changes in U.S. interest rates, changes in credit spreads, inflation, or real estate market deterioration, individually or in combination, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or liquidity. Our hedging assets seek to reduce the net economic sensitivity of our potential obligations from guaranteed benefits to equity market and interest rate fluctuations. Because of the accounting asymmetries between our hedging targets and statutory and GAAP accounting principles for our guaranteed benefits, rising equity markets and/or rising interest rates may result in statutory or GAAP losses.
Concentration of our investment portfolio in any particular segment of the economy may have adverse effects on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
The concentration of our investment portfolios in any particular industry, collateral type, group of related industries or geographic sector could have an adverse effect on our investment portfolios and consequently on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. Events or developments that have a negative impact on any particular industry, group of related industries or geographic region may have a greater adverse effect on our investment portfolio to the extent that the portfolio is concentrated rather than diversified.
Risks Relating to Estimates, Assumptions and Valuations
Actual results could materially differ from the analytical models we use to assist our decision making in key areas such as underwriting, capital, hedging, reserving, and catastrophe risks, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or liquidity.
We employ various modeling techniques (e.g., scenarios, predictive, stochastic and/or forecasting) to analyze and estimate exposures, loss trends and other risks associated with our insurance businesses, investments and capital management. We use the modeled outputs and related analyses to assist us in decision-making related to, among other things, underwriting, pricing, capital allocation, reserving, investments, hedging, reinsurance, and catastrophe risk. Both proprietary and third party models we use incorporate numerous assumptions and forecasts about the future level and variability of interest rates, capital requirements, loss frequency and severity, currency exchange rates, policyholder behavior, equity markets and inflation, among others. The modeled outputs and related analyses are subject to the inherent limitations of any statistical analysis, including the use of historical internal and industry data and assumptions, which may be stale, incomplete or erroneous. Consequently, actual results may differ materially from our modeled results. The profitability and financial condition of the Company substantially depends on the extent to which our actual experience is consistent with assumptions we use in our models and ultimate model outputs. If, based upon these models or other factors, we misprice our products or our estimates of the risks we are exposed to prove to be materially inaccurate, our business, financial condition, results of operations or liquidity may be adversely affected.

15



Our valuations of many of our financial instruments include methodologies, estimations and assumptions that are subject to differing interpretations and could result in changes to investment valuations that may materially adversely affect our business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity.
The following financial instruments are carried at fair value in the Company's consolidated financial statements: fixed maturities, equity securities, freestanding and embedded derivatives, certain hedge fund investments, and separate account assets. The determination of fair values is made at a specific point in time, based on available market information and judgments about financial instruments, including estimates of the timing and amounts of expected future cash flows and the credit standing of the issuer or counterparty. The use of different methodologies and assumptions may have a material effect on the estimated fair value amounts.
During periods of market disruption, including periods of significantly increasing/decreasing interest rates, rapidly widening/narrowing credit spreads or illiquidity, it may be difficult to value certain of our securities if trading becomes less frequent and/or market data becomes less observable. There may be certain asset classes that were in active markets with significant observable data that become illiquid due to the financial environment. In such cases, securities may require more subjectivity and management judgment in determining their fair values and those fair values may differ materially from the value at which the investments may be ultimately sold. Further, rapidly changing or unprecedented credit and equity market conditions could materially impact the valuation of securities and the period-to-period changes in value could vary significantly. Decreases in value could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity.
Evaluation of available-for-sale securities for other-than-temporary impairment involves subjective determinations and could materially impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
The evaluation of impairments is a quantitative and qualitative process, which is subject to risks and uncertainties and is intended to determine whether a credit and/or non-credit impairment exists and whether an impairment should be recognized in current period earnings or in other comprehensive income. The risks and uncertainties include changes in general economic conditions, the issuer's financial condition or future recovery prospects, the effects of changes in interest rates or credit spreads and the expected recovery period. For securitized financial assets with contractual cash flows, the Company uses its best estimate of cash flows over the life of the security to determine if a security is other-than-temporarily-impaired. In addition, estimating future cash flows involves incorporating information received from third-party sources and making internal assumptions and judgments regarding the future performance of the underlying collateral and assessing the probability that an adverse change in future cash flows has occurred. The determination of the amount of other-than-temporary impairments is based upon our quarterly evaluation and assessment of known and inherent risks associated with the respective asset class. Such evaluations and assessments are revised as conditions change and new information becomes available.
Additionally, our management considers a wide range of factors about the security issuer and uses their best judgment in evaluating the cause of the decline in the estimated fair value of the security and in assessing the prospects for recovery. Inherent in management's evaluation of the security are assumptions and estimates about the operations of the issuer and its future earnings potential. Impairment losses in earnings could materially adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
If assumptions used in estimating future gross profits differ from actual experience, we may be required to accelerate the amortization of DAC and increase reserves for guaranteed minimum death and withdrawal benefits, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
The Company deferred acquisition costs associated with the prior sales of its variable annuity products. Deferred acquisition costs for the variable annuity products are amortized over the expected life of the contracts. The remaining deferred but not yet amortized cost is referred to as the Deferred Acquisition Cost (“DAC”) asset. We amortize these costs in proportion to the present value of estimated gross profits (“EGPs”). The Company evaluates the EGPs compared to the DAC asset to determine if an impairment exists. The Company also establishes reserves for GMDB and the life contingent portion of GMWB using components of EGPs. The projection of EGPs, or components of EGPs, requires the use of certain assumptions, principally related to separate account fund returns, surrender and lapse rates, interest margin (including impairments), mortality, benefit utilization, annuitization and hedging costs. Of these factors, we anticipate that changes in separate account fund returns are most likely to impact the EGP, along with the rate of amortization of such costs. However, other factors such as those the Company might employ to reduce risk, such as the cost of hedging or other risk mitigating techniques, as well as the effect of increased surrenders, could also significantly reduce estimates of future gross profits. Estimating future gross profits is a complex process requiring considerable judgment and the forecasting of events well into the future. If our assumptions regarding policyholder behavior, including lapse rates, benefit utilization, surrenders, annuitization, hedging costs or costs to employ other risk mitigating techniques prove to be inaccurate or if significant or sustained equity market declines occur, we could be required to accelerate the amortization of DAC related to variable annuity contracts, and increase reserves for GMDB and life-contingent GMWB which would result in a charge to net income. Such adjustments could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.

16



If our businesses do not perform well, we may be required to establish a valuation allowance against the deferred income tax asset or to recognize an impairment of our goodwill, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
Our income tax expense includes deferred income taxes arising from temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities and carryforwards for foreign tax credits, capital losses, net operating losses and alternative minimum tax credits. Deferred tax assets are assessed periodically by management to determine if it is more likely than not that the deferred income tax assets will be realized. Factors in management's determination include the performance of the business, including the ability to generate, from a variety of sources and tax planning strategies, sufficient future taxable income and capital gains before net operating loss and capital loss carryforwards expire. If based on available information, it is more likely than not that we are unable to recognize a full tax benefit on deferred tax assets, then a valuation allowance will be established with a corresponding charge to net income (loss). Charges to increase our valuation allowance could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
Goodwill represents the excess of the amounts we paid to acquire subsidiaries and other businesses over the fair value of their net assets at the date of acquisition. We test goodwill at least annually for impairment. Impairment testing is performed based upon estimates of the fair value of the “reporting unit” to which the goodwill relates. The reporting unit is the operating segment or a business one level below that operating segment if discrete financial information is prepared and regularly reviewed by management at that level. The fair value of the reporting unit is impacted by the performance of the business and could be adversely impacted if new business, customer retention, profitability or other drivers of performance differ from expectations. If it is determined that the goodwill has been impaired, the Company must write down the goodwill by the amount of the impairment, with a corresponding charge to net income (loss). These write downs could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition.
It is difficult for us to predict our potential exposure for asbestos and environmental claims, and our ultimate liability may exceed our currently recorded reserves, which may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
We continue to receive asbestos and environmental claims. Significant uncertainty limits the ability of insurers and reinsurers to estimate the ultimate reserves necessary for unpaid losses and related expenses for both environmental and particularly asbestos claims. For some asbestos and environmental claims, we believe that the actuarial tools and other techniques we employ to estimate the ultimate cost of claims for more traditional kinds of insurance exposure are less precise in estimating reserves for our asbestos and environmental exposures. In addition, the assumptions used to estimate reserves for asbestos and environmental claims are subject to significant uncertainty, including assumptions about claim frequency, average severity and how insurance coverage applies. Accordingly, the degree of variability of reserve estimates for these longer-tailed exposures is significantly greater than for other more traditional exposures. It is also not possible to predict changes in the legal and legislative environment and their effect on the future development of asbestos and environmental claims. Because of the significant uncertainties that limit the ability of insurers and reinsurers to estimate the ultimate reserves necessary for unpaid losses and related expenses for both environmental and particularly asbestos claims, the ultimate liabilities may exceed the currently recorded reserves. Increases in reserves would be recognized as an expense during the periods in which these determinations are made, thereby adversely affecting our results of operations for the related periods. Depending on the scale of any changes in these estimated losses, such determinations could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Financial Strength, Credit and Counterparty Risks
The amount of statutory capital that we have, and the amount of statutory capital that we must hold to maintain our financial strength and credit ratings and meet other requirements, can vary significantly from time to time and is sensitive to a number of factors outside of our control, including equity market, credit market and interest rate conditions, changes in policyholder behavior, changes in rating agency models, and changes in regulations.
We conduct the vast majority of our business through licensed insurance company subsidiaries. Accounting standards and statutory capital and reserve requirements for these entities are prescribed by the applicable insurance regulators and the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (“NAIC”). Insurance regulators have established regulations that provide minimum capitalization requirements based on risk-based capital (“RBC”) formulas for both life and property and casualty companies. The RBC formula for life companies establishes capital requirements relating to insurance, business, asset and interest rate risks, including equity, interest rate and expense recovery risks associated with variable annuities and group annuities that contain death benefits or certain living benefits. The RBC formula for property and casualty companies adjusts statutory surplus levels for certain underwriting, asset, credit and off-balance sheet risks.

17



In any particular year, statutory surplus amounts and RBC ratios may increase or decrease depending on a variety of factors, including the amount of statutory income or losses generated by our insurance subsidiaries, the amount of additional capital our insurance subsidiaries must hold to support business growth, the amount of dividends or distributions taken out of our insurance subsidiaries, changes in equity market levels, the value of certain fixed-income and equity securities in our investment portfolio, the value of certain derivative instruments, changes in interest rates, the impact of internal reinsurance arrangements, admissibility of deferred tax assets and changes to the NAIC RBC formulas. Most of these factors are outside of the Company's control. The Company's financial strength and credit ratings are significantly influenced by the statutory surplus amounts and RBC ratios of our insurance company subsidiaries. In addition, rating agencies may implement changes to their internal models that have the effect of increasing the amount of statutory capital we must hold in order to maintain our current ratings. Also, in extreme scenarios of equity market declines and other capital market volatility, the amount of additional statutory reserves that we are required to hold for our variable annuity guarantees increases at a greater than linear rate. This reduces the statutory surplus used in calculating our RBC ratios. When equity markets increase, surplus levels and RBC ratios would generally be expected to increase. However, as a result of a number of factors and market conditions, including the level of hedging costs and other risk transfer activities, statutory reserve requirements for death and living benefit guarantees and increases in RBC requirements, surplus and RBC ratios may not increase when equity markets increase. Due to these factors, projecting statutory capital and the related RBC ratios is complex. If our statutory capital resources are insufficient to maintain a particular rating by one or more rating agencies, we may seek to raise capital through public or private equity or debt financing. If we were not to raise additional capital, either at our discretion or because we were unable to do so, our financial strength and credit ratings might be downgraded by one or more rating agencies.
Downgrades in our financial strength or credit ratings, which may make our products less attractive, could increase our cost of capital and inhibit our ability to refinance our debt, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Financial strength and credit ratings are important in establishing the competitive position of insurance companies. Rating agencies assign ratings based upon several factors. While most of the factors relate to the rated company, some of the factors relate to the views of the rating agency (including its assessment of the strategic importance of the rated company to the insurance group), general economic conditions, and circumstances outside the rated company's control. In addition, rating agencies may employ different models and formulas to assess the financial strength of a rated company, and from time to time rating agencies have altered these models. Changes to the models, general economic conditions, or other circumstances outside our control could impact a rating agency's judgment of its internal rating and the publicly issued rating it assigns us. We cannot predict what actions rating agencies may take, or what actions we may take in response to the actions of rating agencies, which may adversely affect us.
Our financial strength ratings, which are intended to measure our ability to meet policyholder obligations, are an important factor affecting public confidence in most of our products and, as a result, our competitiveness. A downgrade or a potential downgrade in the rating of our financial strength or of one of our principal insurance subsidiaries could affect our competitive position and reduce future sales of our products.
Our credit ratings also affect our cost of capital. A downgrade or a potential downgrade of our credit ratings could make it more difficult or costly to refinance maturing debt obligations, to support business growth at our insurance subsidiaries and to maintain or improve the financial strength ratings of our principal insurance subsidiaries. Downgrades could begin to trigger potentially material collateral calls on certain of our derivative instruments and counterparty rights to terminate derivative relationships, both of which could limit our ability to purchase additional derivative instruments. These events could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. For a further discussion of potential impacts of ratings downgrades on derivative instruments, including potential collateral calls, see Part II, Item 7, MD&A - Capital Resources and Liquidity - Derivative Commitments.
Losses due to nonperformance or defaults by others, including issuers of investment securities, mortgage loans or reinsurance and derivative instrument counterparties, could have a material adverse effect on the value of our investments, business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Issuers or borrowers whose securities or loans we hold, customers, trading counterparties, counterparties under swaps and other derivative contracts, reinsurers, clearing agents, exchanges, clearing houses and other financial intermediaries and guarantors may default on their obligations to us due to bankruptcy, insolvency, lack of liquidity, adverse economic conditions, operational failure, fraud, government intervention or other reasons. Such defaults could have a material adverse effect on the value of our investments, business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. Additionally, the underlying assets supporting our structured securities or loans may deteriorate causing these securities or loans to incur losses.
Our investment portfolio includes securities backed by real estate assets, the value of which may be adversely impacted if conditions in the real estate market significantly deteriorate, including declines in property values and increases in vacancy rates, delinquencies and foreclosures, ultimately resulting in a reduction in expected future cash flows for certain securities.

18



The Company also has exposure to foreign-based issuers of securities and providers of reinsurance. These foreign issuers include European and certain emerging market issuers. Despite stabilization in the European market, there are still fundamental structural issues that remain and may result in the re-emergence of fiscal and economic issues. In addition, there has been recent volatility within certain emerging market countries spurred by concerns over the potential for rising U.S. interest rates, slowing global growth, lower prices for oil and other commodities, and the devaluation of certain currencies. Further details of the European and certain emerging market private and sovereign issuers held within the investment portfolio and the Company's European based reinsurance arrangements can be found in Part II, Item 7, MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management - Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management.
Property value declines and loss rates that exceed our current estimates, as outlined in Part II, Item 7, MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management - Other-Than-Temporary Impairments, or a worsening of global economic conditions could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
To the extent the investment portfolio is not adequately diversified, concentrations of credit risk may exist which could negatively impact the Company if significant adverse events or developments occur in any particular industry, group of related industries or geographic regions. The Company’s investment portfolio is not exposed to any credit concentration risk of a single issuer greater than 10% of the Company's stockholders' equity other than U.S. government and U.S. government agencies backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government. However, if issuers of securities or loans we hold are acquired, merge or otherwise consolidate with other issuers of securities or loans held by the Company, our investment portfolio’s credit concentration risk to issuers could increase above the 10% threshold, for a period of time, until the Company is able to sell securities to get back in compliance with the established investment credit policies. For discussion of the Company’s exposure to credit concentration risk of reinsurers, see the risk factor below.
We may incur losses due to our reinsurers' unwillingness or inability to meet their obligations under reinsurance contracts and the availability, pricing and adequacy of reinsurance may not be sufficient to protect us against losses.
As an insurer, we frequently use reinsurance to reduce the effect of losses that may arise from, among other things, catastrophes, GMDB's under variable annuity contracts and other risks that can cause unfavorable results of operations, and to effect the sale of one line of business to an independent company. Under these reinsurance arrangements, other insurers assume a portion of our losses and related expenses; however, we remain liable as the direct insurer on all risks reinsured. Consequently, ceded reinsurance arrangements do not eliminate our obligation to pay claims, and we are subject to our reinsurers' credit risk with respect to our ability to recover amounts due from them. Although we regularly evaluate the financial condition of our reinsurers to minimize our exposure to significant losses from reinsurer insolvencies, our reinsurers may become financially unsound or dispute their contractual obligations. The inability or unwillingness of any reinsurer to meet its financial obligations to us, including the impact of any insolvency or rehabilitation proceedings involving a reinsurer that could affect the Company's access to collateral held in trust, could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. This risk may be magnified by a concentration of reinsurance-related credit risk resulting from the sale of the Company’s Individual Life business. Further details of such concentration can be found in Part II, Item 7, MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management - Reinsurance as a Risk Management Strategy - Life Insurance Product Reinsurance Recoverable.
In addition, market conditions beyond our control determine the availability and cost of the reinsurance we are able to purchase. Reinsurance pricing changes significantly over time, and no assurances can be made that reinsurance will remain continuously available to us to the same extent and on the same terms as are currently available. If we were unable to maintain our current level of reinsurance or purchase new reinsurance protection in amounts that we consider sufficient and at prices that we consider acceptable, we would have to either accept an increase in our net liability exposure, reduce the amount of business we write, or develop to the extent possible other alternatives to reinsurance, such as use of the capital markets. Further, due to the inherent uncertainties as to collection and the length of time before reinsurance recoverables will be due, it is possible that future adjustments to the Company’s reinsurance recoverables, net of the allowance, could be required, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated results of operations or cash flows in a particular quarterly or annual period.
Our ability to declare and pay dividends is subject to limitations.
The payment of future dividends on our capital stock is subject to the discretion of our board of directors, which considers, among other factors, our operating results, overall financial condition, credit-risk considerations and capital requirements, as well as general business and market conditions.

19



Moreover, as a holding company that is separate and distinct from our insurance subsidiaries, we have no significant business operations of our own. Therefore, we rely on dividends from our insurance company subsidiaries and other subsidiaries as the principal source of cash flow to meet our obligations. These obligations include payments on our debt securities and the payment of dividends on our capital stock. The Connecticut insurance holding company laws limit the payment of dividends by Connecticut-domiciled insurers and require notice to and approval by the state insurance commissioner for the declaration or payment of dividends above certain levels. The insurance holding company laws of the other jurisdictions in which our insurance subsidiaries are incorporated, or deemed commercially domiciled, generally contain similar, and in some instances more restrictive, limitations on the payment of dividends. Dividends paid to us by our insurance subsidiaries are further dependent on their cash requirements. For further discussion on dividends from insurance subsidiaries, see Part II, Item 7, MD&A - Capital Resources & Liquidity.
Our rights to participate in any distribution of the assets of any of our subsidiaries, for example, upon their liquidation or reorganization, and the ability of holders of our common stock to benefit indirectly from a distribution, are subject to the prior claims of creditors of the applicable subsidiary, except to the extent that we may be a creditor of that subsidiary. Holders of our capital stock are only entitled to receive such dividends as our board of directors may declare out of funds legally available for such payments. Moreover, our common stockholders are subject to the prior dividend rights of any holders of our preferred stock or depositary shares representing such preferred stock then outstanding. The terms of our outstanding junior subordinated debt securities prohibit us from declaring or paying any dividends or distributions on our capital stock or purchasing, acquiring, or making a liquidation payment on such stock, if we have given notice of our election to defer interest payments but the related deferral period has not yet commenced or a deferral period is continuing.
Insurance Industry and Product-Related Risks
Our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity may be materially adversely affected by unfavorable loss development.
Our success, in part, depends upon our ability to accurately assess the risks associated with the coverage provided to policyholders that we insure. We establish property and casualty loss reserves to cover our estimated liability for the payment of all unpaid losses and loss expenses incurred with respect to premiums earned on the policies that we write. Loss reserves do not represent an exact calculation of liability. Rather, loss reserves are estimates of what we expect the ultimate settlement and administration of claims will cost, less what has been paid to date. These estimates are based upon actuarial projections and on our assessment of currently available data, as well as estimates of claims severity and frequency, legal theories of liability and other factors. Loss reserve estimates are refined periodically as experience develops and claims are reported and settled. Establishing an appropriate level of loss reserves is an inherently uncertain process. Because of this uncertainty, it is possible that our reserves at any given time will prove inadequate. Furthermore, since estimates of aggregate loss costs for prior accident years are used in pricing our insurance products, we could later determine that our products were not priced adequately to cover actual losses and related loss expenses in order to generate a profit. To the extent we determine that losses and related loss expenses are emerging unfavorably to our initial expectations, we will be required to increase reserves. Increases in reserves would be recognized as an expense during the period or periods in which these determinations are made, thereby adversely affecting our results of operations for the related period or periods. Depending on any changes in these estimated losses, such determinations could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or liquidity.
We are particularly vulnerable to losses from catastrophes, both natural and man-made, which could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Our insurance operations expose us to claims arising out of catastrophes. Catastrophes can be caused by various unpredictable natural events, including, among others, earthquakes, hurricanes, hailstorms, severe winter weather, wind storms, fires, tornadoes, and pandemics. Catastrophes can also be man-made, such as terrorist attacks, cyber-attacks, explosions or infrastructure failures.
The geographic distribution of our business subjects us to catastrophe exposure for events occurring in a number of areas, including, but not limited to, hurricanes in Florida, the Gulf Coast, the Northeast and the Atlantic coast regions of the United States, tornadoes in the Midwest and Southeast, earthquakes in California and the New Madrid region of the United States, and the spread of disease. Any increases in the values and concentrations of insured employees and property in these areas would increase the severity of catastrophic events in the future. In addition, changing climate conditions across longer time scales, including the potential risk of broader climate change, may be increasing, or may in the future increase, the severity of certain natural catastrophe losses across various geographic regions.Potential examples of the impact of climate change on catastrophe exposure include, but are not limited to the following: an increase in the frequency or severity of wind and thunderstorm and tornado/hailstorm events due to increased convection in the atmosphere, more frequent brush fires in certain geographies due to prolonged periods of drought, higher incidence of deluge flooding, and the potential for an increase in severity of the largest hurricane events due to higher sea surface temperatures. In addition, our businesses have exposure to global or nationally occurring pandemics caused by highly infectious and potentially fatal diseases, and are spread through human, animal or plant populations. Additionally, due to such catastrophes, caused by natural or man-made events, policyholders may be unable to meet their obligations to pay premiums on our insurance policies.

20



Our liquidity could be constrained by a catastrophe, or multiple catastrophes, which could result in extraordinary losses. In addition, in part because accounting rules do not permit insurers to reserve for such catastrophic events until they occur, claims from catastrophic events could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or liquidity. To the extent that the frequency or severity of catastrophe losses changes over time or models improve, we will seek to reflect any of these changes in the design and pricing of our products. However, the Company may be exposed to regulatory or legislative actions that prevent a full recognition of loss expectations in the design or pricing of our products or result in additional risk-shifting to the insurance industry.
The occurrence of one or more terrorist attacks in the geographic areas we serve or the threat of terrorism in general may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
The occurrence of one or more terrorist attacks in the geographic areas we serve could result in substantially higher claims under our insurance policies than we have anticipated. Private sector catastrophe reinsurance is limited and generally unavailable for terrorism losses caused by attacks with nuclear, biological, chemical or radiological weapons. Reinsurance coverage from the federal government under the Terrorism Risk Insurance Program Reauthorization Act of 2015 (“TRIPRA”) is also limited. Although TRIPRA provides benefits for certified acts of terrorism that exceed a certain threshold of industry losses ($100 in 2015, increasing to $200 by 2020), those benefits are subject to a deductible and other limitations. Under TRIPRA, once our losses exceed a deductible of 20% of our subject commercial property and casualty insurance premium for the preceding calendar year, the federal government will reimburse us a percentage of our losses (85% in 2015, decreasing 1% annually until 2020) attributable to certain acts of terrorism which exceed this deductible up to a total industry program cap of $100 billion. Our estimated deductible under the program is $1.2 billion for 2016. In addition, because the interpretation of this law is untested, there is substantial uncertainty as to how it will be applied to specific circumstances.
Accordingly, the effects of a terrorist attack in the geographic areas we serve may result in claims and related losses for which we do not have adequate reinsurance. This would likely cause us to increase our reserves, adversely affect our results during the period or periods affected and, could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. Further, the continued threat of terrorism and the occurrence of terrorist attacks, as well as heightened security measures and military action in response to these threats and attacks or other geopolitical or military crises, may cause significant volatility in global financial markets, disruptions to commerce and reduced economic activity. These consequences could have an adverse effect on the value of the assets in our investment portfolio as well as those in our separate accounts. Terrorist attacks also could disrupt our operations centers in the U.S. or abroad. As a result, it is possible that any, or a combination of all, of these factors may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity may be adversely affected by the emergence of unexpected and unintended claim and coverage issues.
As industry practices and legal, judicial, social and other environmental conditions change, unexpected and unintended issues related to claims and coverage may emerge. These issues may either extend coverage beyond our underwriting intent or increase the frequency or severity of claims. In some instances, these changes may not become apparent until some time after we have issued insurance contracts that are affected by the changes. As a result, the full extent of liability under our insurance contracts may not be known for many years after a contract is issued, and this liability may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity at the time it becomes known.
Competitive activity or technological changes may adversely affect our market share, demand for our products, or our financial results, which could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.
The industries in which we operate are highly competitive. Our principal competitors are other property and casualty insurers, group benefits providers and other mutual fund companies. Competitors may expand their risk appetites in products and services where The Hartford currently enjoys a competitive advantage. Larger competitors with more capital and new entrants to the market could result in increased pricing pressures on a number of our products and services and may harm our ability to maintain or increase our profitability. For example, larger competitors may have lower operating costs and an ability to absorb greater risk while maintaining their financial strength ratings, thereby allowing them to price their products more competitively. Consolidation among insurance companies may allow competitors to grow earnings and achieve economies of scale, giving them an overall competitive advantage. In addition, a number of insurers are making use of "big data" analytics to, among other things, improve pricing accuracy, be more targeted in marketing, strengthen customer relationships and provide more customized loss prevention services. If they are able to use big data more effectively than we are, it may give them a competitive advantage. Because of the highly competitive nature of these industries, there can be no assurance that we will continue to compete effectively with our industry rivals, or that competitive pressure will not have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.

21



Our business could also be affected by technological changes, including further advancements in automotive safety features, the development of autonomous or “self-driving” vehicles, and platforms that facilitate ride sharing. These technologies could impact the frequency or severity of losses, disrupt the demand for certain of our products, or reduce the size of the automobile insurance market as a whole. While there is substantial uncertainty about the timing, penetration and reliability of such technologies, any such impacts could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.
We may experience difficulty in marketing, distributing and providing insurance products and investment advisory services through current and future distribution channels and advisory firms.
We distribute our insurance products and mutual funds through a variety of distribution channels, including brokers, independent agents, broker-dealers, banks, affinity partners, our own internal sales force and other third-party organizations. In some areas of our business, we generate a significant portion of our business through or in connection with individual third-party arrangements. For example, we market personal lines products in large part through an exclusive licensing arrangement with AARP that continues through January 1, 2023. Our ability to distribute products through affinity partners may be adversely impacted by membership levels and the pace of membership growth. We periodically negotiate provisions and renewals of certain of these relationships, and there can be no assurance that such terms will remain acceptable to us or such third parties. An interruption in our continuing relationship with certain of these third parties, including potentially as a result of a strategic transaction or other Company initiatives, could materially affect our ability to market our products and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
As a property and casualty insurer, the premium rates we are able to charge and the profits we are able to obtain are affected by the actions of state insurance departments that regulate our business, the cyclical nature of the business in which we compete and our ability to adequately price the risks we underwrite, which may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Pricing adequacy depends on a number of factors, including the ability to obtain regulatory approval for rate changes, proper evaluation of underwriting risks, the ability to project future loss cost frequency and severity, our response to rate actions taken by competitors, and expectations about regulatory and legal developments and expense levels. We seek to price our property and casualty insurance policies such that insurance premiums and future net investment income earned on premiums received will provide for an acceptable profit in excess of underwriting expenses and the cost of paying claims.
State insurance departments that regulate us often propose premium rate changes for the benefit of the consumer at the expense of the insurer and may not allow us to reach targeted levels of profitability. In addition to regulating rates, certain states have enacted laws that require a property and casualty insurer conducting business in that state to participate in assigned risk plans, reinsurance facilities, joint underwriting associations and other residual market plans, or to offer coverage to all consumers and often restrict an insurer's ability to charge the price it might otherwise charge or restrict an insurer's ability to offer or enforce specific policy deductibles. In these markets, we may be compelled to underwrite significant amounts of business at lower than desired rates or accept additional risk not contemplated in our existing rates, participate in the operating losses of residual market plans or pay assessments to fund operating deficits of state-sponsored funds, possibly leading to lower returns on equity. The laws and regulations of many states also limit an insurer's ability to withdraw from one or more lines of insurance in the state, except pursuant to a plan that is approved by the state's insurance department. Additionally, certain states require insurers to participate in guaranty funds for impaired or insolvent insurance companies. These funds periodically assess losses against all insurance companies doing business in the state. Any of these factors could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations or liquidity.
Additionally, the property and casualty insurance market is historically cyclical, experiencing periods characterized by relatively high levels of price competition, less restrictive underwriting standards, more expansive coverage offerings and relatively low premium rates, followed by periods of relatively low levels of competition, more selective underwriting standards, more coverage restrictions and relatively high premium rates. Prices tend to increase for a particular line of business when insurance carriers have incurred significant losses in that line of business in the recent past or when the industry as a whole commits less of its capital to writing exposures in that line of business. Prices tend to decrease when recent loss experience has been favorable or when competition among insurance carriers increases. In all of our property and casualty insurance product lines and states, there is a risk that the premium we charge may ultimately prove to be inadequate as reported losses emerge. In addition, there is a risk that regulatory constraints, price competition or incorrect pricing assumptions could prevent us from achieving targeted returns. Inadequate pricing could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.

22



Adjustments to our risk management program relating to products we offered with guaranteed benefits to emphasize protection of economic value may result in statutory and U.S. GAAP volatility in our earnings and potentially material charges to net income (loss).
Some of the in-force business within our Talcott Resolution operations, especially variable annuities, offer guaranteed benefits, including guaranteed minimum death benefits and guaranteed minimum withdrawal benefits. These GMDBs and GMWBs expose the Company to interest rate risk but also have significant equity risk. A decline in equity markets would not only result in lower earnings, but would also increase our exposure to liability for benefit claims. We use reinsurance and benefit designs, such as caps, to mitigate the exposure associated with GMDB. We also use reinsurance in combination with product management actions, such as rider fee increases, investment restrictions and buyout offers, as well as derivative instruments to attempt to minimize the claim exposure and to reduce the volatility of net income associated with the GMWB liability.  We remain liable for the guaranteed benefits in the event that reinsurers or derivative counterparties are unable or unwilling to pay, which could result in a need for additional capital to support in-force business.
From time to time, we may adjust our risk management program based on contracts in force, market conditions, or other factors. While we believe that these actions improve the efficiency of our risk management related to these benefits,  any such adjustments may result in greater statutory and U.S. GAAP earnings volatility and, based upon the types of hedging instruments used, can result in potentially material charges to net income (loss) in periods of rising equity market pricing levels, higher interest rates and declines in volatility. We are also subject to the risk that these management actions prove ineffective or that unanticipated policyholder behavior, combined with adverse market events, produces economic losses beyond the scope of the risk management techniques employed, which individually or collectively may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Regulatory and Legal Risks
The impact of regulatory initiatives and legislative developments, including the implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act of 2010, could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Regulatory initiatives and legislative developments may significantly affect our operations and prospects in ways that we cannot predict. U.S. and overseas governmental and regulatory authorities, including the SEC, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the "Federal Reserve"), the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”), the NYSE and FINRA are considering enhanced or new regulatory requirements intended to prevent future financial crises or otherwise stabilize the institutions under their supervision. Such measures are likely to lead to stricter regulation of financial institutions generally, and heightened prudential requirements for systemically important companies in particular. Such measures could include taxation of financial transactions and restrictions on employee compensation.
The Dodd-Frank Act was enacted on July 21, 2010, mandating changes to the regulation of the financial services industry. Implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act is ongoing and may affect our operations and governance in ways that could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. The Dodd-Frank Act requires central clearing of, and imposes new margin requirements on, certain derivatives transactions, which increases the costs of our hedging program. Other provisions in the Dodd-Frank Act that may impact us include: the “Federal Insurance Office” within Treasury; the possible adverse impact on the pricing and liquidity of the securities in which we invest resulting from the proprietary trading and market making limitation of the Volcker Rule; the possible adverse impact on the market for insurance-linked securities, including catastrophe bonds, resulting from the limitations of banking entity involvement in and ownership of certain asset-backed securities transactions; and enhancements to corporate governance, especially regarding risk management.
The Dodd-Frank Act vests the Financial Stability Oversight Council (“FSOC”) with the power to designate “systemically important” institutions, which are subject to special regulatory supervision and other provisions intended to prevent, or mitigate the impact of, future disruptions in the U.S. financial system. Based on its most current financial data, The Hartford is below the quantitative thresholds used by the FSOC to determine which nonbank companies merit consideration. However, the FSOC has indicated it will review on a quarterly basis whether nonbank financial institutions meet the metrics for further review. If we were to be designated as a systemically important institution, we would be subject to heightened regulation under the Federal Reserve, which could impact requirements regarding our capital, liquidity and leverage as well as our business and investment conduct. In addition, we could be subject to assessments to pay for the orderly liquidation of other systemically important financial institutions that have become insolvent. As a result of these requirements, we could incur substantial costs that would affect our ability to price our products competitively, which may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.

23



We may experience unfavorable judicial or legislative developments involving claim litigation that could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
The Hartford is involved in claims litigation arising in the ordinary course of business, both as a liability insurer defending or providing indemnity for third-party claims brought against insureds and as an insurer defending coverage claims brought against it. The Hartford accounts for such activity through the establishment of unpaid loss and loss adjustment expense reserves. The Company is also involved in legal actions that do not arise in the ordinary course of business, some of which assert claims for substantial amounts. Pervasive or significant changes in the judicial environment relating to matters such as trends in the size of jury awards, developments in the law relating to the liability of insurers or tort defendants, and rulings concerning the availability or amount of certain types of damages could cause our ultimate liabilities to change from our current expectations. Changes in federal or state tort litigation laws or other applicable law could have a similar effect. It is not possible to predict changes in the judicial and legislative environment and their impact on the future development of the adequacy of our loss reserves, particularly reserves for longer-tailed lines of business, including asbestos and environmental reserves, and how those changes might adversely affect our ability to price our products appropriately. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity could also be adversely affected if judicial or legislative developments cause our ultimate liabilities to increase from current expectations.
Potential changes in regulation may increase our business costs and required capital levels, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
We are subject to extensive laws and regulations that are complex, subject to change and often conflicting in their approach or intended outcomes. Compliance with these laws and regulations is costly and can affect our strategy, as well as the demand for and profitability of the products we offer.
State insurance laws regulate most aspects of our insurance businesses, and our insurance subsidiaries are regulated by the insurance departments of the states in which they are domiciled, licensed or authorized to conduct business. These regulatory regimes are generally designed to protect the interests of policyholders rather than insurers, their shareholders and other investors. U.S. state laws grant insurance regulatory authorities broad administrative powers with respect to, among other things, licensing and authorization for lines of business, statutory capital and reserve requirements, limitations on the types and amounts of certain investments, underwriting limitations, transactions with affiliates, dividend limitations, changes in control, premium rates and a variety of other financial and non-financial components of an insurer's business.
In addition, future regulatory initiatives could be adopted at the federal or state level that could impact the profitability of our businesses. For example, the NAIC and state insurance regulators are continually reexamining existing laws and regulations, specifically focusing on modifications to statutory accounting principles, interpretations of existing laws and the development of new laws and regulations. The NAIC continues to enhance the U.S. system of insurance solvency regulation, with a particular focus on group supervision, risk-based capital, accounting and financial reporting, enterprise risk management and reinsurance. Any proposed or future legislation or NAIC initiatives, if adopted, may be more restrictive on our ability to conduct business than current regulatory requirements or may result in higher costs or increased statutory capital and reserve requirements. In addition, the Federal Reserve Board and the International Association of Insurance Supervisors ("IAIS") each have initiatives underway to develop insurance group capital standards. While the Company would not currently be subject to either of these capital standard regimes, it is possible that in the future standards similar to what is being contemplated by the Federal Reserve Board or the IAIS could apply to the Company. The NAIC is in the process of developing a U.S. group capital calculation that will employ a methodology based on aggregated risk-based capital.
Further, because these laws and regulations are complex and sometimes inexact, there is also a risk that our business may not fully comply with a particular regulator's or enforcement authority's interpretation of a legal, accounting, or reserving issue or that such regulator’s or enforcement authority’s interpretation may change over time to our detriment, or expose us to different or additional regulatory risks. The application of these regulations and guidelines by insurers involves interpretations and judgments that may not be consistent with the opinion of state insurance departments. We cannot provide assurance that such differences of opinion will not result in regulatory, tax or other challenges to the actions we have taken to date. The result of those potential challenges could require us to increase levels of statutory capital and reserves or incur higher operating and/or tax costs.
In addition, our international operations are subject to regulation in the relevant jurisdictions in which they operate which in many ways is similar to the state regulation outlined above, with similar related restrictions and obligations. Our asset management businesses are also subject to extensive regulation in the various jurisdictions where they operate.
These laws and regulations are primarily intended to protect investors in the securities markets or investment advisory clients and generally grant supervisory authorities broad administrative powers. Compliance with these laws and regulations is costly, time consuming and personnel intensive, and may have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. See the risk factor, “The impact of regulatory initiatives and legislative developments, including the implementation of The Dodd-Frank Act of 2010, could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.”

24



Changes in federal or state tax laws could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
Changes in federal or state tax laws could have a material adverse effect on our profitability and financial condition, and could result in our incurring materially higher corporate taxes. Higher tax rates may cause the small businesses we insure to hire fewer workers and decrease investment in their businesses, including purchasing vehicles, property and equipment, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. Conversely, if income tax rates decline it could adversely affect the Company's ability to realize the benefits of its deferred tax assets.
In addition, the Company’s tax return reflects certain items, including but not limited to, tax-exempt bond interest, dividends received deductions, tax credits (such as foreign tax credits), and insurance reserve deductions. There is an increasing risk that, in the context of deficit reduction or overall tax reform, federal and/or state tax legislation could modify or eliminate these items, impacting the Company, its investments, investment strategies, and/or its policyholders. Although the specific form of any such legislation is uncertain, changes to the taxation of municipal bond interest could materially and adversely impact the value of those bonds, limit our investment choices and depress portfolio yield. Elimination of the dividends received deduction or changes to the taxation of reserving methodologies for P&C companies could increase the Company’s actual tax rate, thereby reducing earnings. Moreover, many of the products that the Company previously sold benefit from one or more forms of tax-favored status under current federal and state income tax regimes. For example, the Company previously sold annuity contracts that allowed policyholders to defer the recognition of taxable income earned within the contract. Because the Company no longer sells these products, changes in the future taxation of life insurance and/or annuity contracts will not adversely impact future sales. If, however, the treatment of earnings accrued inside an annuity contract was changed prospectively, and the tax-favored status of existing contracts was grandfathered, holders of existing contracts would be less likely to surrender, which would make running off our existing annuity business more difficult.
Regulatory requirements could delay, deter or prevent a takeover attempt that shareholders might consider in their best interests.
Before a person can acquire control of a U.S. insurance company, prior written approval must be obtained from the insurance commissioner of the state where the domestic insurer is domiciled. Prior to granting approval of an application to acquire control of a domestic insurer, the state insurance commissioner will consider such factors as the financial strength of the applicant, the acquirer's plans for the future operations of the domestic insurer, and any such additional information as the insurance commissioner may deem necessary or appropriate for the protection of policyholders or in the public interest. Generally, state statutes provide that control over a domestic insurer is presumed to exist if any person, directly or indirectly, owns, controls, holds with the power to vote, or holds proxies representing 10 percent or more of the voting securities of the domestic insurer or its parent company. Because a person acquiring 10 percent or more of our common stock would indirectly control the same percentage of the stock of our U.S. insurance subsidiaries, the insurance change of control laws of various U.S. jurisdictions would likely apply to such a transaction. Other laws or required approvals pertaining to one or more of our existing subsidiaries, or a future subsidiary, may contain similar or additional restrictions on the acquisition of control of the Company. These laws may discourage potential acquisition proposals and may delay, deter, or prevent a change of control, including transactions that our Board of Directors and some or all of our shareholders might consider to be desirable.
Changes in accounting principles and financial reporting requirements could result in material changes to our reported results of operations and financial condition.
U.S. GAAP and related financial reporting requirements are complex, continually evolving and may be subject to varied interpretation by the relevant authoritative bodies. Such varied interpretations could result from differing views related to specific facts and circumstances. Changes in U.S. GAAP and financial reporting requirements, or in the interpretation of U.S. GAAP or those requirements, could result in material changes to our reported results and financial condition.
Other Strategic and Operational Risks
As our Talcott Resolution business continues to runoff, the Company is exposed to a number of risks related to the runoff business that could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.
Despite being in runoff, Talcott Resolution represents a meaningful share of the Company’s earnings. Talcott Resolution’s revenues and earnings will decline over time as variable and fixed annuity policies lapse. While the Company has been reducing expenses associated with the Talcott Resolution business as the revenues from that business decline, going forward it may become more difficult to reduce expenses, particularly corporate and other enterprise shared services costs, and this could adversely affect the Company’s results of operations going forward. In addition, dividends and distributions from the Company’s life insurance subsidiaries have helped fund a significant portion of share repurchases and pay downs of debt under the Company’s announced capital management program. As the Talcott Resolution earnings decline, there will be less retained earnings in the Company’s Talcott Resolution insurance subsidiaries available to fund capital management actions.

25



Further, while the Company continues to actively consider alternatives for reducing the size and risk of the annuity book of business, opportunities to do so may be limited and any initiatives pursued may not achieve the anticipated benefits and may negatively impact our statutory capital, net income, core earnings or shareholders’ equity. The Company could pursue transactions or other strategic options to reduce the size and risk of Talcott Resolution's annuity book of business which could result in a significant loss to the Company.
The ability to execute on our capital management plan, expense reduction initiatives and other actions, which may include acquisitions, divestitures or restructurings, is subject to material challenges, uncertainties and risks which could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
The ability to execute on our capital management plan remains subject to material challenges, uncertainties and risks. We may not achieve all of the benefits we expect to derive from our plan to repurchase our equity and reduce our debt. Our capital management plan is subject to execution risks, including, among others, risks related to market fluctuations and investor interest and potential legal constraints that could delay execution at an otherwise optimal time. There can be no assurance that we will in fact complete our capital management plan over the planned time frame or at all. Initiatives to reduce expenses so that our ongoing businesses remain or become cost efficient may not be successful and we may not be able to reduce corporate and shared services expenses in the manner and on the schedule we currently anticipate. We may take further actions beyond the capital management plan, which may include acquisitions, divestitures or restructurings, that may involve additional uncertainties and risks that negatively impact our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
If we are unable to maintain the availability of our systems and safeguard the security of our data due to the occurrence of disasters or a cyber or other information security incident, our ability to conduct business may be compromised, we may incur substantial costs and suffer other negative consequences, all of which may have a material adverse effect on our business, reputation, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.
We use technology to process, store, retrieve, evaluate and utilize customer and company data and information. Our information technology and telecommunications systems, in turn, interface with and rely upon third-party systems or maintenance. Our business is highly dependent on our ability, and the ability of certain third parties, to access our systems to perform necessary business functions, including, without limitation, providing insurance quotes, processing premium payments, making changes to existing policies, filing and paying claims, administering variable annuity products and mutual funds, providing customer support, managing our investment portfolios and hedging programs. and conducting our financial reporting and analysis.
Systems failures or outages could compromise our ability to perform our business functions in a timely manner, which could harm our ability to conduct business and hurt our relationships with our business partners and customers. In the event of a disaster such as a natural catastrophe, a pandemic, an industrial accident, a cyber attack, a blackout, a terrorist attack (including conventional, nuclear, biological, chemical or radiological) or war, systems upon which we rely may be inaccessible to our employees, customers or business partners for an extended period of time. Even if our employees and business partners are able to report to work, they may be unable to perform their duties for an extended period of time if our data or systems used to conduct our business are disabled or destroyed.
Our systems have been, and will likely continue to be, subject to viruses or other malicious codes, unauthorized access, cyber-attacks or other computer related penetrations. The frequency and sophistication of such threats continue to increase as well. While, to date, The Hartford is not aware of having experienced a material breach of our cyber security systems, administrative and technical controls as well as other preventive actions we take to reduce the risk of cyber incidents and protect our information technology may be insufficient to prevent physical and electronic break-ins, denial of service, cyber-attacks or other security breaches to our systems or those of third parties with whom we do business. Such an event could compromise our confidential information as well as that of our clients and third parties, with whom we interact, impede or interrupt our business operations and may result in other negative consequences, including remediation costs, loss of revenue, additional regulatory scrutiny and litigation and reputational damage. In addition, we routinely transmit, to third parties personal, confidential and proprietary information, which may be related to employees and customers, by email and other electronic means, along with receiving and storing such information on our systems. Although we attempt to keep such information confidential, we may be unable to utilize such capabilities in all events, especially with clients, vendors, service providers, counterparties and other third parties who may not have or use appropriate controls to protect confidential information.
Furthermore, certain of our businesses are subject to compliance with regulations enacted by U.S. federal and state governments, the European Union or other jurisdictions or enacted by various regulatory organizations or exchanges relating to the privacy of the information of clients, employees or others and, in some cases, specifying required control processes. A misuse or mishandling of confidential or proprietary information being sent to or received from an employee or third party could result in legal liability, regulatory action and reputational harm.

26



Third parties to whom we outsource certain of our functions, including but not limited to third party administrators, are also subject to cyber-breaches of confidential information, along with  the other risks outlined above, any one of which may result in our incurring substantial costs and other negative consequences, including a material adverse effect on our business, reputation, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity. While we maintain cyber liability insurance that provides both third party liability and first party insurance coverages, our insurance may not be sufficient to protect against all loss.
Our framework for managing operational risks may not be effective in mitigating risk and loss to us that could adversely affect our businesses.
Our business performance is highly dependent on our ability to manage operational risks that arise from a large number of day-to-day business activities, including insurance underwriting, claims processing, servicing, investment, financial and tax reporting, compliance with regulatory requirements and other activities, many of which are very complex and for some of which we rely on third parties. In addition, information technology investments we have made or plan to make in order to improve our operations are subject to material challenges, uncertainties and risks which may adversely impact our ability to achieve the intended business growth, expense reduction and operational efficiencies. In particular, a number of the information technology platforms we use to administer and service our business are aging. While we have replaced a number of these systems in recent years, some older information technology platforms remain in place and efforts to replace and modernize them may take longer than expected or may not achieve the intended benefits.
We seek to monitor and control our exposure to operational risks through a risk control framework encompassing a variety of reporting systems, internal controls, management review processes and other mechanisms. We cannot be completely confident that these processes and procedures will effectively control all known risks or effectively identify unforeseen risks, or that our employees and third-party agents will effectively implement them. Management of operational risks can fail for a number of reasons, including design failure, systems failure, failures to perform, cyber security attacks, human error, or unlawful activities on the part of employees or third parties. In the event that our controls are not effective or not properly implemented, we could suffer financial or other loss, disruption of our businesses, regulatory sanctions or damage to our reputation. Losses resulting from these failures can vary significantly in size, scope and scale and may have material adverse effects on our financial condition or results of operations.
If we experience difficulties arising from outsourcing and similar third-party relationships, our ability to conduct business may be compromised, which may have an adverse effect on our business and results of operations.
We outsource certain business and administrative functions and rely on third-party vendors to provide certain services on our behalf. We have also taken action to reduce coordination costs and take advantage of economies of scale by transitioning multiple functions and services to a small number of third-party providers. We periodically negotiate provisions and renewals of these relationships, and there can be no assurance that such terms will remain acceptable to us or such third parties. If our continuing relationship with certain third-party providers, particularly those on which we rely for multiple functions or services, is interrupted, or if such third-party providers experience disruptions or do not perform as anticipated, or we experience problems with a transition, we may experience operational difficulties, an inability to meet obligations (including, but not limited to, policyholder obligations), increased costs and a loss of business that may have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations. For other risks associated with our outsourcing of certain functions, see the risk factor, “If we are unable to maintain the availability of our systems and safeguard the security of our data due to the occurrence of disasters or a cyber or other information security incident, our ability to conduct business may be compromised, we may incur substantial costs and suffer other negative consequences, all of which may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.”

27



We may not be able to protect our intellectual property and may be subject to infringement claims.
We rely on a combination of contractual rights and copyright, trademark, patent and trade secret laws to establish and protect our intellectual property. Although we use a broad range of measures to protect our intellectual property rights, third parties may infringe or misappropriate our intellectual property. We may have to litigate to enforce and protect our copyrights, trademarks, patents, trade secrets and know-how or to determine their scope, validity or enforceability, which represents a diversion of resources that may be significant in amount and may not prove successful. The loss of intellectual property protection or the inability to secure or enforce the protection of our intellectual property assets could have a material adverse effect on our business and our ability to compete. We also may be subject to costly litigation in the event that another party alleges our operations or activities infringe upon their intellectual property rights. Third parties may have, or may eventually be issued, patents that could be infringed by our products, systems, methods, processes or services. Any party that holds such a patent could make a claim of infringement against us. We may be subject to patent claims from certain individuals and companies who have acquired patent portfolios for the sole purpose of asserting such claims against other companies. We may also be subject to claims by third parties for breach of copyright, trademark, patent, trade secret or license usage rights. Any such claims and any resulting litigation could result in significant liability for damages. If we were found to have infringed a third-party patent or other intellectual property rights, we could incur substantial liability, and in some circumstances could be enjoined from providing certain products or services to our customers or utilizing and benefiting from certain methods, processes, systems, copyrights, trademarks, trade secrets or licenses, or alternatively could be required to enter into costly licensing arrangements with third parties, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

28



Item 1B.
UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
None.
Item 2.
PROPERTIES
As of December 31, 2015, The Hartford owned building space of approximately 1.8 million square feet which comprised its Hartford, Connecticut location and other properties within the greater Hartford, Connecticut area. In addition, as of December 31, 2015, The Hartford leased approximately 1.6 million square feet, throughout the United States of America, and approximately 37 thousand square feet, in other countries. All of the properties owned or leased are used by one or more of all six reporting segments, depending on the location. For more information on reporting segments, see Part I, Item 1, Business — Reporting Segments. The Company believes its properties and facilities are suitable and adequate for current operations.

29



Item 3.
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
Litigation
The Hartford is involved in claims litigation arising in the ordinary course of business, both as a liability insurer defending or providing indemnity for third-party claims brought against insureds and as an insurer defending coverage claims brought against it. The Hartford accounts for such activity through the establishment of unpaid loss and loss adjustment expense reserves. Subject to the uncertainties in the following discussion under the caption “Asbestos and Environmental Claims,” management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such ordinary-course claims litigation, after consideration of provisions made for potential losses and costs of defense, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flows of The Hartford.
The Hartford is also involved in other kinds of legal actions, some of which assert claims for substantial amounts. These actions include, among others, and in addition to the matters in the following description, putative state and federal class actions seeking certification of a state or national class. Such putative class actions have alleged, for example, underpayment of claims or improper underwriting practices in connection with various kinds of insurance policies, such as personal and commercial automobile, property, disability, life and inland marine. The Hartford also is involved in individual actions in which punitive damages are sought, such as claims alleging bad faith in the handling of insurance claims or other allegedly unfair improper business practices. Like many other insurers, The Hartford also has been joined in actions by asbestos plaintiffs asserting, among other things, that insurers had a duty to protect the public from the dangers of asbestos and that insurers committed unfair trade practices by asserting defenses on behalf of their policyholders in the underlying asbestos cases. Management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such lawsuits, after consideration of provisions made for estimated losses, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition of The Hartford. Nonetheless, given the large or indeterminate amounts sought in certain of these actions, and the inherent unpredictability of litigation, the outcome in certain matters could, from time to time, have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations or cash flows in particular quarterly or annual periods.
In addition to the inherent difficulty of predicting litigation outcomes, the Mutual Funds Litigation identified below purports to seek substantial damages for unsubstantiated conduct spanning a multi-year period based on novel applications of complex legal theories. The alleged damages are not quantified or factually supported in the complaint, and, in any event, the Company's experience shows that demands for damages often bear little relation to a reasonable estimate of potential loss. The court has made no substantive legal decisions defining the scope of the claims or the potentially available damages, and no legal precedent has been identified that would aid in determining a reasonable estimate of potential loss. Accordingly, management cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss or range of loss, if any.
Mutual Funds Litigation - In February 2011, a derivative action was brought on behalf of six Hartford retail mutual funds in the United States District Court for the District of New Jersey, alleging that Hartford Investment Financial Services, LLC (“HIFSCO”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company, received excessive advisory and distribution fees in violation of its statutory fiduciary duty under Section 36(b) of the Investment Company Act of 1940. HIFSCO moved to dismiss and, in September 2011, the motion was granted in part and denied in part, with leave to amend the complaint. In November 2011, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint on behalf of The Hartford Global Health Fund, The Hartford Conservative Allocation Fund, The Hartford Growth Opportunities Fund, The Hartford Inflation Plus Fund, The Hartford Advisors Fund, and The Hartford Capital Appreciation Fund. Plaintiffs seek to rescind the investment management agreements and distribution plans between HIFSCO and these funds and to recover the total fees charged thereunder or, in the alternative, to recover any improper compensation HIFSCO received, in addition to lost earnings. HIFSCO filed a partial motion to dismiss the amended complaint and, in December 2012, the court dismissed without prejudice the claims regarding distribution fees and denied the motion with respect to the advisory fees claims. In March 2014, the plaintiffs filed a new complaint that, among other things, added as new plaintiffs The Hartford Floating Rate Fund and The Hartford Small Company Fund and named as a defendant Hartford Funds Management Company, LLC (“HFMC”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company which assumed the role as advisor to the funds as of January 2013. In March 2015, the plaintiffs filed a new complaint that, among other things, removed The Hartford Small Company Fund as a plaintiff. HFMC and HIFSCO dispute the allegations and moved for summary judgment in June 2015. At the same time, plaintiffs moved for partial summary judgment with respect to The Hartford Capital Appreciation Fund.
Asbestos and Environmental Claims - As discussed in Part II, Item 7, MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates - Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance - Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims, The Hartford continues to receive asbestos and environmental claims that involve significant uncertainty regarding policy coverage issues. Regarding these claims, The Hartford continually reviews its overall reserve levels and reinsurance coverages, as well as the methodologies it uses to estimate its exposures. Because of the significant uncertainties that limit the ability of insurers and reinsurers to estimate the ultimate reserves necessary for unpaid losses and related expenses, particularly those related to asbestos, the ultimate liabilities may exceed the currently recorded reserves. Any such additional liability cannot be reasonably estimated now but could be material to The Hartford's consolidated operating results and liquidity.
Item 4.
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
Not applicable.

30



PART II
Item 5.
MARKET FOR THE HARTFORD’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
The Hartford’s common stock is traded on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) under the trading symbol “HIG”.
The following table presents the high and low closing prices for the common stock of The Hartford on the NYSE for the periods indicated, and the quarterly dividends declared per share.
 
1st Qtr.
2nd Qtr.
3rd Qtr.
4th Qtr.
2015
 
 
 
 
Common Stock Price
 
 
 
 
High
$
43.10

$
42.86

$
49.53

$
49.24

Low
$
38.90

$
40.77

$
43.03

$
42.11

Dividends Declared
$
0.18

$
0.18

$
0.21

$
0.21

2014
 
 
 
 
Common Stock Price
 
 
 
 
High
$
36.14

$
36.37

$
37.80

$
42.27

Low
$
32.18

$
33.30

$
33.85

$
35.47

Dividends Declared
$
0.15

$
0.15

$
0.18

$
0.18

On February 25, 2016, The Hartford’s Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend of $0.21 per common share payable on April 1, 2016 to common shareholders of record as of March 7, 2016. As of February 24, 2016, the Company had approximately 13,471 registered holders of record of the Company's common stock. A substantially greater number of holders of our common stock are “street name” holders or beneficial holders, whose shares are held of record by banks, brokers and other financial institutions. The closing price of The Hartford’s common stock on the NYSE on February 24, 2016 was $41.90.
On June 15, 2015, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer certified to the NYSE that he is not aware of any violation by the Company of NYSE corporate governance listing standards, as required by Section 303A.12(a) of the NYSE’s Listed Company Manual.
There are also various legal and regulatory limitations governing the extent to which The Hartford’s insurance subsidiaries may extend credit, pay dividends or otherwise provide funds to The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. as discussed in Part II, Item 7, MD&A — Capital Resources and Liquidity — Liquidity Requirements and Sources of Capital.
For information related to securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans, see Part III, Item 12, Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters,
Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer
The following table summarizes the Company’s repurchases of its common stock for the three months ended December 31, 2015:
Period
Total Number of Shares Purchased
Average
Price Paid per Share
Total Number of Shares Purchased as Part of Publicly Announced Plans or Programs
Approximate Dollar Value of Shares that May Yet Be Purchased Under the Plans or Programs [1]
 
 
 
 
(in millions)
October 1, 2015 – October 31, 2015
2,837,050

$
46.92

2,837,050
$
1,647

November 1, 2015 – November 30, 2015
3,286,572

$
46.23

3,286,572
$
1,495

December 1, 2015 – December 31, 2015
3,682,862

$
44.81

3,682,862
$
1,330

Total
9,806,484

$
45.90

9,806,484
 
[1]
In July 2015, the Board of Directors approved an increase in the Company's authorized equity repurchase program that provides the Company with the ability to repurchase $4.375 billion in equity during the period commencing on January 1, 2014 and ending on December 31, 2016. The Company’s repurchase authorization permits purchases of common stock, as well as warrants or other derivative securities. Repurchases may be made in the open market, through derivative, accelerated share repurchase and other privately negotiated transactions, and through plans designed to comply with Rule 10b5-1(c) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. The timing of any future repurchases will be dependent upon several factors, including the market price of the Company’s securities, the Company’s capital position, consideration of the effect of any repurchases on the Company’s financial strength or credit ratings, and other corporate considerations. The repurchase program may be modified, extended or terminated by the Board of Directors at any time.

31



Total Return to Shareholders
The following tables present The Hartford’s annual percentage return and five-year total return on its common stock including reinvestment of dividends in comparison to the S&P 500 and the S&P Insurance Composite Index.
Annual Return Percentage
 
For the years ended
Company/Index
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.
(37.55
)%
41.01
%
64.12
%
17.13
%
6.12
%
S&P 500 Index
2.11
 %
16.00
%
32.39
%
13.69
%
1.38
%
S&P Insurance Composite Index
(8.28
)%
19.09
%
46.71
%
8.29
%
2.33
%
Cumulative Five-Year Total Return
 
Base
 
 
Period
For the years ended
Company/Index
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.
$
100

62.45

88.07

144.54

169.30

179.66

S&P 500 Index
$
100

102.11

118.45

156.82

178.29

180.75

S&P Insurance Composite Index
$
100

91.72

109.23

160.25

173.53

177.57


32



Item 6.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
(Dollar amounts in millions, except for per share data)
The following table sets forth the Company's selected consolidated financial data at the dates and for the periods indicated below. The selected financial data should be read in conjunction with Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ("MD&A") presented in Item 7 and the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements and the related Notes beginning on page F-1.
 
2015
2014
2013
2012
2011
Income Statement Data
 
 
 
 
 
Total revenues
$
18,377

$
18,614

$
20,673

$
22,086

$
21,667

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes
1,978

1,699

1,471

(89
)
(293
)
Income from continuing operations, net of tax
1,673

1,349

1,225

220

256

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
9

(551
)
(1,049
)
(258
)
456

Net income (loss)
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

$
(38
)
$
712

Balance Sheet Data
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
228,348

$
245,013

$
277,884

$
298,513

$
302,609

Short-term debt
$
275

$
456

$
438

$
320

$

Total debt (including capital lease obligations)
$
5,359

$
6,109

$
6,544

$
7,126

$
6,216

Preferred stock
$

$

$

$
556

$
556

Total stockholders’ equity
$
17,642

$
18,720

$
18,905

$
22,447

$
21,486

Net income (loss) available to common shareholders per common share
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
4.05

$
1.81

$
0.37

$
(0.18
)
$
1.51

Diluted
$
3.96

$
1.73

$
0.36

$
(0.17
)
$
1.40

Cash dividends declared per common share
$
0.78

$
0.66

$
0.50

$
0.40

$
0.40



33



Item 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
(Dollar amounts in millions, except for per share data, unless otherwise stated)
The Hartford provides projections and other forward-looking information in the following discussions, which contain many forward-looking statements, particularly relating to the Company’s future financial performance. These forward-looking statements are estimates based on information currently available to the Company, are made pursuant to the safe harbor provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 and are subject to the cautionary statements set forth on pages 3 and 4 of this Form 10-K. Actual results are likely to differ, and in the past have differed, materially from those forecast by the Company, depending on the outcome of various factors, including, but not limited to, those set forth in each following discussion and in Part I, Item 1A, Risk Factors. The Hartford undertakes no obligation to publicly update any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise.
The Hartford defines increases or decreases greater than or equal to 200% as “NM” or not meaningful.
INDEX
Description
Page
The Hartford's Operations
Consolidated Results of Operations
Investment Results
Critical Accounting Estimates
Key Performance Measures and Ratios
Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Group Benefits
Talcott Resolution

34



THE HARTFORD’S OPERATIONS
Overview
The Hartford conducts business principally in six reporting segments including Commercial Lines, Personal Lines, Property & Casualty Other Operations, Group Benefits, Mutual Funds and Talcott Resolution, as well as a Corporate category. The Hartford includes in its Corporate category the Company’s capital raising activities (including debt financing and related interest expense), purchase accounting adjustments related to goodwill and other expenses not allocated to the reporting segments.
On June 30, 2014, the Company completed the sale of all of the issued and outstanding equity of Hartford Life Insurance KK, a Japanese company ("HLIKK") to ORIX Life Insurance Corporation, a subsidiary of ORIX Corporation, a Japanese company. HLIKK sold variable and fixed annuity policies in Japan from 2001 to 2009 and had been in runoff since 2009.
On December 12, 2013, the Company completed the sale of Hartford Life International Limited ("HLIL"), which comprised the Company's U.K. variable annuity business, to Columbia Insurance Company, a Berkshire Hathaway company. On January 1, 2013, the Company completed the sale of its Retirement Plans business to Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Company ("MassMutual") and on January 2, 2013, the Company completed the sale of its Individual Life insurance business to The Prudential Insurance Company of America ("Prudential"), a subsidiary of Prudential Financial, Inc.
For further discussion of these transactions, see Note 5 - Reinsurance and Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. The businesses reinsured to MassMutual and Prudential are included in the Talcott Resolution reporting segment.
The Company derives its revenues principally from: (a) premiums earned for insurance coverage; (b) fee income, including asset management fees, on separate account and mutual fund assets and mortality and expense fees, as well as cost of insurance charges; (c) net investment income; (d) fees earned for services provided to third parties; and (e) net realized capital gains and losses. Premiums charged for insurance coverage are earned principally on a pro rata basis over the terms of the related policies in-force. Asset management fees and mortality and expense fees are primarily generated from separate account assets. Cost of insurance charges are assessed on the net amount at risk for investment-oriented life insurance products.
The profitability of the Company's property and casualty insurance businesses over time is greatly influenced by the Company’s underwriting discipline, which seeks to manage exposure to loss through favorable risk selection and diversification, its management of claims, its use of reinsurance, the size of its in force block, actual mortality and morbidity experience, and its ability to manage its expense ratio which it accomplishes through economies of scale and its management of acquisition costs and other underwriting expenses. Pricing adequacy depends on a number of factors, including the ability to obtain regulatory approval for rate changes, proper evaluation of underwriting risks, the ability to project future loss cost frequency and severity based on historical loss experience adjusted for known trends, the Company’s response to rate actions taken by competitors, its expense levels and expectations about regulatory and legal developments. The Company seeks to price its insurance policies such that insurance premiums and future net investment income earned on premiums received will cover underwriting expenses and the ultimate cost of paying claims reported on the policies and provide for a profit margin. For many of its insurance products, the Company is required to obtain approval for its premium rates from state insurance departments.
The financial results in the Company’s mutual fund and variable annuity businesses depend largely on the amount of the contract holder or shareholder account value or assets under management on which it earns fees and the level of fees charged. Changes in account value or assets under management are driven by two main factors: net flows, and the market return of the funds, which is heavily influenced by the return realized in the equity markets. Net flows are comprised of deposits less withdrawals and surrenders, redemptions, death benefits, policy charges and annuitizations of investment type contracts, such as variable annuity contracts. In the mutual fund business, net flows are known as net sales. Net sales are comprised of new sales less redemptions by mutual fund customers. The Company uses the average daily value of the S&P 500 Index as an indicator for evaluating market returns of the underlying account portfolios. Financial results of variable products are highly correlated to the growth in account values or assets under management since these products generally earn fee income on a daily basis. Equity market movements could also result in benefits for or charges against deferred acquisition costs.
The profitability of fixed annuities and other “spread-based” products depends largely on the Company’s ability to earn target spreads between earned investment rates on its general account assets and interest credited to policyholders.
The investment return, or yield, on invested assets is an important element of the Company’s earnings since insurance products are priced with the assumption that premiums received can be invested for a period of time before benefits, loss and loss adjustment expenses are paid. Due to the need to maintain sufficient liquidity to satisfy claim obligations, the majority of the Company’s invested assets have been held in available-for-sale securities, including, among other asset classes, equities, corporate bonds, municipal bonds, government debt, short-term debt, mortgage-backed securities and asset-backed securities and collateralized debt obligations.

35



The primary investment objective for the Company is to maximize economic value, consistent with acceptable risk parameters, including the management of credit risk and interest rate sensitivity of invested assets, while generating sufficient after-tax income to meet policyholder and corporate obligations. Investment strategies are developed based on a variety of factors including business needs, regulatory requirements and tax considerations.
For more information on the Company's reporting segments, refer to Part I, Item 1, Business — Reporting Segments.
Financial Highlights for the Year Ended December 31, 2015
Net income was $1,682, or $3.96 per diluted share, compared with net income of $798, or $1.73 per diluted share, in the prior year.
Common share repurchases totaled $1,250, or approximately 28.4 million shares for the year.
Book value per diluted common share (excluding AOCI) increased to $43.76 from $40.71 as of the prior year end due to the effect of net income less dividends and the effect of share repurchases for the year.
Net investment income decreased 3.9% to $3,030 compared to the prior year primarily due to a decrease in income from limited partnerships and other alternative investments and the effect of the runoff of Talcott Resolution.
Annualized investment yield after-tax was 3.0% in 2015, consistent with 2014. New money yield of 3.4% in 2015 decreased from 3.6%, in the prior year, primarily due to lower interest rates.
Net unrealized gains, after-tax, in the investment portfolio declined by $1,091 compared to the prior year due primarily to wider credit spreads and increased interest rates.
Property & Casualty written premium increased 3% over the prior year, comprised of 4% growth in Commercial Lines and 1% in Personal Lines.
Property & Casualty combined ratio, before catastrophes and prior year development, improved to 91.0 from 91.5 in the prior year, with improvement in Commercial Lines partially offset by deterioration in Personal Lines.
Catastrophe losses of $332, before tax, decreased from catastrophe losses of $341, before tax, in the prior year.
Unfavorable prior accident year development, driven primarily by asbestos and environmental reserves, totaled $250, before tax, compared with unfavorable prior year development of $228 before tax, in the prior year.
Group Benefits core earnings margin increased to 5.6% from 5.2% in the prior year.
Talcott Resolution after-tax income from continuing operations was $428, compared with $370 in the prior year.

36



CONSOLIDATED RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
The Consolidated Results of Operations should be read in conjunction with the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements and the related Notes beginning on page F-1.
 
2015
2014
2013
Increase
(Decrease) From 2014 to 2015
Increase
(Decrease) From 2013 to 2014
Earned premiums
$
13,577

$
13,336

$
13,231

$241
$105
Fee income
1,839

1,996

2,105

(157)
(109)
Net investment income
3,030

3,154

3,264

(124)
(110)
Net realized capital gains (losses) [1]
(156
)
16

1,798

(172)
(1,782)
Other revenues
87

112

275

(25)
(163)
Total revenues
18,377

18,614

20,673

(237)
(2,059)
Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
10,775

10,805

11,048

(30)
(243)
Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs
1,502

1,729

1,794

(227)
(65)
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
3,772

4,028

4,176

(256)
(148)
Loss on extinguishment of debt
21


213

21
(213)
Reinsurance (gain) loss on disposition
(28
)
(23
)
1,574

(5)
(1,597)
Interest expense
357

376

397

(19)
(21)
Total benefits, losses and expenses
16,399

16,915

19,202

(516)
(2,287)
Income from continuing operations before income taxes
1,978

1,699

1,471

279
228
Income tax expense
305

350

246

(45)
104
Income from continuing operations, net of tax
1,673

1,349

1,225

324
124
Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
9

(551
)
(1,049
)
560
498
Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

$884
$622
[1]
Includes net realized capital gains in 2013 of $1,575 on investments transferred at fair value in business disposition by reinsurance.
Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
The increase in net income from 2014 to 2015 was primarily due to the net effect of the following items:
A decrease in the loss from discontinued operations of $560, net of tax, compared to 2014 pertains primarily to the realized capital loss of $659 on the sale of the Japan variable annuity business in 2014.
A decrease of $157, before tax, in fee income was primarily due to the continued runoff of the Talcott Resolution annuity business.
Net realized capital losses of $156, before tax, in 2015, largely driven by results of the variable annuity hedge program compared to net realized capital gains of $16, before tax, in 2014.
Net investment income of $3,030, before tax, in 2015 decreased from $3,154, before tax, in 2014, primarily due to lower income from limited partnerships and other alternative investments and the continued decline in Talcott Resolution assets under management. For further discussion of investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss).
An $80, before tax, improvement in current accident year underwriting results before catastrophes in Property & Casualty resulting from a 1.1 point decrease in the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes and prior accident year development and an increase in earned premium. The increase in earned premiums of 3% or $320, before tax, in 2015, compared to 2014, reflected earned premium growth of 4% in Commercial Lines and 2% in Personal Lines. For a discussion of the Company's operating results by segment, see the segment sections of MD&A.
Unfavorable prior accident year reserve development in Property & Casualty of $250, before tax, in 2015, compared to unfavorable reserve development of $228, before tax, in 2014. Prior accident year reserve development in 2015 was primarily due to an increase in reserves for asbestos and environmental claims, in part, due to a small percentage of direct accounts having experienced greater than expected claim filings, including mesothelioma claims. Prior accident year reserve development in 2014 was primarily due to an increase in reserves for asbestos and environmental claims, primarily due to a higher than previously estimated number of mesothelioma claim filings and an increase in costs associated with asbestos litigation.
A loss on extinguishment of debt of $21, before tax, in 2015 related to the redemption of $296 aggregate principal amount of outstanding 4.0% senior notes. The resulting loss on extinguishment of debt consists of a make-whole premium.

37



A $227, before tax, decrease in DAC amortization driven, in part, by a favorable unlock in Talcott Resolution in 2015, compared to unfavorable in 2014.
Pension settlement charge of $128, before tax, in 2014, within insurance operating costs and other expenses, related to voluntary lump-sum settlements with vested participants in the Company's defined benefit pension plan who had separated from service, but who had not yet commenced annuity benefits.
Differences between the Company's effective income tax rate and the U.S. statutory rate of 35% are due primarily to tax-exempt interest earned on invested assets and the dividends received deduction ("DRD"). Income tax expense in 2015, decreased by $45 from $350 in 2014, primarily due to a federal income tax benefit of $36, related to the release of reserves due to the resolution of uncertain tax positions and a benefit of $94 from the partial reduction of the deferred tax valuation allowance on the capital loss carryover due to taxable gains on the termination of certain derivatives, partially offset by the effect of higher income from continuing operations, before tax. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
The increase in net income from 2013 to 2014 was primarily due to the net effect of the following items:
A decrease in the loss from discontinued operations to $551, net of tax, compared to $1,049, net of tax, in 2013. The loss from discontinued operations in 2014 includes the results of operations and the realized capital loss on the sale of HLIKK. The loss from discontinued operations in 2013 includes the results of operations of HLIKK and U.K. annuity businesses and the realized capital loss on the sale of HLIL. The results of operations for HLIKK annuity business in 2013 include the write-off of DAC and higher hedging losses. For further discussion of the sale of these businesses, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
A $299 before tax improvement in current accident year underwriting results before catastrophes in Property & Casualty resulting in a 2.9 point decrease in the combined ratio before catastrophes and prior accident year development. Also contributing to the improvement in underwriting results was an increase in earned premiums of 2% or $232, before tax, in 2014, compared to 2013, reflecting earned premium growth of 1% in Commercial Lines and 4% in Personal Lines.
A loss on extinguishment of debt of $213, before tax, in 2013 related to the repurchase of approximately $800 of senior notes at a premium to the face amount of the then outstanding debt. The resulting loss on extinguishment of debt consists of the repurchase premium, the write-off of the unamortized discount and debt issuance and other costs related to the repurchase transaction.
Pension settlement charge of $128, before tax, in 2014, in insurance operating costs and other expenses, related to voluntary lump-sum settlements with vested participants in the Company's defined benefit pension plan who had separated from service, but who had not yet commenced annuity benefits. For additional information, see MD&A - Capital Resources and Liquidity, Pension Plans and Other Postretirement Benefits.
Net investment income of $3,154, before tax, in 2014, decreased from $3,264, before tax, in 2013. The decrease in net investment income is primarily due to lower income from fixed maturities, as a result of a decline in asset levels, primarily in Talcott Resolution, lower income from repurchase agreements, and the impact of reinvesting at lower interest rates.
Current accident year catastrophe losses in Property & Casualty of $341, before tax, in 2014, compared to $312, before tax, in 2013. The increase in current accident year catastrophe losses was primarily due to increased frequency and severity from wind and hail events across various U.S. geographic regions.
Unfavorable prior accident year reserve development in Property & Casualty of $228, before tax, in 2014, compared to unfavorable reserve development of $192, before tax, in 2013. Unfavorable prior accident year reserve development in 2014 was primarily related to an increase in reserves for asbestos and environmental claims, primarily due to a higher than previously estimated number of mesothelioma claim filings and an increase in costs associated with asbestos litigation. Unfavorable prior accident year reserve development in 2013 was primarily related to an increase in net asbestos reserves due to higher claim frequency and severity, as well as costs and expenses associated with litigating asbestos coverage matters.
Differences between the Company's effective income tax rate and the U.S. statutory rate of 35% are due primarily to tax-exempt interest earned on invested assets and the dividends received deduction ("DRD"). The $104 increase in income tax expense in 2014 compared with 2013 was primarily due to the $228 increase in income from continuing operations, before tax. Income tax expense of $350 and $246 in 2014 and 2013, respectively, includes separate account DRD benefits of $114 and $139, respectively.

38



The following table presents net income (loss) for each reporting segment, as well as the Corporate category. For a discussion of the Company's operating results by segment, see the segment sections of MD&A.
Net Income (Loss) by Segment
2015
2014
2013
Increase (Decrease) From 2014 to 2015
Increase (Decrease) From 2013 to 2014
Commercial Lines
$
1,003

$
983

$
870

$
20

$
113

Personal Lines
187

207

229

(20
)
(22
)
Property & Casualty Other Operations
(53
)
(108
)
(2
)
55

(106
)
Group Benefits
187

191

192

(4
)
(1
)
Mutual Funds
86

87

76

(1
)
11

Talcott Resolution
430

(187
)
(634
)
617

447

Corporate
(158
)
(375
)
(555
)
217

180

Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

$
884

$
622

Investment Results
Composition of Invested Assets
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Amount
Percent
Amount
Percent
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale ("AFS"), at fair value
$
59,196

81.4
%
$
59,384

77.9
%
Fixed maturities, at fair value using the fair value option ("FVO")
503

0.7
%
488

0.6
%
Equity securities, AFS, at fair value [1]
1,121

1.5
%
1,047

1.4
%
Mortgage loans
5,624

7.7
%
5,556

7.3
%
Policy loans, at outstanding balance
1,447

2.0
%
1,431

1.9
%
Limited partnerships and other alternative investments
2,874

4.0
%
2,942

3.9
%
Other investments [2]
120

0.2
%
547

0.7
%
Short-term investments
1,843

2.5
%
4,883

6.4
%
Total investments
$
72,728

100
%
$
76,278

100
%
[1]
Includes equity securities at fair value using the FVO of $282 and $348 as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
[2]
Primarily relates to derivative instruments.
Total investments decreased since December 31, 2014, primarily due to a decrease in short-term investments as well as a decrease in other investments and fixed maturities, AFS. The decrease in short-term investments was primarily the result of the continued run-off of Talcott Resolution, the use of assets for share repurchases and debt repayment, and the reinvestment of short-term investments into longer dated fixed maturities. The decrease in other investments was primarily due to a decline in derivatives resulting from termination of open positions and an increase in interest rates. The decrease in fixed maturities, AFS was due to a decrease in valuations as a result of widening credit spreads and an increase in interest rates, which more than offset the reinvestment of short-term investments.

39



Net Investment Income (Loss)
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
(Before tax)
Amount
Yield [1]
Amount
Yield [1]
Amount
Yield [1]
Fixed maturities [2]
$
2,409

4.2
%
$
2,420

4.2
%
$
2,552

4.3
%
Equity securities
25

2.4
%
38

4.8
%
30

3.6
%
Mortgage loans
267

4.7
%
265

4.7
%
260

4.9
%
Policy loans
82

5.7
%
80

5.6
%
83

5.9
%
Limited partnerships and other alternative investments
227

8.0
%
294

10.4
%
287

9.5
%
Other [3]
138

 
179

 
167

 
Investment expense
(118
)
 
(122
)
 
(115
)
 
Total net investment income
$
3,030

4.3
%
$
3,154

4.4
%
$
3,264

4.4
%
Total net investment income excluding limited partnerships and other alternative investments
2,803

4.1
%
2,860

4.1
%
2,977

4.2
%
[1]
Yields calculated using annualized net investment income divided by the monthly average invested assets at cost, amortized cost, or adjusted carrying value, as applicable, excluding repurchase agreement and securities lending collateral , if any, and derivatives book value. Yield calculations for each period exclude assets associated with the disposition of the Japan annuities business, as applicable.
[2]
Includes net investment income on short-term investments.
[3]
Primarily includes income from derivatives that qualify for hedge accounting and hedge fixed maturities.
Year ended December 31, 2015, compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Total net investment income decreased primarily due to a decrease in income from limited partnerships and other alternative investments. Other factors contributing to the decline in net investment income were reinvesting at lower interest rates and a decrease in invested asset levels, partially offset by make-whole payments on fixed maturities, higher income received from previously impaired securities, and prepayment penalties on mortgage loans.
The annualized net investment income yield, excluding limited partnerships and other alternative investments, was 4.1% in 2015, consistent with 2014. Excluding make-whole payments on fixed maturities, income received from previously impaired securities, and prepayment penalties on mortgage loans, the annualized investment income yield, excluding limited partnerships and other alternative investments, was 4.0% in 2015, down from 4.1% in 2014.
The new money yield excluding certain U.S. Treasury securities and cash equivalent securities, for the year ended December 31, 2015, was approximately 3.4% which was below the average yield of sales and maturities of 3.8% for the same period due to the current interest rate environment. For the year ended December 31, 2015, the new money yield of 3.4% decreased slightly from 3.6% in 2014, largely due to lower interest rates.
Going forward, if interest rates continue to stay at current levels, we expect the annualized net investment income yield, excluding limited partnerships and other alternative investments, to decline from the current net investment income yield due to lower reinvestment rates. The estimated impact on net investment income is subject to change as the composition of the portfolio changes through portfolio management and trading activities and changes in market conditions.
Year ended December 31, 2014, compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
Total net investment income decreased primarily due to a decrease in income from fixed maturities as a result of a decline in asset levels, lower income from repurchase agreements, and the impact of reinvesting at lower interest rates. The annualized net investment income yield, excluding limited partnerships and other alternative investments, declined to 4.1% in 2014 versus 4.2% in 2013. The decline was primarily attributable to lower income from repurchase agreements and lower reinvestment rates.

40



Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses)
 
For the years ended December 31,
(Before tax)
2015
2014
2013
Gross gains on sales [1]
$
460

$
527

$
2,313

Gross losses on sales
(405
)
(250
)
(659
)
Net other-than-temporary impairment ("OTTI") losses recognized in earnings
(102
)
(59
)
(73
)
Valuation allowances on mortgage loans
(5
)
(4
)
(1
)
Periodic net coupon settlements on credit derivatives
11

1

(8
)
Results of variable annuity hedge program
 
 


GMWB derivatives, net
(87
)
5

262

Macro hedge program
(46
)
(11
)
(234
)
Total results of variable annuity hedge program
(133
)
(6
)
28

Other, net [2]
18

(193
)
198

Net realized capital gains (losses)
$
(156
)
$
16

$
1,798

[1]
Includes $1.5 billion of gains relating to the sales of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses in the year ended December 31, 2013.
[2]
Primarily consists of changes in value of non-qualifying derivatives, including credit derivatives, interest rate derivatives used to manage duration, and the yen denominated fixed payout annuity hedge.
Details on the Company’s net realized capital gains and losses are as follows:
Gross Gains and Losses on Sales
Gross gains on sales for the year ended December 31, 2015, were primarily due to gains on the sale of corporate, U.S. treasury, and equity securities. Gross losses on sales for the year ended December 31, 2015, were primarily the result of losses on the sale of corporate, equity and U.S. treasury securities. The sales were primarily a result of duration, liquidity and credit management, as well as tactical changes to the portfolio as a result of changing market conditions, including sales to reduce exposure to energy, emerging markets and other below investment grade corporate securities.
Gross gains on sales for the year ended December 31, 2014, were primarily due to gains on the sale of corporate securities, CMBS, RMBS, and municipal securities. Gross losses on sales for the year ended December 31, 2014, were primarily the result of losses on the sale of corporate and foreign government and government agency securities, which included sales resulting from a reduction in our exposure to the emerging market and energy sector securities as well as other portfolio management activities. The sales were primarily a result of duration, liquidity and credit management, as well as tactical changes to the portfolio as a result of changing market conditions.
Gross gains on sales for the year ended December 31, 2013, were predominately from the sale of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses resulting in a gain of $1.5 billion. The remaining gains on sales were primarily due to the sales of corporate securities and tax-exempt municipals. Gross losses on sales were primarily the result of the sales of U.S. Treasuries and mortgage backed securities, predominantly due to duration, liquidity and credit management as well as progress towards sector allocation objectives.
Net OTTI Losses
See Other-Than-Temporary Impairments within the Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management section of the MD&A.
Valuation Allowances on Mortgage Loans
See Valuation Allowances on Mortgage Loans within the Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management section of the MD&A.
Variable Annuity Hedge Program
For the year ended December 31, 2015, the loss related to the combined GMWB derivatives, net, which include the GMWB product, reinsurance, and hedging derivatives, was primarily driven by losses of $42 due to liability/model assumption updates, and losses of $18 resulting from an underperformance of the underlying actively managed funds compared to their respective indices. The loss on the macro hedge program for the year ended December 31, 2015 was primarily due to a loss of $44 driven by time decay on options.

41



For the year ended December 31, 2014, the gain related to the combined GMWB derivatives, net, which include the GMWB product, reinsurance, and hedging derivatives, was primarily driven by gains of $25 on liability/model assumption updates and gains of $15 due to increased volatility, partially offset by a loss of $26 resulting from policyholder behavior primarily related to increased surrenders. The loss on the macro hedge program for the year ended December 31, 2014 was primarily due to a loss of $25 driven by an improvement in the domestic equity markets, partially offset by a gain of $17 related to a decrease in interest rates.
For the year ended December 31, 2013 the gain on GMWB related derivatives, net, was primarily related to gains of $203 from revaluing the liability for living benefits largely driven by favorable policyholder behavior related to increased surrenders and gains of $38 due to liability assumption updates for lapses and withdrawal rates. The loss on the macro hedge program for the year ended December 31, 2013 was primarily driven by losses of $114 due to an improvement in domestic equity markets, losses of $56 related to an increase in interest rates, and losses of $31 related to a decrease in equity market volatility.
Other, net
Other, net gain for the year ended December 31, 2015 was primarily related to gains of $46 related to modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts, primarily driven by widening credit spreads and an increase in interest rates. Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts are accounted for as embedded derivatives and transfer to the reinsurer the investment experience related to the assets supporting the reinsured policies. Also included were gains of $15 on currency derivatives primarily driven by appreciation of the British pound in comparison to the U.S. dollar. These gains were partially offset by losses of $16 related to fixed payout annuity hedges primarily driven by an increase in U.S. interest rates, losses of $14 on credit derivatives driven by widening credit spreads, and losses of $12 on interest rate derivatives due to an increase in interest rates.
Other, net loss for the year ended December 31, 2014 was primarily related to a loss of $172 on interest rate derivatives used to manage the risk of a rise in interest rates and manage duration, driven by a decline in U.S. interest rates.
Other, net gain for the year ended December 31, 2013 was primarily related to gains of $71 on interest rate derivatives primarily associated with fixed rate bonds sold as part of the Individual Life and Retirement Plan business dispositions. For further information on the business dispositions, see Note 18 of Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements. Additional gains included $69 on interest rate derivatives primarily due to an increase in U.S. interest rates and $42 of gains on credit derivatives due to credit spreads tightening.

42



CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES
The preparation of financial statements, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”), requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ, and in the past have differed, from those estimates.
The Company has identified the following estimates as critical in that they involve a higher degree of judgment and are subject to a significant degree of variability:
property and casualty insurance product reserves, net of reinsurance;
estimated gross profits used in the valuation and amortization of assets and liabilities associated with variable annuity and other universal life-type contracts;
evaluation of other-than-temporary impairments on available-for-sale securities and valuation allowances on mortgage loans;
living benefits required to be fair valued (in other policyholder funds and benefits payable);
evaluation of goodwill for impairment;
valuation of investments and derivative instruments;
valuation allowance on deferred tax assets; and
contingencies relating to corporate litigation and regulatory matters.
Certain of these estimates are particularly sensitive to market conditions, and deterioration and/or volatility in the worldwide debt or equity markets could have a material impact on the Consolidated Financial Statements. In developing these estimates management makes subjective and complex judgments that are inherently uncertain and subject to material change as facts and circumstances develop. Although variability is inherent in these estimates, management believes the amounts provided are appropriate based upon the facts available upon compilation of the financial statements.
Property & Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance
The Hartford establishes reserves on its property and casualty insurance products to provide for the estimated costs of paying claims under insurance policies written by the Company. These reserves include estimates for both claims that have been reported and those that have not yet been reported, and include estimates of all expenses associated with processing and settling these claims. Incurred but not reported (“IBNR”) reserves represent the difference between the estimated ultimate cost of all claims and the actual reported loss and loss adjustment expenses (“reported losses”). Reported losses represent cumulative loss and loss adjustment expenses paid plus case reserves for outstanding reported claims. Company actuaries evaluate the total reserves (IBNR and case reserves) on an accident year basis. An accident year is the calendar year in which a loss is incurred, or, in the case of claims-made policies, the calendar year in which a loss is reported.
Reserve estimates can change over time because of unexpected changes in the external environment. Potential external factors include (1) changes in the inflation rate for goods and services related to covered damages such as medical care, hospital care, auto parts, wages and home and building repair; (2) changes in the general economic environment that could cause unanticipated changes in the claim frequency per unit insured; (3) changes in the litigation environment as evidenced by changes in claimant attorney representation in the claims negotiation and settlement process; (4) changes in the judicial environment regarding the interpretation of policy provisions relating to the determination of coverage and/or the amount of damages awarded for certain types of damages; (5) changes in the social environment regarding the general attitude of juries in the determination of liability and damages; (6) changes in the legislative environment regarding the definition of damages; and (7) new types of injuries caused by new types of injurious exposure: past examples include pharmaceutical products, silica, lead paint, molestation or abuse and construction defects.
Reserve estimates can also change over time because of changes in internal Company operations. Potential internal factors include (1) periodic changes in claims handling procedures; (2) growth in new lines of business where exposure and loss development patterns are not well established; (3) changes in the quality of risk selection in the underwriting process; (4) changes in the geographic mix of business; (5) changes in the mix of business by industry; (6) changes in policy language; or (7) changes in the mix of business by policy limit or deductible.
In the case of assumed reinsurance, all of the above risks apply. In addition, changes in ceding company case reserving and reporting patterns can create additional factors that need to be considered in estimating the reserves. Due to the inherent complexity of the assumptions used, final claim settlements may vary significantly from the present estimates, particularly when those settlements may not occur until well into the future.

43



Through both facultative and treaty reinsurance agreements, the Company cedes a share of the risks it has underwritten to other insurance companies. The Company’s net reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses include anticipated recovery from reinsurers on unpaid claims. The estimated amount of the anticipated recovery, or reinsurance recoverable, is net of an allowance for uncollectible reinsurance.
Reinsurance recoverables include an estimate of the amount of gross loss and loss adjustment expense reserves that may be ceded under the terms of the reinsurance agreements, including IBNR for unpaid losses. The Company calculates its ceded reinsurance projection based on the terms of any applicable facultative and treaty reinsurance, often including an estimate by reinsurance agreement of how IBNR for losses will ultimately be ceded.
The Company provides an allowance for uncollectible reinsurance, reflecting management’s best estimate of reinsurance cessions that may be uncollectible in the future due to reinsurers’ unwillingness or inability to pay. The Company analyzes recent developments in commutation activity between reinsurers and cedants, recent trends in arbitration and litigation outcomes in disputes between reinsurers and cedants and the overall credit quality of the Company’s reinsurers. Where its contracts permit, the Company secures funding of future claim obligations with various forms of collateral, including irrevocable letters of credit, secured trusts, funds held accounts and group-wide offsets. The allowance for uncollectible reinsurance was $266 as of December 31, 2015, comprised of $46 related to Commercial Lines and $220 related to Property & Casualty Other Operations.
The Company’s estimate of reinsurance recoverables, net of an allowance for uncollectible reinsurance, is subject to similar risks and uncertainties as the estimate of the gross reserve for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses.
The Hartford, like other insurance companies, categorizes and tracks its insurance reserves for its segments by “line of business”. Commercial Lines policy packages that include property and general liability coverages are generally referred to as the package line of business. Furthermore, The Hartford regularly reviews the appropriateness of reserve levels at the line of business level, taking into consideration the variety of trends that impact the ultimate settlement of claims for the subsets of claims in each particular line of business. In addition, Property & Casualty Other Operations categorizes reserves as asbestos and environmental (“A&E”), whereby the Company reviews these reserve levels by type of event, rather than by line of business. Adjustments to previously established reserves, which may be material, are reflected in the operating results of the period in which the adjustment is determined to be necessary. In the judgment of management, information currently available has been properly considered in the reserves established for losses and loss adjustment expenses.
Loss and loss adjustment expense reserves by line of business as of December 31, 2015, net of reinsurance are as follows:
 
Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Property & Casualty
Other Operations
Total Property &
Casualty Insurance
Auto liability
$
701

$
1,361

$

$
2,062

Auto physical damage
21

25


46

Homeowners’

414


414

Professional liability
508



508

Package business
1,274



1,274

General liability
2,431

25


2,456

Bond
185



185

Commercial property
143



143

A&E
22

1

1,959

1,982

Workers’ compensation
8,981



8,981

Assumed reinsurance


138

138

All other non-A&E


754

754

Total reserves-net
14,266

1,826

2,851

18,943

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,293

19

570

2,882

Total reserves-gross
$
16,559

$
1,845

$
3,421

$
21,825


44



Reserving Methodology
(See Reserving for Asbestos and Environmental Claims within Property & Casualty Other Operations for a discussion of how A&E reserves are set)
How Reserves are Set
Reserves are set by line of business within the various segments. A single line of business may be written in more than one segment. Case reserves are established by a claims handler on each individual claim and are adjusted as new information becomes known during the course of handling the claim. Lines of business for which loss data (e.g., paid losses and case reserves) emerge (i.e., is reported) over a long period of time are referred to as long-tail lines of business. Lines of business for which loss data emerge more quickly are referred to as short-tail lines of business. The Company’s shortest-tail lines of business are property and auto physical damage. The longest tail lines of business include workers’ compensation, general liability, professional liability and assumed reinsurance. For short-tail lines of business, emergence of paid loss and case reserves is credible and likely indicative of ultimate losses. For long-tail lines of business, emergence of paid losses and case reserves is less credible in the early periods and, accordingly, may not be indicative of ultimate losses.
The Company’s reserving actuaries regularly review reserves for both current and prior accident years using the most current claim data. For most lines of business, these reserve reviews incorporate a variety of actuarial methods and judgments and involve rigorous analysis. These selections incorporate input, as judged by the reserving actuaries to be appropriate, from claims personnel, pricing actuaries and operating management on reported loss cost trends and other factors that could affect the reserve estimates. Most reserves are reviewed fully each quarter, including loss and loss adjustment expense reserves for property, auto physical damage, auto liability, package business, workers’ compensation, most general liability and professional liability. Other reserves are reviewed semi-annually (twice per year) or annually. These include, but are not limited to, reserves for losses incurred in accident years older than twelve and twenty years, for Personal and Commercial Lines, respectively, bond, assumed reinsurance, latent exposures, such as construction defects, and unallocated loss adjustment expense. For reserves that are reviewed semi-annually or annually, management monitors the emergence of paid and reported losses in the intervening quarters to either confirm that the estimate of ultimate losses should not change or, if necessary, perform a reserve review to determine whether the reserve estimate should change.
An expected loss ratio is used in initially recording the reserves for both short-tail and long-tail lines of business. This expected loss ratio is determined through a review of prior accident years’ loss ratios and expected changes to earned pricing, loss costs, mix of business, ceded reinsurance and other factors that are expected to impact the loss ratio for the current accident year. For short-tail lines, IBNR for the current accident year is initially recorded as the product of the expected loss ratio for the period, earned premium for the period and the proportion of losses expected to be reported in future calendar periods for the current accident period. For long-tailed lines, IBNR reserves for the current accident year are initially recorded as the product of the expected loss ratio for the period and the earned premium for the period, less reported losses for the period.
In addition to the expected loss ratio, the actuarial techniques or methods used primarily include paid and reported loss development and frequency / severity techniques as well as the Bornhuetter-Ferguson method (a combination of the expected loss ratio and paid development or reported development method). Within any one line of business, the methods that are given more influence vary based primarily on the maturity of the accident year, the mix of business and the particular internal and external influences impacting the claims experience or the methods. The output of the reserve reviews are reserve estimates that are referred to herein as the “actuarial indication”.
Most of the Company’s property and casualty insurance product reserves are not discounted. However, the Company has discounted liabilities funded through structured settlements and has discounted certain reserves for indemnity payments due to permanently disabled claimants under workers’ compensation policies. For further discussion of these discounted liabilities, see Note 10 - Reserves for Future Policy Benefits and Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, U.S. property and casualty insurance product reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses, net of reinsurance recoverables, reported under U.S. GAAP were approximately equal to net reserves reported on a statutory basis. Under U.S. GAAP, liabilities for unpaid losses for permanently disabled workers’ compensation claimants are discounted at rates that are no higher than risk-free interest rates in effect at the time the claims are incurred and which can vary from the statutory discount rates set by regulators. In addition, a portion of the U.S. GAAP provision for uncollectible reinsurance is not recognized under statutory accounting, largely offsetting the difference in discounting.
Provided below is a general discussion of which methods are preferred by line of business. Because the actuarial estimates are generated at a much finer level of detail than line of business (e.g., by distribution channel, coverage, accident period), this description should not be assumed to apply to each coverage and accident year within a line of business. Also, as circumstances change, the methods that are given more influence will change.

45



Property and Auto Physical Damage. These lines are fast-developing and paid and reported development techniques are used as these methods use historical data to develop paid and reported loss development patterns, which are then applied to current paid and reported losses by accident period to estimate ultimate losses. The Company relies primarily on reported development techniques although a review of frequency and severity and the initial loss expectation based on the expected loss ratio is used for the most immature accident months. The advantage of frequency / severity techniques is that frequency estimates are generally easier to predict and external information can be used to supplement internal data in making severity estimates.
Personal Auto Liability. For auto liability, and bodily injury in particular, the Company performs a greater number of techniques than it does for property and auto physical damage. In addition to traditional paid and reported development methods, the Company relies on frequency/severity techniques and Berquist-Sherman techniques. Because the paid development technique is affected by changes in claim closure patterns and the reported development method is affected by changes in case reserving practices, the Company uses Berquist-Sherman techniques which adjust these patterns to reflect current settlement rates and case reserving techniques. The Company generally uses the reported development method for older accident years as a higher percentage of ultimate losses are reflected in reported losses than in cumulative paid losses and a combination of reported development, frequency/severity and Berquist-Sherman methods for more recent accident years. Recent periods can be influenced by changes in case reserve practices and changing disposal rates; the frequency/severity techniques are not affected as much by these changes and the Berquist-Sherman techniques specifically adjust for these changes.
Auto Liability for Commercial Lines and Short-Tailed General Liability. The Company performs a variety of techniques, including the paid and reported development methods and frequency / severity techniques. For older, more mature accident years, the Company finds that reported development techniques are best. For more recent accident years, the Company typically prefers frequency / severity techniques that make separate assumptions about loss activity above and below a selected capping level.
Long-Tailed General Liability, Bond and Large Deductible Workers’ Compensation. For these long-tailed lines of business, the Company generally relies on the expected loss ratio and reported development techniques. The Company generally weights these techniques together, relying more heavily on the expected loss ratio method at early ages of development and more on the reported development method as an accident year matures.
Workers’ Compensation. Workers’ compensation is the Company’s single largest reserve line of business so a wide range of methods are reviewed in the reserve analysis. Methods performed include paid and reported development, variations on expected loss ratio methods, and an in-depth analysis on the largest states. In recent years, we have seen an acceleration of paid losses relative to historical patterns and have adjusted our expected loss development patterns accordingly. This acceleration has largely been due to two factors. First, we have seen a higher concentration of first dollar workers' compensation business and less excess of loss business over the past 10 years, resulting in fewer longer-tailed, excess workers' compensation claims in recent accident years. Second, there has been an increase in lump sum settlements across multiple accident years as management has executed on strategies to achieve mutually beneficial settlements with claimants. Adjusting for the effect of an acceleration in payments, paid loss development techniques are generally preferred for the workers' compensation line. Although paid techniques may be less predictive of the ultimate liability when a low percentage of ultimate losses are paid as in early periods of development, given changes in the frequency of workers’ compensation claims over time, the Company places greater reliance on paid methods with continued consideration of incurred methods, open claim approaches, state-by-state analysis and the expected loss ratio approaches.
Professional Liability. Reported and paid loss developments patterns for this line tend to be volatile. Therefore, the Company typically relies on frequency and severity techniques.
Assumed Reinsurance and All Other. For these lines, the Company tends to rely on the reported development techniques. In assumed reinsurance, assumptions are influenced by information gained from claim and underwriting audits.
Allocated Loss Adjustment Expenses (ALAE). For some lines of business (e.g., professional liability and assumed reinsurance), ALAE and losses are analyzed together. For most lines of business, however, ALAE is analyzed separately, using paid development techniques and an analysis of the relationship between ALAE and loss payments.
Unallocated Loss Adjustment Expense (ULAE). ULAE is analyzed separately from loss and ALAE. For most lines of business, incurred ULAE costs to be paid in the future are projected based on an expected cost per claim year and the anticipated claim closure pattern and the ratio of paid ULAE to paid loss.

46



The final step in the reserve review process involves a comprehensive review by senior reserving actuaries who apply their judgment and, in concert with senior management, determine the appropriate level of reserves based on the information that has been accumulated. Numerous factors are considered in this process including, but not limited to, the assessed reliability of key loss trends and assumptions that may be significantly influencing the current actuarial indications, pertinent trends observed over the recent past, the level of volatility within a particular line of business, and the improvement or deterioration of actuarial indications in the current period as compared to the prior periods. Total recorded net reserves, excluding asbestos and environmental, were 4.1% higher than the actuarial indication of the reserves as of December 31, 2015.
For a discussion of changes to reserve estimates recorded in 2015, see Reserve Roll-forwards and Development included below in this section.
Current Trends Contributing to Reserve Uncertainty
The Hartford is a multi-line company in the property and casualty insurance business. The Hartford is therefore subject to reserve uncertainty stemming from a number of conditions, including but not limited to those noted above, any of which could be material at any point in time. Certain issues may become more or less important over time as conditions change. As various market conditions develop, management must assess whether those conditions constitute a long-term trend that should result in a reserving action (i.e., increasing or decreasing the reserve).
Within Commercial Lines and Property & Casualty Other Operations, the Company has exposure to claims asserted for bodily injury as a result of long-term or continuous exposure to harmful products or substances. Examples include, but are not limited to, pharmaceutical products, silica and lead paint. The Company also has exposure to claims from construction defects, where property damage or bodily injury from negligent construction is alleged. In addition, the Company has exposure to claims asserted against religious institutions and other organizations relating to molestation or abuse. Such exposures may involve potentially long latency periods and may implicate coverage in multiple policy periods. These factors make reserves for such claims more uncertain than other bodily injury or property damage claims. With regard to these exposures, the Company is monitoring trends in litigation, the external environment, the similarities to other mass torts and the potential impact on the Company’s reserves.
In Personal Lines, reserving estimates are generally less variable than for the Company’s other property and casualty segments because of the coverages having relatively shorter periods of loss emergence. Estimates, however, can still vary due to a number of factors, including interpretations of frequency and severity trends and their impact on recorded reserve levels. Severity trends can be impacted by changes in internal claim handling and case reserving practices in addition to changes in the external environment. These changes in claim practices increase the uncertainty in the interpretation of case reserve data, which increases the uncertainty in recorded reserve levels. In addition, the introduction of new products and class plans has led to a different mix of business by type of insured than the Company experienced in the past. Such changes in mix increase the uncertainty of the reserve projections, since historical data and reporting patterns may not be applicable to the new business.
In standard commercial lines, workers’ compensation is the Company’s single biggest line of business and the line of business with the longest pattern of loss emergence. To the extent that payment patterns are impacted by increases or decreases in the frequency of settlement payments, historical patterns would be less reliable, increasing the uncertainty around reserve estimates. Medical costs make up more than 50% of workers’ compensation payments. As such, reserve estimates for workers’ compensation are particularly sensitive to changes in medical inflation, the changing use of medical care procedures and changes in state legislative and regulatory environments. In addition, a changing economic environment can affect the ability of an injured worker to return to work and the length of time a worker receives disability benefits.
In specialty lines, many lines of insurance are “long-tail”, including large deductible workers’ compensation insurance; as such, reserve estimates for these lines are more difficult to determine than reserve estimates for shorter-tail lines of insurance. Estimating required reserve levels for large deductible workers’ compensation insurance is further complicated by the uncertainty of whether losses that are attributable to the deductible amount will be paid by the insured; if such losses are not paid by the insured due to financial difficulties, the Company would be contractually liable. Auto severity trends can be impacted by changes in internal claim handling and case reserving practices in addition to changes in the external environment. These changes in claim practices increase the uncertainty in the interpretation of case reserve data, which increases the uncertainty in recorded reserve levels. Another example of reserve variability relates to reserves for directors’ and officers’ insurance. There is potential volatility in the required level of reserves due to the continued uncertainty regarding the number and severity of class action suits. Additionally, the Company’s exposure to losses under directors’ and officers’ insurance policies is primarily in excess layers, making estimates of loss more complex.
Impact of Changes in Key Assumptions on Reserve Volatility
As stated above, the Company’s practice is to estimate reserves using a variety of methods, assumptions and data elements. Within its reserve estimation process for reserves other than asbestos and environmental, the Company does not consistently use statistical loss distributions or confidence levels around its reserve estimate and, as a result, does not disclose reserve ranges.

47



The reserve estimation process includes assumptions about a number of factors in the internal and external environment. Across most lines of business, the most important assumptions are future loss development factors applied to paid or reported losses to date. The trend in loss costs is also a key assumption, particularly in the most recent accident years, where loss development factors are less credible.
The following discussion includes disclosure of possible variation from current estimates of loss reserves due to a change in certain key indicators of potential losses. Each of the impacts described below is estimated individually, without consideration for any correlation among key indicators or among lines of business. Therefore, it would be inappropriate to take each of the amounts described below and add them together in an attempt to estimate volatility for the Company’s reserves in total. For any one reserving line of business, the estimated variation in reserves due to changes in key indicators is a reasonable estimate of possible variation that may occur in the future, likely over a period of several calendar years. It is important to note that the variation discussed is not meant to be a worst-case scenario, and therefore, it is possible that future variation may be more than the amounts discussed below.
Recorded reserves for auto liability, net of reinsurance, are approximately $2.1 billion across all lines, $1.4 billion of which is in Personal Lines. Personal auto liability reserves are shorter-tailed than other lines of business (such as workers’ compensation) and, therefore, less volatile. However, the size of the reserve base means that future changes in estimates could be material to the Company’s results of operations in any given period. The key indicator for Personal Lines auto liability is the annual loss cost trend, particularly the severity trend component of loss costs. A 2.5 point change in annual severity for the two most recent accident years would change the estimated net reserve need by $80, in either direction. A 2.5 point change in annual severity is within the Company’s historical variation.
Recorded reserves for workers’ compensation, net of reinsurance, are approximately $9.0 billion. Loss development patterns are a key indicator for this line of business, particularly for more mature accident years. Historically, loss development patterns have been impacted by, among other things, medical cost inflation and other changes in loss cost trends. The Company has reviewed the historical variation in paid loss development patterns. If the paid loss development patterns change by 2%, the estimated net reserve need would change by $400, in either direction. A 2% change in paid loss development patterns is within the Company’s historical variation, as measured by the variation around the average development factors as reported in statutory accident year reports.
Recorded reserves for general liability, net of reinsurance, are approximately $2.5 billion. Loss development patterns are a key indicator for this line of business, particularly for more mature accident years. Historically, loss development patterns have been impacted by, among other things, emergence of new types of claims (e.g., construction defect claims) or a shift in the mixture between smaller, more routine claims and larger, more complex claims. The Company has reviewed the historical variation in reported loss development patterns. If the reported loss development patterns change by 10%, the estimated net reserve need would change by $200, in either direction. A 10% change in reported loss development patterns is within the Company’s historical variation, as measured by the variation around the average development factors as reported in statutory accident year reports.
Reserving for Asbestos and Environmental Claims within Property & Casualty Other Operations
How A&E Reserves are Set
In establishing reserves for asbestos claims, the Company evaluates its insureds’ estimated liabilities for such claims using a ground-up approach. The Company considers a variety of factors, including the jurisdictions where underlying claims have been brought, past, pending and anticipated future claim activity, disease mix, past settlement values of similar claims, dismissal rates, allocated loss adjustment expense, and potential bankruptcy impact.
Similarly, a ground-up exposure review approach is used to establish environmental reserves. The Company’s evaluation of its insureds’ estimated liabilities for environmental claims involves consideration of several factors, including historical values of similar claims, the number of sites involved, the insureds’ alleged activities at each site, the alleged environmental damage at each site, the respective shares of liability of potentially responsible parties at each site, the appropriateness and cost of remediation at each site, the nature of governmental enforcement activities at each site, and potential bankruptcy impact.
Having evaluated its insureds’ probable liabilities for asbestos and/or environmental claims, the Company then evaluates its insureds’ insurance coverage programs for such claims. The Company considers its insureds’ total available insurance coverage, including the coverage issued by the Company. The Company also considers relevant judicial interpretations of policy language and applicable coverage defenses or determinations, if any.
Evaluation of both the insureds’ estimated liabilities and the Company’s exposure to the insureds depends heavily on an analysis of the relevant legal issues and litigation environment. This analysis is conducted by the Company’s lawyers and is subject to applicable privileges.
For both asbestos and environmental reserves, the Company also compares its historical direct and net loss and expense paid and reported experience year by year, to assess any emerging trends, fluctuations or characteristics suggested by the aggregate paid and reported activity.

48



Once the gross ultimate exposure for indemnity and allocated loss adjustment expense is determined for its insureds by each policy year, the Company calculates its ceded reinsurance projection based on any applicable facultative and treaty reinsurance and the Company’s experience with reinsurance collections.
Uncertainties Regarding Adequacy of Asbestos and Environmental Reserves
A number of factors affect the variability of estimates for asbestos and environmental reserves including assumptions with respect to the frequency of claims, the average severity of those claims settled with payment, the dismissal rate of claims with no payment, resolution of coverage disputes with our policyholders and the expense to indemnity ratio. The uncertainty with respect to the underlying reserve assumptions for asbestos and environmental adds a greater degree of variability to these reserve estimates than reserve estimates for more traditional exposures. While this variability is reflected in part in the size of the range of reserves developed by the Company, that range may still not be indicative of the potential variance between the ultimate outcome and the recorded reserves. The recorded net reserves as of December 31, 2015 of approximately $2.0 billion ($1.7 billion and $0.3 billion for asbestos and environmental, respectively) are within an estimated range, unadjusted for covariance, of $1.6 billion to $2.4 billion. The process of estimating asbestos and environmental reserves remains subject to a wide variety of uncertainties, which are detailed in Note 12 - Commitments and Contingencies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. The Company believes that its current asbestos and environmental reserves are appropriate. However, analyses of future developments could cause the Company to change its estimates and ranges of its asbestos and environmental reserves, and the effect of these changes could be material to the Company's consolidated operating results and liquidity. Consistent with the Company's long-standing reserve practices, the Company will continue to review and monitor its reserves in Property & Casualty Other Operations regularly, including its annual reviews of asbestos liabilities, reinsurance recoverables, the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance, and environmental liabilities, and where future developments indicate, make appropriate adjustments to the reserves. In 2016, the Company will complete the annual ground-up asbestos and environmental reserve studies during the second quarter.
Reserve Roll-forwards and Development
Based on the results of the quarterly reserve review process, the Company determines the appropriate reserve adjustments, if any, to record. Recorded reserve estimates are adjusted after consideration of numerous factors, including but not limited to, the magnitude of the difference between the actuarial indication and the recorded reserves, improvement or deterioration of actuarial indications in the period, the maturity of the accident year, trends observed over the recent past and the level of volatility within a particular line of business. In general, adjustments are made more quickly to more mature accident years and less volatile lines of business. Such adjustments of reserves are referred to as “prior accident year development”. Increases in previous estimates of ultimate loss costs are referred to as either an increase in prior accident year reserves or as unfavorable reserve development. Decreases in previous estimates of ultimate loss costs are referred to as either a decrease in prior accident year reserves or as favorable reserve development. Reserve development can influence the comparability of year over year underwriting results and is set forth in the paragraphs and tables that follow.
Total Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance, Results
In the opinion of management, based upon the known facts and current law, the reserves recorded for the Company’s property and casualty insurance products at December 31, 2015 represent the Company’s best estimate of its ultimate liability for losses and loss adjustment expenses related to losses covered by policies written by the Company. However, because of the significant uncertainties surrounding reserves, and particularly asbestos and environmental exposures, it is possible that management’s estimate of the ultimate liabilities for these claims may change and that the required adjustment to recorded reserves could exceed the currently recorded reserves by an amount that could be material to the Company’s results of operations and liquidity.

49



A roll-forward of property and casualty insurance product liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses follows:
Year Ended December 31, 2015
 
Commercial Lines
Personal
Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,465

$
1,874

$
3,467

$
21,806

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,459

18

564

3,041

Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
14,006

1,856

2,903

18,765

Provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
3,712

2,578

25

6,315

Current accident year catastrophes [3]
121

211


332

Prior accident year development
53

(21
)
218

250

Total provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
3,886

2,768

243

6,897

Less: payments
3,626

2,798

295

6,719

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
14,266

1,826

2,851

18,943

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,293

19

570

2,882

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,559

$
1,845

$
3,421

$
21,825

Earned premiums
$
6,511

$
3,873

 
 
Loss and loss expense paid ratio [1]
55.7

72.2

 
 
Loss and loss expense incurred ratio
59.7

71.5

 
 
Prior accident year development (pts) [2]
0.8

(0.5
)
 
 
[1]
The “loss and loss expense paid ratio” represents the ratio of paid losses and loss adjustment expenses to earned premiums.
[2]
“Prior accident year development (pts)” represents the ratio of prior accident year development to earned premiums.
[3]
Contributing to the current accident year catastrophes losses were the following events:
Year Ended December 31, 2015
Category

Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Total
Property and
Casualty
Insurance
Wind and hail [1]
$
43

$
114

$
157

Winter storms [1]
$
57

$
27

$
84

Tornadoes [1]
18

29

47

Other [2]
3

41

44

Total
$
121

$
211

$
332

[1] These amounts represent an aggregation of multiple catastrophes.
[2] Consists primarily of wildfires.

50



Prior accident year development recorded in 2015
Included within prior accident year development were the following increases (decreases) to reserves:
Year Ended December 31, 2015
 
Commercial Lines
Personal
Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Auto liability
$
62

$
(8
)
$

$
54

Homeowners

9


9

Professional liability
(36
)


(36
)
Package business
28



28

General liability
8



8

Bond
(2
)


(2
)
Commercial property
(6
)


(6
)
Net asbestos reserves


146

146

Net environmental reserves


55

55

Workers’ compensation
(37
)


(37
)
Workers’ compensation discount accretion
29



29

Catastrophes

(18
)

(18
)
Other reserve re-estimates, net
7

(4
)
17

20

Total prior accident year development
$
53

$
(21
)
$
218

$
250

During 2015, the Company’s re-estimates of prior accident year reserves included the following significant reserve changes:
Increased reserves in commercial auto liability due to increased severity of large claims predominantly for accident years 2010 to 2013.
Decreased reserves in professional liability for claims made years 2009 through 2012 primarily for large accounts. Claim costs have emerged favorably as these years have matured and management has placed more weight on the emerged experience.
Increased reserves in Small Commercial package business driven by higher than expected severity on liability claims, impacting recent accident years.
Decreased reserves in workers' compensation due to an improvement in claim closure rates resulting in a decrease in outstanding claims for permanently disabled claimants. In addition, accident years 2013 and 2014 continue to exhibit favorable frequency and medical severity trends; management has been placing additional weight on this favorable experience as it becomes more credible.
Decreased catastrophe reserves primarily for accident year 2014 as fourth quarter 2014 catastrophes have developed favorably.
Within Other reserve re-estimates, net, decreased contract surety reserves across several accident years and decreased commercial surety reserves for accident years 2012 through 2014 as a result of lower emerged losses. These reserve decreases were offset by an increase in commercial surety reserves related to accident years 2007 and prior, as the number of new claims reported has outpaced expectations. 
Refer to the Property & Casualty Other Operations sections for discussion of the increase in net asbestos reserves, net environmental reserves and other reserve re-estimates, net.

51



A roll-forward of property and casualty insurance product liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses follows:
Year Ended December 31, 2014
 
Commercial Lines
Personal
Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,293

$
1,864

$
3,547

$
21,704

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,442

13

573

3,028

Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
13,851

1,851

2,974

18,676

Provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
3,733

2,498


6,231

Current accident year catastrophes [3]
109

232


341

Prior accident year development
13

(46
)
261

228

Total provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
3,855

2,684

261

6,800

 Less: payments
3,665

2,679

367

6,711

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
14,041

1,856

2,868

18,765

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,464

18

559

3,041

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,505

$
1,874

$
3,427

$
21,806

Earned premiums
$
6,289

$
3,806

 
 
Loss and loss expense paid ratio [1]
58.3

70.4

 
 
Loss and loss expense incurred ratio
61.3

70.5

 
 
Prior accident year development (pts) [2]
0.2

(1.2
)
 
 
[1]
The “loss and loss expense paid ratio” represents the ratio of paid losses and loss adjustment expenses to earned premiums.
[2]
“Prior accident year development (pts)” represents the ratio of prior accident year development to earned premiums.
[3]
Contributing to the current accident year catastrophes losses were the following events:
Year Ended December 31, 2014
Category

Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Total
Property and
Casualty
Insurance
Wind and hail [1]
$
45

$
196

$
241

Winter storms [1]
54

19

73

Other [2]
10

17

27

Total
$
109

$
232

$
341

[1] Amounts represent an aggregation of multiple catastrophes.
[2] Includes tornadoes, earthquakes and flooding.

52



Prior accident year development recorded in 2014
Included within prior accident year development were the following increases (decreases) to reserves:
Year Ended December 31, 2014
 
Commercial Lines
Personal
Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Auto liability
$
23

$
2

$

$
25

Homeowners

(7
)

(7
)
Professional liability
(17
)


(17
)
Package business
3



3

General liability
(25
)


(25
)
Bond
8



8

Commercial property
2



2

Net asbestos reserves


212

212

Net environmental reserves


30

30

Workers’ compensation
(7
)


(7
)
Workers’ compensation discount accretion
30



30

Catastrophes
(14
)
(31
)

(45
)
Other reserve re-estimates, net
10

(10
)
19

19

Total prior accident year development
$
13

$
(46
)
$
261

$
228

During 2014, the Company’s re-estimates of prior accident year reserves included the following significant reserve changes:
Increased reserves in commercial auto liability due to an increased frequency of severe claims spread across several accident years.
Homeowners reserves emerged favorably for accident year 2013, primarily related to favorable development on fire and water-related claims.
Decreased professional liability reserves for accident years 2013, 2012 and 2010 due to lower frequency of reported claims.
Decreased general liability reserves due to lower frequency in late emerging claims.
Bond reserves emerged favorably for accident years 2008 to 2013, offset by adverse emergence on reserves for accident years 2007 and prior.
Decreased catastrophe reserves primarily for accident year 2013, as fourth quarter 2013 catastrophes have developed favorably.
Decreased workers' compensation reserves for recent accident years due to improved frequency and lower estimated claim handling costs.
Refer to the Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims section for discussion of the increase in net asbestos reserves, net environmental reserves and other reserve re-estimates, net.

53



A roll-forward of property and casualty insurance product liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses follows:
Year Ended December 31, 2013
 
Commercial Lines
Personal
Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,020

$
1,926

$
3,770

$
21,716

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,365

16

646

3,027

Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
13,655

1,910

3,124

18,689

Provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
3,897

2,412


6,309

Current accident year catastrophes [3]
105

207


312

Prior accident year development
83

(39
)
148

192

Total provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
4,085

2,580

148

6,813

Less: payments
3,889

2,639

298

6,826

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
13,851

1,851

2,974

18,676

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,442

13

573

3,028

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,293

$
1,864

$
3,547

$
21,704

Earned premiums
$
6,203

$
3,660

 
 
Loss and loss expense paid ratio [1]
62.7

72.1

 
 
Loss and loss expense incurred ratio
65.9

70.5

 
 
Prior accident year development (pts) [2]
1.3

(1.1
)
 
 
[1]
The “loss and loss expense paid ratio” represents the ratio of paid losses and loss adjustment expenses to earned premiums.
[2]
“Prior accident year development (pts)” represents the ratio of prior accident year development to earned premiums.
[3]
Contributing to the current accident year catastrophes losses were the following events:
Year Ended December 31, 2013
Category

Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Total
Property and
Casualty
Insurance
Wind and hail [1]
$
65

$
103

$
168

Tornadoes [1]
27

63

90

Other [2]
13

41

54

Total
$
105

$
207

$
312

[1] Amounts represent an aggregation of multiple catastrophes.
[2] Includes wildfire, winter storms and flooding.

54



Prior accident years development recorded in 2013
Included within prior accident year development were the following increases (decreases) in reserves:
Year Ended December 31, 2013
 
Commercial Lines
Personal
Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Auto liability
$
141

$
3

$

$
144

Homeowners

(6
)

(6
)
Professional liability
(29
)


(29
)
Package business
2



2

General liability
(75
)


(75
)
Bond
(8
)


(8
)
Commercial property
(7
)


(7
)
Net asbestos reserves


130

130

Net environmental reserves


12

12

Uncollectible reinsurance
(25
)


(25
)
Workers’ compensation
(2
)


(2
)
Workers’ compensation - NY 25a Fund for Reopened Cases
80



80

Workers’ compensation discount accretion
30



30

Catastrophes
(24
)
(39
)

(63
)
Other reserve re-estimates, net

3

6

9

Total prior accident year development
$
83

$
(39
)
$
148

$
192

During 2013, the Company’s re-estimates of prior accident years reserves included the following significant reserve changes:
Increased commercial auto liability reserves, primarily related to specialty lines claims, arising from a higher frequency of large loss bodily injury claims in accident years 2010 through 2012.
Decreased professional liability reserves for accident years 2008 through 2012 due to lower than expected claim severity, primarily for large-sized accounts.
Decreased general liability reserves for accident years 2006 through 2011. The emergence of claim severity as well as the frequency of late reported claims for these years was lower than expected and management has placed more weight on the emerged experience.
The Company reviewed the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance in the second quarter of 2013 and decreased the allowance as a result of favorable collections compared to expectations.
The decrease in workers’ compensation reserves is the net of decreases for accident year 2009 and prior reflecting favorable development in average severity, the result of a speed up in settlements and the result of moving to an enhanced state-level analysis of loss experience, offset by unfavorable development of workers’ compensation reserves for accident years 2010 through 2012 reflecting the emergence of a higher mix of more severe claims.
Increased reserves related to the closing of the New York Section 25A Fund for Reopened Cases (the "Fund"). These claims were previously funded through assessments and paid by the Fund. The claims became payable by the Company effective January 1, 2014.
Decreased catastrophe reserves primarily related to Storm Sandy.
Other reserve re-estimates, net includes an $18 recovery related to a class action settlement with American International Group involving prior accident years involuntary workers compensation pool loss and loss adjustment expense.
Refer to the Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims section for further discussion of the increase in net asbestos and net environmental reserves.

55



Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims
Reserve Activity
Reserves and reserve activity in Property & Casualty Other Operations are categorized and reported as asbestos, environmental, or “all other”. The “all other” category of reserves covers a wide range of insurance and assumed reinsurance coverages, including, but not limited to, potential liability for construction defects, lead paint, silica, pharmaceutical products, molestation and other long-tail liabilities.
The following table presents reserve activity, inclusive of estimates for both reported and incurred but not reported claims, net of reinsurance, for Property & Casualty Other Operations, categorized by asbestos, environmental and all other claims.
Property & Casualty Other Operations Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
 
Asbestos
 
Environmental
All Other [1] [2]
Total
2015
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning liability — net [3] [4]
$
1,710

 
$
241

$
952

$
2,903

Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred
156

 
58

29

243

Less: Losses and loss adjustment expenses paid
154

 
52

89

295

Ending liability — net [3] [4]
$
1,712

[5]
$
247

$
892

$
2,851

2014
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning liability — net [3] [4]
$
1,714

 
$
270

$
990

$
2,974

Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred
212

 
30

19

261

Less: Losses and loss adjustment expenses paid
216

 
59

92

367

Ending liability — net [3] [4]
$
1,710

 
$
241

$
917

$
2,868

2013
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning liability — net [3] [4]
$
1,776

 
$
290

$
1,058

$
3,124

Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred
130

 
12

6

148

Less: Losses and loss adjustment expenses paid
192

 
32

74

298

Ending liability — net [3] [4]
$
1,714

 
$
270

$
990

$
2,974

[1]
Hartford Financial Products International ("HFPI") net reserves of $35 as of December 31, 2014, have been prospectively reclassified from Commercial Lines to "All Other" as HFPI does not write new business.    
[2]
In addition to various insurance and assumed reinsurance exposures, "All Other” includes unallocated loss adjustment expense reserves. “All Other” also includes the Company’s allowance for uncollectible reinsurance. When the Company commutes a ceded reinsurance contract or settles a ceded reinsurance dispute, the portion of the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance attributable to that commutation or settlement, if any, is reclassified to the appropriate cause of loss including asbestos, environmental or all other.
[3]
Excludes amounts reported in Commercial Lines and Personal Lines reporting segments (collectively “Ongoing Operations”) for asbestos and environmental net liabilities of $14 and $9 respectively, as of December 31, 2015, $16 and $6, respectively, as of December 31, 2014, and $18 and $5, respectively, as of December 31, 2013; excludes total net losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 of $15, $16 and $15, respectively, related to asbestos and environmental claims; and excludes total net losses and loss adjustment expenses paid for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 of $15, $17 and $14, respectively, related to asbestos and environmental claims.
[4]
Gross of reinsurance, asbestos and environmental reserves, including liabilities in Ongoing Operations, were $2,222 and $287, respectively, as of December 31, 2015; $2,193 and $267, respectively, as of December 31, 2014; and $2,182 and $311, respectively, as of December 31, 2013.
[5]
The one year and average three year net paid amounts for asbestos claims, including Ongoing Operations, were $166 and $198, respectively, resulting in a one year net survival ratio of 10.4 and a three year net survival ratio of 8.7. Net survival ratio is the quotient of the net carried reserves divided by the average annual payment amount and is an indication of the number of years that the net carried reserve would last (i.e., survive) if the future annual claim payments were consistent with the calculated historical average.
For paid and incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses reporting, the Company classifies its asbestos and environmental reserves into three categories: Direct, Assumed Reinsurance and London Market. Direct insurance includes primary and excess coverage. Assumed Reinsurance includes both “treaty” reinsurance (covering broad categories of claims or blocks of business) and “facultative” reinsurance (covering specific risks or individual policies of primary or excess insurance companies). London Market business includes the business written by one or more of the Company’s subsidiaries in the United Kingdom, which are no longer active in the insurance or reinsurance business. Such business includes both direct insurance and assumed reinsurance. Of the three categories of claims (Direct, Assumed Reinsurance and London Market), direct policies tend to have the greatest factual development from which to estimate the Company’s exposures.

56



Assumed insurance exposures are less predictable than direct insurance exposures because the Company does not generally receive notice of a reinsurance claim until the underlying direct insurance claim is mature. This causes a delay in the receipt of information at the reinsurer level and adds to the uncertainty of estimating related reserves.
London Market exposures are the most uncertain of the three categories of claims. As a participant in the London Market (comprised of both Lloyd’s of London and London Market companies), certain subsidiaries of the Company wrote business on a subscription basis, with those subsidiaries’ involvement being limited to a relatively small percentage of a total contract placement. Claims are reported, via a broker, to the “lead” underwriter and, once agreed to, are presented to the following markets for concurrence. This reporting and claim agreement process makes estimating liabilities for this business the most uncertain of the three categories of claims.
The following table sets forth paid and incurred loss activity by the three categories of claims for asbestos and environmental.
Paid and Incurred Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses (“LAE”) Development — Asbestos and Environmental
 
Asbestos [1]
Environmental [1]
 
Paid Losses & LAE
Incurred Losses & LAE
Paid Losses & LAE
Incurred Losses & LAE
2015
 
 
 
 
Gross
 
 
 
 
Direct
$
145

$
190

$
44

$
67

Assumed Reinsurance
57

(1
)
5

(4
)
London Market
17

62

16

18

Total
219

251

65

81

Ceded
(65
)
(95
)
(13
)
(23
)
Net
$
154

$
156

$
52

$
58

2014
 
 
 
 
Gross
 
 
 
 
Direct
$
201

$
206

$
55

$
23

Assumed Reinsurance
72

70

12


London Market
17

28

6

7

Total
290

304

73

30

Ceded
(74
)
(92
)
(14
)

Net
$
216

$
212

$
59

$
30

2013
 
 
 
 
Gross
 
 
 
 
Direct
$
159

$
72

$
23

$
6

Assumed Reinsurance
68

50

4

6

London Market
16

8

6


Total
243

130

33

12

Ceded
(51
)

(1
)

Net
$
192

$
130

$
32

$
12

[1]
Excludes asbestos and environmental paid and incurred loss and LAE reported in Ongoing Operations. Total gross losses and LAE incurred in Ongoing Operations for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 includes $16, $19 and $15, respectively, related to asbestos and environmental claims. Total gross losses and LAE paid in Ongoing Operations for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 includes $16, $21 and $14, respectively, related to asbestos and environmental claims.

57



In the fourth quarters of 2015, 2014 and 2013, the Company completed evaluations of certain of its non-asbestos and non-environmental reserves in Property & Casualty Other Operations, including its assumed reinsurance liabilities. In 2015 and 2014, the Company's prior year development was impacted by unfavorable frequency of international workers' compensation claims. The Company's prior year development on these reserves was immaterial in 2013.
During the second quarters of 2015, 2014 and 2013, the Company completed its annual ground-up asbestos reserve evaluations. As part of these evaluations, the Company reviewed all of its open direct domestic insurance accounts exposed to asbestos liability, as well as assumed reinsurance accounts and its London Market exposures for both direct insurance and assumed reinsurance. During 2015, the Company found a substantial majority of direct accounts have trended as expected, and the Company has seen no material changes in the underlying legal environment during the past year. However, a small percentage of the Company’s direct accounts have experienced greater than expected claim filings, including mesothelioma claims. This was driven by a subset of peripheral defendants with a high concentration of filings in specific, adverse jurisdictions. As a result, the aggregate indemnity and defense costs have not declined as expected. To a lesser degree, the Company also saw unfavorable development on certain assumed reinsurance accounts, driven by various account-specific factors, including filing activity experienced by the direct accounts. Based on this evaluation, the Company increased its net asbestos reserves by $146 in second quarter 2015. During 2014, the Company found estimates for certain direct accounts increased, principally due to a higher than previously estimated number of mesothelioma claim filings and an increase in costs associated with asbestos litigation. The Company also experienced unfavorable development on certain of its assumed reinsurance accounts driven by a variety of account-specific factors, including those experienced by the direct policyholders. Based on this evaluation, the Company increased its net asbestos reserves by $212 in second quarter 2014. During 2013, the Company found estimates for individual cases changed based upon the particular circumstances in such accounts. These cases were case specific and not as a result of any underlying change in current environment. The Company experienced moderate increases in claim frequency and severity as well as expense and costs associated with litigating asbestos coverage matters, particularly against certain smaller, more peripheral insureds. The Company also experienced unfavorable development on certain of its assumed reinsurance accounts driven largely by the same factors experienced by the direct policyholders. Based on this evaluation, the Company increased its net asbestos reserves by $130 in second quarter 2013. The Company currently expects to continue to perform an evaluation of its asbestos liabilities annually.
During the second quarters of 2015, 2014 and 2013, the Company completed its annual ground-up environmental reserve evaluations. In each of these evaluations, the Company reviewed all of its open direct domestic insurance accounts exposed to environmental liability, as well as assumed reinsurance accounts and its London Market exposures for both direct and assumed reinsurance. During 2015, the substantial majority of the Company's environmental exposures trended as expected, however the Company found loss and expense estimates for certain individual account exposures increased based upon an increase in clean-up costs, including at a handful of Superfund sites. In addition, new claim severity has deteriorated, although frequency continues to decline as expected. During 2014 and 2013, the Company found estimates for certain individual account exposures increased based upon unfavorable litigation results and increased clean-up and expense costs. The net effect of these account-specific changes as well as quarterly actuarial evaluations of new account emergence and historical loss and expense paid experience resulted in increases of $58, $30 and $12 in net environmental reserves in 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Company currently expects to continue to perform an evaluation of its environmental liabilities annually.
The Company divides its gross asbestos and environmental exposures into Direct, Assumed Reinsurance and London Market. Direct asbestos exposures include Major Asbestos Defendants, Non-Major Accounts, and Unallocated Direct Accounts.
Major Asbestos Defendants represent the “Top 70” accounts in Tillinghast's published Tiers 1 and 2 and Wellington accounts. Major Asbestos Defendants have the fewest number of asbestos accounts and include reserves related to PPG Industries, Inc. (“PPG”). In January 2009, the Company, along with approximately three dozen other insurers, entered into a modified agreement in principle with PPG to resolve the Company's coverage obligations for all its PPG asbestos liabilities. The agreement is contingent on the fulfillment of certain conditions. Major Asbestos Defendants gross asbestos reserves accounted for approximately 25% of the Company's total Direct gross asbestos reserves as of June 30, 2015.
Non-Major Accounts are all other open direct asbestos accounts and largely represent smaller and more peripheral defendants. These exposures represented 1,132 accounts and contained approximately 46% of the Company's total Direct gross asbestos reserves as of June 30, 2015.    
Unallocated Direct Accounts includes an estimate of the reserves necessary for asbestos claims related to direct insureds that have not previously tendered asbestos claims to the Company and exposures related to liability claims that may not be subject to an aggregate limit under the applicable policies.

58



The Company provides an allowance for uncollectible reinsurance, reflecting management’s best estimate of reinsurance cessions that may be uncollectible in the future due to reinsurers’ unwillingness or inability to pay. The Company currently expects to perform its regular comprehensive review of Property & Casualty Other Operations reinsurance recoverables annually. During the second quarters of 2015, 2014 and 2013, the Company completed its annual evaluations of the collectability of the reinsurance recoverables and the adequacy of the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance associated with older, long-term casualty liabilities reported in the Property & Casualty Other Operations. In conducting this evaluation, the Company used its most recent detailed evaluations of ceded liabilities reported in the segment. The Company analyzed the overall credit quality of the Company’s reinsurers, recent trends in arbitration and litigation outcomes in disputes between cedants and reinsurers and recent developments in commutation activity between reinsurers and cedants. The evaluation in the second quarters of 2015, 2014, and 2013 resulted in no material adjustments to the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance. As of December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance for Property & Casualty Other Operations totaled $220, $225, and $202. Due to the inherent uncertainties as to collection and the length of time before reinsurance recoverables become due, particularly for older, long-term casualty liabilities, it is possible that future adjustments to the Company’s reinsurance recoverables, net of the allowance, could be required.
A summary of asbestos and environmental reserves in Ongoing Operations and Other Operations is presented in the following table.
Summary of A&E Reserves
As of December 31, 2015
 
Asbestos [1]
Environmental [2]
Total A&E
Gross
 
 
 
     Direct
$
1,681

$
222

$
1,903

     Assumed Reinsurance
234

14

248

     London Market
307

51

358

     Total
2,222

287

2,509

Ceded
(496
)
(31
)
(527
)
Net
$
1,726

$
256

$
1,982

[1]
The one year gross paid amount for total asbestos claims is $231, resulting in a one year gross survival ratio of 9.6. The three year average gross paid amount for total asbestos claims is $263, resulting in a three year gross survival ratio of 8.5.
[2]
The one year gross paid amount for total environmental claims is $68, resulting in a one year gross survival ratio of 4.2. The three year average gross paid amount for total environmental claims is $64, resulting in a three year gross survival ratio of 4.5.

59



Impact of Re-estimates
The establishment of property and casualty insurance product reserves is an estimation process, using a variety of methods, assumptions and data elements. Ultimate losses may vary materially from the current estimates. Many factors can contribute to these variations and the need to change the previous estimate of required reserve levels. Subsequent changes can generally be thought of as being the result of the emergence of additional facts that were not known or anticipated at the time of the prior reserve estimate and/or changes in interpretations of information and trends.
The table below shows the range of annual reserve re-estimates experienced by The Hartford over the past ten years. The amount of prior accident year development (as shown in the reserve rollforward) for a given calendar year is expressed as a percent of the beginning calendar year reserves, net of reinsurance. The percentage relationships presented are significantly influenced by the facts and circumstances of each particular year and by the fact that only the last ten years are included in the range. Accordingly, these percentages are not intended to be a prediction of the range of possible future variability. See “Impact of key assumptions on reserve volatility” within this section for further discussion of the potential for variability in recorded loss reserves.
 
Commercial Lines
Personal
Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty [1]
Annual range of prior accident year unfavorable (favorable) development for the ten years ended December 31, 2015
(3.1)% - 1.0%
(6.9)% - (0.2)%
1.9% - 9.3%
(1.2)% - 2.0%
[1]
Excluding the reserve increases for asbestos and environmental reserves, over the past ten years reserve re-estimates for total property and casualty insurance ranged from (2.5)% to 0.3%.
The potential variability of the Company’s property and casualty insurance product reserves would normally be expected to vary by segment and the types of loss exposures insured by those segments. Illustrative factors influencing the potential reserve variability for each of the segments are discussed above.
A table depicting the historical development of the liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net of reinsurance, follows:
Loss Development Table
Loss And Loss Adjustment Expense Liability Development — Net of Reinsurance
Years Ended December 31,
 
2005
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
Liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net of reinsurance
$
16,863

$
17,604

$
18,231

$
18,347

$
18,210

$
17,948

$
18,517

$
18,689

$
18,676

$
18,765

$
18,943

Cumulative paid losses and loss expenses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
One year later
3,702

3,727

3,703

3,771

3,882

4,037

4,216

4,274

4,072

4,066

 
Two years later
6,122

5,980

5,980

6,273

6,401

6,664

6,897

7,019

6,801


 
Three years later
7,755

7,544

7,752

8,074

8,241

8,503

8,875

9,015



 
Four years later
8,889

8,833

9,048

9,411

9,538

9,928

10,329




 
Five years later
9,903

9,778

10,061

10,395

10,649

11,015





 
Six years later
10,674

10,564

10,845

11,303

11,534






 
Seven years later
11,334

11,216

11,612

12,072







 
Eight years later
11,895

11,883

12,270








 
Nine years later
12,493

12,487









 
Ten years later
13,044










 
Liabilities re-estimated
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
One year later
17,159

17,652

18,005

18,161

18,014

18,315

18,513

18,881

18,904

19,015

 
Two years later
17,347

17,475

17,858

18,004

18,136

18,275

18,686

19,207

19,170


 
Three years later
17,318

17,441

17,700

18,139

18,093

18,299

19,013

19,515



 
Four years later
17,497

17,439

17,866

18,120

18,056

18,629

19,375




 
Five years later
17,613

17,676

17,848

18,092

18,408

18,980





 
Six years later
17,895

17,673

17,857

18,437

18,742






 
Seven years later
17,899

17,749

18,215

18,764







 
Eight years later
18,045

18,097

18,499








 
Nine years later
18,390

18,372









 
Ten years later
18,640










 
Deficiency (redundancy), net of reinsurance
$
1,777

$
768

$
268

$
417

$
532

$
1,032

$
858

$
826

$
494

$
250




60



The previous table shows the cumulative deficiency (redundancy) of the Company’s reserves, net of reinsurance, as now estimated with the benefit of additional information. Those amounts are comprised of changes in estimates of gross losses and changes in estimates of related reinsurance recoveries.
The following table, for the periods presented, reconciles the net reserves to the gross reserves, as initially estimated and recorded, and as currently estimated and recorded, and computes the cumulative deficiency (redundancy) of the Company’s reserves before reinsurance.
Loss And Loss Adjustment Expense Liability Development — Gross
Years Ended December 31,
 
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
Net reserve, as initially estimated
$
17,604

$
18,231

$
18,347

$
18,210

$
17,948

$
18,517

$
18,689

$
18,676

$
18,765

$
18,943

Reinsurance and other recoverables, as initially estimated
4,387

3,922

3,586

3,441

3,077

3,033

3,027

3,028

3,041

2,882

Gross reserve, as initially estimated
$
21,991

$
22,153

$
21,933

$
21,651

$
21,025

$
21,550

$
21,716

$
21,704

$
21,806

$
21,825

Net re-estimated reserve
$
18,372

$
18,499

$
18,764

$
18,742

$
18,980

$
19,375

$
19,515

$
19,170

$
19,015

 
Re-estimated reinsurance and other recoverables
4,890

4,611

4,292

3,891

3,544

3,466

3,271

3,210

3,181

 
Gross re-estimated reserve
$
23,262

$
23,110

$
23,056

$
22,633

$
22,524

$
22,841

$
22,786

$
22,380

$
22,196

 
Gross deficiency (redundancy)
$
1,271

$
957

$
1,123

$
982

$
1,499

$
1,291

$
1,070

$
676

$
390

 
The following table is derived from the Loss Development table and summarizes the effect of reserve re-estimates, net of reinsurance, on calendar year operations for the ten-year period ended December 31, 2015. The total of each column details the amount of reserve re-estimates made in the indicated calendar year and shows the accident years to which the re-estimates are applicable. The amounts in the total accident year column on the far right represent the cumulative reserve re-estimates during the ten year period ended December 31, 2015 for the indicated accident year(s).
Effect of Net Reserve Re-estimates on Calendar Year Operations
 
Calendar Year
 
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
Total
By Accident Year
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2005 & Prior
$
296

$
188

$
(29
)
$
179

$
116

$
282

$
4

$
145

$
346

$
250

$
1,777

2006

(140
)
(148
)
(213
)
(118
)
(45
)
(7
)
(69
)
2

25

(713
)
2007


(49
)
(113
)
(156
)
(71
)
(15
)
(67
)
10

9

(452
)
2008



(39
)
1

(31
)
(1
)
(37
)
(13
)
43

(77
)
2009




(39
)
(13
)
(24
)
(8
)
7

7

(70
)
2010





245

3

61

(22
)
16

303

2011






36

148

(4
)
12

192

2012







19


(55
)
(36
)
2013








(98
)
(43
)
(141
)
2014









(14
)
(14
)
Total increase (decrease)
$
296

$
48

$
(226
)
$
(186
)
$
(196
)
$
367

$
(4
)
$
192

$
228

$
250

$
769


61



Reserve changes for accident years 2005 and Prior
The largest impacts of net reserve re-estimates are shown in the “2005 & Prior” accident years. The net reserve re-estimates are driven, in part, by increased reserves for asbestos, environmental, assumed casualty reinsurance, workers’ compensation and general liability claims. Numerous actuarial assumptions on assumed casualty reinsurance turned out to be low, including loss cost trends, particularly on excess of loss business, and the impact of deteriorating terms and conditions.
The net reserve re-estimates in 2006 were largely attributable to decreases in the reinsurance recoverable asset associated with older, long-term casualty liabilities, and unexpected unfavorable development on mature claims in both general liability and workers’ compensation. In contrast, catastrophe reserves related to the 2004 and 2005 hurricanes developed favorably in 2006.
In 2007, the Company refined its processes for allocating incurred but not reported (“IBNR”) reserves by accident year, resulting in a reclassification of $347 of IBNR reserves from the 2003 to 2006 accident years to the 2002 and prior accident years. This reclassification of reserves by accident year had no effect on total recorded reserves within any segment or on total recorded reserves for any line of business within a segment.
The reserve re-estimates in 2009, 2010, 2011, 2013, 2014 and 2015 were largely driven by increases in asbestos and environmental reserves, resulting from the Company’s annual evaluations of these liabilities. These reserve evaluations reflect deterioration in the litigation environment surrounding asbestos and environmental liabilities during this period.
Reserve changes for accident years 2006 through 2009
During 2007 and 2008, the Company recognized favorable re-estimates of both loss and allocated loss adjustment expenses for the 2006 and 2007 accident years on workers’ compensation claims, driven, in part, by state regulatory reforms in California and Florida, underwriting actions, and expense reduction initiatives that had a greater impact in controlling costs than originally estimated.
Even after considering the reclassification of IBNR reserves, accident years 2006 and 2007 show favorable reserve development in 2007 through 2011. A portion of the favorable reserve development comes from short-tail lines of business, where results emerge quickly.
Unfavorable reserve re-estimates in 2015 for accident years 2006 and 2008 are primarily related to elevated workers' compensation loss emergence. Accident year 2008 was also unfavorably impacted in 2015 by an increase in general liability reserves.
In 2007, the Company decreased reserves for accident year 2006 package business claims as reported losses emerged favorably to previous expectations. In 2007 through 2009, the Company decreased reserves for accident year 2006 general liability claims due to the favorable emergence of losses for high hazard and umbrella general liability claims. Reserves for professional liability claims were decreased in 2008 and 2009 related to the 2006 and 2007 accident years due to a lower estimate of claim severity on both directors’ and officers’ insurance claims and errors and omissions insurance claims. Reserves for Personal Lines auto liability claims were decreased in 2008 due largely to an improvement in emerged claim severity for the 2006 and 2007 accident years.
Modest favorable reserve re-estimates in 2010 through 2013 for accident year 2009 are primarily related to liability lines of business.
Reserve changes for accident years 2010 and 2011
Unfavorable reserve re-estimates in 2011 on accident year 2010 were largely driven by workers' compensation. Loss cost trends were higher than initially expected as an increase in frequency outpaced a moderation of severity trends. Unfavorable reserve re-estimates in 2013 on accident year 2010 and 2011 were primarily related to workers' compensation and commercial auto liability. Workers' compensation loss cost trends were higher than initially expected as an increase in frequency outpaced a moderation of severity trends. Unfavorable commercial auto liability reserve re-estimates were driven by higher frequency of large loss bodily injury claims.
Favorable reserve re-estimates in 2014 for accident year 2010 were driven by lower frequency of professional liability reported claims, favorable bond claim emergence and lower frequency of late emerging liability claims.
Modest unfavorable reserve re-estimates in 2015 for accident years 2010 and 2011 were driven by increased reserves in commercial auto liability due to increased severity of large claims.
Reserve changes for accident years 2012 and 2013
Modest unfavorable reserve re-estimates during 2013 for accident year 2012 were primarily related to commercial auto liability driven by higher frequency of large loss loss bodily injury claims offset by reserve releases related to Storm Sandy. Reserves were decreased in 2015 for accident year 2012 due to favorable frequency and medical severity trends for workers' compensation, favorable professional liability claim emergence and lower frequency of late emerging general liability claims, partially offset by increased reserves in commercial auto liability due to increased severity of large claims.

62



Reserves were decreased in 2014 for accident year 2013 driven by lower estimated claim handling costs for workers' compensation and lower frequency of reported claims for professional liability. Reserves were also decreased in 2014 for accident year 2013 driven by favorable development of fourth quarter catastrophes and favorable emergence of losses for property lines of business. Reserves were decreased in 2015 for accident year 2013 driven by favorable frequency and medical severity trends for workers' compensation and favorable professional liability claim emergence, partially offset by unfavorable reserve re-estimates in commercial auto liability driven by increased severity of large claims.
Reserve changes for accident year 2014
Reserves were decreased in 2015 driven by favorable frequency and medical severity trends for workers' compensation and favorable development of fourth quarter catastrophes, partially offset by increased severity of liability claims on package business.
Estimated Gross Profits Used in the Valuation and Amortization of Assets and Liabilities Associated with Variable Annuity and Other Universal Life-Type Contracts
Estimated gross profits (“EGPs”) are used in the amortization of the deferred policy acquisition costs ("DAC") asset and sales inducement assets (“SIA”). Portions of EGPs are also used in the valuation of reserves for death and other insurance benefit features on variable annuity and other universal life type contracts.
The most significant EGP based balances are as follows:
 
Talcott Resolution
 
As of December 31,
 
2015
2014
DAC [1]
$
1,180

$
1,200

SIA
$
56

$
89

Death and Other Insurance Benefit Reserves, net of reinsurance [2]
$
340

$
331

[1]
For additional information on DAC, see Note 7 - Deferred Policy Acquisition Costs of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
[2]
For additional information on death and other insurance benefit reserves, see Note 9 - Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Unlocks
The benefit (charge) to income from continuing operations, net of tax by asset and liability as a result of the Unlocks is as follows:
 
Talcott Resolution
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
DAC
$
69

$
(136
)
$
(199
)
SIA
(17
)
(35
)
(20
)
URR

42

16

Death and Other Insurance Benefit Reserves
28

34

36

Total (before tax)
$
80

$
(95
)
$
(167
)
Income tax effect
28

(33
)
(58
)
Total (after-tax)
$
52

$
(62
)
$
(109
)
The Unlock benefit, after-tax, for the year ended December 31, 2015 was primarily due to assumption changes related to benefit utilization and lower assumed lapse rates, partially offset by a lower assumed general account spread and higher assumed withdrawal rates.
The Unlock charge for the year ended December 31, 2014 was primarily due to lower future estimated gross profits on the fixed annuity block driven by the continued low interest rate environment as well as higher variable annuity unit costs due to higher than expected surrenders, partially offset by actual separate account returns being above our aggregated estimated returns during the period.
The Unlock charge for the year ended December 31, 2013 was primarily due to assumption changes in connection with the annual policyholder behavior assumption study, partially offset by actual separate account returns above our aggregated estimated returns during the period.

63



For most annuity contracts, the Company estimates gross profits over 20 years as EGPs emerging subsequent to that time frame are immaterial. Products sold in a particular year are aggregated into cohorts. Future gross profits for each cohort are projected over the estimated lives of the underlying contracts, based on future account value projections for variable annuity products. The projection of future account values requires the use of certain assumptions including: separate account returns; separate account fund mix; fees assessed against the contract holder’s account balance; surrender and lapse rates; interest margin; mortality; and the extent and duration of hedging activities and hedging costs. Changes in these assumptions and changes to other policyholder behavior assumptions such as resets, partial surrenders, reaction to price increases, and asset allocations cause EGPs to fluctuate, which impacts earnings.
The Company determines EGPs from a single deterministic reversion to mean (“RTM”) separate account return projection which is an estimation technique commonly used by insurance entities to project future separate account returns. Through this estimation technique, the Company’s DAC model is adjusted to reflect actual account values at the end of each quarter. Through consideration of recent market returns, the Company will unlock, or adjust, projected returns over a future period so that the account value returns to the long-term expected rate of return, providing that those projected returns do not exceed certain caps. The Unlock for future separate account returns is determined each quarter. Under RTM, the expected long term weighted average rate of return is 8.3%.
In the fourth quarter of 2015, the Company completed a comprehensive policyholder behavior assumption study which resulted in a non-market related after-tax benefit of $9 and incorporated the results of that study into its projection of future gross profits. Additionally, throughout the year, the Company evaluates various aspects of policyholder behavior and will revise its policyholder assumptions if credible emerging data indicates that changes are warranted. The Company will continue to evaluate its assumptions related to policyholder behavior as initiatives to reduce the size of the annuity business are implemented by management. Upon completion of an annual assumption study or evaluation of credible new information, the Company will revise its assumptions to reflect its current best estimate. These assumption revisions will change the projected account values and the related EGPs in the DAC and SIA amortization models, as well as the death and other insurance benefit reserving model.
All assumption changes that affect the estimate of future EGPs including the update of current account values, the use of the RTM estimation technique and policyholder behavior assumptions are considered an Unlock in the period of revision. An Unlock adjusts DAC, SIA, and death and other insurance benefit reserve balances in the Consolidated Balance Sheets with an offsetting benefit or charge in the Consolidated Statements of Operations in the period of the revision. An Unlock that results in an after-tax benefit generally occurs as a result of actual experience or future expectations of product profitability being favorable compared to previous estimates. An Unlock that results in an after-tax charge generally occurs as a result of actual experience or future expectations of product profitability being unfavorable compared to previous estimates.
EGPs are also used to determine the expected excess benefits and assessments included in the measurement of death and other insurance benefit reserves. These excess benefits and assessments are derived from a range of stochastic scenarios that have been calibrated to the Company’s RTM separate account returns. The determination of death and other insurance benefit reserves is also impacted by discount rates, lapses, volatilities, mortality assumptions and benefit utilization, including assumptions around annuitization rates.
In addition to updating assumptions in the fourth quarter of each year, an Unlock revises EGPs, on a quarterly basis, to reflect the Company’s current best estimate assumptions and market updates of policyholder account value. Modifications to the Company’s hedging programs may impact EGPs, and correspondingly impact DAC recoverability. After each quarterly Unlock, the Company also tests the aggregate recoverability of DAC by comparing the DAC balance to the present value of future EGPs. The margin between the DAC balance and the present value of future EGPs for variable annuities was 40% as of December 31, 2015. If the margin between the DAC asset and the present value of future EGPs is exhausted, then further reductions in EGPs would cause portions of DAC to be unrecoverable and the DAC asset would be written down to equal future EGPs.
Evaluation of OTTI on Available-for-Sale Securities and Valuation Allowances on Mortgage Loans
The Company has a monitoring process that is overseen by a committee of investment and accounting professionals which identifies investments that are subject to an enhanced evaluation on a quarterly basis to determine if an other-than-temporary impairment (“impairment”) is present for AFS securities or a valuation allowance is required for mortgage loans. This evaluation is a quantitative and qualitative process, which is subject to risks and uncertainties. For further discussion of the accounting policies, see the Significant Investment Accounting Policies Section in Note 1 - Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. For a discussion of impairments recorded, see the Other-Than-Temporary Impairments within the Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management section of the MD&A.

64



Living Benefits Required to be Fair Valued (in Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable)
Fair values for GMWBs classified as embedded derivatives are calculated using the income approach based upon internally developed models, because active, observable markets do not exist for those items. The fair value of these GMWBs and the related reinsurance and customized freestanding derivatives are calculated as an aggregation of the following components: Best Estimate Claim Payments; Credit Standing Adjustment; and Margins. The resulting aggregation is reconciled or calibrated, if necessary, to market information that is, or may be, available to the Company, but may not be observable by other market participants, including reinsurance discussions and transactions. The Company believes the aggregation of these components, as necessary and as reconciled or calibrated to the market information available to the Company, results in an amount that the Company would be required to transfer to or receive from market participants in an active liquid market, if one existed, for those market participants to assume the risks associated with the guaranteed minimum benefits and the related reinsurance and customized derivatives. The fair value is likely to materially diverge from the ultimate settlement of the liability as the Company believes settlement will be based on our best estimate assumptions rather than those best estimate assumptions plus risk margins. In the absence of any transfer of the guaranteed benefit liability to a third party, the release of risk margins is likely to be reflected as realized gains in future periods’ net income. Oversight of the Company's valuation policies and processes for product and GMWB reinsurance derivatives is performed by a multidisciplinary group comprised of finance, actuarial and risk management professionals. This multidisciplinary group reviews and approves changes and enhancements to the Company's valuation model as well as associated controls
For further discussion on the impact of fair value changes from living benefits see Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, and for a discussion on the sensitivities of certain living benefits due to capital market factors see Part II, Item 7, MD&A — Variable Product Guarantee Risks and Risk Management.
Evaluation of Goodwill for Impairment
Goodwill balances are reviewed for impairment at least annually or more frequently if events occur or circumstances change that would indicate that a triggering event for a potential impairment has occurred. The goodwill impairment test follows a two-step process. In the first step, the fair value of a reporting unit is compared to its carrying value. If the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the impairment test is performed for purposes of measuring the impairment. In the second step, the fair value of the reporting unit is allocated to all of the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit to determine an implied goodwill value. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit’s goodwill exceeds the implied goodwill value, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.
Management’s determination of the fair value of each reporting unit incorporates multiple inputs into discounted cash flow calculations including assumptions that market participants would make in valuing the reporting unit. Assumptions include levels of economic capital, future business growth, earnings projections, assets under management for Mutual Funds, and the weighted average cost of capital used for purposes of discounting. Decreases in the amount of legal entity capital held or economic capital allocated to a reporting unit, decreases in business growth, decreases in earnings projections and increases in the weighted average cost of capital will all cause a reporting unit’s fair value to decrease, increasing the possibility of impairment.
A reporting unit is defined as an operating segment or one level below an operating segment. The Company’s reporting units, for which goodwill has been allocated, are equivalent to the Company’s operating segments of Group Benefits, Personal Lines and Mutual Funds.
The carrying value of goodwill is $498 as of December 31, 2015 and is comprised of $241 for Mutual Funds, $138 for Group Benefits and $119 for Personal Lines.
The annual goodwill assessment for the Mutual Funds, Group Benefits and Personal Lines reporting units was completed as of October 31, 2015, which resulted in no write-downs of goodwill for the year ended December 31, 2015. All reporting units passed the first step of the annual impairment test with a significant margin. For information regarding the 2014 and 2013 impairment tests see Note 8 -Goodwill of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

65



Valuation of Investments and Derivative Instruments
Fixed Maturities, AFS; Equity Securities, AFS; Equity Securities, FVO, Fixed Maturities, FVO; Equity Securities, Trading; and Short-term Investments
The fair value of fixed maturities, equity securities, and short-term investments in an active and orderly market (i.e., not distressed or forced liquidation) are determined by management after considering the following pricing sources: quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities, prices from third-party services, independent broker quotations or internal matrix pricing processes. Security pricing is applied using a “waterfall” approach whereby publicly available prices are first sought from third-party pricing services, any remaining unpriced securities are submitted to independent brokers for prices, or lastly, securities are priced using an internal pricing matrix. Typical inputs used by these pricing sources include, but are not limited to, benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, bids, offers, and/or estimated cash flows, prepayment speeds and default rates. Most fixed maturities do not trade daily. Based on the typical trading volumes and the lack of quoted market prices for fixed maturities, third-party pricing services utilize matrix pricing to derive security prices. Matrix pricing relies on securities' relationships to other benchmark quoted securities, which trade more frequently. Pricing services utilize recently reported trades of identical or similar securities making adjustments through the reporting date based on the preceding outlined available market observable information. If there are no recently reported trades, the third-party pricing services may develop a security price using expected future cash flows based upon collateral performance and discounted at an estimated market rate. Both matrix pricing and discounted cash flow techniques develop prices by factoring in the time value for cash flows and risk, including liquidity and credit.
Included in the pricing of asset-backed-securities ("ABS") and residential mortgage-backed securities ("RMBS") are estimates of the rate of future prepayments of principal over the remaining life of the securities. Such estimates are derived based upon the characteristics of the underlying structure and prepayment speeds previously experienced at the interest rate levels projected for the underlying collateral. Actual prepayment experience may vary from these estimates. For further discussion, see the AFS Securities, Equity Securities, FVO Fixed Maturities, FVO, Equity Securities, Trading, and Short-Term Investments section in Note 4 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
The Company has analyzed the third-party pricing services' valuation methodologies and related inputs, and has also evaluated the various types of securities in its investment portfolio to determine an appropriate fair value hierarchy level based upon trading activity and the observability of market inputs. For further discussion of fair value measurement, see Note 4 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Derivative Instruments, including Embedded Derivatives within Investments
The fair value of derivative instruments is determined using pricing valuation models for over-the-counter ("OTC") derivatives that utilize market data inputs, quoted market prices for exchanged-traded derivatives and transactions cleared through central clearing houses ("OTC-cleared"), or independent broker quotations. Excluding embedded and reinsurance related derivatives, as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, 96% and 96%, respectively, of derivatives, based upon notional values, were priced by valuation models or quoted market prices. The remaining derivatives were priced by broker quotations. The derivatives are valued using mid-market level inputs that are predominantly observable in the market with the exception of the customized swap contracts that hedge GMWB liabilities. Inputs used to value derivatives include, but are not limited to, swap interest rates, foreign currency forward and spot rates, credit spreads and correlations, interest and equity volatility and equity index levels. For further discussion on derivative instrument valuation methodologies, see the Derivative Instruments, including embedded derivatives within the investments section in Note 4 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. For further discussion on GMWB and other guaranteed living benefits valuation methodologies, see the Living Benefits Required to be Fair Valued section in Note 4 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Limited Partnerships and Other Alternative Investments
Limited partnerships and other alternative investments include hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value. These funds are fair valued using the net asset value per share or equivalent (“NAV”), as a practical expedient, calculated on a monthly basis and is the amount at which a unit or shareholder may redeem their investment, if redemption is allowed. Certain impediments to redemption include, but are not limited to the following: 1) redemption notice periods vary and may be as long as 90 days, 2) redemption may be restricted (e.g. only be allowed on a quarter-end), 3) a holding period referred to as a lock-up may be imposed whereby an investor must hold their investment for a specified period of time before they can make a notice for redemption, 4) gating provisions may limit all redemptions in a given period to a percentage of the entities' equity interests, or may only allow an investor to redeem a portion of their investment at one time and 5) early redemption penalties may be imposed that are expressed as a percentage of the amount redeemed. The Company regularly assesses impediments to redemption and current market conditions that will restrict the redemption at the end of the notice period. For further discussion of fair value measurement, see Note 4 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. In addition, certain limited partnerships and other alternative investments are accounted for under the equity method of accounting. For further discussion, see the Investments - Overview section of Note 1 of Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

66



Valuation Allowance on Deferred Tax Assets
Deferred tax assets represent the tax benefit of future deductible temporary differences and tax carryforwards. Deferred tax assets are measured using the enacted tax rates expected to be in effect when such benefits are realized if there is no change in tax law. Under U.S. GAAP, we test the value of deferred tax assets for impairment on a quarterly basis at the entity level within each tax jurisdiction, consistent with our filed tax returns. Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance if, based on the weight of available evidence, it is more likely than not that some portion, or all, of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The determination of the valuation allowance for our deferred tax assets requires management to make certain judgments and assumptions. In evaluating the ability to recover deferred tax assets, we have considered all available evidence as of December 31, 2015, including past operating results, forecasted earnings, future taxable income, and prudent and feasible tax planning strategies. In the event we determine it is more likely than not that we will not be able to realize all or part of our deferred tax assets in the future, an increase to the valuation allowance would be charged to earnings in the period such determination is made. Likewise, if it is later determined that it is more likely than not that those deferred tax assets would be realized, the previously provided valuation allowance would be reversed. Our judgments and assumptions are subject to change given the inherent uncertainty in predicting future performance and specific industry and investment market conditions.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company has recorded a deferred tax asset valuation allowance of $79 and $181, respectively, relating primarily to U.S. capital loss carryovers. The reduction in the valuation allowance stems primarily from taxable gains on the termination of derivatives during the period. In assessing the need for a valuation allowance, management considered future taxable temporary difference reversals, future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryovers, taxable income in open carry back years and other tax planning strategies. From time to time, tax planning strategies could include holding a portion of debt securities with market value losses until recovery, altering the level of tax exempt securities held, making investments which have specific tax characteristics, and business considerations such as asset-liability matching. Management views such tax planning strategies as prudent and feasible and would implement them, if necessary, to realize the deferred tax assets.
Contingencies Relating to Corporate Litigation and Regulatory Matters
Management evaluates each contingent matter separately. A loss is recorded if probable and reasonably estimable. Management establishes reserves for these contingencies at its “best estimate,” or, if no one number within the range of possible losses is more probable than any other, the Company records an estimated reserve at the low end of the range of losses.
The Company has a quarterly monitoring process involving legal and accounting professionals. Legal personnel first identify outstanding corporate litigation and regulatory matters posing a reasonable possibility of loss. These matters are then jointly reviewed by accounting and legal personnel to evaluate the facts and changes since the last review in order to determine if a provision for loss should be recorded or adjusted, the amount that should be recorded, and the appropriate disclosure. The outcomes of certain contingencies currently being evaluated by the Company, which relate to corporate litigation and regulatory matters, are inherently difficult to predict, and the reserves that have been established for the estimated settlement amounts are subject to significant changes. Management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such lawsuits, after consideration of provisions made for estimated losses, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition of the Company. In view of the uncertainties regarding the outcome of these matters, as well as the tax-deductibility of payments, it is possible that the ultimate cost to the Company of these matters could exceed the reserve by an amount that would have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated results of operations and liquidity in a particular quarterly or annual period.

67



KEY PERFORMANCE MEASURES AND RATIOS
The Company considers the measures and ratios in the following discussion to be key performance indicators for its businesses. Management believes that these ratios and measures are useful in understanding the underlying trends in The Hartford’s businesses. However, these key performance indicators should only be used in conjunction with, and not in lieu of, the results presented in the segment discussions that follow in this MD&A. These ratios and measures may not be comparable to other performance measures used by the Company’s competitors.
Definitions of Non-GAAP and other Measures and Ratios
Account Value
Account value includes policyholders’ balances for investment contracts and reserves for future policy benefits for insurance contracts. Account value is a measure used by the Company because a significant portion of the Company’s fee income is based upon the level of account value. These revenues increase or decrease with a rise or fall in the amount of account value whether caused by changes in the market or through net flows.
Assets Under Management
Assets under management (“AUM”) include account values and mutual fund assets. AUM is a measure used by the Company because a significant portion of the Company’s revenues are based upon asset values. These revenues increase or decrease with a rise or fall in AUM whether caused by changes in the market or through net flows.
Catastrophe Ratio
The catastrophe ratio (a component of the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio) represents the ratio of catastrophe losses incurred in the current calendar year (net of reinsurance) to earned premiums and includes catastrophe losses incurred for both the current and prior accident years. A catastrophe is an event that causes $25 or more in industry insured property losses and affects a significant number of property and casualty policyholders and insurers. The catastrophe ratio includes the effect of catastrophe losses, but does not include the effect of reinstatement premiums.
Combined Ratio
The combined ratio is the sum of the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio, the expense ratio and the policyholder dividend ratio. This ratio is a relative measurement that describes the related cost of losses and expenses for every $100 of earned premiums. A combined ratio below 100 demonstrates underwriting profit; a combined ratio above 100 demonstrates underwriting losses.
Combined Ratio before Catastrophes and Prior Accident Year Development
The combined ratio before catastrophes and prior accident year development, a non-GAAP financial measure, represents the combined ratio for the current accident year, excluding the impact of catastrophes. Combined ratio is the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure. A reconciliation of combined ratio to combined ratio before prior accident year development for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 is set forth in MD&A - Commercial Lines and Personal Lines.
Core Earnings
Core earnings, a non-GAAP measure, is an important measure of the Company’s operating performance. The Company believes that core earnings provides investors with a valuable measure of the performance of the Company’s ongoing businesses because it reveals trends in our insurance and financial services businesses that may be obscured by including the net effect of certain realized capital gains and losses, certain restructuring and other costs, pension settlements, loss on extinguishment of debt, reinsurance gains and losses from disposal of businesses, income tax benefit from reduction in deferred income tax valuation allowance, discontinued operations, and the impact of Unlocks to DAC, SIA, and death and other insurance benefit reserve balances. Some realized capital gains and losses are primarily driven by investment decisions and external economic developments, the nature and timing of which are unrelated to the insurance and underwriting aspects of our business. Accordingly, core earnings excludes the effect of all realized gains and losses (net of tax and the effects of DAC) that tend to be highly variable from period to period based on capital market conditions. The Company believes, however, that some realized capital gains and losses are integrally related to our insurance operations, so core earnings includes net realized gains and losses such as net periodic settlements on credit derivatives. These net realized gains and losses are directly related to an offsetting item included in the income statement such as net investment income. Net income (loss) is the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure. Core earnings should not be considered as a substitute for net income (loss) and does not reflect the overall profitability of the Company’s business. Therefore, the Company believes that it is useful for investors to evaluate both net income (loss) and core earnings when reviewing the Company’s performance.

68



A reconciliation of net income to core earnings is set forth in the following table:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

Less: Unlock benefit (charge), after-tax
52

(62
)
(109
)
Less: Net realized capital gains (losses), after-tax and DAC, excluded from core earnings [1]
(114
)
(20
)
121

Less: Restructuring and other costs, after-tax
(13
)
(49
)
(44
)
Less: Pension settlement, after-tax

(83
)

Less: Loss on extinguishment of debt, after-tax
(14
)

(138
)
Less: Net reinsurance gain (loss) on dispositions, after-tax
18

15

(24
)
Less: Income tax benefit from reduction in valuation allowance
94



Less: Income (loss) from discontinued operations, after-tax
9

(551
)
(1,049
)
Core earnings
$
1,650

$
1,548

$
1,419

[1]
Excludes net realized gain on dispositions of $1.0 billion, after-tax, for the year ended December 31, 2013 relating to the sales of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses which are included in net reinsurance loss on dispositions, after-tax.
Core Earnings Margin
Core earnings margin is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company uses to evaluate, and believes is an important measure of, the Group Benefits segment’s operating performance. Core earnings margin is calculated by dividing core earnings by revenues excluding buyouts and realized gains (losses). Net income margin is the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure. The Company believes that core earnings margin provides investors with a valuable measure of the performance of Group Benefits because it reveals trends in the business that may be obscured by the effect of buyouts and realized gains (losses). Core earnings margin should not be considered as a substitute for net income margin and does not reflect the overall profitability of Group Benefits. Therefore, the Company believes it is important for investors to evaluate both core earnings margin and net income margin when reviewing performance. A reconciliation of net income margin to core earnings margin for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 is set forth in the Margin section within MD&A - Group Benefits.
Current Accident Year Loss and Loss Adjustment Expense Ratio before Catastrophes
The current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes is a measure of the cost of non-catastrophe claims incurred in the current accident year divided by earned premiums. Management believes that the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes is a performance measure that is useful to investors as it removes the impact of volatile and unpredictable catastrophe losses and prior accident year development.
Expense Ratio
The expense ratio for the underwriting segments of Commercial Lines and Personal Lines is the ratio of underwriting expenses to earned premiums. Underwriting expenses include the amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs and insurance operating costs and expenses, including certain centralized services and bad debt expense. Deferred policy acquisition costs include commissions, taxes, licenses and fees and other underwriting expenses and are amortized over the policy term.
The expense ratio for Group Benefits is expressed as the ratio of insurance operating costs and other expenses and amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs, to premiums and other considerations, excluding buyout premiums.
Fee Income
Fee income is largely driven from amounts collected as a result of contractually defined percentages of assets under management. These fees are generally collected on a daily basis. Therefore, the growth in assets under management either through positive net flows or net sales, or favorable market performance will have a favorable impact on fee income. Conversely, either negative net flows or net sales, or unfavorable market performance will reduce fee income.
Full Surrender Rates
Full surrender rates are an internal measure of contract surrenders calculated using annualized full surrenders divided by a two-point average of annuity account values. The full surrender rate represents full contract liquidation and excludes partial withdrawals.

69



Loss and Loss Adjustment Expense Ratio
The loss and loss adjustment expense ratio is a measure of the cost of claims incurred in the calendar year divided by earned premium and includes losses incurred for both the current and prior accident years, as well as the costs of mortality and morbidity and other contractholder benefits to policyholders. Among other factors, the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio needed for the Company to achieve its targeted return on equity fluctuates from year to year based on changes in the expected investment yield over the claim settlement period, the timing of expected claim settlements and the targeted returns set by management based on the competitive environment.
The loss and loss adjustment expense ratio is affected by claim frequency and claim severity, particularly for shorter-tail property lines of business, where the emergence of claim frequency and severity is credible and likely indicative of ultimate losses. Claim frequency represents the percentage change in the average number of reported claims per unit of exposure in the current accident year compared to that of the previous accident year. Claim severity represents the percentage change in the estimated average cost per claim in the current accident year compared to that of the previous accident year. As one of the factors used to determine pricing, the Company’s practice is to first make an overall assumption about claim frequency and severity for a given line of business and then, as part of the ratemaking process, adjust the assumption as appropriate for the particular state, product or coverage.
Loss Ratio, excluding Buyouts
The loss ratio is utilized for the Group Benefits segment and is expressed as a ratio of benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses to premiums and other considerations, excluding buyout premiums. Since Group Benefits occasionally buys a block of claims for a stated premium amount, the Company excludes this buyout from the loss ratio used for evaluating the underwriting results of the business as buyouts may distort the loss ratio. Buyout premiums represent takeover of open claim liabilities and other non-recurring premium amounts.
Mutual Fund Assets
Mutual fund assets are owned by the shareholders of those funds and not by the Company and therefore are not reflected in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Mutual fund assets are a measure used by the Company because a significant portion of the Company’s revenues are based upon asset values. These revenues increase or decrease with a rise or fall in AUM whether caused by changes in the market or through net flows.
New Business Written Premium
New business written premium represents the amount of premiums charged for policies issued to customers who were not insured with the Company in the previous policy term. New business written premium plus renewal policy written premium equals total written premium.
Policies in Force
Policies in force represent the number of policies with coverage in effect as of the end of the period. The number of policies in force is a growth measure used for Personal Lines and standard commercial lines within Commercial Lines and is affected by both new business growth and policy count retention.
Policy Count Retention
Policy count retention represents the ratio of the number of policies renewed during the period divided by the number of policies available to renew. The number of policies available to renew represents the number of policies, net of any cancellations, written in the previous policy term. Policy count retention is affected by a number of factors, including the percentage of renewal policy quotes accepted and decisions by the Company to non-renew policies because of specific policy underwriting concerns or because of a decision to reduce premium writings in certain classes of business or states. Policy count retention is also affected by advertising and rate actions taken by competitors.
Policyholder Dividend Ratio
The policyholder dividend ratio is the ratio of policyholder dividends to earned premium.
Prior Accident Year Loss and Loss Adjustment Expense Ratio
The prior accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio represents the increase (decrease) in the estimated cost of settling catastrophe and non-catastrophe claims incurred in prior accident years as recorded in the current calendar year divided by earned premiums.

70



Reinstatement Premiums
Reinstatement premium represents additional ceded premium paid for the reinstatement of the amount of reinsurance coverage that was reduced as a result of a reinsurance loss payment.
Renewal Earned Price Increase (Decrease)
Written premiums are earned over the policy term, which is six months for certain Personal Lines auto business and twelve months for substantially all of the remainder of the Company’s Property and Casualty business. Since the Company earns premiums over the six to twelve month term of the policies, renewal earned price increases (decreases) lag renewal written price increases (decreases) by six to twelve months.
Renewal Written Price Increase (Decrease)
Renewal written price increase (decrease) represents the combined effect of rate changes, amount of insurance and individual risk pricing decisions per unit of exposure since the prior year. The rate component represents the change in rate filings during the period and the amount of insurance represents the change in the value of the rating base, such as model year/vehicle symbol for auto, building replacement costs for property and wage inflation for workers’ compensation. A number of factors affect renewal written price increases (decreases) including expected loss costs as projected by the Company’s pricing actuaries, rate filings approved by state regulators, risk selection decisions made by the Company’s underwriters and marketplace competition. Renewal written price changes reflect the property and casualty insurance market cycle. Prices tend to increase for a particular line of business when insurance carriers have incurred significant losses in that line of business in the recent past or the industry as a whole commits less of its capital to writing exposures in that line of business. Prices tend to decrease when recent loss experience has been favorable or when competition among insurance carriers increases. Renewal written price statistics are subject to change from period to period, based on a number of factors, including changes in actuarial estimates and the effect of subsequent cancellations and non-renewals on rate achieved, and modifications made to better reflect ultimate pricing achieved.
Return on Assets (“ROA”), Core Earnings
ROA, core earnings, is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company uses to evaluate, and believes is an important measure of, certain of the segment’s operating performance. ROA is the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure. The Company believes that ROA, core earnings, provides investors with a valuable measure of the performance of certain of the Company’s on-going businesses because it reveals trends in our businesses that may be obscured by the effect of realized gains (losses). ROA, core earnings, should not be considered as a substitute for ROA and does not reflect the overall profitability of our businesses. Therefore, the Company believes it is important for investors to evaluate both ROA, core earnings, and ROA when reviewing the Company’s performance. ROA, core earnings is calculated by dividing core earnings by a two-point average AUM. A reconciliation of ROA to ROA, core earnings for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, is set forth in the ROA section within MD&A - Mutual Funds.
Underwriting Gain (Loss)
The Company's management evaluates profitability of the P&C businesses primarily on the basis of underwriting gain (loss). Underwriting gain (loss) is a before-tax measure that represents earned premiums less incurred losses, loss adjustment expenses and underwriting expenses. Underwriting gain (loss) is influenced significantly by earned premium growth and the adequacy of the Company's pricing. Underwriting profitability over time is also greatly influenced by the Company's pricing and underwriting discipline, which seeks to manage exposure to loss through favorable risk selection and diversification, its management of claims, its use of reinsurance and its ability to manage its expense ratio, which it accomplishes through economies of scale and its management of acquisition costs and other underwriting expenses. Net income (loss) is the most directly comparable GAAP measure. The Company believes that underwriting gain (loss) provides investors with a valuable measure of before-tax profitability derived from underwriting activities, which are managed separately from the Company's investing activities. A reconciliation of underwriting gain (loss) to net income (loss) for Commercial Lines, Personal Lines and Property & Casualty Other Operations is set forth in their respective discussions herein.

71



Written and Earned Premiums
Written premium is a statutory accounting financial measure which represents the amount of premiums charged for policies issued, net of reinsurance, during a fiscal period. Earned premium is a U.S. GAAP and statutory measure. Premiums are considered earned and are included in the financial results on a pro rata basis over the policy period. Management believes that written premium is a performance measure that is useful to investors as it reflects current trends in the Company’s sale of property and casualty insurance products. Written and earned premium are recorded net of ceded reinsurance premium.
Traditional life insurance type products, such as those sold by Group Benefits, collect premiums from policyholders in exchange for financial protection for the policyholder from a specified insurable loss, such as death or disability. These premiums together with net investment income earned from the overall investment strategy are used to pay the contractual obligations under these insurance contracts. Two major factors, new sales and persistency, impact premium growth. Sales can increase or decrease in a given year based on a number of factors, including but not limited to, customer demand for the Company’s product offerings, pricing competition, distribution channels and the Company’s reputation and ratings. Persistency refers to the percentage of policies remaining in-force from year-to-year.

72




COMMERCIAL LINES
Results of Operations
Underwriting Summary
2015
2014
2013
Written premiums
$
6,625

$
6,381

$
6,208

Change in unearned premium reserve
114

92

5

Earned premiums
6,511

6,289

6,203

Losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
3,712

3,733

3,897

Current accident year catastrophes
121

109

105

Prior accident year development
53

13

83

Total losses and loss adjustment expenses
3,886

3,855

4,085

Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs
951

919

905

Underwriting expenses
1,178

1,086

1,082

Dividends to policyholders
17

15

16

Underwriting gain
479

414

115

Net servicing income [1]
20

23

21

Net investment income
910

958

984

Net realized capital gains (losses)
(6
)
(30
)
72

Other expenses
2

(3
)
(1
)
Income from continuing operations before income taxes
1,405

1,362

1,191

Income tax expense
409

385

320

Income from continuing operations, net of tax
996

977

871

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
7

6

(1
)
Net income
$
1,003

$
983

$
870

[1]
Includes servicing revenues of $87, $113, and $112 for the years ended December 31, 2015, December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013 respectively.
Premium Measures [1]
2015
2014
2013
New business premium
$
1,121

$
1,088

$
1,035

Standard commercial lines policy count retention
84
%
84
%
81
%
Standard commercial lines renewal written pricing increase
2
%
5
%
7
%
Standard commercial lines renewal earned pricing increase
4
%
7
%
8
%
Standard commercial lines policies in-force as of end of period (in thousands)
1,325

1,277

1,250

[1]
Standard commercial lines consists of small commercial and middle market. Standard commercial premium measures exclude middle market specialty programs and livestock lines of business.
Underwriting Ratios
2015
2014
2013
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
57.0

59.4

62.8

Current accident year catastrophes
1.9

1.7

1.7

Prior accident year development
0.8

0.2

1.3

Total loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
59.7

61.3

65.9

Expense ratio
32.7

31.9

32.0

Policyholder dividend ratio
0.3

0.2

0.3

Combined ratio
92.6

93.4

98.1

Current accident year catastrophes and prior year development
2.7

1.9

3.0

Combined ratio before catastrophes and prior year development
90.0

91.5

95.1


73



2016 Outlook
The Company expects economic conditions to continue to improve slowly driving a modest increase in exposures, while pricing is anticipated to further moderate. As such, the Company expects low single-digit written premiums growth in 2016 driven by small commercial and middle market where the Company continues to develop comprehensive product solutions, deeper relationships with distribution partners, differentiating customer experiences and enhanced ease of doing business processes and technologies. In specialty lines, the Company expects flat written premium growth as increases in bond and professional liability are expected to be offset by a decline in national accounts. The Company expects the Commercial Lines combined ratio before catastrophes and prior accident year development will be between approximately 89.0 and 91.0 for 2016, compared to 90.0 in 2015, as earned pricing increases are expected to be in-line with long-term loss costs trends.
Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Overview
Net income increased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, primarily due to a higher underwriting gain and lower realized capital losses, partially offset by lower net investment income. The increase in underwriting gain was primarily driven by a lower current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes, partially offset by higher underwriting expenses and unfavorable prior accident year development. Underwriting expenses in 2014 included a reduction of $49, before tax, in the Company's estimated liability for NY State Workers' Compensation Board assessments.
Revenues - Earned and Written Premiums
Earned premiums increased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, reflecting written premium growth over the preceding twelve months.
Written premiums, as compared to prior year period, increased in 2015 in small commercial, middle market and specialty commercial lines. Written premium increased in all small commercial lines of business, particularly in workers’ compensation driven by higher new, renewal and audit premium, as well as in Spectrum package business driven by higher new and renewal premium. Written premium increased in middle market driven primarily by higher new, renewal and audit premium in construction as well as higher new and renewal premium in marine. Written premium increased in specialty commercial primarily as a result of higher retrospective premium on loss sensitive business in national accounts.
Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses increased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, reflecting earned premium growth, unfavorable prior accident year development and modestly higher catastrophes.
The decrease in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, was primarily driven by lower loss and loss adjustment expense ratios in workers' compensation, general liability and financial products, as well as lower non-catastrophe property losses. The decrease in workers compensation was due to earned pricing increases and declining frequency, partially offset by modestly higher severity. Accordingly, the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes decreased by 2.4 points to 57.0 in 2015 from 59.4 in 2014.
Current accident year catastrophe losses totaled $121, before tax, in 2015, compared to $109, before tax, in 2014. Catastrophe losses for both years were primarily due to winter storms and wind and hail events across various U.S. geographic regions. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Prior accident year reserves increased $53, before tax, in 2015, compared to $13, before tax, in 2014. Net reserve increases in 2015 were primarily related to commercial auto liability and package business, as well as workers' compensation discount accretion, partially offset by a decrease in reserves for workers’ compensation and professional liability. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Reserve Roll-forwards and Development.
Underwriting Ratios
The combined ratio, before catastrophes and prior year development, decreased 1.5 points to 90.0 in 2015 from 91.5 in 2014 reflecting improvements in all three business lines within Commercial Lines. The decrease reflected a decrease in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes.
Investment Results
Investment income decreased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).

74



Income Taxes
The effective tax rates in 2015 and 2014 differ from the U.S. Federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
Overview
Net income, as compared to the prior year period, increased in 2014 primarily due to an improvement in underwriting results, driven by lower current accident year losses and loss adjustment expenses before catastrophes and lower prior accident year development, partially offset by a shift to net realized capital losses in the current year from net realized capital gains in the prior year period. Underwriting expenses, compared to the prior year period, reflect a reduction of $49, before tax, in the Company's estimated liability for NY State Workers' Compensation Board assessments.
Revenues - Earned and Written Premium
Earned premiums increased in 2014, reflecting the impact of higher written premiums primarily in small commercial and to a lesser extent in middle market, partially offset by written premium declines in specialty lines.
Written premium increased in all small commercial lines of business, driven by favorable renewal premium due to higher policy count retention and higher written pricing, as well as an increase in new business and higher audit premium on workers' compensation policies. Written premium increases in middle market were driven primarily by higher renewal written premium in property, general liability and auto, partially offset by the impact of underwriting actions that reduced written premium in the programs business. Written premium decreases in specialty lines were primarily the result of underwriting actions to improve profitability of the captives business, partially offset by growth in national accounts and bond.
Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses reflect favorable current accident year losses before catastrophes in all lines of business and lower unfavorable prior accident year development.
The reduction in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes in 2014 was primarily driven by a lower loss and loss adjustment expense ratio in workers' compensation due to earned pricing increases and favorable frequency and severity trends. Accordingly, the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes decreased by 3.4 points to 59.4 in 2014 from 62.8 in 2013.
Current accident year catastrophe losses of $109, before tax, in 2014, compared to $105, before tax, in 2013. Losses in 2014 were primarily due to multiple winter storm and wind and hail events across various U.S. geographic regions. Losses in 2013 were primarily due to multiple wind and hail and tornado events across various U.S. geographic regions. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Prior accident year development increases of $13, before tax, in 2014, compared to $83, before tax, in 2013. Development in 2014 was primarily due to discount accretion on workers' compensation and an increase related to commercial auto liability, partially offset by a decrease of professional and general liability reserves. Development in 2013 was primarily due to increases related to commercial auto liability and the closing of the New York Section 25A Fund for Reopened Cases, partially offset by a decrease of professional and general liability reserves. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Reserve Roll-forwards and Development.
Underwriting Ratios
The combined ratio, before catastrophes and prior year development, improved 3.6 points to 91.5 in 2014 from 95.1 in 2013. The improvement primarily reflects a decrease in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes, as well as a decrease in the expense ratio (including a 0.8 point favorable impact on the expense ratio related to a reduction in NY State Workers' Compensation Board assessments).
Investment Results
Investment income decreased in 2014, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).
Income Taxes
The effective tax rate, in both periods, differs from the U.S. Federal statutory rate primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

75



PERSONAL LINES
Results of Operations
Underwriting Summary
2015
2014
2013
Written premiums
$
3,918

$
3,861

$
3,719

Change in unearned premium reserve
45

55

59

Earned premiums
3,873

3,806

3,660

Losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
2,578

2,498

2,412

Current accident year catastrophes
211

232

207

Prior accident year development
(21
)
(46
)
(39
)
Total losses and loss adjustment expenses
2,768

2,684

2,580

Amortization of DAC
359

348

332

Underwriting expenses
628

604

634

Underwriting gain
118

170

114

Net servicing income [1]
4

3

34

Net investment income
128

129

145

Net realized capital gains (losses)
4

(5
)
34

Other income [2]
15

2

2

Income before income taxes
269

299

329

Income tax expense
82

92

100

Net income
$
187

$
207

$
229

[1]
Includes servicing revenues of $163 for year ended December 31, 2013.
[2]
Includes a benefit of $17, before tax, for the year ended December 31, 2015, from the resolution of litigation.
Written Premiums
2015
2014
2013
Product Line
 
 
 
Automobile
$
2,721

$
2,659

$
2,562

Homeowners
1,197

1,202

1,157

Total
$
3,918

$
3,861

$
3,719

Earned Premiums
 
 
 
Product Line
 
 
 
Automobile
$
2,671

$
2,613

$
2,522

Homeowners
1,202

1,193

1,138

Total
$
3,873

$
3,806

$
3,660


76



Premium Measures
2015
2014
2013
Policies in-force end of period (in thousands)
 
 
 
Automobile
2,062

2,049

2,019

Homeowners
1,272

1,309

1,319

New business written premium
 
 
 
Automobile
$
422

$
415

$
374

Homeowners
$
110

$
130

$
131

Policy count retention
 
 
 
Automobile
84
%
85
%
86
%
Homeowners
85
%
86
%
87
%
Renewal written pricing increase
 
 
 
Automobile
6
%
5
%
5
%
Homeowners
8
%
8
%
7
%
Renewal earned pricing increase
 
 
 
Automobile
6
%
5
%
5
%
Homeowners
8
%
8
%
6
%
Underwriting Ratios
2015
2014
2013
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
66.6

65.6

65.9

Current accident year catastrophes
5.4

6.1

5.7

Prior accident year development
(0.5
)
(1.2
)
(1.1
)
Total loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
71.5

70.5

70.5

Expense ratio
25.5

25.0

26.4

Combined ratio
97.0

95.5

96.9

Current accident year catastrophes and prior year development
4.9

4.9

4.6

Combined ratio before catastrophes and prior year development
92.0

90.6

92.3

Product Combined Ratios
2015
2014
2013
Automobile
 
 
 
Combined ratio
99.4

98.4

99.0

Combined ratio before catastrophes and prior year development
99.0

97.1

98.4

Homeowners
 
 
 
Combined ratio
92.1

90.0

90.7

Combined ratio before catastrophes and prior year development
76.8

76.4

77.5

2016 Outlook
The Company expects written premium growth to decrease slightly in 2016 driven by AARP Agency and Agency Other, partially offset by growth in AARP Direct. The Company expects the combined ratio before catastrophes and prior accident year development will be between approximately 90.0 and 92.0 for 2016 compared to 92.0 in 2015 primarily due to an improvement in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes. For auto, the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes is expected to decrease in 2016, driven by earned pricing increases and the expected benefit of underwriting and claims initiatives partially offset by moderate average claim trends, though subject to uncertainty given the increase in auto claim frequency experienced in the last half of 2015. For homeowners, the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes is expected to decrease slightly in 2016, driven by earned pricing increases partially offset by increased average claim severity.

77



Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Overview
Net income decreased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, primarily due to a lower underwriting gain driven by deterioration in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes and lower favorable prior accident year development, partially offset by a decrease in current accident year catastrophes.
Revenues - Earned and Written Premiums
Earned and written premiums increased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, primarily due to renewal written and earned pricing increases. Policy count retention for both auto and homeowners was lower in 2015, as compared to the prior year, driven in part by renewal written pricing increases and planned underwriting initiatives.
Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses increased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, primarily due to higher current accident year before catastrophe losses and lower favorable prior accident year development partially offset by lower current accident year catastrophe losses.
Current accident year losses and loss adjustment expenses before catastrophes increased in 2015 compared to 2014 as a result of the effect of increases in earned premiums, and increases in auto liability and auto physical damage loss costs, as well as higher homeowners water and fire-related claims, which were partially offset by lower homeowners weather-related claims. The current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes of 66.6 in 2015 increased 1.0 points from from 65.6 in 2014.
Current accident year catastrophe losses of $211, before tax, decreased in 2015 compared to $232, before tax, in 2014. Catastrophe losses in 2015 were primarily due to wildfires in California and multiple events (wind and hail primarily) across various U.S. geographic regions. Catastrophe losses in 2014 were primarily due to multiple thunderstorm and winter storm events across various U.S. geographic regions. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Favorable prior accident year development of $21, before tax, decreased in 2015 compared to $46, before tax, in 2014. Net reserve decreases for 2015 were primarily related to accident year 2014 catastrophes. Net reserve decreases for 2014 were primarily related to prior accident year catastrophes, as well as prior accident year homeowners and extra contractual liability reserves. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Underwriting Ratios
The combined ratio, before current accident year catastrophes and prior year development, increased 1.4 points to 92.0 in 2015 from 90.6 in 2014 reflecting an increase in the current accident year before catastrophes loss and loss adjustment expense ratio due to higher automobile loss costs and increased non-weather losses in homeowners.
Investment Results
Investment income increased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).
Income Taxes
The effective tax rates in 2015 and 2014 differ from the U.S. Federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

78



Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
Overview
Net income, as compared to the prior year period, decreased in 2014 primarily due to a change to net realized capital losses and a decrease in net servicing income, partially offset by improvements in underwriting results, driven by higher earned premiums and lower underwriting expenses.
Revenues - Earned and Written Premiums
Earned and written premiums increased in 2014 reflecting new business written premium growth in auto, primarily from AARP Direct and AARP Agency, improved earned pricing increases in both auto and homeowners, and continued high levels of premium retention.
Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses reflect an increase in current accident year loss and loss adjustment expenses before catastrophes and higher current accident year catastrophes, partially offset by higher favorable prior accident year development.
Current accident year losses and loss adjustment expenses before catastrophes increased in 2014 compared to 2013 driven by growth in earned premium, partially offset by a decline in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes to 65.6 in 2014 from 65.9 in 2013.
Current accident year catastrophe losses of $232, before tax, in 2014 compared to $207, before tax, in 2013. Losses in 2014 were primarily due to multiple thunderstorm and winter storm events across various U.S. geographic regions. Losses in 2013 were primarily due to multiple thunderstorm, hail and tornado events across various U.S. geographic regions. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Prior accident year reserve decreases of $46, before tax, in 2014 compared to $39, before tax, in 2013. Net reserve decrease in 2014 was primarily related to prior accident year catastrophes, as well as prior accident year homeowners and extra contractual liability reserves. Net reserve decrease in 2013 was primarily related to Storm Sandy. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Underwriting Ratios
The combined ratio, before current accident year catastrophes and prior year development, improved to 90.6 in 2014 from 92.3 in 2013.
Investment Results
Investment income decreased in 2014, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).
Income Taxes
The effective tax rates in 2014 and 2013 differ from the U.S. Federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

79



PROPERTY & CASUALTY OTHER OPERATIONS
Results of Operations
Underwriting Summary
2015
2014
2013
Written premiums
$
35

$
2

$
2

Change in unearned premium reserve
3

1

1

Earned premiums
32

1

1

Losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
Current accident year
25



Prior accident year development
218

261

148

Total losses and loss adjustment expenses
243

261

148

Underwriting expenses
32

37

29

Underwriting loss
(243
)
(297
)
(176
)
Net servicing expense


(1
)
Net investment income
133

129

141

Net realized capital gains
3

3

12

Other income
7

6

2

Loss before income taxes
(100
)
(159
)
(22
)
Income tax benefit
(47
)
(51
)
(20
)
Net loss
$
(53
)
$
(108
)
$
(2
)
Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Net loss, as compared to the prior year period, decreased in 2015 primarily due to lower unfavorable net asbestos and environmental reserve development associated with the Company's annual ground-up reserve evaluations. Additionally, in connection with the assumption of previously reinsured business, the Company recognized written premiums of $31 partially offset by current accident year losses of $25 in 2015 upon consolidation of certain P&C run-off entities in the United Kingdom.
Total losses and loss adjustment expenses in 2015 and 2014 include prior accident year development, as a result of the annual ground-up reserve evaluations, of $146 and $212, before tax, respectively, related to asbestos reserves and $52 and $27, respectively, related to environmental reserves. Reserve increases in 2015 were primarily related to an increase in reserves for asbestos and environmental claims due to greater than expected asbestos claim filings, including mesothelioma claims, from a small percentage of the Company's direct accounts and an increase in estimated environmental cleanup costs, including at certain Superfund sites.
Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
Net loss, as compared to the prior year period, increased in 2014 primarily due to higher unfavorable net asbestos and environmental reserve development. As part of its annual ground-up asbestos and environmental reserve evaluations in 2014, the Company increased the associated reserves by $212 and $27, before tax, respectively. Reserve increases in 2014 were primarily due to a higher than previously estimated number of mesothelioma claim filings and an increase in costs associated with asbestos litigation. In 2013, the Company increased its net asbestos and environmental reserves by $130 and $10, before tax, respectively.
The effective tax rates in 2015, 2014 and 2013 differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For further discussion of income taxes, see the Income Taxes section within Note 1 - Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
For information on net asbestos and environmental reserves, see Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims within the Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance section in Critical Accounting Estimates.

80



GROUP BENEFITS
Results of Operations
Operating Summary
2015
2014
2013
Premiums and other considerations [1]
$
3,136

$
3,095

$
3,330

Net investment income
371

374

390

Net realized capital gains (losses)
(11
)
15

50

Total revenues
3,496

3,484

3,770

Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
2,427

2,362

2,518

Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs
31

32

33

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
788

836

964

Total benefits, losses and expenses
3,246

3,230

3,515

Income before income taxes
250

254

255

Income tax expense
63

63

63

Net income [1]
$
187

$
191

$
192

[1]
Group Benefits has a block of Association - Financial Institution business that is subject to a profit sharing arrangement with third parties which was terminated on December 31,2014. The Association - Financial Institutions business represented $72 and $277 of premiums and other considerations, and $1 and $1 of net income in 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Premiums and other considerations
2015
2014
2013
Fully insured — ongoing premiums
$
3,068

$
3,014

$
3,272

Buyout premiums
1

20

1

Fee income
67

61

57

Total premiums and other considerations
3,136

3,095

3,330

Fully insured ongoing sales, excluding buyouts
$
467

$
326

$
393

Ratios, excluding buyouts
2015
2014
2013
Group disability loss ratio
81.6
%
83.5
%
84.0
%
Group life loss ratio
74.7
%
70.5
%
69.5
%
Total loss ratio
77.4
%
76.2
%
75.6
%
Expense ratio
26.1
%
28.2
%
29.9
%
Selected ratios excluding Association - Financial Institutions
 
 
 
Group life loss ratio, excluding Association - Financial Institutions
74.7
%
72.8
%
76.2
%
Total loss ratio, excluding Association - Financial Institutions
77.4
%
77.4
%
79.3
%
Expense ratio, excluding Association - Financial Institutions
26.1
%
27.2
%
26.8
%
Margin
2015
2014
2013
Net income
5.4
 %
5.5
%
5.1
%
Effect of net realized gains/(losses), net of tax on after-tax margin
(0.2
)%
0.3
%
0.8
%
Core earnings
5.6
 %
5.2
%
4.3
%
2016 Outlook
The Company expects premiums to increase for 2016 due primarily to continued strong book persistency. The Company expects Group Benefits' disability and life results to improve as a result of continued pricing actions, improved disability severity, and favorable life mortality compared to 2015. In addition, the Company expects the expense ratio to improve due to the continued focus on expense management. The Company expects Group Benefits' core earnings margin will be between approximately 5.5% and 6.0% for 2016 as compared to 5.6% in 2015.

81



Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Net income decreased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, primarily due to higher benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses, higher net realized capital losses and lower net investment income partially offset by higher premiums and other considerations and lower insurance operating costs and other expenses.
Premiums and other considerations increased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period, due primarily to increased sales and improved persistency and pricing, partially offset by management actions related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business. Excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business, fully insured ongoing premiums increased 4% in 2015. Insurance operating costs and other expenses decreased in 2015, compared to the prior year period, due primarily to lower profit sharing expense related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business.
Fully insured ongoing sales, excluding buyouts increased 43% in 2015, as compared to prior year period, primarily due to an increase in large case accounts.
The total loss ratio increased by 1.2 points in 2015, as compared to the prior year period due to a higher group life loss ratio and the impact of Association - Financial Institutions business in 2014, partially offset by a lower disability loss ratio. Excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business, the total loss ratio was flat to prior year. Excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business, the life loss ratio increased 1.9 points due to favorable changes in reserve assumptions in 2014 and less favorable severity in the current year. The disability loss ratio improved 1.9 points due to changes in long term disability reserve assumptions for claim recoveries which favorably impacted the disability loss ratio by 1.2 points, as well as improved incidence and pricing partially offset by unfavorable long term disability claim severity.
The expense ratio improved 2.1 points in 2015, compared to the prior year period, primarily due to lower profit sharing expense related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business. Excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business, the expense ratio improved 1.1 points reflecting premium growth and lower expenses.
Investment income and net realized capital gains decreased in 2015, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).
The effective tax rate, in both periods, differs from the U.S. Federal statutory rate primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
Net income slightly decreased in 2014, as compared to the prior year period, primarily due to lower premiums and other considerations, net investment income and net realized capital gains, offset by lower benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses and insurance operating costs and other expenses.
Premiums and other considerations decreased in 2014, as compared to the prior year period, due primarily to management actions related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business. Insurance operating costs and other expenses decreased in 2014, compared to the prior year period, due primarily to lower profit sharing expense related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business.
Fully insured ongoing sales, excluding buyouts declined 17% in 2014, as compared to prior year period. Excluding Association - Financial Institutions block of business, fully insured ongoing sales, excluding buyouts decreased 12% in 2014 primarily due to lower large case sales.
The total loss ratio increased by 0.6 points in 2014, as compared to the prior year period. Excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business, the loss ratio improved 1.9 points in 2014 due to improvements in both the life and disability loss ratios. The life loss ratio improvement reflects favorable mortality experience, improved pricing, and the impact of changes in reserve assumptions. The disability loss ratio improvement reflects improved accident year incidence and pricing partially offset by higher new claim severity and less favorable development on prior accident year recoveries.
The expense ratio improved 1.7 points in 2014, compared to the prior year period, primarily due to lower profit sharing expense related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business in relation to lower premium and other considerations.
Core earnings margin improved 0.9 points in 2014, compared to the prior year period. The improvement was primarily due to the improved loss ratio excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business.
Investment income and net realized capital gains decreased in 2014, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).
The effective tax rate, in both periods, differs from the U.S. Federal statutory rate primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

82



MUTUAL FUNDS
Results of Operations
Operating Summary
2015
2014
2013
Fee income and other revenue
$
723

$
723

$
668

Net investment income
1



Total revenues
724

723

668

Amortization of DAC
22

28

39

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
568

559

511

Total benefits, losses and expenses
590

587

550

Income before income taxes
134

136

118

Income tax expense
48

49

42

Net income
$
86

$
87

$
76

 
 
 
 
Average Total Mutual Funds segment AUM
$
92,791

$
95,177

$
92,191

Return on Assets ("ROA")
9.3

9.1

8.2

Effect of restructuring, net of tax

(0.5
)
(0.2
)
Effect of net realized gains, net of tax and DAC


(0.1
)
ROA, core earnings
9.3

9.6

8.5

 
 
 
 
Mutual Funds segment AUM
 
 
 
 Mutual Fund AUM - beginning of period
$
73,035

$
70,918

$
61,611

Sales
17,527

15,249

15,172

Redemptions [1]
(16,036
)
(16,636
)
(19,696
)
Net flows
1,491

(1,387
)
(4,524
)
Change in market value and other
(113
)
3,504

13,831

 Mutual Fund AUM - end of period
$
74,413

$
73,035

$
70,918

Talcott AUM [2]
$
17,549

$
20,584

$
25,817

Total Mutual Funds segment AUM
$
91,962

$
93,619

$
96,735

 
 
 
 
Mutual Fund AUM by Asset Class
 
 
 
Equity
$
47,369

$
45,221

$
42,426

Fixed Income
12,625

14,046

14,632

Multi-Strategy Investments [3]
14,419

13,768

13,860

 Mutual Fund AUM
$
74,413

$
73,035

$
70,918

[1]
The year ended December 31, 2014 includes a planned asset transfer of $0.7 billion to the HIMCO Variable Insurance Trust (“HVIT”) which supports legacy retirement mutual funds and runoff mutual funds (see footnote [2]). HVIT's invested assets are managed by Hartford Investment Management Company, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company.
[2]
Talcott AUM consist of Company-sponsored mutual fund assets held in separate accounts supporting variable insurance and investment products. The year ended December 31, 2014 includes a planned asset transfer of $2.0 billion to HVIT.
[3]
Includes balanced, allocation, target date and alternative investment products.
2016 Outlook
The primary objective of the Mutual Funds segment is to grow total assets under management and core earnings. Strong fund performance, market appreciation, developing and maintaining client relationships and positive net flows are all factors that can increase assets under management. Assuming average historical increases in market levels off of Mutual Funds December 31, 2015 assets under management, the Company expects moderate 2016 earnings growth, driven by improved earnings in the Mutual Funds business, offset by the run-off of the Talcott assets supporting the Company's legacy variable insurance products. A decline in market levels in 2016 would negatively impact earnings.

83



Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Net income decreased in 2015, compared to the prior year period which included a one time state tax benefit, primarily due to a combination of lower average AUM and higher spending on marketing initiatives. Total AUM declined reflecting market depreciation and the continued runoff of Talcott AUM. Mutual fund AUM increased by 2% reflecting higher sales and stable redemption.
Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
Net income, as compared to the prior year period, increased in 2014 primarily due to higher fee revenue driven by higher Mutual Fund average AUM. AUM increased reflecting positive market performance of the Mutual Fund assets throughout the year coupled with year over year improvements in net flows offset by expected runoff of Talcott assets. Redemptions in 2014 included fund liquidations of $0.7 billion and a transfer of HVIT assets within the Hartford of $2.7 billion.


84



TALCOTT RESOLUTION
Results of Operations
Operating Summary
2015
2014
2013
Earned premiums [1]
$
92

$
206

$
94

Fee income and other [1]
1,041

1,201

1,369

Net investment income
1,470

1,542

1,577

Net realized capital (losses) gains
(161
)
26

1,719

Total revenues
2,442

2,975

4,759

Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
1,451

1,643

1,717

Amortization of DAC
139

402

485

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
469

567

645

Reinsurance (gain) loss on disposition in 2014 and 2013, respectively
(28
)
(23
)
1,505

Total benefits, losses and expenses
2,031

2,589

4,352

Income from continuing operations, before income taxes
411

386

407

Income tax expense (benefit)
(17
)
16

(7
)
Income from continuing operations
428

370

414

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax [2]
2

(557
)
(1,048
)
Net income (loss)
$
430

$
(187
)
$
(634
)
Assets Under Management (end of period)
 
 
 
Variable annuity account value
$
44,245

$
52,861

$
81,942

Fixed market value adjusted and payout annuities
8,109

8,748

13,203

Institutional annuity account value
15,077

15,636

16,857

Other account value [4]
88,151

91,163

108,133

Total account value [3]
$
155,582

$
168,408

$
219,127

Variable Annuity Account Value [5]
 
 
 
Account value, beginning of period
$
52,861

$
61,812

$
64,824

Net outflows
(7,938
)
(11,726
)
(14,598
)
Change in market value and other
(678
)
2,775

11,586

Account value, end of period
$
44,245

$
52,861

$
61,812

[1]
Includes earned premiums, fee income and other related to the Retirement Plans business of $38 and the Individual Life business of $2 for the year ended December 31, 2013.
[2]
Represents the loss from operations and sale of HLIKK in 2014 and 2013, and HLIL in 2013. For additional information, see Note 18 Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
[3]
Included in the balance is approximately $(1.0) billion for the year ended December 31, 2013 related to a Talcott Resolution intra-segment funding agreement which eliminates in consolidation.
[4]
Other account value includes $33.2 billion, $14.6 billion, and $40.3 billion as of December 31, 2015, and $36.5 billion, $14.9 billion, $39.8 billion as of December 31, 2014, and $54.7 billion, $14.7 billion, and $38.7 billion as of December 31, 2013, for the Retirement Plans, Individual Life, and Private Placement Life Insurance businesses; respectively. Account values associated with the Retirement Plans, and Individual Life businesses no longer generate asset-based fee income due to the sales of these businesses through reinsurance.
[5]
Excludes account value related to the HLIKK business sold on June 30, 2014.

85



2016 Outlook
The principal goal for Talcott Resolution is to efficiently manage the runoff of the business while honoring the Company's obligations to its contractholders. As a result, the Company expects account values and consequently earnings to decline due to surrenders, policyholder initiatives or transactions with third parties, that will reduce the size of this legacy book of business. Risk-reducing transactions may also cause a reduction in statutory capital and shareholders’ equity.
As the Company's annuity book continues to runoff, earnings are expected to decline.  A key driver to the decline in earnings will be the pace at which customers surrender their contracts.  In 2015, the Company experienced 9.6% variable annuity full surrender rates driven by market appreciation, continued aging of the block and in-force management initiatives.  Contract counts decreased 11% for variable annuities in 2015.  Looking forward, the Company expects variable annuity surrender rates to decline in 2016, as 2015 included the effect of in-force management initiatives that accelerated surrenders, likely resulting in lower surrender rates going forward.
Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Net income for the year ended December 31, 2015 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2014 increased primarily due to lower DAC amortization driven by a favorable unlock in 2015 versus an unfavorable unlock in 2014, lower insurance operating costs and other expenses, and lower benefits and losses due to the continued runoff of the variable annuity block, partially offset by lower fee income due to the continued runoff of the variable annuity block, lower net investment income due to a decrease in income from limited partnerships and alternative investments and realized capital losses related to the variable annuity hedge program. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses). In addition, the year ended December 31, 2014 included a loss from discontinued operations due to the sale of HLIKK.
Account values for Talcott Resolution decreased to approximately $156 billion at year ended December 31, 2015 from approximately $168 billion at year ended December 31, 2014 primarily due to a reduction in Retirement Plans' account value and net outflows and market value depreciation in variable annuity account value. For the year ended December 31, 2015 variable annuity net outflows decreased by approximately $3.8 billion as compared to the prior year period due to lower outflows from in-force management initiatives.
For the year ended December 31, 2015 the annualized full surrender rate on variable annuities declined to 9.6% compared to 13.5% for the year ended December 31, 2014. This decline was primarily due to lower surrenders from in-force management initiatives as well as in-force management initiatives in prior years accelerated surrenders resulting in lower surrender rates post initiatives.
Contract counts decreased 11% for variable annuities at year ended December 31, 2015 compared to year ended December 31, 2014 primarily due to in-force management initiatives and the continued aging of the block.
The effective tax rates in 2015 and 2014 differ from the U.S. Federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in separate account DRD. The income tax provision for the year ended December 31, 2015 includes a $36 net reduction in the provision for income taxes primarily related to the release of reserves due to the resolution of uncertain tax positions. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
The net loss for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased compared to the net loss for the year ended December 31, 2013 primarily due to the decrease in the loss from discontinued operations, net of tax, related to the sale of HLIKK. Also contributing to the decrease in net loss were lower amortization of DAC, and lower insurance operating costs and other expenses, including lower costs associated with the enhanced surrender value program, and higher income from limited partnerships and other alternative investments, partially offset by a decline in earned fee income attributable to the continued runoff of the business, and a decline in net investment income excluding that from limited partnerships and other alternative investments.
Account values for Talcott Resolution decreased to approximately $168 billion at year ended December 31, 2014 from approximately $219 billion at year ended December 31, 2013 due primarily to the sale of HLIKK, and net outflows partially offset by market value appreciation in variable annuities. For the year ended December 31, 2014 variable annuity net outflows decreased by approximately $2.9 billion as compared to the prior year period due to lower outflows from in-force management initiatives.
For the year ended December 31, 2014 the annualized full surrender rate on variable annuities declined to 13.5% compared to 16.7% for the year ended December 31, 2013. This decline was primarily due to lower surrenders from in-force management initiatives.
Contract counts decreased 13% for variable annuities at year ended December 31, 2014 compared to year ended December 31, 2013 primarily due to market appreciation, in-force management initiatives and the continued aging of the block.
The effective tax rates in 2014 and 2013 differ from the U.S. Federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in separate account DRD. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

86



CORPORATE
Results of Operations
Operating Summary
2015
2014
2013
Fee income [1]
$
8

$
10

$
12

Net investment income
17

22

27

Net realized capital gains (losses)
15

7

(89
)
Total revenues
40

39

(50
)
Insurance operating costs and other expenses [1]
53

114

78

Pension settlement

128


Loss on extinguishment of debt
21


213

Reinsurance loss on disposition


69

Interest expense
357

376

397

Total benefits, losses and expenses
431

618

757

Loss from continuing operations before income taxes
(391
)
(579
)
(807
)
Income tax benefit
(233
)
(204
)
(252
)
Net loss
$
(158
)
$
(375
)
$
(555
)
[1]
Fee income includes the income associated with the sales of non-proprietary insurance products in the Company’s broker-dealer subsidiaries that has an offsetting commission expense in insurance operating costs and other expenses.
Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Net loss, as compared to the prior year period, decreased in 2015 primarily due to an increase in income tax benefit of $94 from the partial reduction of the deferred tax valuation allowance on capital loss carryovers established when the HLIKK annuity business was sold. The reduction in valuation allowance stems primarily from taxable gains on sales of investments during the period. The net loss also decreased due to lower insurance operating costs and interest expense as well as the effect of a pension settlement charge in 2014, partially offset by a loss on extinguishment of debt in second quarter 2015.
Insurance operating costs and other expenses decreased for 2015 largely due to a reduction in restructuring costs. In 2014, insurance operating costs and expenses includes a benefit of $10, before tax, for recoveries for past legal expenses associated with closed litigation. Interest expense declined in 2015 due to a decrease in outstanding debt from debt maturities and the paydown of senior notes. In 2015, $456 of the Company's senior notes matured and $317 of senior notes were redeemed for cash. For additional information regarding debt, see Note 11 - Debt of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
For a reconciliation of the tax provision at the U.S. Federal statutory rate to the provision (benefit) for income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
Net loss, as compared to the prior year period, decreased in 2014 primarily due to decreases in the loss on extinguishment of debt, a change to net realized capital gains, decreases in the reinsurance loss on disposition, and a lower effective income tax rate benefit in 2013.
The pension settlement charge in 2014 is related to voluntary lump-sum settlements with vested participants in the Company's defined benefit pension plan who had separated from service, but who had not yet commenced annuity benefits. For additional information regarding the pension settlement, see Note 16 - Employee Benefit Plans of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Insurance operating costs and other expenses increased in 2014 primarily due to benefits recognized in 2013 related to an insurance company recovery and the favorable resolution in 2013 of items under the Company's spin-off agreement with its former parent company. Interest expense declined in 2014 due to a decrease in outstanding debt from debt maturities and the paydown of $800 of senior notes in 2013.
In 2014, $200 of the Company's senior notes matured. For additional information regarding debt, see Note 11 - Debt of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
For a reconciliation of the tax provision at the U.S. Federal statutory rate to the provision (benefit) for income taxes, see Note 14 - Income Taxes of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

87



ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT
The Company has an enterprise risk management function (“ERM”) that is charged with providing analysis of the Company’s risks on an individual and aggregated basis and with ensuring that the Company’s risks remain within its risk appetite and tolerances. The Company has established the Enterprise Risk and Capital Committee (“ERCC”) that includes the Company’s CEO, President, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Investment Officer, Chief Risk Officer, General Counsel and others as deemed necessary by the committee chair. The ERCC is responsible for managing the Company’s risks and overseeing the enterprise risk management program.
The Company categorizes its main risks as follows:
Insurance Risk
Operational Risk
Financial Risk
Insurance Risk Management
The Company categorizes its insurance risks across both property-casualty and life products. The Company's insurance operations are vested in the ability to add value through the effective underwriting, pooling, and pricing of insurance risks. The Company has developed a disciplined approach to insurance risk management that is well integrated into the organization's underwriting, pricing, reinsurance, claims, and capital management processes.
At the same time, the Company has policies and procedures to manage concentrations or correlations of insurance risk, including ERM policies governing the risks related to natural and man-made property catastrophes such as hurricanes, earthquakes, tornado/hailstorms, winter storms, pandemics, terrorism, and casualty catastrophes. The Company establishes risk limits to control potential loss and actively monitors the risk exposures as a percent of statutory surplus or total available capital resources. The Company also uses reinsurance to transfer insurance risk to well-established and financially secure reinsurers. For additional information, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management, Reinsurance as a Risk Management Strategy.
Non-Catastrophic Insurance Risks
Non-catastrophic insurance risks exist within each of the Company's divisions and include, but are not limited to, the following:
Property: Risk of loss to personal or commercial property from automobile related accidents, weather, explosions, smoke, shaking, fire, theft, vandalism, inadequate installation, faulty equipment, collisions and falling objects, and/or machinery mechanical breakdown resulting in physical damage and other covered perils.
Liability: Risk of loss from automobile related accidents, uninsured and underinsured drivers, lawsuits from accidents, defective products, breach of warranty, negligent acts by professional practitioners, environmental claims, latent exposures, fraud, coercion, forgery, failure to fulfill obligations per contract surety, liability from errors and omissions, derivative lawsuits, and other securities actions and covered perils.
Mortality: Risk of loss from unexpected trends in insured deaths impacting timing of payouts from life insurance or annuity products, personal or commercial automobile related accidents, and death of employees or executives during the course of employment, while on disability, or while collecting workers compensation benefits.
Morbidity: Risk of loss to an insured from illness incurred during the course of employment or illness from other covered perils.
Disability: Risk of loss incurred from personal or commercial automobile related losses, accidents arising outside of the workplace, injuries or accidents incurred during the course of employment, or from equipment, with each loss resulting in short term or long term disability payments.
Longevity: Risk of loss from increased life expectancy trends among policyholders receiving long term benefit payments or annuity payouts.
The Company's processes for managing these risks include disciplined underwriting protocols, exposure controls, sophisticated risk based pricing, risk modeling, risk transfer, and capital management strategies. The Company has established underwriting guidelines for both individual risks, including individual policy limits, and risks in the aggregate, including aggregate exposure limits by geographic zone and peril. Pricing indications for each line of business are set independently by the Company's pricing actuaries and are integrated into the reserve review process to ensure consistency between pricing and reserving. Monthly reports track loss cost trends relative to pricing objectives within each state and product, and the Company's reserving actuaries provide an independent report to the Board on the Company's reserve position and loss cost trends.

88



Natural Catastrophe Risk
Natural catastrophe risk is defined as the exposure arising from natural phenomena (e.g., weather, earthquakes, wildfires, etc.) that create a concentration or aggregation of loss across the Company's insurance or asset portfolios. The Company uses both internal and third-party models to estimate the potential loss resulting from various catastrophe events and the potential financial impact those events would have on the Company's financial position and results of operations across the property-casualty, group life, disability, and asset management businesses. For natural catastrophe perils, the Company's modeled loss estimates are derived by averaging 21 modeled loss events representing a 250 year return. The Company generally limits its estimated pre-tax loss as a result of natural catastrophes for property & casualty exposures from a single 250-year event to less than 30% of statutory surplus of the property and casualty insurance subsidiaries prior to reinsurance and to less than 15% of statutory surplus of the property and casualty insurance subsidiaries after reinsurance. While Enterprise Risk Management has a process to track and manage these limits, from time to time the estimated loss to natural catastrophes from a single 250-year event prior to reinsurance may fluctuate above or below these limits due to changes in modeled loss estimates, exposures or statutory surplus.
For the peril of earthquake, the 21 events averaged to determine the modeled loss estimate include events occurring in California as well as the Northeastern, Southeastern, Northwestern, Midwestern, New Madrid and Great Lakes regions of the United States with associated magnitudes ranging from 7.1 to 9.2 on the Moment Magnitude scale. The estimated 250 year pre-tax probable maximum loss from earthquake events is estimated to be $810 before reinsurance and $494 net of reinsurance. For the peril of hurricane, the 21 events averaged to determine the modeled loss estimate include category 1 through 5 events in Florida, as well as Mid Atlantic, Northeastern and Texas region landfalls. The estimated 250 year pre-tax probable maximum losses from hurricane events are estimated to be $1.5 billion and $685, before and after reinsurance, respectively. The loss estimates represent total property losses for hurricane events and property and workers compensation losses for earthquake events resulting from a single event. The estimates provided are based on 250-year return period loss estimates that have a 0.4% likelihood of being exceeded in any single year.
The net loss estimates provided above assume that the Company is able to recover all losses ceded to reinsurers under its reinsurance programs. There are various methodologies used in the industry to estimate the potential property and workers compensation losses that would arise from various catastrophe events and companies may use different models and assumptions in their estimates. Therefore, the Company's estimates of gross and net losses arising from a 250-year hurricane or earthquake event may not be comparable to estimates provided by other companies. Furthermore, the Company's estimates are subject to significant uncertainty and could vary materially from the actual losses that would arise from these events and the loss estimates provided by other companies. The Company also manages natural catastrophe risk for group life and group disability, which in combination with property and workers compensation loss estimates are subject to separate enterprise risk management net aggregate loss limits as a percent of enterprise surplus.
Terrorism Risk
The Company defines terrorism risk as the risk of losses from terrorist attacks, including losses caused by single-site and multi-site conventional attacks, as well as the potential for attacks using nuclear, biological, chemical or radiological weapons (“NBCR”). The Company monitors aggregations of terrorism risk exposure around key landmarks primarily in major metropolitan areas that span the Company's insurance portfolio. ERM limits for terrorism apply to aggregations of risk across property-casualty, group benefits and specific asset portfolios and are defined based on a deterministic, single-site conventional terrorism attack scenario. The Company manages its potential estimated loss from a conventional terrorism loss scenario up to $1.7 billion gross of reinsurance and before coverage under TRIPRA. In addition, the Company monitors exposures monthly and employs both internally developed and vendor-licensed loss modeling tools as part of its risk management discipline. While our modeled exposures to conventional terrorist attacks around landmark locations may fluctuate above and below $1.7 billion, currently, all such terrorism exposures are within ERM limits. For a discussion on risks related to terrorist attacks, see the risk factor, "The occurrence of one or more terrorist attacks in the geographic areas we serve or the threat of terrorism in general may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity."

89



Pandemic Risk
Pandemic risk is the exposure to loss arising from widespread influenza or other pathogens or bacterial infections that create an aggregation of loss across the Company's insurance or asset portfolios. Consistent with industry practice, the Company assesses exposure to pandemics by analyzing the potential impact from a variety of pandemic scenarios based on conditions consistent with historical outbreaks of flu-like viruses such as the “Severe” 1918 Spanish Flu, the Asian flu of 1957, the Hong Kong flu of 1968, and the 2009 outbreak of the swine flu. For pandemic risk, the Company generally limits its estimated pre-tax loss from a single 250 year event to less than 10% of total available capital resources. In evaluating these scenarios, the Company assesses the impact on group life policies, short-term and long term disability, annuities, COLI, property & casualty claims, and losses in the investment portfolio associated with market declines in the event of a widespread pandemic. While ERM has a process to track and manage these limits, from time to time, the estimated loss for pandemics may fluctuate above or below these limits due to changes in modeled loss estimates, exposures, or statutory surplus. Currently, the Company's estimated pre-tax loss for pandemic is less than 10% of total available capital resources and is based on a single 250 year event.
Reinsurance as a Risk Management Strategy
The Hartford utilizes reinsurance to transfer risk to affiliated and unaffiliated insurers. Reinsurance is used to manage aggregation of risk as well as to transfer certain risk to reinsurance companies based on specific geographic or risk concentrations. All reinsurance processes are aligned under a single enterprise reinsurance risk management policy. Reinsurance purchasing is a centralized function across Commercial Lines, Personal Lines and Talcott Resolution to support a consistent strategy and to ensure that the reinsurance activities are fully integrated into the organization's risk management processes.
A variety of traditional reinsurance products are used as part of the Company's risk management strategy, including excess of loss occurrence-based products that protect property and workers compensation exposures, and individual risk or quota share arrangements, that protect specific classes or lines of business. The Company has no significant finite risk contracts in place and the statutory surplus benefit from all such prior year contracts is immaterial. Facultative reinsurance is used by the Company to manage policy-specific risk exposures based on established underwriting guidelines. The Hartford also participates in governmentally administered reinsurance facilities such as the Florida Hurricane Catastrophe Fund (“FHCF”), the Terrorism Risk Insurance Program established under The Terrorism Risk Insurance Program Reauthorization Act of 2015 (“TRIPRA”) and other reinsurance programs relating to particular risks or specific lines of business.
Reinsurance for Catastrophes
The Company has several catastrophe reinsurance programs, including reinsurance treaties that cover property and workers’ compensation losses aggregating from single catastrophe events. The following table summarizes the primary catastrophe treaty reinsurance coverages that the Company has in place as of January 1, 2016:
Coverage
 
Effective for the period
 
% of layer(s) reinsurance
 
Per occurrence limit
 
Retention
Principal property catastrophe program covering property catastrophe losses from a single event [1]

1/1/2016 to 1/1/2017

90%

$
850


$
350

Reinsurance with the FHCF covering Florida Personal Lines property catastrophe losses from a single event

6/1/2015 to 6/1/2016

90%

$
116

[2]
$
37

Workers compensation losses arising from a single catastrophe event [3]

7/1/2015 to 7/1/2016

80%

$
350


$
100

[1]
Certain aspects of our catastrophe treaty have terms that extend beyond the traditional one year term.
[2]
The per occurrence limit on the FHCF treaty is $116 for the 6/1/2015 to 6/1/2016 treaty year based on the Company's election to purchase the required coverage from FHCF. Coverage is based on the best available information from FHCF, which was updated in January 2016
[3]
In addition to the limit shown, the workers compensation reinsurance includes a non-catastrophe, industrial accident layer, 80% of a $30 per event limit in excess of a $20 retention.
In addition to the property catastrophe reinsurance coverage described in the above table, the Company has other catastrophe and working layer treaties and facultative reinsurance agreements that cover property catastrophe losses on an aggregate excess of loss and on a per risk basis. The principal property catastrophe reinsurance program and certain other reinsurance programs include a provision to reinstate limits in the event that a catastrophe loss exhausts limits on one or more layers under the treaties. In addition, covering the period from January 1, 2014 to December 31, 2016, the Company has an aggregate loss treaty in place which provides one limit of $200 over the three-year period of aggregate qualifying property catastrophe losses in excess of a net retention of $860.

90


Reinsurance for Terrorism
For the risk of terrorism, private sector catastrophe reinsurance capacity is generally limited and largely unavailable for terrorism losses caused by nuclear, biological, chemical or radiological weapons attacks. As such, the Company's principal reinsurance protection against large-scale terrorist attacks is the coverage currently provided through TRIPRA to the end of 2020. On January 12, 2015, the President signed TRIPRA 2015, extending TRIPRA 2007, through the end of 2020. TRIPRA 2015 provides a backstop for insurance-related losses resulting from any “act of terrorism”, which is certified by the Secretary of the Treasury, in consultation with the Secretary of Homeland Security and the Attorney General, for losses that exceed a threshold of industry losses of $100 in 2015, and continue to increase to $200 by 2020. Under the program, in any one calendar year, the federal government would pay losses of 85% in 2015, which then continue to decrease 1% annually, starting on January 1st, 2016, down to 80% by the year 2020, from a certified act of terrorism after an insurer's losses exceed 20% of the Company's eligible direct commercial earned premiums of the prior calendar year up to a combined annual aggregate limit for the federal government and all insurers of $100 billion. The Company's estimated deductible under the program is $1.2 billion for 2016. If an act of terrorism or acts of terrorism result in covered losses exceeding the $100 billion annual industry aggregate limit, a future Congress would be responsible for determining how additional losses in excess of $100 billion will be paid.
Among other items, TRIPRA required that the President's Working Group on Financial Markets (“PWG”) continue to perform an analysis regarding the long-term availability and affordability of insurance for terrorism risk. Among the findings detailed in the PWG's initial report, released October 2, 2006, were that the high level of uncertainty associated with predicting the frequency of terrorist attacks, coupled with the unwillingness of some insurance policyholders to purchase insurance coverage, makes predicting long-term development of the terrorism risk market difficult, and that there is likely little potential for future market development for NBCR coverage. The January 2011 PWG report notes some improvements in capacity and modeling, but also noted that take-up rates for terrorism coverage remained relatively flat over the past three years and that insurers remain uncertain about the ability of models to predict the frequency and severity of terrorist attacks. The April 2014 PWG report notes that the availability and affordability of insurance for terrorism risk has not changed appreciably since 2010. Take up rates have increased since the first year of TRIA and are stable at 60% in the aggregate. The private market does not have capacity to provide reinsurance for terrorism risk to the extent provided by TRIPRA. With respect to NBCR coverage, a December 2008 study by the U.S. Government Accountability Office (“GAO”) found that property and casualty insurers still generally seek to exclude NBCR coverage from their commercial policies when permitted. However, while nuclear, pollution and contamination exclusions are contained in many property and liability insurance policies, the GAO report concluded that such exclusions may be subject to challenges in court because they were not specifically drafted to address terrorist attacks. Furthermore, workers compensation policies generally have no exclusion or limitations. The GAO found that commercial property and casualty policyholders, including companies that own high-value properties in large cities, generally reported that they could not obtain NBCR coverage. Commercial property and casualty insurers generally remain unwilling to offer NBCR coverage because of uncertainties about the risk and the potential for catastrophic losses.
Reinsurance Recoverables
Reinsurance Security
To manage reinsurer credit risk, a reinsurance security review committee evaluates the credit standing, financial performance, management and operational quality of each potential reinsurer. Through this process, the Company maintains a centralized list of reinsurers approved for participation in reinsurance transactions. Only reinsurers approved through this process are eligible to participate in new reinsurance transactions. The Company's approval designations reflect the differing credit exposure associated with various classes of business. Participation eligibility is categorized based upon the nature of the risk reinsured, including the expected liability payout duration. In addition to defining participation eligibility, the Company regularly monitors credit risk exposure to each reinsurance counterparty and has established limits tiered by counterparty credit rating. For further discussion on how the Company manages and mitigates third party credit risk, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management, Credit Risk.

91


Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reinsurance Recoverables
Property and casualty insurance product reinsurance recoverables represent loss and loss adjustment expense recoverables from a number of entities, including reinsurers and pools.
The components of the gross and net reinsurance recoverables are summarized as follows:
 
As of December 31,
Reinsurance Recoverables
2015
2014
Paid loss and loss adjustment expenses
$
119

$
133

Unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses
2,662

2,868

Gross reinsurance recoverables
2,781

3,001

Less: Allowance for uncollectible reinsurance
(266
)
(271
)
Net reinsurance recoverables
$
2,515

$
2,730

Distribution of Gross Reinsurance Recoverables
As shown in the following table, a portion of the total gross reinsurance recoverables relates to the Company’s mandatory participation in various involuntary assigned risk pools and the value of annuity contracts held under structured settlement agreements. Reinsurance recoverables due from mandatory pools are backed by the financial strength of the property and casualty insurance industry. Annuities purchased from third-party life insurers under structured settlements are recognized as reinsurance recoverables in cases where the Company has not obtained a release from the claimant. Of the remaining gross reinsurance recoverables, the portion of recoverables due from companies rated by A.M. Best is as follows:
 
As of December 31,
Distribution of Gross Reinsurance Recoverables
2015
2014
Gross reinsurance recoverables
$
2,781

 
$
3,001

 
Less: mandatory (assigned risk) pools and structured settlements
(551
)
 
(567
)
 
Gross reinsurance recoverables excluding mandatory pools and structured settlements
$
2,230

 
$
2,434

 
 
 
% of Total
 
% of Total
Rated A- (Excellent) or better by A.M. Best [1]
$
1,474

66.1
%
$
1,561

64.1
%
Other rated by A.M. Best
4

0.2
%
4

0.2
%
Total rated companies
1,478

66.3
%
1,565

64.3
%
Voluntary pools
82

3.7
%
92

3.8
%
Captives
387

17.3
%
488

20.0
%
Other not rated companies
283

12.7
%
289

11.9
%
Total
$
2,230

100.0
%
$
2,434

100.0
%
[1]
Based on A.M. Best ratings as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
Where its contracts permit, the Company secures future claim obligations with various forms of collateral, including irrevocable letters of credit, secured trusts, funds held accounts and group wide offsets. As part of its reinsurance recoverable review, the Company analyzes recent developments in commutation activity between reinsurers and cedants, recent trends in arbitration and litigation outcomes in disputes between cedants and reinsurers and the overall credit quality of the Company’s reinsurers. As indicated in the above table, 66.1% of the gross reinsurance recoverables due from reinsurers rated by A.M. Best were rated A- (excellent) or better as of December 31, 2015. Due to the inherent uncertainties as to collection and the length of time before such amounts will be due, it is possible that future adjustments to the Company’s reinsurance recoverables, net of the allowance, could be required, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated results of operations or cash flows in a particular quarterly or annual period.
Annually, the Company completes evaluations of the reinsurance recoverable asset associated with older, long-term casualty liabilities reported in the Property & Casualty Other Operations reporting segment, and the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance reported in the Commercial Lines reporting segment. For a discussion regarding the results of these evaluations, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.

92


Life Insurance Product Reinsurance Recoverables
Life insurance product reinsurance recoverables represent future policy benefits and unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses and other policyholder funds and benefits payable that are recoverable from a number of reinsurers.
The components of the gross and net reinsurance recoverables are as follows:
 
As of December 31,
Reinsurance Recoverables
2015
2014
Future policy benefits and unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses and other policyholder funds and benefits payable
20,674

20,190

Gross reinsurance recoverables
$
20,674

$
20,190

Less: Allowance for uncollectible reinsurance [1]


Net reinsurance recoverables
$
20,674

$
20,190

[1]
No allowance for uncollectible reinsurance is required as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014
As of December 31, 2015, the Company has reinsurance recoverables from MassMutual and Prudential of $8.6 billion and $10.8 billion, respectively. As of December 31, 2014 the Company had reinsurance recoverables from MassMutual and Prudential of $8.6 billion and $10.4 billion, respectively. The Company's obligations to its direct policyholders that have been reinsured to Mass Mutual and Prudential are secured by invested assets held in trust. Net of invested assets held in trust, as of December 31, 2015, the Company has no reinsurance-related concentrations of credit risk greater than 10% of the Company’s consolidated stockholders’ equity.
Guaranty Funds and Other Insurance-related Assessments
As part of its risk management strategy, the Company regularly monitors the financial wherewithal of other insurers and, in particular, activity by insurance regulators and various state guaranty associations relating to troubled insurers. In all states, insurers licensed to transact certain classes of insurance are required to become members of a guaranty fund. In most states, in the event of the insolvency of an insurer writing any such class of insurance in the state, members of the funds are assessed to pay certain claims of the insolvent insurer. A particular state's fund assesses its members based on their respective written premiums in the state for the classes of insurance in which the insolvent insurer was engaged. Assessments are generally limited for any year to one or two percent of the premiums written per year depending on the state. The amount and timing of assessments related to past insolvencies is unpredictable.
Citizens Property Insurance Corporation in Florida (“Citizens”), a non-affiliate insurer, provides property insurance to Florida homeowners and businesses that are unable to obtain insurance from other carriers, including for properties deemed to be “high risk.” Citizens maintains a Personal Lines account, a Commercial Lines account and a High Risk account. If Citizens incurs a deficit in any of these accounts, Citizens may impose a “regular assessment” on other insurance carriers in the state, such as the Company, to fund the deficits, subject to certain restrictions and subject to approval by the Florida Office of Insurance Regulation. Carriers are then permitted to surcharge policyholders to recover the assessments over the next few years. Citizens may also opt to finance a portion of the deficits through issuing bonds and may impose “emergency assessments” on other insurance carriers to fund the bond repayments. Unlike with regular assessments, however, insurance carriers only serve as a collection agent for emergency assessments and are not required to remit surcharges for emergency assessments to Citizens until they collect surcharges from policyholders. Under U.S. GAAP, the Company is required to accrue for regular assessments in the period the assessments become probable and estimable and the obligating event has occurred. Surcharges to recover the amount of regular assessments may not be recorded as an asset until the related premium is written. Emergency assessments that may be levied by Citizens are not recorded in the income statement.
Operational Risk Management
The Hartford has an Operational Risk Management (“ORM”) function whose responsibility is to provide a comprehensive and enterprise-wide view of the Company's operational risk on an aggregate basis. The Company defines operational risk as the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or from external events. Operational risk is inherent in our business and functional areas. It includes legal risk and considers reputational risk as an impact.
ORM is responsible for establishing, maintaining and communicating the framework, principles and guidelines of The Hartford's operational risk management program. In addition, ORM also manages business continuity, model risk management, the ORM system, and risk assessments. Responsibility for day-to-day management of operational risk lies within each business unit and functional area.

93



ORM works closely with the Operational Risk Committee (“ORC”), an enterprise wide governance group comprised of senior leaders from functional areas such as ORM, Operations and Technology, Claims, Legal, Compliance, Finance and Internal Audit. The ORC meets regularly and provides a forum for ensuring the effective identification, assessment, control, ownership, management and reporting of operational risks across the enterprise. Members of the ORC provide periodic risk updates to the ERCC and Audit Committee. Individual committees, such as the Enterprise Privacy and Security Committee, Enterprise Health, Environment and Safety Committee, and the Model Oversight Committees focus on specific operational risk issues.
ORM has various tools and processes for identifying, monitoring, measuring, prioritizing, and reporting operational risks. ORM facilitates the business risk assessment process which is used to identify the top risks in the business and functional areas, evaluate controls to mitigate those risks, and monitor control improvements. ORM also facilitates loss event collection and analysis, scenario analysis, and aggregated reporting of risks. ORM uses a centralized Governance, Risk, and Compliance (GRC) system to support effective and efficient management of operational risk across the Company.
Financial Risk Management
The Company identifies the following categories of financial risk:
Liquidity Risk
Interest Rate Risk
Equity Risk
Foreign Currency Exchange Risk
Credit Risk
Financial risks include direct and indirect risks to the Company's financial objectives coming from events that impact market conditions or prices. Financial risk also includes exposure to events that may cause correlated movement in multiple risk factors. The primary sources of financial risks are the Company's general account assets and the liabilities and the guarantees which the company has written over various liability products, particularly its portfolio of variable annuities. The Company assesses its financial risk on a U.S. GAAP, statutory and economic basis. The Hartford has developed a disciplined approach to financial risk management that is well integrated into the Company's underwriting, pricing, hedging, claims, asset and liability management, new product, and capital management processes. Consistent with its risk appetite, the Company establishes financial risk limits to control potential loss. Exposures are actively monitored, and mitigated where appropriate. The Company uses various risk management strategies, including reinsurance and over-the-counter and exchange traded derivatives with counterparties meeting the appropriate regulatory and due diligence requirements. Derivatives are utilized to achieve one of four Company-approved objectives: to hedge risk arising from interest rate, equity market, commodity market, credit spread and issuer default, price or currency exchange rate risk or volatility; to manage liquidity; to control transaction costs; or to enter into synthetic replication transactions.
Liquidity Risk
Liquidity risk is the risk to current or prospective earnings or capital arising from the Company's inability or perceived inability to meet its contractual cash obligations at the legal entity level when they come due over given time horizons without incurring unacceptable costs and without relying on uncommitted funding sources. Liquidity risk includes the inability to manage unplanned increases or accelerations in cash outflows, decreases or changes in funding sources, and changes in market conditions that affect the ability to liquidate assets quickly to meet obligations with minimal loss in value. Components of liquidity risk include funding risk, company specific liquidity risk and market liquidity risk. Funding risk is the gap between sources and uses of cash under normal and stressed conditions taking into consideration structural, regulatory and legal entity constraints. Company specific liquidity risk represents changes in institution-specific conditions that affect the Company's ability to sell assets or otherwise transact business without incurring a significant loss in value. Market liquidity risk represents changes in general market conditions that affect the institution's ability to sell assets or otherwise transact business without incurring a significant loss in value is market liquidity risk.
The Company has defined ongoing monitoring and reporting requirements to assess liquidity across the enterprise under both current and stressed market conditions. The Company measures and manages liquidity risk exposures and funding needs within prescribed limits and across legal entities taking into account legal, regulatory and operational limitations to the transferability of liquidity. The Company also monitors internal and external conditions, and identifies material risk changes and emerging risks that may impact liquidity. The Company's CFO has primary responsibility for liquidity risk.
For further discussion on liquidity see the section on Capital Resources and Liquidity.

94



Interest Rate Risk
Interest rate risk is the risk of financial loss due to adverse changes in the value of assets and liabilities arising from movements in interest rates. Interest rate risk encompasses exposures with respect to changes in the level of interest rates, the shape of the term structure of rates and the volatility of interest rates. Interest rate risk does not include exposure to changes in credit spreads. The Company has exposure to interest rates arising from its fixed maturity securities, interest sensitive liabilities and discount rate assumptions associated with the Company’s pension and other post retirement benefit obligations.
An increase in interest rates from current levels is generally a favorable development for the Company. Interest rate increases are expected to provide additional net investment income, reduce the cost of the variable annuity hedging program, and limit the potential risk of margin erosion due to minimum guaranteed crediting rates in certain Talcott Resolution products. However, if long-term interest rates rise dramatically within a six to twelve month time period, certain Talcott Resolution businesses may be exposed to disintermediation risk. Disintermediation risk refers to the risk that policyholders will surrender their contracts in a rising interest rate environment requiring the Company to liquidate assets in an unrealized loss position. In conjunction with the interest rate risk measurement and management techniques, certain of Talcott Resolution's fixed income product offerings have market value adjustment provisions at contract surrender. An increase in interest rates may also impact the Company’s tax planning strategies and in particular its ability to utilize tax benefits of previously recognized realized capital losses.
A decline in interest rates results in certain mortgage-backed and municipal securities being more susceptible to paydowns and prepayments or calls. During such periods, the Company generally will not be able to reinvest the proceeds at comparable yields. Lower interest rates will also likely result in lower net investment income, increased hedging costs associated with variable annuities and, if declines are sustained for a long period of time, it may subject the Company to reinvestment risk and possibly reduced profit margins associated with guaranteed crediting rates on certain Talcott Resolution products. Conversely, the fair value of the investment portfolio will increase when interest rates decline and the Company’s interest expense will be lower on its variable rate debt obligations.
The Company manages its exposure to interest rate risk by constructing investment portfolios that maintain asset allocation limits and asset/liability duration matching targets which may include the use of derivatives. The Company analyzes interest rate risk using various models including parametric models and cash flow simulation under various market scenarios of the liabilities and their supporting investment portfolios. Key metrics that the Company uses to quantify its exposure to interest rate risk inherent in its invested assets and interest rate sensitive liabilities include duration, convexity and key rate duration. Duration is the price sensitivity of a financial instrument or series of cash flows to a parallel change in the underlying yield curve used to value the financial instrument or series of cash flows. For example, a duration of 5 means the price of the security will change by approximately 5% for a 100 basis point change in interest rates. Convexity is used to approximate how the duration of a security changes as interest rates change in a parallel manner. Key rate duration analysis measures the price sensitivity of a security or series of cash flows to each point along the yield curve and enables the Company to estimate the price change of a security assuming non-parallel interest rate movements.
To calculate duration, convexity, and key rate durations, projections of asset and liability cash flows are discounted to a present value using interest rate assumptions. These cash flows are then revalued at alternative interest rate levels to determine the percentage change in fair value due to an incremental change in the entire yield curve for duration and convexity, or a particular point on the yield curve for key rate duration. Cash flows from corporate obligations are assumed to be consistent with the contractual payment streams on a yield to worst basis. Yield to worst is a basis that represents the lowest potential yield that can be received without the issuer actually defaulting. The primary assumptions used in calculating cash flow projections include expected asset payment streams taking into account prepayment speeds, issuer call options and contract holder behavior. Mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities are modeled based on estimates of the rate of future prepayments of principal over the remaining life of the securities. These estimates are developed by incorporating collateral surveillance and anticipated future market dynamics. Actual prepayment experience may vary from these estimates.
The Company is also exposed to interest rate risk based upon the sensitivity of the present value of the Company’s pension and other postretirement benefit obligations to changes in liability discount rates. The discount rate assumption is based upon an interest rate yield curve that reflects high-quality fixed income investments consistent with the maturity profile of the expected liability cash flows. For further discussion of discounting pension and other postretirement benefit obligations, refer to Note 16 - Employee Benefit Plans of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. In addition, management evaluates performance of certain Talcott Resolution products based on net investment spread which is, in part, influenced by changes in interest rates.
The investments and liabilities primarily associated with interest rate risk are included in the following discussion. Certain product liabilities, including those containing GMWB or GMDB, expose the Company to interest rate risk but also have significant equity risk. These liabilities are discussed as part of the Variable Product Guarantee Risks and Risk Management section.

95



Fixed Maturity Investments
The Company’s investment portfolios primarily consist of investment grade fixed maturity securities. The fair value of fixed maturity investments was $59.7 billion and $59.9 billion at December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The fair value of these and other invested assets fluctuate depending on the interest rate environment and other general economic conditions. The weighted average duration of the portfolio, including fixed maturities, commercial mortgage loans, certain derivatives, and cash equivalents, was approximately 5.5 years and 5.3 years as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
Liabilities
The Company’s issued investment contracts and certain insurance product liabilities, other than non-guaranteed separate accounts, include asset accumulation vehicles such as fixed annuities, guaranteed investment contracts, other investment and universal life-type contracts and certain insurance products such as long-term disability.
Asset accumulation vehicles primarily require a fixed rate payment, often for a specified period of time, such as fixed rate annuities with a market value adjustment feature. The term to maturity of these contracts generally range from less than one year to ten years. A fixed interest rate is specified in the contract based upon the term selected. These contracts contain surrender values that are based upon a market value adjustment formula if held for shorter periods.  The formula typically is based on current interest crediting rates being offered for new market value annuity purchases at the time of contract issuance with terms equal to the remaining term to maturity.  The market value adjustment may be positive or negative, depending upon market interest rates at surrender. In addition, certain products such as corporate owned life insurance contracts and the general account portion of Talcott Resolution's variable annuity products credit interest to policyholders subject to market conditions and minimum interest rate guarantees. The term to maturity of the asset portfolio supporting these products may range from short to intermediate.
While interest rate risk associated with many of these products has been reduced through the use of market value adjustment features and surrender charges, the primary risk associated with these products is that the spread between investment return and credited rate may not be sufficient to earn targeted returns.
The Company also manages the risk of certain insurance liabilities similarly to investment type products due to the relative predictability of the aggregate cash flow payment streams. Products in this category may contain significant reliance upon actuarial pricing assumptions (including mortality and morbidity) and do have some element of cash flow uncertainty. Product examples include structured settlement contracts, on-benefit annuities (i.e., the annuitant is currently receiving benefits thereon) and short-term and long-term disability contracts. The cash outflows associated with these policy liabilities are not interest rate sensitive but do vary based on the timing and amount of benefit payments. The primary risks associated with these products are that the benefits will exceed expected actuarial pricing and/or that the actual timing of the cash flows will differ from those anticipated, or interest rate levels earned on the investment portfolio may deviate from those assumed in product pricing, ultimately resulting in an investment return lower than that assumed in pricing. The average duration of the liability cash flow payments can range from less than one year to in excess of fifteen years.
Derivatives
The Company utilizes a variety of derivative instruments to mitigate interest rate risk associated with its investment portfolio or hedge liabilities. Interest rate swaps are primarily used to convert interest receipts or payments to a fixed or variable rate. The use of such swaps enable the Company to customize contract terms and conditions to desired objectives and manage the duration profile within established tolerances. Interest rate swaps are also used to hedge the variability in the cash flow of a forecasted purchase or sale of fixed rate securities due to changes in interest rates. Interest rate caps, floors, swaps, swaptions, and futures may be used to manage portfolio duration.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, notional amounts pertaining to derivatives utilized to manage interest rate risk, including offsetting positions, totaled $17.8 billion and $19.3 billion, respectively ($17.7 billion and $19.2 billion, respectively, related to investments and $0.1 billion and $0.1 billion, respectively, related to Talcott Resolution liabilities). The fair value of these derivatives was $(796) and $(468) as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. These amounts do not include derivatives associated with the Variable Annuity Hedging Program.

96



Interest Rate Sensitivity
Invested Assets Supporting Fixed Liabilities
Included in the following table is the before-tax change in the net economic value of investment contracts (e.g., fixed annuity contracts) issued by the Company’s Talcott Resolution segment, as well as certain insurance product liabilities (e.g., disability contracts) issued by the Company’s Group Benefits segment, for which the payment rates are fixed at contract issuance and/or the investment experience is substantially absorbed by the Company’s operations, along with the corresponding invested assets. Also included in this analysis are the interest rate sensitive derivatives used by the Company to hedge its exposure to interest rate risk in the investment portfolios supporting these contracts. This analysis does not include the assets and corresponding liabilities of certain insurance products such as auto, property, term life insurance, and certain life contingent annuities. Certain financial instruments, such as limited partnerships and other alternative investments, have been omitted from the analysis due to the fact that these investments generally lack sensitivity to interest rate changes. Insulated separate account assets and liabilities are excluded from the analysis because gains and losses in separate accounts accrue to policyholders. The calculation of the estimated hypothetical change in net economic value below assumes a 100 basis point upward and downward parallel shift in the yield curve.
Interest Rate Sensitivity of Fixed Liabilities and Invested Assets Supporting Them
Change in Net Economic Value as of December 31,
 
2015
2014
Basis point shift
-100

+100

-100

+100

Increase (decrease) in economic value, before tax
$
(420
)
$
261

$
(452
)
$
304

The carrying value of fixed maturities, commercial mortgage loans and short-term investments related to the businesses included in the table above was $25.3 billion and $27.2 billion, as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The assets supporting the fixed liabilities are monitored and managed within set duration guidelines, and are evaluated on a daily basis, as well as annually using scenario simulation techniques in compliance with regulatory requirements.
Invested Assets not Supporting Fixed Liabilities
The following table provides an analysis showing the estimated before-tax change in the fair value of the Company’s investments and related derivatives, excluding assets supporting fixed liabilities which are included in the table above, assuming 100 basis point upward and downward parallel shifts in the yield curve as of December 31, 2015 and 2014. Certain financial instruments, such as limited partnerships and other alternative investments, have been omitted from the analysis due to the fact that these investments generally lack sensitivity to interest rate changes.
Interest Rate Sensitivity of Invested Assets not Supporting Fixed Liabilities
Change in Fair Value as of December 31,
 
2015
2014
Basis point shift
-100

+100

-100

+100

Increase (decrease) in fair value, before tax
$
2,186

$
(2,063
)
$
2,182

$
(2,083
)
The carrying value of fixed maturities, commercial mortgage loans and short-term investments related to the businesses included in the table above was $41.9 billion and $43.1 billion, as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The selection of the 100 basis point parallel shift in the yield curve was made only as an illustration of the potential hypothetical impact of such an event and should not be construed as a prediction of future market events. Actual results could differ materially from those illustrated above due to the nature of the estimates and assumptions used in the above analysis. The Company’s sensitivity analysis calculation assumes that the composition of invested assets and liabilities remain materially consistent throughout the year and that the current relationship between short-term and long-term interest rates will remain constant over time. As a result, these calculations may not fully capture the impact of portfolio re-allocations, significant product sales or non-parallel changes in interest rates.
Equity Risk
Equity risk is defined as the risk of financial loss due to changes in the value of global equities or equity indices. The Company has exposure to equity risk from assets under management, embedded derivatives within the Company’s variable annuities and assets that support the Company’s pension and other post retirement benefit plans. Equity Risk on the Company’s Variable Annuity products is mitigated through various hedging programs. (See the Variable Annuity Hedge Program Section)

97



The Company's exposure to equity risk includes the potential for lower earnings associated with certain businesses such as mutual funds and variable annuities where fee income is earned based upon the value of the assets under management. For further discussion of equity risk, see the Variable Product Guarantee Risks and Risk Management section below. In addition, Talcott Resolution includes certain guaranteed benefits, primarily associated with variable annuity products, which increase the Company's potential benefit exposure in the periods that equity markets decline.
The Company is also subject to equity risk based upon the assets that support its pension and other post retirement benefit plans. The asset allocation mix is reviewed on a periodic basis. In order to minimize risk, the pension plans maintain a listing of permissible and prohibited investments. In addition, the pension plans have certain concentration limits and investment quality requirements imposed on permissible investment options. For further discussion of equity risk associated with the pension plans, see the Critical Accounting Estimates section of the MD&A under “Pension and Other Postretirement Benefit Obligations” and Note 16 Employee Benefit Plans of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Variable Product Guarantee Risks and Risk Management
The Company’s variable products are significantly influenced by the U.S. and other equity markets. Increases or declines in equity markets impact certain assets and liabilities related to the Company’s variable products and the Company’s earnings derived from those products. The Company’s variable products include variable annuity contracts and mutual funds.
Generally, declines in equity markets will:
reduce the value of assets under management and the amount of fee income generated from those assets;
increase the liability for GMWB benefits resulting in realized capital losses;
increase the value of derivative assets used to hedge product guarantees resulting in realized capital gains;
increase the costs of the hedging instruments we use in our hedging program;
increase the Company’s net amount at risk ("NAR") for GMDB and GMWB benefits;
increase the amount of required assets to be held backing variable annuity guarantees to maintain required regulatory reserve levels and targeted risk based capital ratios; and
decrease the Company’s estimated future gross profits, resulting in a DAC unlock charge. See Estimated Gross Profits Used in the Valuation and Amortization of Assets and Liabilities Associated with Variable Annuity Contracts within the Critical Accounting Estimates section of the MD&A for further information.
Generally, increases in equity markets will have the inverse impact of those listed in the preceding discussion. For additional information, see Risk Hedging - Variable Annuity Hedging Program section.
Variable Annuity Guaranteed Benefits
The Company’s variable annuities include GMDB and certain contracts with GMDB also include GMWB features. Declines in the equity markets will increase the Company’s liability for these benefits. Many contracts with a GMDB include a maximum anniversary value ("MAV"), which in rising markets resets the guarantee on anniversary to be 'at the money'. As the MAV increases, it can increase the NAR for subsequent declines in account value. Generally, a GMWB contract is ‘in the money’ if the contractholder’s guaranteed remaining balance ("GRB") becomes greater than the account value.
The NAR is generally defined as the guaranteed minimum benefit amount in excess of the contractholder’s current account value. Variable annuity account values with guarantee features were $44.2 billion and $52.9 billion as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively.

98



The following tables summarize the account values of the Company’s variable annuities with guarantee features and the NAR split between various guarantee features (retained net amount at risk does not take into consideration the effects of the variable annuity hedge programs in place as of each balance sheet date):
Total Variable Annuity Guarantees
As of December 31, 2015
($ in billions)
Account
Value
Gross Net Amount at Risk
Retained Net Amount at Risk
% of Contracts In the Money[2]
% In the Money [2] [3]
U.S. Variable Annuity [1]
 
 
 
 
 
GMDB
$
44.2

$
4.2

$
1.1

55
%
9
%
GMWB
20.2

0.2

0.2

11
%
9
%
Total Variable Annuity Guarantees
As of December 31, 2014
($ in billions)
Account
Value
Gross Net Amount at Risk
Retained Net Amount at Risk
% of Contracts In the Money [2]
% In the Money [2] [3]
U.S. Variable Annuity [1]
 
 
 
 
 
GMDB
$
52.9

$
3.8

$
0.8

23
%
14
%
GMWB
24.8

0.2

0.1

6
%
11
%
[1]
Policies with a guaranteed living benefit also have a guaranteed death benefit. The NAR for each benefit is shown; however these benefits are not additive. When a policy terminates due to death, any NAR related to GMWB is released. Similarly, when a policy goes into benefit status on a GMWB, the GMDB NAR is reduced to zero.
[2]
Excludes contracts that are fully reinsured.
[3]
For all contracts that are “in the money”, this represents the percentage by which the average contract was in the money.
Many policyholders with a GMDB also have a GMWB. Policyholders that have a product that offers both guarantees can only receive the GMDB or GMWB. The GMDB NAR disclosed in the preceding tables is a point in time measurement and assumes that all participants utilize the GMDB benefit on that measurement date. For additional information on the Company's GMDB liability, see Note 9 - Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
The Company expects to incur GMDB payments in the future only if the policyholder has an “in the money” GMDB at their death. For policies with a GMWB rider, the company expects to incur GMWB payments in the future only if the account value is reduced over time to a specified level through a combination of market performance and periodic withdrawals, at which point the contract holder will receive an annuity equal to the GRB which is generally equal to premiums less withdrawals. For the Company’s “life-time” GMWB products, this annuity can exceed the GRB. As the account value fluctuates with equity market returns on a daily basis and the “life-time” GMWB payments may exceed the GRB, the ultimate amount to be paid by the Company, if any, is uncertain and could be significantly more or less than the Company’s current carried liability. For additional information on the Company’s GMWB liability, see Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

99



Variable Annuity Market Risk Exposures
The following table summarizes the broad Variable Annuity Guarantees offered by the Company and the market risks to which the guarantee is most exposed from a U.S. GAAP accounting perspective:
Variable Annuity Guarantees [1]
U.S. GAAP Treatment [1]
Primary Market Risk Exposures [1]
GMDB and life-contingent component of the GMWB
Accumulation of the portion of fees required to cover expected claims, less accumulation of actual claims paid
Equity Market Levels
GMWB (excluding life-contingent portions)
Fair Value
Equity Market Levels / Implied
Volatility / Interest Rates
[1]
Each of these guarantees and the related U.S. GAAP accounting volatility will also be influenced by actual and estimated policyholder behavior.
Risk Hedging
Variable Annuity Hedging Program
The Company’s variable annuity hedging is primarily focused, through the use of reinsurance and capital market derivative instruments, on reducing the economic exposure to market risks associated with guaranteed benefits that are embedded in our variable annuity contracts. The variable annuity hedging also considers the potential impacts on statutory accounting results.
Reinsurance
The Company uses reinsurance for a portion of contracts with GMWB riders issued prior to the third quarter of 2003 and GMWB risks associated with a block of business sold between the third quarter of 2003 and the second quarter of 2006. The Company also uses reinsurance for a majority of the GMDB issued.
Capital Market Derivatives
GMWB Hedge Program
The Company enters into derivative contracts to hedge market risk exposures associated with the GMWB liabilities that are not reinsured. These derivative contracts include customized swaps, interest rate swaps and futures, and equity swaps, options, and futures, on certain indices including the S&P 500 index, EAFE index, and NASDAQ index.
Additionally, the Company holds customized derivative contracts to provide protection from certain capital market risks for the remaining term of specified blocks of non-reinsured GMWB riders. These customized derivative contracts are based on policyholder behavior assumptions specified at the inception of the derivative contracts. The Company retains the risk for differences between assumed and actual policyholder behavior and between the performance of the actively managed funds underlying the separate accounts and their respective indices.
While the Company actively manages this dynamic hedging program, increased U.S. GAAP earnings volatility may result from factors including, but not limited to: policyholder behavior, capital markets, divergence between the performance of the underlying funds and the hedging indices, changes in hedging positions and the relative emphasis placed on various risk management objectives.
Macro Hedge Program
The Company’s macro hedging program uses derivative instruments, such as options and futures on equities and interest rates, to provide protection against the statutory tail scenario risk arising from GMWB and GMDB liabilities on the Company’s statutory surplus. These macro hedges cover some of the residual risks not otherwise covered by the dynamic hedging program. Management assesses this residual risk under various scenarios in designing and executing the macro hedge program. The macro hedge program will result in additional U.S. GAAP earnings volatility as changes in the value of the macro hedge derivatives, which are designed to reduce statutory reserve and capital volatility, may not be closely aligned to changes in GAAP liabilities.
Variable Annuity Hedging Program Sensitivities
The underlying guaranteed living benefit liabilities and the related hedge assets within the GMWB (excluding life contingent GMWB payments) and Macro hedge programs are carried at fair value, with the exception of liabilities within the Macro hedge program.

100



The following table presents our estimates of the potential instantaneous impacts from sudden market stresses related to equity market prices, interest rates, and implied market volatilities. The following sensitivities represent: (1) the net estimated difference between the change in the fair value of GMWB liabilities and the underlying hedge instruments and (2) the estimated change in fair value of the hedge instruments for the macro program, before the impacts of amortization of DAC, and taxes. As noted in the preceding discussion, certain hedge assets are used to hedge liabilities that are not carried at fair value and will not have a liability offset in the U.S. GAAP sensitivity analysis. All sensitivities are measured as of year end and are related to the fair value of liabilities and hedge instruments in place at that date for the Company’s variable annuity hedge programs. The impacts presented in the table that follows are estimated individually and measured without consideration of any correlation among market risk factors.
GAAP Sensitivity Analysis
As of December 31, 2015
(before tax and DAC) [1]
GMWB
Macro
Equity Market Return
-20
 %
-10
 %
10
 %
-20
 %
-10
 %
10
 %
Potential Net Fair Value Impact
$
(19
)
$
(6
)
$

$
168

$
70

$
(43
)
Interest Rates
-50bps

-25bps

+25bps

-50bps

-25bps

+25bps

Potential Net Fair Value Impact
$
2

$
1

$
(3
)
$
12

$
6

$
(6
)
Implied Volatilities
10
 %
2
 %
-10
 %
10
 %
2
 %
-10
 %
Potential Net Fair Value Impact
$
(50
)
$
(10
)
$
48

$
93

$
19

$
(89
)
[1]
These sensitivities are based on the following key market levels as of December 31, 2015: 1) S&P of 2044; 2) 10yr US swap rate of 2.25%; and 3) S&P 10yr volatility of 27.16%
The preceding sensitivity analysis is an estimate and should not be used to predict the future financial performance of the Company's variable annuity hedge programs. The actual net changes in the fair value liability and the hedging assets illustrated in the preceding table may vary materially depending on a variety of factors which include but are not limited to:
The sensitivity analysis is only valid as of the measurement date and assumes instantaneous changes in the capital market factors and no ability to rebalance hedge positions prior to the market changes;
Changes to the underlying hedging program, policyholder behavior, and variation in underlying fund performance relative to the hedged index, which could materially impact the liability; and
The impact of elapsed time on liabilities or hedge assets, any non-parallel shifts in capital market factors, or correlated moves across the sensitivities.
Foreign Currency Exchange Risk
Foreign currency exchange risk is defined as the risk of financial loss due to changes in the relative value between currencies. The Company’s foreign currency exchange risk is related to non-U.S. dollar denominated investments, which primarily consist of fixed maturity and equity investments, a yen denominated fixed payout annuity and changes in equity of a P&C runoff entity in the United Kingdom. In addition, the Company’s Talcott Resolution operations formerly issued non-U.S. dollar denominated funding agreement liability contracts. A significant portion of the Company’s foreign currency exposure is mitigated through the use of derivatives.
Fixed Maturity and Equity Investments
The risk associated with the non-U.S. dollar denominated fixed maturities and equities relates to potential decreases in value and income resulting from unfavorable changes in foreign exchange rates. The fair values of the non-U.S. dollar denominated fixed maturities and equities at December 31, 2015 and 2014 were approximately $921 and $549, respectively. Included in these amounts are $530 and $398 at December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, related to non-U.S. dollar denominated fixed maturity and equity securities that directly support liabilities denominated in the same currencies. At December 31, 2015 and 2014, the derivatives used to hedge currency exchange risk related to the remaining non-U.S. dollar denominated fixed maturities and equities had a total notional amount of $444 and $137, respectively, and total fair value of $18 and $2, respectively.
Based on the fair values of the Company’s non-U.S. dollar denominated securities and derivative instruments as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, management estimates that a 10% unfavorable change in exchange rates would decrease the fair values by a before-tax total of approximately $48 and $38, respectively. The estimated impact was based upon a 10% change in December 31 spot rates. The selection of the 10% unfavorable change was made only for illustration of the potential hypothetical impact of such an event and should not be construed as a prediction of future market events. Actual results could differ materially from those illustrated above due to the nature of the estimates and assumptions used in the analysis.

101



Liabilities
The Company has foreign currency exchange risk associated with yen denominated fixed payout annuities under a reinsurance contract. The Company has entered into pay U.S. dollar, receive yen swap contracts to hedge the currency exposure between the U.S. dollar denominated assets and the yen denominated fixed liability reinsurance payments. In addition, during 2015, the Company entered into certain foreign currency forwards to hedge the currency impacts on changes in equity of a P&C runoff entity in the United Kingdom. At December 31, 2015 the derivatives used to hedge the currency impacts had a total notional amount of $191 and a total fair value of $6.
Talcott Resolution previously issued non-U.S. dollar denominated funding agreement liability contracts. The Company hedged the foreign currency risk associated with these liability contracts with currency rate swaps. At December 31, 2015 and 2014, the derivatives used to hedge foreign currency exchange risk related to foreign denominated liability contracts had a total notional amount of $94, and a total fair value of $(26) and $(20), respectively.
Financial Risk on Statutory Capital
Statutory surplus amounts and risk-based capital (“RBC”) ratios may increase or decrease in any period depending upon a variety of factors and may be compounded in extreme scenarios or if multiple factors occur at the same time. At times the impact of changes in certain market factors or a combination of multiple factors on RBC ratios can be counterintuitive. Factors include:
In general, as equity market levels and interest rates decline, the amount and volatility of both our actual potential obligation, as well as the related statutory surplus and capital margin for death and living benefit guarantees associated with variable annuity contracts can be materially negatively affected, sometimes at a greater than linear rate. Other market factors that can impact statutory surplus, reserve levels and capital margin include differences in performance of variable subaccounts relative to indices and/or realized equity and interest rate volatilities. In addition, as equity market levels increase, generally surplus levels will increase. RBC ratios will also tend to increase when equity markets increase. However, as a result of a number of factors and market conditions, including the level of hedging costs and other risk transfer activities, reserve requirements for death and living benefit guarantees and RBC requirements could increase with rising equity markets, resulting in lower RBC ratios. Non-market factors, which can also impact the amount and volatility of both our actual potential obligation, as well as the related statutory surplus and capital margin, include actual and estimated policyholder behavior experience as it pertains to lapsation, partial withdrawals, and mortality.
As the value of certain fixed-income and equity securities in our investment portfolio decreases, due in part to credit spread widening, statutory surplus and RBC ratios may decrease.
As the value of certain derivative instruments that do not get hedge accounting decreases, statutory surplus and RBC ratios may decrease.
Our statutory surplus is also impacted by widening credit spreads as a result of the accounting for the assets and liabilities in our fixed MVA annuities. Statutory separate account assets supporting the fixed MVA annuities are recorded at fair value. In determining the statutory reserve for the fixed MVA annuities, we are required to use current crediting rates. In many capital market scenarios, current crediting rates are highly correlated with market rates implicit in the fair value of statutory separate account assets. As a result, the change in statutory reserve from period to period will likely substantially offset the change in the fair value of the statutory separate account assets. However, in periods of volatile credit markets, actual credit spreads on investment assets may increase sharply for certain sub-sectors of the overall credit market, resulting in statutory separate account asset market value losses. As actual credit spreads are not fully reflected in the current crediting rates the calculation of statutory reserves will not substantially offset the change in fair value of the statutory separate account assets resulting in reductions in statutory surplus. This has resulted and may continue to result in the need to devote significant additional capital to support the product.
With respect to our fixed annuity business, sustained low interest rates may result in a reduction in statutory surplus and an increase in NAIC required capital.
Most of these factors are outside of the Company’s control. The Company’s financial strength and credit ratings are significantly influenced by the statutory surplus amounts and RBC ratios of our insurance company subsidiaries. In addition, rating agencies may implement changes to their internal models that have the effect of increasing or decreasing the amount of statutory capital we must hold in order to maintain our current ratings.
The Company has reinsured approximately 33% of its risk associated with GMWB and 74% of its risk associated with the aggregate GMDB exposure. These reinsurance agreements serve to reduce the Company’s exposure to changes in the statutory reserves and the related capital and RBC ratios associated with changes in the capital markets. The Company also continues to explore other solutions for mitigating the capital market risk effect on surplus, such as internal and external reinsurance solutions, modifications to our hedging program, changes in product design and expense management.

102



Credit Risk
Credit risk is defined as the risk to earnings or capital due to uncertainty of an obligor’s or counterparty’s ability or willingness to meet its obligations in accordance with contractually agreed upon terms. The majority of the Company’s credit risk is concentrated in its investment holdings but is also present in reinsurance and insurance portfolios. Credit risk is comprised of three major factors: the risk of change in credit quality, or credit migration risk; the risk of default; and the risk of a change in value due to changes in credit spread. A decline in creditworthiness is typically associated with an increase in an investment’s credit spread, potentially resulting in an increase in other-than-temporary impairments and an increased probability of a realized loss upon sale.
The objective of the Company’s enterprise credit risk management strategy is to identify, quantify, and manage credit risk on an aggregate portfolio basis and to limit potential losses in accordance with an established credit risk management policy. The Company manages to its credit risk appetite by primarily holding a diversified mix of investment grade issuers and counterparties across its investment, reinsurance, and insurance portfolios. Potential losses are also limited within portfolios by diversifying across geographic regions, asset types, and sectors.
The Company manages credit risk exposure from its inception to its maturity or sale. Both the investment and reinsurance areas have formulated procedures for counterparty approvals and authorizations. Although approval processes may vary by area and type of credit risk, approval processes establish minimum levels of creditworthiness and financial stability. Credits considered for investment are subjected to underwriting reviews. Within the investment portfolio, private securities are subject to committee review for approval.
Credit risks are managed on an on-going basis through the use of various processes and analyses. At the investment, reinsurance, and insurance product levels, fundamental credit analyses are performed at the issuer/counterparty level on a regular basis. To provide a holistic review within the investment portfolio, fundamental analyses are supported by credit ratings, assigned by nationally recognized rating agencies or internally assigned, and by quantitative credit analyses. The Company utilizes various risk tools, such as credit value at risk ("VaR") to measure spread, migration, and default risk on a monthly basis. Issuer and security level risk measures are also utilized. In the event of deterioration in credit quality, the Company maintains watch lists of problem counterparties within the investment and reinsurance portfolios. The watch lists are updated based on regular credit examinations and management reviews. The Company also performs quarterly assessments of probable expected losses in the investment portfolio. The process is conducted on a sector basis and is intended to promptly assess and identify potential problems in the portfolio and to recognize necessary impairments.
Credit risk policies at the enterprise and operation level ensure comprehensive and consistent approaches to quantifying, evaluating, and managing credit risk under expected and stressed conditions. These policies define the scope of the risk, authorities, accountabilities, terms, and limits, and are regularly reviewed and approved by senior management. Aggregate counterparty credit quality and exposure is monitored on a daily basis utilizing an enterprise-wide credit exposure information system that contains data on issuers, ratings, exposures, and credit limits. Exposures are tracked on a current and potential basis. Credit exposures are reported regularly to the Company's Asset Liability Committee ("ALCO") and the ERCC. Exposures are aggregated by ultimate parent across investments, reinsurance receivables, insurance products with credit risk, and derivative counterparties.
The Company exercises various methods to mitigate its credit risk exposure within its investment and reinsurance portfolios. Some of the reasons for mitigating credit risk include financial instability or poor credit, avoidance of arbitration or litigation, future uncertainty of the counterparty, and exposure in excess of risk tolerances. Credit risk within the investment portfolio is most commonly mitigated through asset sales or the use of derivative instruments. Counterparty credit risk is mitigated through the practice of entering into contracts only with strong creditworthy institutions and through the practice of holding and posting of collateral. In addition, transactions cleared through a central clearing house reduce risk due to their ability to require daily variation margin, monitor the Company's ability to request additional collateral in the event of a counterparty downgrade, and be an independent valuation source. Systemic credit risk is mitigated through the construction of high-quality, diverse portfolios that are subject to regular underwriting of credit risks. For further discussion of the Company’s investment and derivative instruments, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management, Portfolio Risks and Risk Management and Note 6 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. For further discussion on managing and mitigating credit risk from the use of reinsurance via an enterprise security review process, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management, Insurance Risk Management, Reinsurance as a Risk Management Strategy.
As of December 31, 2015, the Company had no investment exposure to any credit concentration risk of a single issuer or counterparty greater than 10% of the Company's stockholders' equity, other than the U.S. government and certain U.S. government securities. For further discussion of concentration of credit risk in the investment portfolio, see the Concentration of Credit Risk section in Note 6 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

103



Derivative Instruments
The Company utilizes a variety of OTC, OTC-cleared and exchange-traded derivative instruments as a part of its overall risk management strategy, as well as to enter into replication transactions. Derivative instruments are used to manage risk associated with interest rate, equity market, commodity market, credit spread, issuer default, price, and currency exchange rate risk or volatility. Replication transactions are used as an economical means to synthetically replicate the characteristics and performance of assets that are permissible investments under the Company’s investment policies. For further information on the Company’s use of derivatives, see Note 6 Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Derivative activities are monitored and evaluated by the Company’s compliance and risk management teams and reviewed by senior management. In addition, the Company monitors counterparty credit exposure on a monthly basis to ensure compliance with Company policies and statutory limitations. The notional amounts of derivative contracts represent the basis upon which pay or receive amounts are calculated and are not reflective of credit risk. Downgrades to the credit ratings of The Hartford’s insurance operating companies may have adverse implications for its use of derivatives including those used to hedge benefit guarantees of variable annuities. In some cases, downgrades may give derivative counterparties for OTC derivatives and clearing brokers for OTC-cleared derivatives the right to cancel and settle outstanding derivative trades or require additional collateral to be posted. In addition, downgrades may result in counterparties and clearing brokers becoming unwilling to engage in or clear additional derivatives or may require collateralization before entering into any new trades. This would restrict the supply of derivative instruments commonly used to hedge variable annuity guarantees, particularly long-dated equity derivatives and interest rate swaps.
The Company uses various derivative counterparties in executing its derivative transactions. The use of counterparties creates credit risk that the counterparty may not perform in accordance with the terms of the derivative transaction. The Company has derivative counterparty exposure policies which limit the Company’s exposure to credit risk. The Company’s policies with respect to derivative counterparty exposure establishes market-based credit limits, favors long-term financial stability and creditworthiness of the counterparty and typically requires credit enhancement/credit risk reducing agreements. The Company minimizes the credit risk of derivative instruments by entering into transactions with high quality counterparties primarily rated A or better, which are monitored and evaluated by the Company’s risk management team and reviewed by senior management. The Company also generally requires that OTC derivative contracts be governed by an International Swaps and Derivatives Association ("ISDA") Master Agreement, which is structured by legal entity and by counterparty and permits right of offset.
The Company has developed credit exposure thresholds which are based upon counterparty ratings. Credit exposures are measured using the market value of the derivatives, resulting in amounts owed to the Company by its counterparties or potential payment obligations from the Company to its counterparties. The Company enters into credit support annexes in conjunction with the ISDA agreements, which require daily collateral settlement based upon agreed upon thresholds. For purposes of daily derivative collateral maintenance, credit exposures are generally quantified based on the prior business day’s market value and collateral is pledged to and held by, or on behalf of, the Company to the extent the current value of the derivatives exceed the contractual thresholds. In accordance with industry standard and the contractual agreements, collateral is typically settled on the next business day. The Company has exposure to credit risk for amounts below the exposure thresholds which are uncollateralized, as well as for market fluctuations that may occur between contractual settlement periods of collateral movements.
For the company’s derivative programs, the maximum uncollateralized threshold for a derivative counterparty for a single legal entity is $10. The Company currently transacts OTC derivatives in five legal entities that have a threshold greater than zero; therefore, the maximum combined threshold for a single counterparty across all legal entities that use derivatives is $50. In addition, the Company may have exposure to multiple counterparties in a single corporate family due to a common credit support provider. As of December 31, 2015, the maximum combined threshold for all counterparties under a single credit support provider across all legal entities that use derivatives was $100. Based on the contractual terms of the collateral agreements, these thresholds may be immediately reduced due to a downgrade in either party’s credit rating. For further discussion, see the Derivative Commitments section of Note 12 Commitments and Contingencies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
For the year ended December 31, 2015, the Company incurred no losses on derivative instruments due to counterparty default.
In addition to counterparty credit risk, the Company may also introduce credit risk through the use of credit default swaps that are entered into to manage credit exposure. Credit default swaps involve a transfer of credit risk of one or many referenced entities from one party to another in exchange for periodic payments. The party that purchases credit protection will make periodic payments based on an agreed upon rate and notional amount, and for certain transactions there will also be an upfront premium payment. The second party, who assumes credit risk, will typically only make a payment if there is a credit event as defined in the contract and such payment will typically be equal to the notional value of the swap contract less the value of the referenced security issuer’s debt obligation. A credit event is generally defined as default on contractually obligated interest or principal payments or bankruptcy of the referenced entity.

104



The Company uses credit derivatives to purchase credit protection and to assume credit risk with respect to a single entity, referenced index, or asset pool. The Company purchases credit protection through credit default swaps to economically hedge and manage credit risk of certain fixed maturity investments across multiple sectors of the investment portfolio. The Company also enters into credit default swaps that assume credit risk as part of replication transactions. Replication transactions are used as an economical means to synthetically replicate the characteristics and performance of assets that are permissible investments under the Company’s investment policies. These swaps reference investment grade single corporate issuers and baskets, which include customized diversified portfolios of corporate issuers, which are established within sector concentration limits and may be divided into tranches which possess different credit ratings.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the notional amount related to credit derivatives that purchase credit protection was $0.4 billion and $0.6 billion, respectively, while the fair value was $18 and $(6), respectively. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the notional amount related to credit derivatives that assume credit risk was $2.5 billion and $1.5 billion, respectively, while the fair value was $(13) and $3, respectively. For further information on credit derivatives, see Note 6 Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management
Investment Portfolio Composition
The following table presents the Company’s fixed maturities, AFS, by credit quality. The following average credit ratings referenced throughout this section are based on availability, and are the midpoint of the applicable ratings among Moody’s, S&P, Fitch and Morningstar. If no rating is available from a rating agency, then an internally developed rating is used.
Fixed Maturities by Credit Quality
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Percent of Total Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Percent of Total Fair Value
United States Government/Government agencies
$
7,911

$
8,179

13.8
%
$
7,135

$
7,596

12.8
%
AAA
6,980

7,195

12.2
%
6,963

7,251

12.2
%
AA
9,943

10,584

17.9
%
9,258

10,056

16.9
%
A
14,297

15,128

25.5
%
15,250

16,717

28.2
%
BBB
14,598

14,918

25.2
%
13,464

14,397

24.2
%
BB & below
3,236

3,192

5.4
%
3,292

3,367

5.7
%
Total fixed maturities, AFS
$
56,965

$
59,196

100
%
$
55,362

$
59,384

100
%
The value of securities in the "United States Government/ Government agencies" category increased, as compared to December 31, 2014, primarily due to purchases of U.S. treasuries as a result of portfolio management between sectors to manage credit, duration and liquidity needs, as well as holding additional securities related to our repurchase agreement program. The decline in the "A" category and the increase in the "BBB" category is primarily due to downgrades of corporate securities and bonds of municipalities and political subdivisions ("municipal bonds") from "A" to "BBB", as well as net purchases. Fixed maturities, FVO, are not included in the preceding table. For further discussion on FVO securities, see Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

105



The following table presents the Company’s AFS securities by type, as well as fixed maturities and equity, FVO.
Securities by Type
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Cost or Amortized Cost
Gross Unrealized Gains
Gross Unrealized Losses
Fair Value
Percent of Total Fair Value
Cost or Amortized Cost
Gross Unrealized Gains
Gross Unrealized Losses
Fair Value
Percent of Total Fair Value
ABS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
$
2,183

$
6

$
(40
)
$
2,149

3.6
%
$
2,052

$
14

$
(28
)
$
2,038

3.4
%
Small business
123

12

(4
)
131

0.2
%
166

14

(8
)
172

0.3
%
Other
214

6

(1
)
219

0.4
%
252

11

(1
)
262

0.4
%
Collateralized debt obligations ("CDOs")
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan obligations ("CLOs")
2,514

4

(21
)
2,497

4.2
%
2,279

4

(17
)
2,266

3.8
%
Commercial real estate ("CREs")
91

42

(1
)
132

0.2
%
114

88

(9
)
193

0.3
%
Other [1]
384

29

(1
)
409

0.7
%
383

6

(10
)
382

0.6
%
Commercial mortgage-backed securities ("CMBS")
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Agency backed [2]
1,224

34

(8
)
1,250

2.1
%
1,136

45

(1
)
1,180

2.0
%
Bonds
2,725

58

(29
)
2,754

4.7
%
2,594

126

(4
)
2,716

4.6
%
Interest only (“IOs”)
719

13

(19
)
713

1.2
%
505

25

(11
)
519

0.9
%
Corporate
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic industry
1,161

55

(45
)
1,171

2.0
%
1,673

105

(22
)
1,756

3.0
%
Capital goods
1,781

110

(15
)
1,876

3.2
%
1,880

192

(4
)
2,068

3.5
%
Consumer cyclical
1,848

68

(24
)
1,892

3.2
%
1,647

128

(8
)
1,767

3.0
%
Consumer non-cyclical
3,735

196

(24
)
3,907

6.6
%
3,473

335

(5
)
3,803

6.4
%
Energy
2,276

84

(111
)
2,249

3.8
%
3,092

252

(49
)
3,295

5.5
%
Financial services
6,083

246

(63
)
6,266

10.6
%
4,942

405

(94
)
5,253

8.8
%
Tech./comm.
3,553

229

(62
)
3,720

6.3
%
3,150

370

(12
)
3,508

5.9
%
Transportation
869

43

(10
)
902

1.5
%
891

82

(4
)
969

1.6
%
Utilities
4,395

299

(60
)
4,634

7.8
%
4,278

496

(13
)
4,761

8.0
%
Other
175

12

(2
)
185

0.3
%
162

17


179

0.3
%
Foreign govt./govt. agencies
1,321

34

(47
)
1,308

2.2
%
1,592

73

(29
)
1,636

2.8
%
Municipal bonds
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Taxable
1,315

92

(9
)
1,398

2.4
%
1,135

135

(2
)
1,268

2.1
%
Tax-exempt
9,809

916

(2
)
10,723

18.1
%
10,600

1,006

(3
)
11,603

19.5
%
RMBS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Agency
2,206

64

(6
)
2,264

3.8
%
2,448

98

(2
)
2,544

4.3
%
Non-agency
89

2


91

0.2
%
81

3


84

0.1
%
Alt-A
68

1


69

0.1
%
55

1


56

0.1
%
Sub-prime
1,623

15

(16
)
1,622

2.7
%
1,231

20

(17
)
1,234

2.1
%
U.S. Treasuries
4,481

222

(38
)
4,665

7.9
%
3,551

326

(5
)
3,872

6.5
%
Fixed maturities, AFS
56,965

2,892

(658
)
59,196

100
%
55,362

4,377

(358
)
59,384

100
%
Equity securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial services
159

1

(2
)
158

18.8
%
149

13


162

23.2
%
Other
683

37

(39
)
681

81.2
%
527

37

(27
)
537

76.8
%
Equity securities, AFS
842

38

(41
)
839

100
%
676

50

(27
)
699

100
%
Total AFS securities
$
57,807

$
2,930

$
(699
)
$
60,035

 
$
56,038

$
4,427

$
(385
)
$
60,083

 
Fixed maturities, FVO
 
 
 
$
503

 
 
 
 
$
488

 
Equity, FVO [3]
 
 
 
$
282

 
 
 
 
$
348

 
[1]
Gross unrealized gains (losses) exclude the fair value of bifurcated embedded derivatives within certain securities. Changes in value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
[2]
Includes securities with pools of loans issued by the Small Business Administration which are backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government.
[3]
Included in equity securities, AFS on the Consolidated Balance Sheets.

106



The fair value of AFS securities was relatively consistent with December 31, 2014, as the impact of widening credit spreads and an increase in interest rates was partially offset by the reinvestment of short-term assets into fixed maturities, as well as the purchase of U.S. Treasuries with the proceeds received from repurchase agreements. The Company has reduced its allocation to tax-exempt municipal bonds in favor of other investments that provide greater after-tax economic return potential given current market conditions and the Company’s tax position. During 2015, the Company increased its investment in the financial services sector through purchases of primarily investment grade corporate securities while reducing it's exposure to the energy sector as a result of the continued volatility in oil prices. These changes are discussed further below.
Energy Exposure
Market values of securities in the energy sector continued to experience volatility throughout 2015. The continued price volatility has caused credit spreads to widen for corporate and sovereign issuers that generate a large portion of their revenues from energy. The impact is more pronounced on issuers with below investment grade credit. Ultimately, the impact on these issuers will be determined by the severity and duration of the decline in prices and the ability of the issuers to hedge price declines, adjust their cost structure or find other sources of revenue.
The Company's direct exposure within its investment portfolio to the energy sector totals approximately 3% of total invested assets as of December 31, 2015 and is primarily comprised of corporate debt. As a result of continued volatility in prices, the Company reduced its exposure to the energy sector during 2015 by an amortized cost of approximately $1 billion. The Company's energy sector investments as of December 31, 2015 are primarily comprised of investment grade securities and the exposure is diversified by issuer, as well as in different sub-sectors of the energy market. The following table summarizes the Company's exposure to the energy sector by security type and credit quality.
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Cost or Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Cost or Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Corporate and equity securities, AFS
 
 
 
 
Investment grade corporate
$
2,058

$
2,068

$
2,818

$
3,043

Below investment grade corporate
218

181

274

252

Equity, AFS
16

13

23

21

Total corporate and equity securities, AFS
2,292

2,262

3,115

3,316

Foreign govt./govt. agencies, AFS








Investment grade
248

251

322

334

Below investment grade
6

6

36

32

Total foreign govt./govt. agencies, AFS [1]
254

257

358

366

Fixed maturities, FVO








Investment grade
2

2

10

10

Below investment grade
4

4

14

14

Total fixed maturities, FVO
6

6

24

24

Short-term investments
10

10

41

41

Total energy exposure [2]
$
2,562

$
2,535

$
3,538

$
3,747

[1]
Includes sovereigns for which oil exports are greater than 4% of gross domestic product.
[2]
Excludes equity securities, FVO with cost and fair value of $45 and $45, respectively, as of December 31, 2014, that are hedged with total return swaps. The Company did not hold any equity securities, FVO within the energy sector as of December 31, 2015.
The Company manages the credit risk associated with the energy sector within the investment portfolio on an on-going basis using macroeconomic analysis and issuer credit analysis. The Company considers alternate scenarios including oil prices remaining at low levels for an extended period and/or declining significantly below current levels. For additional details regarding the Company’s management of credit risks, see the Credit Risk Section of this MD&A. The Company has evaluated all available-for-sale securities for potential other-than-temporary impairments as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, and concluded that for the securities in an unrealized loss position, it is more likely than not that we will recover our entire amortized cost basis in the securities. In addition, the Company does not currently have the intent-to-sell, nor will we be required to sell, the securities discussed above. For additional details regarding the Company’s impairment process, see the Other-Than-Temporary Impairments Section of this MD&A.

107



Emerging Market Exposure
Emerging market securities have been negatively impacted by growing concerns surrounding the growth of the Chinese economy, volatile prices for energy and other commodities, political tension in eastern Europe, softer-than-expected global economic growth, as well as trade and budget deficits, raising the potential for destabilizing capital outflows and rapid currency depreciation. As a result of these factors, credit spreads for certain emerging market securities have been volatile and we expect continued sensitivity to geopolitical events, the ongoing evolution of Fed policy and other economic factors, including contagion risk.
The Company has limited direct exposure within its investment portfolio to emerging market issuers, totaling $1.2 billion and $1.1 billion in amortized cost and fair value, respectively, or approximately 2% of total invested assets as of December 31, 2015, and is primarily comprised of sovereign and corporate debt issued in U.S. dollars. The Company identifies exposures with the issuers’ ultimate parent country of domicile, which may not be the country of the security issuer. The following table presents the Company’s exposure to securities within certain emerging markets currently under the greatest stress, defined as countries that had a sovereign S&P credit rating of B- or below, or countries that have had a current account deficit and have an average inflation level greater than 5% for the past six months, as of either December 31, 2015 or 2014.
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Argentina
$

$

$
2

$
2

Brazil
33

29

123

120

India
21

21

37

37

Indonesia
92

85

82

80

Kazakhstan
55

53

79

73

Lebanon


29

29

South Africa
34

31

54

53

Turkey
76

73

65

67

Ukraine


3

3

Uruguay
32

30

16

17

Venezuela


4

2

Other
73

69

97

96

Total [1]
$
416

$
391

$
591

$
579

[1]
Includes an amortized cost and fair value of $176 and $160, respectively, as of December 31, 2015 and an amortized cost and fair value of $137 and $131, respectively, as of December 31, 2014 included in the exposure to the energy sector table above.
The Company manages the credit risk associated with emerging market securities within the investment portfolio on an on-going basis using macroeconomic analysis and issuer credit analysis subject to diversification and individual credit risk management limits. For additional details regarding the Company’s management of credit risk, see the Credit Risk section of this MD&A. Due to the continued decline in oil prices during 2015, the Company significantly reduced its exposure to countries that rely on the energy sector as a main source of their Gross Domestic Product ("GDP"), such as Brazil.
European Exposure
In recent years, certain economies in the European region have experienced adverse economic conditions, specifically in Europe’s peripheral region (Greece, Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain), that were precipitated in part by elevated unemployment rates weighing on inflation rates, government debt levels and the slowing growth of the region.  However, austerity measures aimed at reducing sovereign debt levels and greater support from the European Central Bank’s have reduced the risk of default on the sovereign debt of the countries within the region. As a result, economic conditions in the region have shown signs of improvement through stabilized credit ratings in Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain. Though economic conditions in the region have improved, continued slow GDP growth and elevated unemployment levels may continue to put pressure on sovereign debt.

108



The Company manages the credit risk associated with the European securities within the investment portfolio on an on-going basis using several processes which are supported by macroeconomic analysis and issuer credit analysis. For additional details regarding the Company’s management of credit risk, see the Credit Risk section of this MD&A. The Company periodically considers alternate scenarios, including a base-case and both positive and negative “tail” scenarios that includes a partial or full break-up of the Eurozone. The outlook for key factors is evaluated, including the economic prospects for key countries, the potential for the spread of sovereign debt contagion, and the likelihood that policymakers and politicians pursue sufficient fiscal discipline and introduce appropriate backstops. Given the inherent uncertainty in the outcome of developments in the Eurozone, however, the Company controls both absolute levels of exposure and the composition of that exposure for investments and derivatives.
The Company has direct European exposure, totaling approximately 6% of total invested assets as of December 31, 2015. The following tables present the Company’s European securities included in the Securities by Type table above. The Company identifies exposures with the issuers’ ultimate parent country of domicile, which may not be the country of the security issuer.
The following tables present the Company’s European securities included in the Securities by Type table above.
 
December 31, 2015
 
Corporate & Equity, AFS Non-Finan. [1]
Corporate & Equity, AFS Financials
Foreign Govt./ Govt. Agencies
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Spain
1

1





1

1

Peripheral region
1

1





1

1

Europe excluding peripheral region [4]
2,622

2,749

1,191

1,229

350

352

4,163

4,330

Total Europe
$
2,623

$
2,750

$
1,191

$
1,229

$
350

$
352

$
4,164

$
4,331

Europe exposure net of credit default swap protection [2]
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
4,161

$
4,331

 
December 31, 2014
 
Corporate & Equity, AFS Non-Finan. [1]
Corporate & Equity, AFS Financials
Foreign Govt./ Govt. Agencies
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Italy
$
1

$
1

$

$

$

$

$
1

$
1

Spain [3]
21

23

1

1



22

24

Ireland
31

35





31

35

Peripheral region
53

59

1

1



54

60

Europe excluding peripheral region [4]
2,832

3,068

971

1,052

373

396

4,176

4,516

Total Europe
$
2,885

$
3,127

$
972

$
1,053

$
373

$
396

$
4,230

$
4,576

Europe exposure net of credit default swap protection [2]
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
4,186

$
4,576

[1]
Includes amortized cost and fair value of $1 and $4 as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, related to limited partnerships and other alternative investments.
[2]
Includes a notional amount and fair value of $3 and $0, respectively, as of December 31, 2015 and $44 and $0, respectively, as of December 31, 2014 related to credit default swap protection. This includes a notional amount of $3 and $3 as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively, related to single name corporate issuers in the financial services sector.
[3]
As of December 31, 2014, the Company had credit default swap protection with a notional amount of $3 related to Corporate and Equity, AFS, respectively.
[4]
Includes an amortized cost and fair value of $308 and $317, respectively, as of December 31, 2015 and an amortized cost and fair value of $389 and $407, respectively, as of December 31 2014 included in the exposure to the energy sector table above.
The Company’s European investment exposure largely relates to corporate entities which are domiciled in or generated a significant portion of its revenue within the United Kingdom, the Netherlands, Germany and Switzerland. Entities domiciled in the United Kingdom comprise the Company's largest exposure; as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the U.K. exposure totals less than 3% of total invested assets. The majority of the European investments are U.S. dollar-denominated, and those securities that are Sterling and euro-denominated are hedged to U.S. dollars or support foreign-denominated liabilities. For a discussion of foreign currency risks, see the Foreign Currency Exchange Risk section of this MD&A. The Company does not hold any sovereign exposure to the peripheral region and does not hold any exposure to issuers in Greece. As of both December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company’s unfunded commitments associated with its investment portfolio was immaterial, and the weighted average credit quality of European investments was A-.

109



As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company’s credit default swaps that provide credit protection on European issuers had a notional amount of $3 and $44, respectively, and a fair value of $0 and $0, respectively. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014 credit default swaps related to the peripheral region that reference single name corporate and financial European issuers had a notional value of $0 and $3, respectively. The maturity dates of credit default swaps are primarily consistent with the hedged bonds. For further information on the use of the Company’s credit derivatives and counterparty credit quality, see Derivative Instruments within the Credit Risk section of this MD&A.
In addition to the credit risk associated with the investment portfolio, as of December 31, 2015, the Company has $216 of reinsurance recoverables due from legal entity counterparties domiciled within Europe. For a more detailed discussion of the Company's reinsurance arrangements, see Note 5 - Reinsurance of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Financial Services
The Company’s investment in the financial services sector is predominantly through investment grade banking and insurance institutions. The following table presents the Company’s fixed maturities and equity, AFS securities in the financial services sector that are included in the preceding Securities by Type table.
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Net Unrealized Gain/(Loss)
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Net Unrealized Gain/(Loss)
AAA
$
40

$
42

$
2

$
31

$
34

$
3

AA
747

763

16

401

436

35

A
2,922

3,025

103

2,610

2,804

194

BBB
2,133

2,188

55

1,681

1,734

53

BB & below
400

406

6

368

407

39

Total [1]
$
6,242

$
6,424

$
182

$
5,091

$
5,415

$
324

[1]
Includes equity, AFS securities with an amortized cost and fair value of $159 and $158, respectively as of December 31, 2015 and an amortized cost and fair value of $149 and $162, respectively, as of December 31, 2014 included in the AFS by type table above.
The Company's investment in the financial services sector increased, as compared to December 31, 2014, due to purchases of primarily investment grade corporate securities, partially offset by a decrease in valuations as a result of an increase in interest rates and wider credit spreads.
Commercial Real Estate
Through December 31, 2015, commercial real estate market conditions, including property prices, occupancies, financial conditions, transaction volume, and delinquencies, continued to improve. In addition, the availability of credit has increased and there is now less concern about the ability of borrowers to refinance as loans come due.

110



The following table presents the Company’s exposure to CMBS bonds by current credit quality and vintage year included in the preceding Securities by Type table. Credit protection represents the current weighted average percentage of the outstanding capital structure subordinated to the Company’s investment holding that is available to absorb losses before the security incurs the first dollar loss of principal and excludes any equity interest or property value in excess of outstanding debt.
CMBS - Bonds [1]
 
December 31, 2015
 
AAA
AA
A
BBB
BB and Below
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
2004 & Prior
$
12

$
12

$
50

$
55

$

$

$

$

$
2

$
2

$
64

$
69

2005
98

107

27

28

5

5

5

5



135

145

2006
149

151

102

104

140

141

61

62

22

22

474

480

2007
202

206

170

178

81

83

20

20

51

52

524

539

2008
37

38









37

38

2009
11

11









11

11

2010
18

19

8

8







26

27

2011
55

59





23

23



78

82

2012
40

40

6

6

26

26

33

32



105

104

2013
16

16

95

97

79

80

9

10

1

1

200

204

2014
329

335

58

58

69

68

6

6

2

2

464

469

2015
201

197

163

158

172

165

71

66



607

586

Total
$
1,168

$
1,191

$
679

$
692

$
572

$
568

$
228

$
224

$
78

$
79

$
2,725

$
2,754

Credit  protection
32.9%
25.8%
18.4%
16.6%
18.7%
26.3%
 
December 31, 2014
 
AAA
AA
A
BBB
BB and Below
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
2004 & Prior
$
13

$
13

$
58

$
64

$
7

$
7

$

$

$
15

$
20

$
93

$
104

2005
175

188

78

80

99

101

83

84

46

46

481

499

2006
287

300

108

115

121

127

63

66

22

23

601

631

2007
211

221

169

182

78

82

31

31

72

73

561

589

2008
40

43









40

43

2009
11

11









11

11

2010
18

20









18

20

2011
56

62





6

6



62

68

2012
40

41



14

14

12

12



66

67

2013
16

16

95

99

71

76

12

13



194

204

2014
350

360

64

66

53

54





467

480

Total
$
1,217

$
1,275

$
572

$
606

$
443

$
461

$
207

$
212

$
155

$
162

$
2,594

$
2,716

Credit  protection
33.0%
25.7%
20.2%
19.5%
18.0%
27.2%
[1]
The vintage year represents the year the pool of loans was originated.
The Company also has exposure to CRE CDOs with an amortized cost and fair value of $91 and $132, respectively, as of December 31, 2015, and $114 and $193, respectively, as of December 31, 2014. These securities are comprised of pools of commercial mortgage loans or equity positions of other CMBS securitizations. We continue to monitor these investments as economic and market uncertainties regarding future performance impact market liquidity and security premiums.

111



In addition to CMBS bonds and CRE CDOs, the Company has exposure to commercial mortgage loans as presented in the following table. These loans are collateralized by a variety of commercial properties and are diversified both geographically throughout the United States and by property type. These loans are primarily in the form of whole loans, where the Company is the sole lender, but may include participations. Loan participations are loans where the Company has purchased or retained a portion of an outstanding loan or package of loans and participates on a pro-rata basis in collecting interest and principal pursuant to the terms of the participation agreement. In general, A-Note participations have senior payment priority, followed by B-Note participations and then mezzanine loan participations. As of December 31, 2015, loans within the Company’s mortgage loan portfolio that have had extensions or restructurings, other than what is allowable under the original terms of the contract, are immaterial.
Commercial Mortgage Loans
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost [1]
Valuation Allowance
Carrying Value
Amortized Cost [1]
Valuation Allowance
Carrying Value
Agricultural
$
33

$
(7
)
$
26

$
51

$
(5
)
$
46

Whole loans
5,458

(16
)
5,442

5,333

(13
)
5,320

A-Note participations
139


139

154


154

B-Note participations
17


17

17


17

Mezzanine loans



19


19

Total
$
5,647

$
(23
)
$
5,624

$
5,574

$
(18
)
$
5,556

[1]
Amortized cost represents carrying value prior to valuation allowances, if any.
During 2015, the Company funded $744 of commercial whole loans with a weighted average loan-to-value (“LTV”) ratio of 63% and a weighted average yield of 3.7%. The Company continues to originate commercial whole loans within primary markets, such as office, industrial and multi-family, focusing on loans with strong LTV ratios and high quality property collateral. There were no mortgage loans held for sale as of December 31, 2015 or December 31, 2014.
Valuation Allowances on Mortgage Loans
Year ended December 31, 2015
For the year ended December 31, 2015, the change in valuation allowances on mortgage loan additions of $5 was largely driven by individual property performance. Continued improvement in commercial real estate property valuations will positively impact future loss development, with future impairments driven by idiosyncratic loan-specific performance rather than overall deteriorating market fundamentals.
Year ended December 31, 2014
For the year ended December 31, 2014, the change in valuation allowances on mortgage loan additions of $4 was largely driven by individual property performance.
Year ended December 31, 2013
For the year ended December 31, 2013, the change in valuation allowances on mortgage loan additions of $2 was largely driven by individual property performance.

112



Municipal Bonds
The following table summarizes the amortized cost, fair value, and weighted average credit quality of the Company's available-for-sale investments in municipal bonds.
 
December 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Weighted Average Credit Quality
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Weighted Average Credit Quality
General Obligation
$
2,069

 
$
2,243

 
AA
 
$
2,259

 
$
2,480

 
AA
Pre-Refunded [1]
850

 
903

 
AAA
 
716

 
748

 
AAA
Revenue


 


 

 


 


 

Transportation
1,566

 
1,744

 
A+
 
1,599

 
1,781

 
A+
Health Care
1,371

 
1,499

 
AA-
 
1,412

 
1,560

 
AA-
Water & Sewer
1,228

 
1,324

 
AA
 
1,204

 
1,308

 
AA
Education
1,109

 
1,205

 
AA
 
1,115

 
1,232

 
AA
Sales Tax
692

 
779

 
AA-
 
916

 
1,020

 
AA-
Leasing [2]
728

 
803

 
AA-
 
772

 
858

 
AA-
Power
658

 
709

 
A+
 
739

 
814

 
A+
Housing
91

 
94

 
AA
 
148

 
153

 
AA
Other
762

 
818

 
AA-
 
855

 
917

 
AA-
Total Revenue
8,205

 
8,975

 
AA-
 
8,760

 
9,643

 
AA-
Total Municipal
$
11,124

 
$
12,121

 
AA-
 
$
11,735

 
$
12,871

 
AA-
[1]
Pre-Refunded bonds are bonds for which an irrevocable trust containing sufficient U.S. treasury, agency, or other securities has been established to fund the remaining payments of principal and interest.
[2]
Leasing revenue bonds are generally the obligations of a financing authority established by the municipality that leases facilities back to a municipality. The notes are typically secured by lease payments made by the municipality that is leasing the facilities financed by the issue. Lease payments may be subject to annual appropriation by the municipality or the municipality may be obligated to appropriate general tax revenues to make lease payments.
As of December 31, 2015, the largest issuer concentrations were the state of California, the Commonwealth of Massachusetts, and the New York Dormitory Authority, which each comprised less than 3% of the municipal bond portfolio and were comprised of general obligation and revenue bonds. As of December 31, 2014, the largest issuer concentrations were the states of Illinois and California, as well as the Commonwealth of Massachusetts, which each comprised less than 3% of the municipal bond portfolio, and were primarily comprised of general obligation and taxable bonds.
Limited Partnerships and Other Alternative Investments
The following table presents the Company’s investments in limited partnerships and other alternative investments which include hedge funds, real estate funds, and private equity and other funds. Hedge funds are comprised of approximately half credit and equity-related funds and approximately half global macro and market neutral focus funds. Real estate funds consist of investments primarily in real estate equity funds, including some funds with public market exposure, and real estate joint ventures. Private equity and other funds primarily consist of investments in funds whose assets typically consist of a diversified pool of investments in small to mid-sized non-public businesses with high growth potential as well as limited exposure to public markets.
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Amount
Percent
Amount
Percent
Hedge funds
$
1,034

36.0
%
$
1,187

40.3
%
Real estate funds
576

20.0
%
561

19.1
%
Private equity and other funds
1,264

44.0
%
1,194

40.6
%
Total
$
2,874

100
%
$
2,942

100
%

113



Available-for-Sale Securities — Unrealized Loss Aging
The total gross unrealized losses were $699 as of December 31, 2015, and have increased $314, or 82%, from December 31, 2014, due to wider credit spreads and higher interest rates. As of December 31, 2015, $582 of the gross unrealized losses were associated with securities depressed less than 20% of cost or amortized cost. The remaining $117 of gross unrealized losses were associated with securities depressed greater than 20%. The securities depressed more than 20% are primarily corporate securities that decreased in value due to widening of the sector credit spreads and an increase in interest rates.
As part of the Company’s ongoing security monitoring process, the Company has reviewed its AFS securities in an unrealized loss position and concluded that these securities are temporarily depressed and are expected to recover in value as the securities approach maturity or as market spreads tighten. For these securities in an unrealized loss position where a credit impairment has not been recorded, the Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows are sufficient to recover the amortized cost basis of the security. Furthermore, the Company neither has an intention to sell nor does it expect to be required to sell these securities. For further information regarding the Company’s impairment analysis, see Other-Than-Temporary Impairments in the Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management section of this MD&A.
The following tables present the Company’s unrealized loss aging for AFS securities by length of time the security was in a continuous unrealized loss position:
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Consecutive Months
Items
Cost or Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Loss [1]
Items
Cost or Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Loss [1]
Three months or less
2,094

$
10,535

$
10,398

$
(137
)
1,412

$
4,014

$
3,963

$
(51
)
Greater than three to six months
819

2,837

2,735

(102
)
643

1,739

1,665

(74
)
Greater than six to nine months
933

4,421

4,194

(227
)
220

417

404

(13
)
Greater than nine to eleven months
329

1,302

1,242

(60
)
102

148

142

(6
)
Twelve months or more
675

3,072

2,896

(173
)
688

4,667

4,429

(241
)
Total
4,850

$
22,167

$
21,465

$
(699
)
3,065

$
10,985

$
10,603

$
(385
)
[1]
Unrealized losses exclude the fair value of bifurcated embedded derivative features of certain securities as changes in value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
The following table presents the Company’s unrealized loss aging for AFS securities continuously depressed over 20% by length of time (included in the preceding table):
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Consecutive Months
Items
Cost or Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Loss [1]
Items
Cost or Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Loss [1]
Three months or less
240

$
288

$
212

$
(76
)
137

$
152

$
113

$
(39
)
Greater than three to six months
130

77

51

(26
)
39

17

11

(6
)
Greater than six to nine months
5

3

2

(1
)
11

4

1

(3
)
Greater than nine to eleven months
6

12

8

(4
)
9

1


(1
)
Twelve months or more
50

28

18

(10
)
49

31

19

(12
)
Total
431

$
408

$
291

$
(117
)
245

$
205

$
144

$
(61
)
[1]
Unrealized losses exclude the fair value of bifurcated embedded derivatives features of certain securities as changes in value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).

114



Other-Than-Temporary Impairments
The following table presents the Company’s impairments recognized in earnings by security type.
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
ABS
$

$

$
9

CRE CDOs
1


2

CMBS
 
 
 
Agency
1



Bonds

2

17

IOs
2

1

4

Corporate
71

35

20

Equity
16

11

15

Municipal
2

3


RMBS
 
 
 
Agency

3


Sub-prime
1

1

6

Foreign government
5



Other
3

3


Total
$
102

$
59

$
73

Year ended December 31, 2015
For the year ended December 31, 2015, impairments recognized in earnings were comprised of securities that the Company intends to sell ("intent-to-sell impairments") of $54, credit impairments of $29, impairments on equity securities of $16, and other impairments of $3.
For the year ended December 31, 2015, impairments were primarily in the corporate sector and resulted from $45 and $26 of intent-to-sell and credit impairments, respectively. The Company incorporates its best estimate of future performance using internal assumptions and judgments that are informed by economic and industry specific trends, as well as our expectations with respect to security specific developments. Non-credit impairments recognized in other comprehensive income were $6 for the year ended December 31, 2015. These non-credit impairments represent the difference between fair value and the Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows discounted at the security’s effective yield prior to impairment, rather than at current market implied credit spreads. Future impairments may develop as the result of changes in intent to sell specific securities or if actual results underperform current modeling assumptions, which may be the result of, but are not limited to, macroeconomic factors and security-specific performance below current expectations. Ultimate loss formation will be a function of macroeconomic factors and idiosyncratic security-specific performance.
Year ended December 31, 2014
For the year ended December 31, 2014, impairments recognized in earnings were comprised of credit impairments of $37, primarily concentrated in corporate securities. Also, included were impairments on debt securities for which the Company had the intent-to-sell of $17, primarily related to equity, AFS securities. In addition, impairments recognized in earnings included impairments on equity securities of $2 that were in an unrealized loss position and the Company no longer believed the securities would recover in the foreseeable future.
Year ended December 31, 2013
For the year ended December 31, 2013, impairments recognized in earnings were comprised of credit impairments of $32, primarily concentrated in corporate and fixed rate CMBS bonds. Also, included were impairments on debt securities for which the Company had the intent-to-sell of $26, primarily related to structured securities with exposure to commercial and residential real estate and corporate securities. In addition, impairments recognized in earnings included impairments on equity securities of $15 that were in an unrealized loss position and the Company no longer believed the securities would recover in the foreseeable future.

115



CAPITAL RESOURCES AND LIQUIDITY
The following section discusses the overall financial strength of The Hartford and its insurance operations including their ability to generate cash flows from each of their business segments, borrow funds at competitive rates and raise new capital to meet operating and growth needs over the next twelve months.
Liquidity Requirements and Sources of Capital
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. (Holding Company)
The liquidity requirements of the holding company of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. (“HFSG Holding Company”) have been and will continue to be met by HFSG Holding Company’s fixed maturities, short-term investments and cash, and dividends from its subsidiaries, principally its insurance operations, as well as the issuance of common stock, debt or other capital securities and borrowings from its credit facilities, as needed.
As of December 31, 2015, HFSG Holding Company held fixed maturities, short-term investments and cash of $1.7 billion. Expected liquidity requirements of the HFSG Holding Company for the next twelve months include payment of 5.5% senior notes of $275 at maturity in October 2016, interest payments on debt of approximately $330 and common stockholder dividends, subject to discretion of the Board of Directors, of approximately $335.
The Hartford has an intercompany liquidity agreement that allows for short-term advances of funds among the HFSG Holding Company and certain affiliates of up to $2.0 billion for liquidity and other general corporate purposes. The Connecticut Insurance Department ("CTDOI") granted approval for certain affiliated insurance companies that are parties to the agreement to treat receivables from a parent, including the HFSG Holding Company, as admitted assets for statutory accounting purposes. As of December 31, 2015, there were no amounts outstanding from the HFSG holding company.
Equity
In July 2015, the Board of Directors approved a $1.6 billion increase in and extension of the Company's authorized equity repurchase program, bringing the total authorization for equity repurchases to $4.375 billion for the period January 1, 2014 through December 31, 2016, with $1.3 billion remaining as of December 31, 2015. Any repurchase of shares under the equity repurchase program is dependent on market conditions and other factors.
During the year ended December 31, 2015, the Company repurchased 28.4 million common shares for $1,250. During the period January 1, 2016 through February 24, 2016, the Company repurchased 5.3 million common shares for $211.
Debt
On March 30, 2015, the Company repaid its $289, 4.0% senior notes at maturity. On May 27, 2015, the Company redeemed for cash the entire $296 aggregate principal amount outstanding of 4.0% senior notes due October 15, 2017 for $317 including a make-whole premium. On November 2, 2015, the Company repaid its $167, 7.3% senior notes at maturity. The Company funded the maturities of the 4.0% and 7.3% senior notes along with the redemption of the 4.0% senior notes with cash on hand. In addition, the Company plans to repay $275 of 5.5% senior notes due October 2016 upon maturity.
In July 2015, the Board of Directors authorized the extension of the existing debt capital management program, bringing the total authorization for debt management to $1.431 billion for the period January 1, 2014 through December 31, 2016. In addition to the payment of the maturing debt of $275, under the program the Company expects to use the remaining authorization of approximately $180 for other debt capital management actions during 2016. Any debt capital management actions are dependent on market conditions and other factors. For further information regarding debt, see Note 11 - Debt of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Intercompany Liquidity Agreements
On January 29, 2015 Hartford Insurance Company of the Midwest, an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, issued a Revolving Note (the "Note") in the principal amount of $58 to Hartford Fire Insurance Company, a subsidiary of the Company, under the intercompany liquidity agreement. The Note matured on March 31, 2015.
Dividends
On February 25, 2016, The Hartford’s Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend of $0.21 per common share payable on April 1, 2016 to common shareholders of record as of March 7, 2016. There are no current restrictions on the HFSG Holding Company's ability to pay dividends to its shareholders. For a discussion of restrictions on dividends to the HFSG Holding Company from its insurance subsidiaries, see "Dividends from Insurance Subsidiaries" below. For a discussion of potential restrictions on the HFSG Holding Company's ability to pay dividends, see Part I, Item 1A, — Risk Factors for the risk factor "Our ability to declare and pay dividends is subject to limitations" .

116



Pension Plans and Other Postretirement Benefits
While the Company has significant discretion in making voluntary contributions to the U. S. qualified defined benefit pension plan, minimum contributions are mandated in certain circumstances pursuant to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended by the Pension Protection Act of 2006, the Worker, Retiree, and Employer Recovery Act of 2008, the Preservation of Access to Care for Medicare Beneficiaries and Pension Relief Act of 2010, the Moving Ahead for Progress in the 21st Century Act of 2012 (MAP-21) and Internal Revenue Code regulations. The Company made contributions to the U. S. qualified defined benefit pension plan of $100, $100 and $100 in 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. No contributions were made to the other postretirement plans in 2015, 2014 and 2013. The Company’s 2015, 2014 and 2013 required minimum funding contributions were immaterial. The Company does not have a 2016 required minimum funding contribution for the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan and the funding requirements for all pension plans are expected to be immaterial. The Company has not determined whether, and to what extent, contributions may be made to the U. S. qualified defined benefit pension plan in 2016. The Company will monitor the funded status of the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan during 2016 to make this determination.
Dividends from Insurance Subsidiaries
Dividends to the HFSG Holding Company from its insurance subsidiaries are restricted by insurance regulation. The payment of dividends by Connecticut-domiciled insurers is limited under the insurance holding company laws of Connecticut. These laws require notice to and approval by the state insurance commissioner for the declaration or payment of any dividend, which, together with other dividends or distributions made within the preceding twelve months, exceeds the greater of (i) 10% of the insurer’s policyholder surplus as of December 31 of the preceding year or (ii) net income (or net gain from operations, if such company is a life insurance company) for the twelve-month period ending on the thirty-first day of December last preceding, in each case determined under statutory insurance accounting principles. In addition, if any dividend of a Connecticut-domiciled insurer exceeds the insurer’s earned surplus, it requires the prior approval of the Connecticut Insurance Commissioner. The insurance holding company laws of the other jurisdictions in which The Hartford’s insurance subsidiaries are incorporated (or deemed commercially domiciled) generally contain similar (although in certain instances somewhat more restrictive) limitations on the payment of dividends. Dividends paid to HFSG Holding Company by its life insurance subsidiaries are further dependent on cash requirements of Hartford Life, Inc. ("HLI") and other factors. In addition to statutory limitations on paying dividends, the Company also takes other items into consideration when determining dividends from subsidiaries. These considerations include, but are not limited to, expected earnings and capitalization of the subsidiary, regulatory capital requirements and liquidity requirements of the individual operating company.
During 2015, HFSG Holding Company received approximately $900 of dividends from its property and casualty insurance subsidiaries including approximately $200 which was subsequently contributed to a U.K. subsidiary to effect the consolidation of certain property and casualty runoff entities in the U.K.  In addition to the property and casualty insurance subsidiaries dividends, HFSG Holding Company received approximately $1.1 billion through a series of transactions with HLI’s life insurance subsidiaries.
In 2016, The Company’s property and casualty insurance subsidiaries are permitted to pay up to a maximum of approximately $1.6 billion in dividends to HFSG Holding Company without prior approval from the applicable insurance commissioner. In 2016, HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving net dividends of approximately $800 from its property and casualty insurance subsidiaries.
In 2016, Hartford Life and Accident Insurance Company ("HLA") is permitted to pay up to a maximum of $165 in dividends without prior approval from the insurance commissioner. In 2016, HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving dividends of approximately $240 from HLA, subject to regulatory approval.
On January 29, 2016, Hartford Life Insurance Company ("HLIC") paid an extraordinary dividend of $500, based on approval received from the insurance commissioner. As a result of this dividend, HLIC has no ordinary dividend capacity for the remainder of 2016. HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving an additional $250 of extraordinary dividends from HLIC during 2016, subject to regulatory approval.
Other Sources of Capital for the HFSG Holding Company
The Hartford endeavors to maintain a capital structure that provides financial and operational flexibility to its insurance subsidiaries, ratings that support its competitive position in the financial services marketplace (see the “Ratings” section below for further discussion), and shareholder returns. As a result, the Company may from time to time raise capital from the issuance of equity, equity-related debt or other capital securities and is continuously evaluating strategic opportunities. The issuance of debt, common equity, equity-related debt or other capital securities could result in the dilution of shareholder interests or reduced net income due to additional interest expense.

117



Shelf Registrations
On August 9, 2013, The Hartford filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) an automatic shelf registration statement (Registration No. 333-190506) for the potential offering and sale of debt and equity securities. The registration statement allows for the following types of securities to be offered: debt securities, junior subordinated debt securities, preferred stock, common stock, depositary shares, warrants, stock purchase contracts, and stock purchase units. In that The Hartford is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Act of 1933, the registration statement went effective immediately upon filing and The Hartford may offer and sell an unlimited amount of securities under the registration statement during the three-year life of the registration statement.
Contingent Capital Facility
The Hartford is party to a put option agreement that provides The Hartford with the right to require the Glen Meadow ABC Trust, a Delaware statutory trust, at any time and from time to time, to purchase The Hartford’s junior subordinated notes in a maximum aggregate principal amount not to exceed $500. Under the Put Option Agreement, The Hartford pays the Glen Meadow ABC Trust premiums on a periodic basis, calculated with respect to the aggregate principal amount of notes that The Hartford had the right to put to the Glen Meadow ABC Trust for such period. The Hartford has agreed to reimburse the Glen Meadow ABC Trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses. The Company holds a variable interest in the Glen Meadow ABC Trust where the Company is not the primary beneficiary. As a result, the Company did not consolidate the Glen Meadow ABC Trust. As of December 31, 2015, The Hartford has not exercised its right to require Glen Meadow ABC Trust to purchase the Notes. As a result, the notes remain a source of capital for the HFSG Holding Company.
Commercial Paper and Revolving Credit Facility
Commercial Paper
The Hartford’s maximum borrowings available under its commercial paper program are $1.0 billion. The Company is dependent upon market conditions to access short-term financing through the issuance of commercial paper to investors. As of December 31, 2015 there was no commercial paper outstanding.
Revolving Credit Facilities
The Company has a senior unsecured five-year revolving credit facility (the “Credit Facility”) that provides for borrowing capacity up to $1.0 billion of unsecured credit through October 31, 2019 available in U.S. dollars, Euro, Sterling, Canadian dollars and Japanese Yen. As of December 31, 2015, no borrowings were outstanding under the Credit Facility. As of December 31, 2015, the Company was in compliance with all financial covenants within the Credit Facility.
Derivative Commitments
Certain of the Company’s derivative agreements contain provisions that are tied to the financial strength ratings, as set by nationally recognized statistical rating agencies, of the individual legal entity that entered into the derivative agreement. If the legal entity’s financial strength were to fall below certain ratings, the counterparties to the derivative agreements could demand immediate and ongoing full collateralization and in certain instances demand immediate settlement of all outstanding derivative positions traded under each impacted bilateral agreement. The settlement amount is determined by netting the derivative positions transacted under each agreement. If the termination rights were to be exercised by the counterparties, it could impact the legal entity’s ability to conduct hedging activities by increasing the associated costs and decreasing the willingness of counterparties to transact with the legal entity. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a net liability position as of December 31, 2015 was $1.3 billion. Of this $1.3 billion the legal entities have posted collateral of $1.5 billion in the normal course of business. In addition, the Company has posted collateral of $34 associated with a customized GMWB derivative. Based on derivative market values as of December 31, 2015, a downgrade of one or two levels below the current financial strength ratings by either Moody’s or S&P would not require additional assets to be posted as collateral. These collateral amounts could change as derivative market values change, as a result of changes in our hedging activities or to the extent changes in contractual terms are negotiated. The nature of the collateral that we would post, if required, would be primarily in the form of U.S. Treasury bills, U.S. Treasury notes and government agency securities.
As of December 31, 2015, the aggregate notional amount and fair value of derivative relationships that could be subject to immediate termination in the event of rating agency downgrades to either BBB+ or Baa1 was $149 and $(10), respectively.

118



Insurance Operations
Current and expected patterns of claim frequency and severity or surrenders may change from period to period but continue to be within historical norms and, therefore, the Company’s insurance operations’ current liquidity position is considered to be sufficient to meet anticipated demands over the next twelve months, including any obligations related to the Company’s restructuring activities. For a discussion and tabular presentation of the Company’s current contractual obligations by period, refer to Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Aggregate Contractual Obligations within the Capital Resources and Liquidity section of the MD&A.
The principal sources of operating funds are premiums, fees earned from assets under management and investment income, while investing cash flows originate from maturities and sales of invested assets. The primary uses of funds are to pay claims, claim adjustment expenses, commissions and other underwriting expenses, taxes, to purchase new investments and to make dividend payments to the HFSG Holding Company.
The Company’s insurance operations consist of property and casualty insurance products (collectively referred to as “Property & Casualty Operations”) and life insurance and legacy annuity products (collectively referred to as “Life Operations”).
Property & Casualty Operations
Property & Casualty Operations holds fixed maturity securities including a significant short-term investment position (securities with maturities of one year or less at the time of purchase) to meet liquidity needs.
As of December 31, 2015, Property & Casualty Operations’ fixed maturities, short-term investments, and cash are summarized as follows:
Fixed maturities
$
25,904

Short-term investments
581

Cash
128

Less: Derivative collateral
182

Total
$
26,431

Liquidity requirements that are unable to be funded by Property & Casualty Operation’s short-term investments would be satisfied with current operating funds, including premiums received or through the sale of invested assets. A sale of invested assets could result in significant realized losses.
Life Operations
Life Operations’ total general account contractholder obligations are supported by $41 billion of cash and total general account invested assets, which includes a significant short-term investment position to meet liquidity needs.
As of December 31, 2015, Life Operations’ fixed maturities, short-term investments, and cash are summarized as follows:
Fixed maturities
$
32,424

Short-term investments
902

Cash
320

Less: Derivative collateral
1,296

Total
$
32,350

Capital resources available to fund liquidity upon contractholder surrender or termination are a function of the legal entity in which the liquidity requirement resides. Generally, obligations of Group Benefits will be funded by Hartford Life and Accident Insurance Company. Obligations of Talcott Resolution will generally be funded by Hartford Life Insurance Company and Hartford Life and Annuity Insurance Company.
HLIC, an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary, is a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston (“FHLBB”). Membership allows HLIC access to collateralized advances, which may be used to support various spread-based businesses and enhance liquidity management. FHLBB membership requires the company to own member stock and advances require the purchase of activity stock. The amount of advances that can be taken are dependent on the asset types pledged to secure the advances. The CTDOI will permit HLIC to pledge up to $1.2 billion in qualifying assets to secure FHLBB advances for 2016. The pledge limit is recalculated annually based on statutory admitted assets and capital and surplus. HLIC would need to seek the prior approval of the CTDOI in order to exceed these limits. As of December 31, 2015, HLIC had no advances outstanding under the FHLBB facility.

119



 
As of
Contractholder Obligations
December 31, 2015
Total Life contractholder obligations
$
171,578

Less: Separate account assets [1]
120,123

General account contractholder obligations
$
51,455

Composition of General Account Contractholder Obligations
 
Contracts without a surrender provision and/or fixed payout dates [2]
$
24,767

U.S. Fixed MVA annuities [3]
5,574

Other [4]
21,114

General account contractholder obligations
$
51,455

[1]
In the event customers elect to surrender separate account assets, Life Operations will use the proceeds from the sale of the assets to fund the surrender, and Life Operations’ liquidity position will not be impacted. In many instances Life Operations will receive a percentage of the surrender amount as compensation for early surrender (surrender charge), increasing Life Operations’ liquidity position. In addition, a surrender of variable annuity separate account or general account assets (see the following) will decrease Life Operations’ obligation for payments on guaranteed living and death benefits.
[2]
Relates to contracts such as payout annuities or institutional notes or surrenders of term life, group benefit contracts or death and living benefit reserves for which surrenders will have no current effect on Life Operations’ liquidity requirements.
[3]
Relates to annuities that are recorded in the general account under U.S. GAAP as the contractholders are subject to the Company's credit risk, although these annuities are held in a statutory separate account. In the statutory separate account, Life Operations is required to maintain invested assets with a fair value greater than or equal to the MVA surrender value of the Fixed MVA contract. In the event assets decline in value at a greater rate than the MVA surrender value of the Fixed MVA contract, Life Operations is required to contribute additional capital to the statutory separate account. Life Operations will fund these required contributions with operating cash flows or short-term investments. In the event that operating cash flows or short-term investments are not sufficient to fund required contributions, the Company may have to sell other invested assets at a loss, potentially resulting in a decrease in statutory surplus. As the fair value of invested assets in the statutory separate account are at least equal to the MVA surrender value of the Fixed MVA contract, surrender of Fixed MVA annuities will have an insignificant impact on the liquidity requirements of Life Operations.
[4]
Surrenders of, or policy loans taken from, as applicable, these general account liabilities, which include the general account option for Life Operations' individual variable annuities and the variable life contracts of the former Individual Life business, the general account option for annuities of the former Retirement Plans business and universal life contracts sold by the former Individual Life business, may be funded through operating cash flows of Life Operations, available short-term investments, or Life Operations may be required to sell fixed maturity investments to fund the surrender payment. Sales of fixed maturity investments could result in the recognition of realized losses and insufficient proceeds to fully fund the surrender amount. In this circumstance, Life Operations may need to take other actions, including enforcing certain contract provisions which could restrict surrenders and/or slow or defer payouts. The Company has ceded reinsurance in connection with the sales of its Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses in 2013 to MassMutual and Prudential, respectively. These reinsurance transactions do not extinguish the Company's primary liability on the insurance policies issued under these businesses. For further information regarding the sale of Retirement Plans and Individual Life, see Note 18- Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

120



Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Aggregate Contractual Obligations
The Company does not have any off-balance sheet arrangements that are reasonably likely to have a material effect on the financial condition, results of operations, liquidity, or capital resources of the Company, except for the contingent capital facility described above, as well as unfunded commitments to purchase investments in limited partnerships and other alternative investments, private placements, and mortgage loans as disclosed in Note 12 - Commitments and Contingencies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
The following table summarizes the Company’s aggregate contractual obligations as of December 31, 2015:
 
Payments due by period
 
Total
Less than
1 year
1-3
years
3-5
years
More than
5 years
Property and casualty obligations [1]
$
22,348

$
5,228

$
5,192

$
2,539

$
9,389

Life, annuity and disability obligations [2]
256,576

17,829

31,881

26,006

180,860

Operating lease obligations [3]
143

39

60

31

13

Long-term debt obligations [4]
11,016

612

1,328

891

8,185

Purchase obligations [5]
2,271

1,482

507

254

28

Other liabilities reflected on the balance sheet [6]
1,664

1,075

405

184


Total
$
294,018

$
26,265

$
39,373

$
29,905

$
198,475

[1]
The following points are significant to understanding the cash flows estimated for obligations under property and casualty contracts:
Reserves for Property & Casualty unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses include IBNR and case reserves. While payments due on claim reserves are considered contractual obligations because they relate to insurance policies issued by the Company, the ultimate amount to be paid to settle both case reserves and IBNR is an estimate, subject to significant uncertainty. The actual amount to be paid is not finally determined until the Company reaches a settlement with the claimant. Final claim settlements may vary significantly from the present estimates, particularly since many claims will not be settled until well into the future.
In estimating the timing of future payments by year, the Company has assumed that its historical payment patterns will continue. However, the actual timing of future payments could vary materially from these estimates due to, among other things, changes in claim reporting and payment patterns and large unanticipated settlements. In particular, there is significant uncertainty over the claim payment patterns of asbestos and environmental claims. In addition, the table does not include future cash flows related to the receipt of premiums that may be used, in part, to fund loss payments.
Under U.S. GAAP, the Company is only permitted to discount reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses in cases where the payment pattern and ultimate loss costs are fixed and determinable on an individual claim basis. For the Company, these include claim settlements with permanently disabled claimants. As of December 31, 2015, the total property and casualty reserves in the above table are gross of a reserve discount of $523.
[2]
Estimated life, annuity and disability obligations include death and disability claims, policy surrenders, policyholder dividends and trail commissions offset by expected future deposits and premiums on in-force contracts. Estimated life, annuity and disability obligations are based on mortality, morbidity and lapse assumptions comparable with the Company’s historical experience, modified for recent observed trends. The Company has also assumed market growth and interest crediting consistent with other assumptions. In contrast to this table, the majority of the Company’s obligations are recorded on the balance sheet at the current account values and do not incorporate an expectation of future market growth, interest crediting, or future deposits. Therefore, the estimated obligations presented in this table significantly exceed the liabilities recorded in reserve for future policy benefits and unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, other policyholder funds and benefits payable, and separate account liabilities. Due to the significance of the assumptions used, the amounts presented could materially differ from actual results. See Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for further information as to Retirement Plans and Individual Life reinsurance transactions.
[3]
Includes future minimum lease payments on operating lease agreements. See Note 12 - Commitments and Contingencies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for additional discussion on lease commitments.
[4]
Includes contractual principal and interest payments. See Note 11 - Debt of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for additional discussion of long-term debt obligations.
[5]
Includes $1 billion in commitments to purchase investments including approximately $748 of limited partnership and other alternative investments, $236 of private placements, and $31 of mortgage loans. Outstanding commitments under these limited partnerships and mortgage loans are included in payments due in less than 1 year since the timing of funding these commitments cannot be reliably estimated. The remaining commitments to purchase investments primarily represent payables for securities purchased which are reflected on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. Also included in purchase obligations is $919 relating to contractual commitments to purchase various goods and services such as maintenance, human resources, and information technology in the normal course of business. Purchase obligations exclude contracts that are cancelable without penalty or contracts that do not specify minimum levels of goods or services to be purchased.
[6]
Includes cash collateral of $369 which the Company has accepted in connection with the Company’s derivative instruments. Since the timing of the return of the collateral is uncertain, the return of the collateral has been included in the payments due in less than 1 year. Also included in other long-term liabilities are net unrecognized tax benefits of $12, retained yen denominated fixed payout annuity liabilities of $703, and consumer notes of $40. Consumer notes include principal payments and contractual interest for fixed rate notes and interest based on current rates for floating rate notes.

121



Capitalization
The capital structure of The Hartford as of December 31, 2015 and 2014 consisted of debt and stockholders’ equity, summarized as follows:
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Change
Short-term debt (includes current maturities of long-term debt)
$
275

$
456

(40
)%
Long-term debt
5,084

5,653

(10
)%
Total debt [1]
5,359

6,109

(12
)%
Stockholders’ equity excluding accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax (“AOCI”)
17,971

17,792

1
 %
AOCI, net of tax
(329
)
928

NM

Total stockholders’ equity
$
17,642

$
18,720

(6
)%
Total capitalization including AOCI
$
23,001

$
24,829

(7
)%
Debt to stockholders’ equity
30
%
33
%
 
Debt to capitalization
23
%
25
%
 
[1]
Total debt of the Company excludes $38 and $71 of consumer notes as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively.
Total stockholders' equity decreased in 2015 primarily due to a decrease in net unrealized capital gains from securities within AOCI. Total capitalization decreased $1,828, or 7%, as of December 31, 2015 compared with December 31, 2014 primarily due to decreases in total debt and the decrease in AOCI.
For additional information regarding AOCI, net of tax, see Note 15 - Changes In and Reclassifications From Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Cash Flow
 
2015
2014
2013
Net cash provided by operating activities
$
2,756

$
1,886

$
1,237

Net provided by for investing activities
$
485

$
1,696

$
3,745

Net cash used for financing activities
$
(3,144
)
$
(4,476
)
$
(5,820
)
Cash — end of year
$
448

$
399

$
1,428

Year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the year ended December 31, 2014
Cash provided by operating activities increased in 2015 as compared to the prior year period primarily due to an increase in premiums collected and reinsurance claim recoveries, as well as decreases in claims and operating expenses paid.
Cash provided by investing activities in 2015 primarily relates to net proceeds from short-term investments of $3.1 billion, partially offset by net payments for available-for-sale securities of $1.9 billion and additions to property and equipment of $307. Cash provided by investing activities in 2014 primarily relates to net proceeds from available-for-sale securities of $2.8 billion, and proceeds from the business sold of $963, partially offset by net payments for short-term investments of $1.9 billion.
Cash used for financing activities in 2015 consists primarily of net payments for deposits, transfers and withdrawals for investments and universal life products of $1.3 billion, acquisition of treasury stock of $1.3 billion and repayment of debt of $773, partially offset by $507 in proceeds from securities sold under repurchase agreements. Cash used for financing activities in 2014 consists primarily of $2.2 billion related to net activity for investment and universal life-type contracts, and acquisition of treasury stock of $1.8 billion.
Year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the year ended December 31, 2013
Cash provided by operating activities in 2014 reflects an increase in premiums collected and a decrease in loss and loss adjustment expenses paid, partially offset by an increase in payments for payables and accruals. Operating cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2014, and 2013 were adequate to meet liquidity requirements. On June 30, 2014, the Company completed the sale of HLIKK. The operations of HLIKK are reported as discontinued operations and are included primarily in net cash provided by operating activities. For further information regarding this transaction, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

122



Cash provided by investing activities in 2014 primarily relates to net proceeds from available-for-sale securities of $2.8 billion, and proceeds from the business sold of $963, partially offset by net payments for short-term investments of $1.8 billion. Cash provided by investing activities in 2013 primarily relates to net proceeds from the sale of available-for-sale securities of $4.9 billion, and proceeds from the business sold of $815, partially offset by net payments on derivatives of $2.2 billion.
Cash used for financing activities in 2014 primarily relates to $2.2 billion related to net payments for deposits, transfers and withdrawals for investment and universal life products and treasury stock acquired of $1.8 billion. Cash used for financing activities in 2013 primarily consists of net payments for deposits, transfers and withdrawals for investment and universal life products of $2.1 billion, a decrease in securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase of $1.9 billion, repayment of long term debt of $1.3 billion and treasury stock acquired of $600.
Equity Markets
For a discussion of the potential impact of the equity markets on capital and liquidity, see the Financial Risk on Statutory Capital and Liquidity Risk section in this MD&A.
Ratings
Ratings are an important factor in establishing a competitive position in the insurance marketplace and impact the Company's ability to access financing and its cost of borrowing. There can be no assurance that the Company’s ratings will continue for any given period of time, or that they will not be changed. In the event the Company’s ratings are downgraded, the Company’s competitive position, ability to access financing, and its cost of borrowing, may be adversely impacted.
The following table summarizes The Hartford’s significant member companies’ financial ratings from the major independent rating organizations as of February 24, 2016:
Insurance Financial Strength Ratings:
A.M. Best
Standard & Poor's
Moody's
Hartford Fire Insurance Company
A+
A+
A1
Hartford Life and Accident Insurance Company
A
A
A2
Hartford Life Insurance Company
A-
BBB+
Baa2
Hartford Life and Annuity Insurance Company
A-
BBB+
Baa2
Other Ratings:
 
 
 
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.:
 
 
 
Senior debt
a-
BBB +
Baa2
Commercial paper
AMB-1
A-2
P-2
These ratings are not a recommendation to buy or hold any of The Hartford’s securities and they may be revised or revoked at any time at the sole discretion of the rating organization.
The agencies consider many factors in determining the final rating of an insurance company. One consideration is the relative level of statutory capital and surplus (referred to collectively as "statutory capital") necessary to support the business written and is reported in accordance with accounting practices prescribed by the applicable state insurance department. See Part I, Item 1A. Risk Factors — “Downgrades in our financial strength or credit ratings, which may make our products less attractive, could increase our cost of capital and inhibit our ability to refinance our debt, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.”

123



Statutory Capital
The table below sets forth statutory capital for the Company’s insurance subsidiaries.
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Life insurance subsidiaries
$
6,591

$
7,157

Property and casualty insurance subsidiaries
8,563

8,069

Total
$
15,154

$
15,226

Statutory capital for the life insurance subsidiaries decreased by $566, primarily due to dividends and returns of capital of $1.1 billion, partially offset by variable annuity impacts of $440 and net income from non-variable annuity business of $320.
Statutory capital for the property and casualty insurance subsidiaries increased by $494, primarily due to statutory net income of $1.5 billion, partially offset by dividends to the HFSG Holding Company of $900 and unrealized loss on investments of $202.
Significant differences between U.S. GAAP stockholders’ equity and aggregate statutory capital prepared in accordance with U.S. STAT include the following:
U.S. STAT excludes equity of non-insurance and foreign insurance subsidiaries not held by U.S. insurance subsidiaries.
Costs incurred by the Company to acquire insurance policies are deferred under U.S. GAAP while those costs are expensed immediately under U.S. STAT.
Temporary differences between the book and tax basis of an asset or liability which are recorded as deferred tax assets are evaluated for recoverability under U.S. GAAP while those amounts deferred are subject to limitations under U.S. STAT.
The assumptions used in the determination of Life benefit reserves are prescribed under U.S. STAT, while the assumptions used under U.S. GAAP are generally the Company’s best estimates. The methodologies for determining life insurance reserve amounts are also different. For example, reserving for living benefit reserves under U.S. STAT is generally addressed by the Commissioners’ Annuity Reserving Valuation Methodology and the related Actuarial Guidelines, while under U.S. GAAP, those same living benefits are either embedded derivatives recorded at fair value or are recorded as SOP 03-1 reserves. The sensitivity of these life insurance reserves to changes in equity markets, as applicable, will be different between U.S. GAAP and U.S. STAT.
The difference between the amortized cost and fair value of fixed maturity and other investments, net of tax, is recorded as an increase or decrease to the carrying value of the related asset and to equity under U.S. GAAP, while U.S. STAT only records certain securities at fair value, such as equity securities and certain lower rated bonds required by the NAIC to be recorded at the lower of amortized cost or fair value.
U.S. STAT for life insurance companies establishes a formula reserve for realized and unrealized losses due to default and equity risks associated with certain invested assets (the Asset Valuation Reserve), while U.S. GAAP does not. Also, for those realized gains and losses caused by changes in interest rates, U.S. STAT for life insurance companies defers and amortizes the gains and losses, caused by changes in interest rates, into income over the original life to maturity of the asset sold (the Interest Maintenance Reserve) while U.S. GAAP does not.
Goodwill arising from the acquisition of a business is tested for recoverability on an annual basis (or more frequently, as necessary) for U.S. GAAP, while under U.S. STAT goodwill is amortized over a period not to exceed 10 years and the amount of goodwill admitted as an asset is limited.
In addition, certain assets, including a portion of premiums receivable and fixed assets, are non-admitted (recorded at zero value and charged against surplus) under U.S. STAT. U.S. GAAP generally evaluates assets based on their recoverability.

124



Risk-Based Capital
The Company's U.S. insurance companies' states of domicile impose risk-based capital (“RBC”) requirements. The requirements provide a means of measuring the minimum amount of statutory capital appropriate for an insurance company to support its overall business operations, based on its size and risk profile. Regulatory compliance is determined by a ratio of a company's total adjusted capital (“TAC”) to its authorized control level RBC (“ACL RBC”). Companies below specific trigger points or ratios are classified within certain levels, each of which requires specified corrective action. The minimum level of TAC before corrective action commences (“Company Action Level”) is two times the ACL RBC. The adequacy of a company's capital is determined by the ratio of a company's TAC to its Company Action Level, known as the "RBC ratio". All of the Company's operating insurance subsidiaries had RBC ratios in excess of the minimum levels required by the applicable insurance regulations. On an aggregate basis, The Company's U.S. property and casualty insurance companies' RBC ratio was in excess of 200% of its Company Action Level as of December 31, 2015 and 2014. The RBC ratios for the Company's principal life insurance operating subsidiaries were all in excess of 400% of their respective Company Action Levels as of December 31, 2015 and 2014. The reporting of RBC ratios is not intended for the purpose of ranking any insurance company, or for use in connection with any marketing, advertising or promotional activities.
Similar to the RBC ratios that are employed by U.S. insurance regulators, regulatory authorities in the international jurisdictions in which The Company operates generally establish minimum solvency requirements for insurance companies. All of The Hartford's international insurance subsidiaries have solvency margins in excess of the minimum levels required by the applicable regulatory authorities.
Sensitivity
In any particular year, statutory capital amounts and RBC ratios may increase or decrease depending upon a variety of factors. The amount of change in the statutory capital or RBC ratios can vary based on individual factors and may be compounded in extreme scenarios or if multiple factors occur at the same time. At times the impact of changes in certain market factors or a combination of multiple factors on RBC ratios can be counterintuitive. For further discussion on these factors and the potential impacts to the life insurance subsidiaries, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management, Financial Risk on Statutory Capital.
Statutory capital at the property and casualty subsidiaries has historically been maintained at or above the capital level required to meet “AA level” ratings from rating agencies. Statutory capital generated by the property and casualty subsidiaries in excess of the capital level required to meet “AA level” ratings is available for use by the enterprise or for corporate purposes. The amount of statutory capital can increase or decrease depending on a number of factors affecting property and casualty results including, among other factors, the level of catastrophe claims incurred, the amount of reserve development, the effect of changes in interest rates on investment income and the discounting of loss reserves, and the effect of realized gains and losses on investments.
In addition, the Company can access the $500 Glen Meadow trust contingent capital facility and maintains the ability to access $1.0 billion of capacity under its revolving credit facility.
Contingencies
Legal Proceedings — For a discussion regarding contingencies related to The Hartford’s legal proceedings, please see the information contained under “Litigation” and “Asbestos and Environmental Claims,” in Note 12 - Commitments and Contingencies of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements and Part II, Item 1 Legal Proceedings, which are incorporated herein by reference.
For a discussion of terrorism reinsurance legislation and how it affects The Hartford, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management, Insurance Risk Management, Terrorism Risk.
Tax proposals and regulatory initiatives which have been or are being considered by Congress and/or the United States Treasury Department could have a material effect on the insurance business. These proposals and initiatives include, or could include, new taxes or assessments on large financial institutions, changes pertaining to the income tax treatment of insurance companies and life insurance products and annuities, repeal or reform of the estate tax and comprehensive federal tax reform, and changes to the regulatory structure for financial institutions. The nature and timing of any Congressional or regulatory action with respect to any such efforts is unclear.
Legislative and Regulatory Developments
Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”)
Since it was enacted in 2010, the Dodd-Frank act has resulted in significant changes to the regulation of the financial services industry, including changes to the rules governing derivatives, restrictions on proprietary trading by certain entities, the creation of a Federal Insurance Office within the U.S. Treasury, and enhancements to corporate governance rules, among other things. The Dodd-Frank Act requires significant rulemaking across numerous agencies within the federal government. Rulemaking and implementation of newly-adopted rules is ongoing and may affect our operations and governance in ways that could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.

125



Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act of 2010 (the "Affordable Care Act")
On March 23, 2010, the President signed the Affordable Care Act. While many of the key provisions of the Affordable Care Act have become effective, there remains uncertainty with its implementation. Federal agencies continue rulemaking for certain provisions, along with the law being subject to legal and legislative challenges. In addition, certain provisions of the Affordable Care Act have been amended or delayed, such as the employer mandate which will continue to be phased in during 2016. The impact of the Affordable Care Act to The Hartford as an employer is consistent with other large employers. The Hartford’s core business does not involve the issuance of health insurance and we do not issue any products that insure customers under the Affordable Care Act’s individual mandate. To date, there have been certain limited impacts to The Hartford's group benefits businesses including additional opportunities to market our group benefits products and services through private exchanges. While we have not observed any material impacts on the Company’s workers’ compensation business or group benefits business, we continue to monitor the impact of the Affordable Care Act on consumer, broker and medical provider behavior for leading indicators of changes in medical costs or loss payments primarily on the Company's workers' compensation and disability liabilities.
Social Security Disability Insurance ("SSDI")
On November 2, 2015, the President signed the Bipartisan Budget Act of 2015 (the "Budget Act"), which, among other things, ensures solvency of the SSDI program through 2022. Prior to the Budget Act's enactment, the SSDI program was projected to become insolvent in 2016, which would have had an impact on the group disability and workers' compensation markets, including reserve impacts and increases in the cost of benefits.
Budget of the United States Government
On February 9, 2016, the Obama Administration released its “Fiscal Year 2017, Budget of the U.S. Government” (the “Budget”). The Budget includes proposals that if enacted, would affect the taxation of life insurance companies and certain life insurance products. In particular, the proposals would change the method used to determine the amount of dividend income received by a life insurance company on assets held in separate accounts used to support products, including variable life insurance and variable annuity contracts, which are eligible for the dividends received deduction (“DRD”). The DRD reduces the amount of dividend income subject to tax and is a significant component of the difference between the Company's actual tax expense and expected amount determined using the federal statutory tax rate of 35%. If this proposal were enacted, the Company's actual tax expense could increase, reducing earnings.
United States Department of Labor Proposed Rule
In April, 2015, the U.S. Department of Labor (DOL) issued a proposed regulation that would, if finalized in its current form, expand the range of activities that would be considered to be fiduciary investment advice under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (“ERISA”) and the Internal Revenue Code. On January 28, 2016, the DOL submitted its final version of the proposed fiduciary rule to the Office of Management and Budget for review. In its proposed form, the rule could have an adverse impact on our current offerings of certain insurance products and investment products, along with contracts in our run-off lines of business. If enacted in its current form, the proposed rule could impact the way we provide investment-related information and support to financial advisors, plan sponsors, plan participants, plan beneficiaries and Individual Retirement Account (IRA) owners. Because we cannot predict the exact nature and extent of changes that may be made to the proposed rule when finalized, the potential effect on our businesses is undeterminable at this time.
Guaranty Fund and Other Insurance-related Assessments
For a discussion regarding Guaranty Fund and Other Insurance-related Assessments, see Note 12 Commitments and Contingencies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
IMPACT OF NEW ACCOUNTING STANDARDS
For a discussion of accounting standards, see Note 1 Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Item 7A.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
The information required by this item is set forth in the Enterprise Risk Management section of Item 7, Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations and is incorporated herein by reference.
Item 8.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
See Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Schedules elsewhere herein.
Item 9.
CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
None.

126



Item 9A.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Evaluation of disclosure controls and procedures
The Company's principal executive officer and its principal financial officer, based on their evaluation of the Company's disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e)) have concluded that the Company's disclosure controls and procedures are effective for the purposes set forth in the definition thereof in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e) as of December 31, 2015.
Management’s annual report on internal control over financial reporting
The management of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (“The Hartford”) is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for The Hartford as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
The Hartford's management assessed its internal controls over financial reporting as of December 31, 2015 in relation to criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting described in “Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013)” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on this assessment under those criteria, The Hartford's management concluded that its internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2015.
Changes in internal control over financial reporting
There were no changes in the Company's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the Company's fourth fiscal quarter of 2015 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal control over financial reporting.
Attestation report of the Company’s registered public accounting firm
The Hartford's independent registered public accounting firm, Deloitte & Touche LLP, has issued their attestation report on the Company's internal control over financial reporting which is set forth below.

127



REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.
Hartford, Connecticut

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively, the "Company") as of December 31, 2015, based on the criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.  The Company's management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Item 9A. Controls and Procedures.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company's principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the company's board of directors, management, and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of consolidated financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of consolidated financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements.
Because of the inherent limitations of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility of collusion or improper management override of controls, material misstatements due to error or fraud may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis.  Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of the internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2015, based on the criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. 
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedules as of and for the year ended December 31, 2015 of the Company and our report, dated February 26, 2016, expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedules.



DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Hartford, Connecticut
February 26, 2016


128



Item 9B.
OTHER INFORMATION
None.
PART III
Item 10.
DIRECTORS, AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE OF THE HARTFORD
Certain of the information called for by Item 10 will be set forth in the definitive proxy statement for the 2016 annual meeting of shareholders (the “Proxy Statement”) to be filed by The Hartford with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days after the end of the fiscal year covered by this Form 10-K under the captions and subcaptions “Board and Governance Matters”, “Director Nominees" and "Section (16)(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance" and is incorporated herein by reference.
The Company has adopted a Code of Ethics and Business Conduct, which is applicable to all employees of the Company, including the principal executive officer, the principal financial officer and the principal accounting officer. The Code of Ethics and Business Conduct is available on the investor relations section of the Company’s website at: http://ir.thehartford.com. Any waiver of, or material amendment to, the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct will be posted promptly to our web site in accordance with applicable NYSE and SEC rules.
Executive Officers of The Hartford
Information about the executive officers of The Hartford who are also nominees for election as directors will be set forth in The Hartford’s Proxy Statement. Set forth below is information about the other executive officers of the Company:
Name
Age
Position with The Hartford and Business Experience
Beth A. Bombara
48
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (July 2014-present); President of Talcott Resolution (July 2012-July 2014); Senior Vice President and Controller (June 2007-July 2012); Vice President (2004-June 2007)
William A. Bloom
52
Executive Vice President of Operations and Technology (August 2014 - present); President of Global Client Services, EXL (July 2010-July 2014); Executive Vice President, Insurance Operations and Technology, Travelers (November 2006-July 2010); Senior Vice President, Chief Information Officer, Travelers (June 2003-November 2006)
Kathy Bromage

58
Chief Marketing and Communications Officer (June 2015-present); Senior Vice President of Strategy and Marketing, Small Commercial and Senior Vice President of Brand Marketing (July 2012-June 2015); Senior Vice President, eBusiness (October 2010-June 2012); Chief Strategy & Marketing Officer, Personal Lines (April 2004-September 2010)
James E. Davey
51
Executive Vice President and President of The Hartford Mutual Funds (2010-present); Executive Vice President, Retirement Division (2009-2010); Executive Vice President, Employer Markets Group (2008-2009); Senior Vice President, Retirement Plans (2006-2008)
Doug Elliot
55
President (July 2014-present); Executive Vice President and President of Commercial Lines (April 2011-July 2014); President and Chief Executive Officer, HSB Group (July 2007-March 2011); President and Chief Operating Officer, HSB Group (January 2007-June 2007); Senior Advisor, Aspen Insurance Holdings (2006)
Martha Gervasi
54
Executive Vice President, Human Resources (May 2012-present); Senior Vice President, Human Resources (November 2010-May 2012); General Manager Human Resources, SABIC Innovative Plastics & SABIC Americas (January 2010-October 2010); Global Human Resource Leader, SABIC Innovative Plastics (September 2007-January 2010)
Brion Johnson
56
President of Talcott resolution (July 2014-present); Executive Vice President, Chief Investment Officer (May 2012-Present); Chief Financial Officer, Hartford Investment Management Company [1] (October 2011-May 2012); Managing Member, Shoreline Arts & Publishing, LLC (2009-2010); Executive Vice President, PPM America, Inc. (2001-2008)
Scott R. Lewis
53
Senior Vice President and Controller (May 2013-present); Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Personal Lines (2009-May 2013); Vice President, P&C Financial Reporting and Analysis (2003-2009)
David C. Robinson
50
Executive Vice President and General Counsel (June 2015-present); Senior Vice President and Director of Commercial Markets Law (August 2014-May 2015); Senior Vice President and Head of Enterprise Transformation, Strategy and Corporate Development (April 2012-August 2014); Senior Vice President and Director of Corporate Law (September 2010-April 2012); Senior Vice President and Director of Property & Casualty Law (November 2006-September 2010)
Robert Rupp
63
Executive Vice President and Chief Risk Officer (October 2011-Present); Executive Vice President, Head of Enterprise-Wide Market Risk, BONY Mellon (September 2008-October 2011); Managing Director, Risk Management, JP Morgan Chase (2004-2008)
Raymond J. Sprague
57
Executive Vice President, Personal Lines (March 2015-present); Executive Vice President, Strategy and Business Development (August 2014-March 2015); Senior Vice President of Small Commercial (July 2008-July 2014)
[1]
Denotes a subsidiary of The Hartford.

129



Item 11.
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
The information called for by Item 11 will be set forth in the Proxy Statement under the subcaptions “Compensation Discussion and Analysis”, “Executive Compensation”, “Director Compensation”, “Report of the Compensation and Management Development Committee”, and “Compensation and Management Development Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation” and is incorporated herein by reference.
Item 12.
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
Certain of the information called for by Item 12 will be set forth in the Proxy Statement under the caption “Information on Stock Ownership” and is incorporated herein by reference.
Equity Compensation Plan Information
The following table provides information as of December 31, 2015 about the securities authorized for issuance under the Company’s equity compensation plans. The Company maintains The Hartford 2005 Incentive Stock Plan (the “2005 Stock Plan”), The Hartford 2010 Incentive Stock Plan (the “2010 Stock Plan”), The Hartford 2014 Incentive Stock Plan (the "2014 Stock Plan") (collectively the "Stock Plans") and The Hartford Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the “ESPP”). On May 21, 2014, the shareholders of the Company approved the 2014 Stock Plan, which superseded the earlier plans. Pursuant to the provisions of the 2014 Stock Plan, no additional shares may be issued from the 2010 Stock Plan. To the extent that any awards under the 2005 Stock Plan and the 2010 Stock Plan are forfeited, terminated, surrendered, exchanged, expire unexercised or are settled in cash in lieu of stock (including to effect tax withholding) or for the issuance of a lesser number of shares than the number of shares subject to the award, the shares subject to such awards (or the relevant portion thereof) shall be available for award under the 2014 Stock Plan and such shares shall be added to the total number of shares available under the 2014 Stock Plan. For a description of the 2014 Stock Plan and the ESPP, see Note 17 - Stock Compensation Plans of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
(a)
(b)
(c)
 
 Number of Securities
to be Issued Upon Exercise of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights [1]
Weighted-average
Exercise Price of Outstanding
Options, Warrants
and Rights [2]
Number of Securities Remaining
Available for Future Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans
(Excluding Securities Reflected in
Column (a)) [3]
Equity compensation plans approved by stockholders
10,444,158

$
33.09

17,030,538

Equity compensation plans not approved by stockholders



Total
10,444,158

$
33.09

17,030,538

[1]
The amount shown in this column includes 3,799,849 outstanding options awarded under the 2005 Stock Plan and the 2010 Stock Plan. The amount shown in this column includes 5,868,990 outstanding restricted stock units and 775,319 outstanding performance shares at 100% of target (which excludes 406,979 shares that vested on December 31, 2015, related to the 2013-2015 performance period) as of December 31, 2015 under the 2010 Stock Plan and the 2014 Stock Plan. The maximum number of performance shares that could be awarded is 1,550,638 (200% of target) if the Company achieved the highest performance level. Under the 2010 and 2014 Stock Plans, no more than 500,000 shares in the aggregate can be earned by an individual employee with respect to restricted stock unit and performance share awards made in a single calendar year.  As a result, the number of shares ultimately distributed to an employee with respect to awards made in the same year will be reduced, if necessary, so that the number does not exceed this limit.
[2]
The weighted-average exercise price reflects outstanding options and does not reflect outstanding restricted stock units or performance shares because they do not have exercise prices.
[3]
Of these shares, 4,944,278 remain available for purchase under the ESPP as of December 31, 2015. 12,086,260 shares remain available for issuance as options, restricted stock units, restricted stock awards or performance shares under the 2014 Stock Plan as of December 31, 2015.
Item 13.
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
Any information called for by Item 13 will be set forth in the Proxy Statement under the caption and subcaption “Board and Governance Matters” and “Director Independence” and is incorporated herein by reference.
Item 14.
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES
The information called for by Item 14 will be set forth in the Proxy Statement under the caption “Audit Matters” and is incorporated herein by reference.

130



PART IV
Item 15.
EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
(a) 
Documents filed as a part of this report:
(1)
Consolidated Financial Statements. See Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Schedules elsewhere herein.
(2)
Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules. See Index to Consolidated Financial Statement and Schedules elsewhere herein.
(3)
Exhibits. See Exhibit Index elsewhere herein.


131



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SCHEDULES
Description
Page
S-2
S-4
S-6
S-7
S-8


F-1



REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.
Hartford, Connecticut

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company”) as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2015.  Our audits also included the consolidated financial statement schedules listed in the Index at Item 15.  These consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedules are the responsibility of the Company's management.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedules based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements.  An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall consolidated financial statement presentation.  We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2015, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.  Also, in our opinion, such consolidated financial statement schedules, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, present fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2015, based on the criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 26, 2016 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting.


DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Hartford, Connecticut
February 26, 2016

F-2

Table of Contents

THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Consolidated Statements of Operations

 
For the years ended December 31,
(In millions, except for per share data)
2015
2014
2013
Revenues
 
 
 
Earned premiums
$
13,577

$
13,336

$
13,231

Fee income
1,839

1,996

2,105

Net investment income
3,030

3,154

3,264

Net realized capital gains (losses):
 

 

 

Total other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) losses
(108
)
(64
)
(93
)
OTTI losses recognized in other comprehensive income (loss) (“OCI”)
6

5

20

Net OTTI losses recognized in earnings
(102
)
(59
)
(73
)
Net realized capital gains on investments transferred at fair value in business disposition by reinsurance


1,575

Other net realized capital gains (losses)
(54
)
75

296

Total net realized capital gains (losses)
(156
)
16

1,798

Other revenues
87

112

275

Total revenues
18,377

18,614

20,673

Benefits, losses and expenses
 

 

 

Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
10,775

10,805

11,048

Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs ("DAC")
1,502

1,729

1,794

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
3,772

4,028

4,176

Loss on extinguishment of debt
21


213

Reinsurance (gain) loss on dispositions
(28
)
(23
)
1,574

Interest expense
357

376

397

Total benefits, losses and expenses
16,399

16,915

19,202

Income from continuing operations before income taxes
1,978

1,699

1,471

Income tax expense
305

350

246

Income from continuing operations, net of tax
1,673

1,349

1,225

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
9

(551
)
(1,049
)
Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

Income from continuing operations, net of tax, available to common shareholders per common share
 
 
 
Basic
$
4.03

$
3.05

$
2.71

Diluted
$
3.93

$
2.93

$
2.50

Net income available to common shareholders per common share
 
 
 
Basic
$
4.05

$
1.81

$
0.37

Diluted
$
3.96

$
1.73

$
0.36

Cash dividends declared per common share
$
0.78

$
0.66

$
0.50


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-3

Table of Contents

THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

 
For the years ended December 31,
(In millions)
2015
2014
2013
Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

Other comprehensive income (loss):
 

 

 

Changes in net unrealized gain on securities
(1,091
)
1,383

(2,431
)
Changes in OTTI losses recognized in other comprehensive income
(2
)
7

35

Changes in net gain on cash-flow hedging instruments
(20
)
42

(320
)
Changes in foreign currency translation adjustments
(47
)
(99
)
(315
)
Changes in pension and other postretirement plan adjustments
(97
)
(326
)
109

OCI, net of tax
(1,257
)
1,007

(2,922
)
Comprehensive income (loss)
$
425

$
1,805

$
(2,746
)
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-4

Table of Contents

THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Consolidated Balance Sheets

 
As of December 31,
(In millions, except for share and per share data)
2015
2014
Assets
 
 
Investments:
 
 
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale, at fair value (amortized cost of $56,965 and $55,362)
$
59,196

$
59,384

Fixed maturities, at fair value using the fair value option (includes variable interest entity assets of $150 and $218)
503

488

Equity securities, available-for-sale, at fair value (cost of $1,135 and $1,027) (includes equity securities, at fair value using the fair value option, of $282 and $348, and variable interest entity assets of $1 and $0)
1,121

1,047

Mortgage loans (net of allowances for loan losses of $23 and $18)
5,624

5,556

Policy loans, at outstanding balance
1,447

1,431

Limited partnerships and other alternative investments (includes variable interest entity assets of $2 and $3)
2,874

2,942

Other investments
120

547

Short-term investments (includes variable interest entity assets, at fair value, of $3 and $16)
1,843

4,883

Total investments
72,728

76,278

Cash (includes variable interest entity assets, at fair value, of $10 and $9)
448

399

Premiums receivable and agents’ balances, net
3,537

3,429

Reinsurance recoverables, net
23,189

22,920

Deferred policy acquisition costs
1,816

1,823

Deferred income taxes, net
3,206

2,897

Goodwill
498

498

Property and equipment, net
974

831

Other assets
1,829

1,236

Separate account assets
120,123

134,702

Total assets
$
228,348

$
245,013

Liabilities
 

 

Reserve for future policy benefits and unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
$
41,572

$
41,444

Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
31,670

32,532

Unearned premiums
5,385

5,255

Short-term debt
275

456

Long-term debt
5,084

5,653

Other liabilities (includes variable interest entity liabilities of $12 and $6)
6,597

6,251

Separate account liabilities
120,123

134,702

Total liabilities
210,706

226,293

Commitments and Contingencies (Note 12)




Stockholders’ Equity
 

 

Common stock, $0.01 par value — 1,500,000,000 shares authorized, 490,923,222 and 490,923,222 shares issued
5

5

Additional paid-in capital
8,973

9,123

Retained earnings
12,550

11,191

Treasury stock, at cost — 89,102,038 and 66,507,690 shares
(3,557
)
(2,527
)
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
(329
)
928

Total stockholders' equity
17,642

18,720

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
228,348

$
245,013

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-5

Table of Contents

THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity

 
For the years ended December 31,
(In millions, except for share data)
2015
2014
2013
Preferred Stock
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$

$

$
556

Conversion of shares to common stock


(556
)
Balance, end of period



Common Stock
5

5

5

Additional Paid-in Capital, beginning of period
9,123

9,894

10,038

Repurchase of warrants


(33
)
Issuance of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans
(165
)
(64
)
(105
)
Stock-based compensation plans expense
78

88

69

Tax benefit on employee stock options and share-based awards
27

6

3

Conversion of mandatory convertible preferred stock


556

Issuance of shares for warrant exercise
(90
)
(801
)
(634
)
Additional Paid-in Capital, end of period
8,973

9,123

9,894

Retained Earnings, beginning of period
11,191

10,683

10,745

Net income
1,682

798

176

Dividends on preferred stock


(10
)
Dividends declared on common stock
(323
)
(290
)
(228
)
Retained Earnings, end of period
12,550

11,191

10,683

Treasury Stock, at cost, beginning of period
(2,527
)
(1,598
)
(1,740
)
Treasury stock acquired
(1,250
)
(1,796
)
(600
)
Issuance of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans
184

82

125

Net shares acquired related to employee incentive and stock compensation plans
(54
)
(16
)
(17
)
Issuance of shares for warrant exercise
90

801

634

Treasury Stock, at cost, end of period
(3,557
)
(2,527
)
(1,598
)
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss), net of tax, beginning of period
928

(79
)
2,843

Total other comprehensive income (loss)
(1,257
)
1,007

(2,922
)
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss), net of tax, end of period
(329
)
928

(79
)
Total Stockholders’ Equity
$
17,642

$
18,720

$
18,905

Common Shares Outstanding, beginning of period (in thousands)
424,416

453,290

436,306

Treasury stock acquired
(28,431
)
(49,518
)
(19,235
)
Issuance of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans
4,877

2,003

2,136

Return of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans and other to treasury stock
(1,311
)
(439
)
(592
)
Conversion of mandatory convertible preferred shares


21,178

Issuance of shares for warrant exercise
2,270

19,080

13,497

Common Shares Outstanding, end of period
401,821

424,416

453,290

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-6

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

 
For the years ended December 31,
(In millions)
2015
2014
2013
Operating Activities
 
 
 
Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities
 

 

 

Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs
1,502

1,729

2,701

Additions to deferred policy acquisition costs
(1,390
)
(1,364
)
(1,330
)
Net realized capital (gains) losses
156

141

(1,149
)
Depreciation and amortization
373

276

189

(Gain) loss on sale of business
(6
)
653

102

Loss on extinguishment of debt
21


213

Reinsurance (gain) loss on disposition
(28
)
(23
)
1,574

Other operating activities, net
153

203

69

Change in assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
Increase (decrease) in reserve for future policy benefits and unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses and unearned premiums
305

226

(308
)
Decrease (increase) in reinsurance recoverables
146

(22
)
(561
)
Decrease (increase) in receivables and other assets
183

(122
)
(409
)
(Decrease) increase in payables and accruals
(704
)
(937
)
497

Increase (decrease) in accrued and deferred income taxes
363

328

(526
)
Net disbursements from investment contracts related to policyholder funds — international variable annuities

(3,993
)
(9,189
)
Net decrease in equity securities, trading

3,993

9,188

Net cash provided by operating activities
2,756

1,886

1,237

Investing Activities
 

 

 

Proceeds from the sale/maturity/prepayment of:
 

 

 

Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
25,946

25,309

40,266

Fixed maturities, fair value option
181

401

322

Equity securities, available-for-sale
1,319

354

274

Mortgage loans
792

646

468

Partnerships
624

490

368

Payments for the purchase of:
 

 

 

Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
(27,744
)
(22,545
)
(35,446
)
Fixed maturities, fair value option
(251
)
(369
)
(150
)
Equity securities, available-for-sale
(1,454
)
(683
)
(212
)
Mortgage loans
(870
)
(604
)
(718
)
Partnerships
(620
)
(312
)
(353
)
Proceeds from business sold

963

815

Net proceeds from (payments for) derivatives
(173
)
10

(2,208
)
Net decrease in policy loans
(30
)
(11
)
(5
)
Net additions to property and equipment
(307
)
(121
)
(64
)
Net proceeds from (payments for) short-term investments
3,071

(1,814
)
318

Other investing activities, net
1

(18
)
70

Net cash provided by investing activities
485

1,696

3,745

Financing Activities
 

 

 

Deposits and other additions to investment and universal life-type contracts
4,718

5,289

5,942

Withdrawals and other deductions from investment and universal life-type contracts
(17,085
)
(21,870
)
(25,034
)
Net transfers from separate accounts related to investment and universal life-type contracts
11,046

14,366

16,978

Repayments at maturity or settlement of consumer notes
(33
)
(13
)
(77
)
Net increase (decrease) in securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
507


(1,988
)
Repurchase of warrants


(33
)
Repayment of debt
(773
)
(200
)
(1,338
)
Proceeds from the issuance of debt


533

Proceeds from net issuance of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans, excess tax benefit and other
42

30

20

Treasury stock acquired
(1,250
)
(1,796
)
(600
)
Dividends paid on preferred stock


(21
)
Dividends paid on common stock
(316
)
(282
)
(202
)
Net cash used for financing activities
(3,144
)
(4,476
)
(5,820
)
Foreign exchange rate effect on cash
(48
)
(135
)
(155
)
Net increase (decrease) in cash
49

(1,029
)
(993
)
Cash — beginning of period
399

1,428

2,421

Cash — end of period
$
448

$
399

$
1,428

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information
 

 

 

Income tax refunds received (payments)
$
80

$
313

$
(69
)
Interest paid
$
361

$
377

$
402

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-7

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollar amounts in millions, except for per share data, unless otherwise stated)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies


Basis of Presentation
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. is a holding company for insurance and financial services subsidiaries that provide property and casualty insurance, group life and disability products and mutual funds to individual and business customers in the United States (collectively, “The Hartford”, the “Company”, “we” or “our”). Also, the Company continues to runoff life and annuity products previously sold.
On June 30, 2014, the Company completed the sale of all of the issued and outstanding equity of Hartford Life Insurance KK, a Japanese company ("HLIKK"), to ORIX Life Insurance Corporation, a subsidiary of ORIX Corporation, a Japanese company. The operations of the Company's HLIKK business are reported as discontinued operations. For further information regarding the sale of HLIKK and discontinued operations, see the following Discontinued Operations section and Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
On December 12, 2013, the Company completed the sale of the issued and outstanding equity of Hartford Life International Limited, a U.K. company ("HLIL"), to Columbia Insurance Company, a Berkshire Hathaway company.
On January 1, 2013, the Company completed the sale of its Retirement Plans business to Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Company ("MassMutual") and on January 2, 2013 the Company completed the sale of its Individual Life insurance business to The Prudential Insurance Company of America ("Prudential"), a subsidiary of Prudential Financial, Inc. These sales were structured as reinsurance transactions.
For further discussion of these transactions, see Note18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
The Consolidated Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”) which differ materially from the accounting practices prescribed by various insurance regulatory authorities.
Consolidation
The Consolidated Financial Statements include the accounts of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc., companies in which the Company directly or indirectly has a controlling financial interest and those variable interest entities (“VIEs”) which the Company is required to consolidate. Entities in which the Company has significant influence over the operating and financing decisions but is not required to consolidate are reported using the equity method. For further information on VIEs see Note 6 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. All intercompany transactions and balances between The Hartford and its subsidiaries and affiliates have been eliminated.
Discontinued Operations
The results of operations of a component of the Company are reported in discontinued operations when certain criteria are met as of the date of disposal, or earlier if classified as held-for-sale. When a component is identified for discontinued operations reporting, amounts for prior periods are retrospectively reclassified as discontinued operations. Prior to January 1, 2015, components were identified as discontinued operations if the operations and cash flows of the component had been or would be eliminated from the ongoing operations of the Company as a result of the disposal transaction and the Company would not have any significant continuing involvement in the operations of the component after the disposal transaction. For transactions occurring January 1, 2015 or later, under updated guidance issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB"), components are identified as discontinued operations if they are a major part of an entity's operations and financial results such as a separate major line of business or a separate major geographical area of operations regardless of whether the Company has significant continuing involvement in the operations of the component after the disposal transaction. For information on the specific discontinued operations, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Use of Estimates
The preparation of financial statements, in conformity with U.S. GAAP, requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

F-8

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

The most significant estimates include those used in determining property and casualty insurance product reserves, net of reinsurance; estimated gross profits used in the valuation and amortization of assets and liabilities associated with variable annuity and other universal life-type contracts; evaluation of other-than-temporary impairments on available-for-sale securities and valuation allowances on investments; living benefits required to be fair valued; evaluation of goodwill for impairment; valuation of investments and derivative instruments; valuation allowance on deferred tax assets; and contingencies relating to corporate litigation and regulatory matters. Certain of these estimates are particularly sensitive to market conditions, and deterioration and/or volatility in the worldwide debt or equity markets could have a material impact on the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Reclassifications
Certain reclassifications have been made to prior year financial information to conform to the current year presentation.
Future Adoption of New Accounting Standards
Financial Instruments
In January 2016, the FASB issued updated guidance for the recognition and measurement of financial instruments. The new guidance will require investments in equity securities to be measured at fair value with changes in fair value reported in net income except for those equity securities that result in consolidation or are accounted for under the equity method of accounting. The new guidance will also require a deferred tax asset resulting from net unrealized losses on available-for-sale fixed maturities that are recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income (“OCI”) to be evaluated for recoverability in combination with the Company’s other deferred tax assets. Under existing guidance, the Company measures investments in equity securities, available-for-sale, at fair value with changes in fair value reported in OCI. As required, the Company will adopt the guidance effective January 1, 2018 through a cumulative effect adjustment to retained earnings. Early adoption is not allowed. The impact to the Company will be increased volatility in net income beginning in 2018. Any difference in the evaluation of deferred tax assets may also affect stockholders equity. Cash flows will not be affected. The impact will depend on the composition of the Company’s investment portfolio in the future and changes in fair value of the Company’s investments. As of December 31, 2015, equity securities available-for-sale totaled $839, with unrealized losses of $2 in accumulated OCI that would have been classified in retained earnings. Had the new accounting guidance been in place since the beginning of 2015, the Company would have recognized mark-to-market unrealized losses of $17 after-tax in net income for the year ended December 31, 2015.
Consolidation
The FASB issued updated consolidation guidance. The updates revise existing guidance for when to consolidate VIEs and general partners’ investments in limited partnerships, end the deferral granted for applying the VIE guidance to certain investment companies, and reduce the number of circumstances where a decision maker’s or service provider’s fee arrangement is deemed to be a variable interest in an entity. The updates also modify consolidation guidance for determining whether limited partnerships are VIEs or voting interest entities. This guidance is effective January 1, 2016, and may be applied fully retrospectively or through a cumulative effect adjustment to retained earnings as of the adoption (modified retrospective approach). The Company will adopt the guidance using a modified retrospective approach effective as of January 1, 2016 and upon adoption, the new guidance will not have a material effect on the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.
Revenue Recognition
The FASB issued updated guidance for recognizing revenue. The guidance excludes insurance contracts and financial instruments. Revenue is to be recognized when, or as, goods or services are transferred to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration that an entity is expected to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services, and this accounting guidance is similar to current accounting for many transactions. This guidance is effective retrospectively on January 1, 2018, with a choice of restating prior periods or recognizing a cumulative effect for contracts in place as of the adoption. Early adoption is permitted as of January 1, 2017. The Company has not yet determined its method for adoption or estimated the effect of the adoption on the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-9

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Significant Accounting Policies
The Company’s significant accounting policies are as follows:
Revenue Recognition
Property and casualty insurance premiums are earned on a pro rata basis over the policy period and include accruals for ultimate premium revenue anticipated under auditable and retrospectively rated policies. Unearned premiums represent the premiums applicable to the unexpired terms of policies in force. An estimated allowance for doubtful accounts is recorded on the basis of periodic evaluations of balances due from insureds, management’s experience and current economic conditions. The Company charges off any balances that are determined to be uncollectible. The allowance for doubtful accounts included in premiums receivable and agents’ balances in the Consolidated Balance Sheets was $134 and $131 as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
Traditional life products' premiums are recognized as revenue when due from policyholders. Group life, disability and accident premiums are generally both due from policyholders and recognized as revenue on a pro rata basis over the period of the contracts.
Fee income for variable annuity and other universal life-type contracts consists of policy charges for policy administration, cost of insurance charges and surrender charges assessed against policyholders’ account balances and are recognized in the period in which services are provided. Amounts representing account value collected from policyholders for investment and universal life-type contracts are considered deposits and are not included in revenue. Unearned revenue reserves, representing amounts assessed as consideration for policy origination of a universal life-type contract, are deferred and recognized in income over the period benefited.
The Company provides investment management, administrative and distribution services to mutual funds. The Company earns fees from these mutual funds which are primarily based on the average daily net asset values of the mutual funds and recorded as fee income in the period in which the services are provided. Commission fees are based on the sale proceeds and recognized at the time of the transaction. Transfer agent fees are assessed as a charge per account and recognized as fee income in the period in which the services are provided.
Other revenues primarily consists of servicing revenues which are recognized as services are performed.
Dividends to Policyholders
Policyholder dividends are paid to certain property and casualty and life insurance policyholders. Policies that receive dividends are referred to as participating policies. Participating dividends to policyholders are accrued and reported in insurance operating costs and other expenses and other liabilities using an estimate of the amount to be paid based on underlying contractual obligations under policies and applicable state laws.
Net written premiums for participating property and casualty insurance policies represented 10%, 9% and 10% of total net written premiums for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Participating dividends to property and casualty policyholders were $17, $15 and $16 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
There were no additional amounts of income allocated to participating policyholders. If limitations exist on the amount of net income from participating life insurance contracts that may be distributed to stockholders, the policyholder’s share of net income on those contracts that cannot be distributed is excluded from stockholders' equity by a charge to operations and an increase to a liability.



F-10

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Investments
Overview
The Company’s investments in fixed maturities include bonds, structured securities, redeemable preferred stock and commercial paper. Most of these investments, along with certain equity securities, which include common and non-redeemable preferred stocks, are classified as available-for-sale ("AFS") and are carried at fair value. The after-tax difference between fair value and cost or amortized cost is reflected in stockholders’ equity as a component of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) (“AOCI”), after adjustments for the effect of deducting certain life and annuity deferred policy acquisition costs and reserve adjustments. Also included in equity securities, AFS are certain equity securities for which the Company elected the fair value option. These equity securities are carried at fair value with changes in value recorded in realized capital gains and losses on the Company's Consolidated Statements of Operations. Fixed maturities for which the Company elected the fair value option are classified as FVO and are carried at fair value with changes in value recorded in realized capital gains and losses. Policy loans are carried at outstanding balance. Mortgage loans are recorded at the outstanding principal balance adjusted for amortization of premiums or discounts and net of valuation allowances. Short-term investments are carried at amortized cost, which approximates fair value. Limited partnerships and other alternative investments are reported at their carrying value and accounted for under the equity method with the Company’s share of earnings included in net investment income. Recognition of income related to limited partnerships and other alternative investments is delayed due to the availability of the related financial information, as private equity and other funds are generally on a three-month delay and hedge funds on a one-month delay. Accordingly, income for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013 may not include the full impact of current year changes in valuation of the underlying assets and liabilities of the funds, which are generally obtained from the limited partnerships and other alternative investments’ general partners. In addition, for investments in a wholly-owned hedge fund of funds, the Company recognizes changes in the fair value of the underlying funds in net investment income, which is consistent with accounting requirements for investment companies. Other investments primarily consist of derivative instruments which are carried at fair value.
Net Realized Capital Gains and Losses
Net realized capital gains and losses from investment sales are reported as a component of revenues and are determined on a specific identification basis. Net realized capital gains and losses also result from fair value changes in fixed maturities and equity securities FVO, and derivatives contracts (both free-standing and embedded) that do not qualify, or are not designated, as a hedge for accounting purposes, ineffectiveness on derivatives that qualify for hedge accounting treatment, and the change in value of derivatives in certain fair-value hedge relationships and their associated hedged asset. Impairments and mortgage loan valuation allowances are recognized as net realized capital losses in accordance with the Company’s impairment and mortgage loan valuation allowance policies as discussed in Note 6 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. Foreign currency transaction remeasurements are also included in net realized capital gains and losses.
Net Investment Income
Interest income from fixed maturities and mortgage loans is recognized when earned on the constant effective yield method based on estimated timing of cash flows. The amortization of premium and accretion of discount for fixed maturities also takes into consideration call and maturity dates that produce the lowest yield. For securitized financial assets subject to prepayment risk, yields are recalculated and adjusted periodically to reflect historical and/or estimated future repayments using the retrospective method; however, if these investments are impaired, any yield adjustments are made using the prospective method. Prepayment fees and make-whole payments on fixed maturities and mortgage loans are recorded in net investment income when earned. For equity securities, dividends will be recognized as investment income on the ex-dividend date. Limited partnerships and other alternative investments primarily use the equity method of accounting to recognize the Company’s share of earnings; however, for a portion of those investments, the Company uses investment fund accounting applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds. For impaired debt securities, the Company accretes the new cost basis to the estimated future cash flows over the expected remaining life of the security by prospectively adjusting the security’s yield, if necessary. The Company’s non-income producing investments were not material for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013.
Derivative Instruments
Overview
The Company utilizes a variety of over-the-counter ("OTC") derivative investments, including transactions cleared through a central clearing house ("OTC-cleared"), and exchange-traded derivative instruments as part of its overall risk management strategy. The types of instruments may include swaps, caps, floors, forwards, futures and options to achieve one of four Company-approved objectives: to hedge risk arising from interest rate, equity market, commodity market, credit spread and issuer default, price or currency exchange rate risk or volatility; to manage liquidity; to control transaction costs; or to enter into synthetic replication transactions.

F-11

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Interest rate, volatility, dividend, credit default and index swaps involve the periodic exchange of cash flows with other parties, at specified intervals, calculated using agreed upon rates or other financial variables and notional principal amounts. Generally, little to no cash or principal payments are exchanged at the inception of the contract. Typically, at the time a swap is entered into, the cash flow streams exchanged by the counterparties are equal in value.
Interest rate cap and floor contracts entitle the purchaser to receive from the issuer at specified dates, the amount, if any, by which a specified market rate exceeds the cap strike interest rate or falls below the floor strike interest rate, applied to a notional principal amount. A premium payment is made by the purchaser of the contract at its inception and no principal payments are exchanged.
Forward contracts are customized commitments that specify a rate of interest or currency exchange rate to be paid or received on an obligation beginning on a future start date and are typically settled in cash.
Financial futures are standardized commitments to either purchase or sell designated financial instruments, at a future date, for a specified price and may be settled in cash or through delivery of the underlying instrument. Futures contracts trade on organized exchanges. Margin requirements for futures are met by pledging securities or cash, and changes in the futures’ contract values are settled daily in cash.
Option contracts grant the purchaser, for a premium payment, the right to either purchase from or sell to the issuer a financial instrument at a specified price, within a specified period or on a stated date. The contracts may reference commodities, which grant the purchaser the right to either purchase from or sell to the issuer commodities at a specified price, within a specified period or on a stated date. Option contracts are typically settled in cash.
Foreign currency swaps exchange an initial principal amount in two currencies, agreeing to re-exchange the currencies at a future date, at an agreed upon exchange rate. There may also be a periodic exchange of payments at specified intervals calculated using the agreed upon rates and exchanged principal amounts.
The Company’s derivative transactions conducted in insurance company subsidiaries are used in strategies permitted under the derivative use plans required by the State of Connecticut, the State of Illinois and the State of New York insurance departments.
Accounting and Financial Statement Presentation of Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities
Derivative instruments are recognized on the Consolidated Balance Sheets at fair value and are reported in Other Investments and Other Liabilities. For balance sheet presentation purposes, the Company has elected to offset the fair value amounts, income accruals, and related cash collateral receivables and payables of OTC derivative instruments executed in a legal entity and with the same counterparty or under a master netting agreement, which provides the Company with the legal right of offset.
The Company also clears interest rate swap and certain credit default swap derivative transactions through central clearing houses. OTC-cleared derivatives require initial collateral at the inception of the trade in the form of cash or highly liquid collateral, such as U.S. Treasuries and government agency investments. Central clearing houses also require additional cash collateral as variation margin based on daily market value movements. For information on collateral, see the derivative collateral arrangements section in Note 6 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statement. In addition, OTC-cleared transactions include price alignment interest either received or paid on the variation margin, which is reflected in net investment income. The Company has also elected to offset the fair value amounts, income accruals and related cash collateral receivables and payables of OTC-cleared derivative instruments based on clearing house agreements.
On the date the derivative contract is entered into, the Company designates the derivative as (1) a hedge of the fair value of a recognized asset or liability (“fair value” hedge), (2) a hedge of the variability in cash flows of a forecasted transaction or of amounts to be received or paid related to a recognized asset or liability (“cash flow” hedge), (3) a hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation (“net investment” hedge) or (4) held for other investment and/or risk management purposes, which primarily involve managing asset or liability related risks and do not qualify for hedge accounting.
Fair Value Hedges
Changes in the fair value of a derivative that is designated and qualifies as a fair value hedge, including foreign-currency fair value hedges, along with the changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that is attributable to the hedged risk, are recorded in current period earnings as net realized capital gains and losses with any differences between the net change in fair value of the derivative and the hedged item representing the hedge ineffectiveness. Periodic cash flows and accruals of income/expense (“periodic derivative net coupon settlements”) are recorded in the line item of the Consolidated Statements of Operations in which the cash flows of the hedged item are recorded.

F-12

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Cash Flow Hedges
Changes in the fair value of a derivative that is designated and qualifies as a cash flow hedge, including foreign-currency cash flow hedges, are recorded in AOCI and are reclassified into earnings when the variability of the cash flow of the hedged item impacts earnings. Gains and losses on derivative contracts that are reclassified from AOCI to current period earnings are included in the line item in the Consolidated Statements of Operations in which the cash flows of the hedged item are recorded. Any hedge ineffectiveness is recorded immediately in current period earnings as net realized capital gains and losses. Periodic derivative net coupon settlements are recorded in the line item of the Consolidated Statements of Operations in which the cash flows of the hedged item are recorded.
Net Investment in a Foreign Operation Hedges
Changes in fair value of a derivative used as a hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation, to the extent effective as a hedge, are recorded in the foreign currency translation adjustments account within AOCI. Cumulative changes in fair value recorded in AOCI are reclassified into earnings upon the sale or complete, or substantially complete, liquidation of the foreign entity. Any hedge ineffectiveness is recorded immediately in current period earnings as net realized capital gains and losses. Periodic derivative net coupon settlements are recorded in the line item of the Consolidated Statements of Operations in which the cash flows of the hedged item are recorded.
Other Investment and/or Risk Management Activities
The Company’s other investment and/or risk management activities primarily relate to strategies used to reduce economic risk or replicate permitted investments and do not receive hedge accounting treatment. Changes in the fair value, including periodic derivative net coupon settlements, of derivative instruments held for other investment and/or risk management purposes are reported in current period earnings as net realized capital gains and losses.
Hedge Documentation and Effectiveness Testing
To qualify for hedge accounting treatment, a derivative must be highly effective in mitigating the designated changes in fair value or cash flow of the hedged item. At hedge inception, the Company formally documents all relationships between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its risk-management objective and strategy for undertaking each hedge transaction. The documentation process includes linking derivatives that are designated as fair value, cash flow, or net investment hedges to specific assets or liabilities on the balance sheet or to specific forecasted transactions and defining the effectiveness and ineffectiveness testing methods to be used. The Company also formally assesses both at the hedge’s inception and ongoing on a quarterly basis, whether the derivatives that are used in hedging transactions have been and are expected to continue to be highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values, cash flows or net investment in foreign operations of hedged items. Hedge effectiveness is assessed primarily using quantitative methods as well as using qualitative methods. Quantitative methods include regression or other statistical analysis of changes in fair value or cash flows associated with the hedge relationship. Qualitative methods may include comparison of critical terms of the derivative to the hedged item. Hedge ineffectiveness of the hedge relationships are measured each reporting period using the “Change in Variable Cash Flows Method”, the “Change in Fair Value Method”, the “Hypothetical Derivative Method”, or the “Dollar Offset Method”.
Discontinuance of Hedge Accounting
The Company discontinues hedge accounting prospectively when (1) it is determined that the qualifying criteria are no longer met; (2) the derivative is no longer designated as a hedging instrument; or (3) the derivative expires or is sold, terminated or exercised.
When hedge accounting is discontinued because it is determined that the derivative no longer qualifies as an effective fair value hedge, the derivative continues to be carried at fair value on the balance sheet with changes in its fair value recognized in current period earnings. Changes in the fair value of the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk is no longer adjusted through current period earnings and the existing basis adjustment is amortized to earnings over the remaining life of the hedged item through the applicable earnings component associated with the hedged item.
When hedge accounting is discontinued because the Company becomes aware that it is not probable that the forecasted transaction will occur, the derivative continues to be carried on the balance sheet at its fair value, and gains and losses that were accumulated in AOCI are recognized immediately in earnings.
In other situations in which hedge accounting is discontinued, including those where the derivative is sold, terminated or exercised, amounts previously deferred in AOCI are reclassified into earnings when earnings are impacted by the hedged item.

F-13

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Embedded Derivatives
The Company purchases and has previously issued financial instruments and products that contain embedded derivative instruments. When it is determined that (1) the embedded derivative possesses economic characteristics that are not clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the host contract and (2) a separate instrument with the same terms would qualify as a derivative instrument, the embedded derivative is bifurcated from the host for measurement purposes. The embedded derivative, which is reported with the host instrument in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, is carried at fair value with changes in fair value reported in net realized capital gains and losses.
Credit Risk
Credit risk is defined as the risk of financial loss due to uncertainty of an obligor’s or counterparty’s ability or willingness to meet its obligations in accordance with agreed upon terms. Credit exposures are measured using the market value of the derivatives, resulting in amounts owed to the Company by its counterparties or potential payment obligations from the Company to its counterparties. The Company generally requires that OTC derivative contracts, other than certain forward contracts, be governed by International Swaps and Derivatives Association ("ISDA") agreements which are structured by legal entity and by counterparty, and permit right of offset. These agreements require daily collateral settlement based upon agreed upon thresholds. For purposes of daily derivative collateral maintenance, credit exposures are generally quantified based on the prior business day’s market value and collateral is pledged to and held by, or on behalf of, the Company to the extent the current value of the derivatives exceed the contractual thresholds. For the Company’s domestic derivative programs, the maximum uncollateralized threshold for a derivative counterparty for a single legal entity is $10. The Company also minimizes the credit risk of derivative instruments by entering into transactions with high quality counterparties primarily rated A or better, which are monitored and evaluated by the Company’s risk management team and reviewed by senior management. OTC-cleared derivatives are governed by clearing house rules. Transactions cleared through a central clearing house reduce risk due to their ability to require daily variation margin, monitor the Company's ability to request additional collateral in the event of a counterparty downgrade, and act as an independent valuation source. In addition, the Company monitors counterparty credit exposure on a monthly basis to ensure compliance with Company policies and statutory limitations.
Cash
Cash represents cash on hand and demand deposits with banks or other financial institutions.
Reinsurance
The Company cedes insurance to affiliated and unaffiliated insurers in order to limit its maximum losses and to diversify its exposures and provide statutory surplus relief. Such arrangements do not relieve the Company of its primary liability to policyholders. Failure of reinsurers to honor their obligations could result in losses to the Company. The Company also assumes reinsurance from other insurers and is a member of and participates in reinsurance pools and associations. Assumed reinsurance refers to the Company’s acceptance of certain insurance risks that other insurance companies or pools have underwritten.
Reinsurance accounting is followed for ceded and assumed transactions that provide indemnification against loss or liability relating to insurance risk (i.e. risk transfer). To meet risk transfer requirements, a reinsurance agreement must include insurance risk, consisting of underwriting, investment, and timing risk, and a reasonable possibility of a significant loss to the reinsurer. If the ceded and assumed transactions do not meet risk transfer requirements, the Company accounts for these transactions as financing transactions.
Premiums, benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses reflect the net effects of ceded and assumed reinsurance transactions. Included in other assets are prepaid reinsurance premiums, which represent the portion of premiums ceded to reinsurers applicable to the unexpired terms of the reinsurance contracts. Included in reinsurance recoverables are balances due from reinsurance companies for paid and unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses and are presented net of an allowance for uncollectible reinsurance. Changes in the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance are reported in benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses in the Company's Consolidated Statements of Operations.
The Company evaluates the financial condition of its reinsurers and concentrations of credit risk. Reinsurance is placed with reinsurers that meet strict financial criteria established by the Company. The Company entered into two reinsurance transactions upon completion of the sales of its Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses in 2013. For further discussion of these transactions, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions and Note 5 - Reinsurance of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Deferred Policy Acquisition Costs
Deferred policy acquisition costs ("DAC") represent costs that are directly related to the acquisition of new and renewal insurance contracts and incremental direct costs of contract acquisition that are incurred in transactions with either independent third parties or employees. Such costs primarily include commissions, premium taxes, costs of policy issuance and underwriting, and certain other expenses that are directly related to successfully issued contracts.

F-14

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

For property and casualty insurance products and group life, disability and accident contracts, costs are deferred and amortized ratably over the period the related premiums are earned. Deferred acquisition costs are reviewed to determine if they are recoverable from future income, and if not, are charged to expense. Anticipated investment income is considered in the determination of the recoverability of DAC.
For life insurance products, the DAC asset related to most universal life-type contracts (including variable annuities) is amortized over the estimated life of the contracts acquired in proportion to the present value of estimated gross profits (“EGPs”). EGPs are also used to amortize other assets and liabilities in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets, such as sales inducement assets (“SIA”). Components of EGPs are also used to determine reserves for universal life-type contracts (including variable annuities) with death or other insurance benefits such as guaranteed minimum death, life-contingent guaranteed minimum withdrawal and universal life insurance secondary guarantee benefits. These benefits are accounted for and collectively referred to as death and other insurance benefit reserves and are held in addition to the account value liability representing policyholder funds.
For most life insurance product contracts, including variable annuities, the Company estimates gross profits over 20 years as EGPs emerging subsequent to that timeframe are immaterial. Products sold in a particular year are aggregated into cohorts. Future gross profits for each cohort are projected over the estimated lives of the underlying contracts, based on future account value projections for variable annuity and variable universal life products. The projection of future account values requires the use of certain assumptions including: separate account returns; separate account fund mix; fees assessed against the contract holder’s account balance; full surrender and partial withdrawal rates; interest margin; mortality; and the extent and duration of hedging activities and hedging costs.
The Company determines EGPs from a single deterministic reversion to mean (“RTM”) separate account return projection which is an estimation technique commonly used by insurance entities to project future separate account returns. Through this estimation technique, the Company’s DAC model is adjusted to reflect actual account values at the end of each quarter. Through consideration of recent market returns, the Company will unlock ("Unlock"), or adjust, projected returns over a future period so that the account value returns to the long-term expected rate of return, providing that those projected returns do not exceed certain caps. This Unlock for future separate account returns is determined each quarter.
In the fourth quarter of 2015, the Company completed a comprehensive policyholder behavior assumption study which resulted in a non-market related after-tax benefit and incorporated the results of that study into its projection of future gross profits. Additionally, throughout the year, the Company evaluates various aspects of policyholder behavior and will revise its policyholder assumptions if credible emerging data indicates that changes are warranted. The Company will continue to evaluate its assumptions related to policyholder behavior as initiatives to reduce the size of the variable annuity business are implemented by management. Upon completion of an annual assumption study or evaluation of credible new information, the Company will revise its assumptions to reflect its current best estimate. These assumption revisions will change the projected account values and the related EGPs in the DAC and SIA amortization models, as well as, the death and other insurance benefit reserving models.
All assumption changes that affect the estimate of future EGPs including the update of current account values, the use of the RTM estimation technique and policyholder behavior assumptions are considered an Unlock in the period of revision. An Unlock adjusts the DAC, SIA and death and other insurance benefit reserve balances in the Consolidated Balance Sheets with an offsetting benefit or charge in the Consolidated Statements of Operations in the period of the revision. An Unlock revises EGPs to reflect the Company’s current best estimate assumptions. The Company also tests the aggregate recoverability of DAC by comparing the existing DAC balance to the present value of future EGPs. An Unlock that results in an after-tax benefit generally occurs as a result of actual experience or future expectations of product profitability being favorable compared to previous estimates. An Unlock that results in an after-tax charge generally occurs as a result of actual experience or future expectations of product profitability being unfavorable compared to previous estimates.
Income Taxes
The Company recognizes taxes payable or refundable for the current year and deferred taxes for the tax consequences of temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax basis of assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years the temporary differences are expected to reverse. A deferred tax provision is recorded for the tax effects of differences between the Company's current taxable income and its income before tax under generally accepted accounting principles in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. For deferred tax assets, the Company records a valuation allowance that is adequate to reduce the total deferred tax asset to an amount that will more likely than not be realized.

F-15

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Goodwill
Goodwill represents the excess of costs over the fair value of net assets acquired. Goodwill is not amortized but is reviewed for impairment at least annually or more frequently if events occur or circumstances change that would indicate that a triggering event for a potential impairment has occurred. The goodwill impairment test follows a two-step process. In the first step, the fair value of a reporting unit is compared to its carrying value. If the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the impairment test is performed for purposes of measuring the impairment. In the second step, the fair value of the reporting unit is allocated to all of the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit to determine an implied goodwill value. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit’s goodwill exceeds the implied goodwill value, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.
Management’s determination of the fair value of each reporting unit incorporates multiple inputs into discounted cash flow calculations, including assumptions that market participants would make in valuing the reporting unit. Assumptions include levels of economic capital, future business growth, earnings projections and assets under management for certain reporting units and the weighted average cost of capital used for purposes of discounting. Decreases in the amount of capital allocated to a reporting unit, decreases in business growth, decreases in earnings projections and increases in the weighted average cost of capital will all cause a reporting unit’s fair value to decrease, increasing the possibility of impairments.
Property and Equipment
Property and equipment which includes capitalized software is carried at cost net of accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation and amortization is based on the estimated useful lives of the various classes of property and equipment and is determined principally on the straight-line method. Accumulated depreciation was $2.3 billion and $2.3 billion as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Depreciation expense was $164, $198, and $174 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features
The Company records the variable account value portion of variable annuity and variable life insurance products and institutional and governmental investment contracts within separate accounts. Separate account assets are reported at fair value and separate account liabilities are reported at amounts consistent with separate account assets. Investment income and gains and losses from those separate account assets accrue directly to the policyholder, who assumes the related investment risk, and are offset by change in the related liability with changes reported in the same line item in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. The Company earns fees for investment management, certain administrative expenses, and mortality and expense risks assumed which are reported in fee income.
Certain contracts classified as universal life-type include death and other insurance benefit features including guaranteed minimum death benefit ("GMDB"), guaranteed minimum income benefit ("GMIB"), and guaranteed minimum withdrawal benefit ("GMWB") riders offered with variable annuity contracts, or secondary guarantee benefits offered with universal life insurance contracts. GMWBs that represent embedded derivatives are accounted for at fair value. Universal life insurance secondary guarantee benefits ensure that the policy will not terminate, and will continue to provide a death benefit, even if there is insufficient policy value to cover the monthly deductions and charges. For the Company's GMWB products, the withdrawal benefit can exceed the guaranteed remaining balance ("GRB"), which is generally equal to premiums less withdrawals. These GMDBs, GMIBs, the life-contingent portion of GMWBs and the universal life insurance secondary guarantees require an additional liability be held above the account value liability representing the policyholders’ funds. This liability is reported in reserve for future policy benefits in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. Changes in the death and other insurance benefit reserves are recorded in benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations.
The death and other insurance benefit liability is determined by estimating the expected present value of the benefits in excess of the policyholder’s expected account value in proportion to the present value of total expected fees. The liability is accrued as actual fees are earned. The expected present value of benefits and fees are generally derived from a set of stochastic scenarios, that have been calibrated to our RTM separate account returns, and assumptions including market rates of return, volatility, discount rates, lapse rates and mortality experience. Consistent with the Company’s policy on the Unlock, the Company regularly evaluates estimates used and adjusts the additional liability balance, with a related charge or credit to benefits, losses and loss adjustment expense. For further information on the Unlock, see the Deferred Policy Acquisition Costs accounting policy section within this footnote.
The Company reinsures a portion of its in-force GMDB and all of its universal life insurance secondary guarantees and net reinsurance costs are recognized ratably over the accumulation period based on total expected assessments.


F-16

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Reserve for Future Policy Benefits and Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Property and Casualty Insurance Products
The Hartford establishes property and casualty insurance product reserves to provide for the estimated costs of paying claims under insurance policies written by the Company. These reserves include estimates for both claims that have been reported and those that have been incurred but not reported, and include estimates of all losses and loss adjustment expenses associated with processing and settling these claims. Estimating the ultimate cost of future losses and loss adjustment expenses is an uncertain and complex process. This estimation process is based significantly on the assumption that past developments are an appropriate predictor of future events, and involves a variety of actuarial techniques that analyze experience, trends and other relevant factors. The uncertainties involved with the reserving process have become increasingly difficult due to a number of complex factors including social and economic trends and changes in the concepts of legal liability and damage awards. Accordingly, final claim settlements may vary from the present estimates, particularly when those payments may not occur until well into the future.
The Hartford regularly reviews the adequacy of its estimated losses and loss adjustment expense reserves by line of business within the various reporting segments. Adjustments to previously established reserves are reflected in the operating results of the period in which the adjustment is determined to be necessary. Such adjustments could possibly be significant, reflecting any variety of new and adverse or favorable trends.
Most of the Company’s property and casualty insurance products reserves are not discounted. However, the Company has discounted to present value certain reserves for indemnity payments due to permanently disabled claimants under workers’ compensation policies at an average interest rate of 3.24% and 3.50% in 2015 and 2014, respectively. These discounted reserves totaled approximately $1.1 billion and $1.0 billion at December 31, 2015 and 2014. The Company also has discounted liabilities for structured settlement agreements that provide fixed periodic payments to claimants. These structured settlements include annuities purchased to fund unpaid losses for permanently disabled claimants. Most of the annuities have been issued by the Company and these structured settlements are recorded at present value as annuity obligations, either within the reserve for future policy benefits if the annuity benefits are life-contingent or within other policyholder funds and benefits payable if the annuity benefits are not life-contingent. Annuities issued by the Company to fund structured settlement payments where the claimant has not released the Company of its obligation totaled $746 and $776 as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. These structured settlement liabilities were discounted to present value using an average interest rate of 6.68% in 2015 and 6.67% in 2014.
Life Insurance Products
Liabilities for future policy benefits are calculated by the net level premium method using interest, withdrawal and mortality assumptions appropriate at the time the policies were issued. The methods used in determining the liability for unpaid losses and future policy benefits are standard actuarial methods. For the tabular reserves, discount rates are based on the Company’s earned investment yield and the morbidity/mortality tables used are standard industry tables modified to reflect the Company’s actual experience when appropriate. These reserves are computed such that they are expected to meet the Company’s future policy obligations. Future policy benefits are computed at amounts that, with additions from estimated premiums to be received and with interest on such reserves compounded annually at certain assumed rates, are expected to be sufficient to meet the Company’s policy obligations at their maturities or in the event of an insured’s death. Changes in or deviations from the assumptions used for mortality, morbidity, expected future premiums and interest can significantly affect the Company’s reserve levels and related future operations.
Liabilities for the Company’s group life and disability contracts, as well as its individual term life insurance policies, include amounts for unpaid losses and future policy benefits. Liabilities for unpaid losses include estimates of amounts to fully settle known reported claims, as well as claims related to insured events that the Company estimates have been incurred but have not yet been reported. These reserve estimates are based on known facts and interpretations of circumstances, and consideration of various internal factors including The Hartford’s experience with similar cases, historical trends involving claim payment patterns, loss payments, pending levels of unpaid claims, loss control programs and product mix. In addition, the reserve estimates are influenced by consideration of various external factors including court decisions, economic conditions and public attitudes. The effects of inflation are implicitly considered in the reserving process. Group life and disability contracts with long tail claim liabilities are discounted because the payment pattern and the ultimate costs are reasonably fixed and determinable on an individual claim basis. These reserves were discounted to present value using a weighted average interest rate of 4.41% in 2015 and 4.53% in 2014.
Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable
Other policyholder funds and benefits payable consist of non-variable account values associated with variable annuity and other universal life-type contracts and investment contracts.


F-17

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Investment contracts consist of institutional and governmental products, without life contingencies, including funding agreements, certain structured settlements and guaranteed investment contracts. The liability for investment contracts is equal to the balance that accrues to the benefit of the contract holder as of the financial statement date, which includes the accumulation of deposits plus credited interest, less withdrawals and amounts assessed through the financial statement date.
Foreign Currency
Foreign currency translation gains and losses are reflected in stockholders’ equity as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). The Company’s foreign subsidiaries’ balance sheet accounts are translated at the exchange rates in effect at each year end and income statement accounts are translated at the average rates of exchange prevailing during the year. The national currencies of the international operations are generally their functional currencies. Gains and losses resulting from the remeasurement of foreign currency transactions are reflected in earnings in realized capital gains (losses) in the period in which they occur.

F-18

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
2. Earnings Per Common Share

The following table presents the computation of basic and diluted earnings per common share.
 
For the years ended December 31,
(In millions, except for per share data)
2015
2014
2013
Earnings
 
 
 
Income from continuing operations
 
 
 
Income from continuing operations, net of tax
$
1,673

$
1,349

$
1,225

Less: Preferred stock dividends


10

Income from continuing operations, net of tax, available to common shareholders
1,673

1,349

1,215

Add: Dilutive effect of preferred stock dividends


10

Income from continuing operations, net of tax, available to common shareholders and assumed conversion of preferred shares
$
1,673

$
1,349

$
1,225

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
$
9

$
(551
)
$
(1,049
)
Net income
 

 

 

Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

Less: Preferred stock dividends


10

Net income available to common shareholders
1,682

798

166

Add: Dilutive effect of preferred stock dividends


10

Net income available to common shareholders and assumed conversion of preferred shares
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

Shares
 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic
415.5

441.8

447.7

Dilutive effect of warrants
4.7

12.1

32.2

Dilutive effect of stock-based awards under compensation plans
5.0

6.3

4.5

Dilutive effect of mandatory convertible preferred shares


6.2

Weighted average shares outstanding and dilutive potential common shares [1]
425.2

460.2

490.6

Earnings (loss) per common share
 
 
 
Basic
 
 
 
Income from continuing operations, net of tax, available to common shareholders
$
4.03

$
3.05

$
2.71

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
0.02

(1.24
)
(2.34
)
Net income available to common shareholders
$
4.05

$
1.81

$
0.37

Diluted
 

 

 

Income from continuing operations, net of tax, available to common shareholders
$
3.93

$
2.93

$
2.50

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
0.03

(1.20
)
(2.14
)
Net income available to common shareholders
$
3.96

$
1.73

$
0.36

[1]
For additional information, see Note 13 - Equity and Note 17 - Stock Compensation Plans of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Basic earnings per share is computed based on the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the year. Diluted earnings per share includes the dilutive effect of assumed exercise or issuance of warrants and stock-based awards under compensation plans, and assumed conversion of preferred shares to common using the treasury stock method. Diluted potential common shares are included in the calculation of diluted per share amounts provided there is income from continuing operations, net of tax.
Under the treasury stock method, for warrants and stock-based awards, shares are assumed to be issued and then reduced for the number of shares repurchaseable with theoretical proceeds at the average market price for the period. Contingently issuable shares are included for the number of shares issuable assuming the end of the reporting period was the end of the contingency period, if dilutive.
Under the if-converted method for mandatory convertible preferred stock the conversion to common shares is assumed if the inclusion of these shares and the related dividend adjustment are dilutive to the earnings per share calculation.

F-19

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
3. Segment Information


The Company currently conducts business principally in six reporting segments, as well as a Corporate category. The Company's revenues from continuing operations are generated primarily in the United States ("U.S."). Any foreign sourced revenue in continuing operations is immaterial.
The Company’s reporting segments, as well as the Corporate category, are as follows:
Commercial Lines
Commercial Lines provides workers’ compensation, property, automobile, marine, livestock, liability and umbrella coverages primarily throughout the U.S., along with a variety of customized insurance products and risk management services including professional liability, bond, surety, and specialty casualty coverages.
Personal Lines
Personal Lines provides standard automobile, homeowners and personal umbrella coverages to individuals across the U.S., including a special program designed exclusively for members of AARP.
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Property & Casualty Other Operations includes certain property and casualty operations, managed by the Company, that have discontinued writing new business and includes substantially all of the Company’s asbestos and environmental exposures.
Group Benefits
Group Benefits provides employers, associations and financial institutions with group life, accident and disability coverage, along with other products and services, including voluntary benefits, and group retiree health.
Mutual Funds
Mutual Funds offers investment products for retail and retirement accounts and provides investment management and administrative services such as product design, implementation and oversight. This business also includes a portion of the run off of the mutual funds which support the Company's variable annuity products.
Talcott Resolution
Talcott Resolution is comprised of runoff business from the Company's individual annuity, institutional, and private-placement life insurance businesses. The Company's individual annuity business consists of variable, fixed, and payout annuity products. In addition, Talcott Resolution includes the retained yen denominated fixed payout annuity liabilities, as well as the Company's discontinued operations from HLIKK prior to its sale in 2014.
Corporate
The Company includes in the Corporate category the Company’s capital raising activities (including debt financing and related interest expense), purchase accounting adjustments related to goodwill and other expenses not allocated to the reporting segments.
Financial Measures and Other Segment Information
Certain transactions between segments occur during the year that primarily relate to tax settlements, insurance coverage, expense reimbursements, services provided, security transfers and capital contributions. Also, one segment may purchase annuity contracts from another to fund pension costs and to settle certain group life claims. In addition, certain inter-segment transactions occur that relate to interest income on allocated surplus. Consolidated net investment income is unaffected by such transactions.

F-20

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
3. Segment Information (continued)

The following table presents revenues by product line for each reporting segment, as well as the Corporate category.
 
For the years ended December 31,
Revenues
2015
2014
2013
Earned premiums and fee income
 
 
 
Commercial Lines
 
 
 
Workers’ compensation
$
3,051

$
2,971

$
2,975

Property
637

559

521

Automobile
614

591

579

Package business
1,203

1,163

1,139

Liability
567

582

566

Bond
218

210

201

Professional liability
221

213

222

Total Commercial Lines
6,511

6,289

6,203

Personal Lines
 

 

 

Automobile
2,671

2,613

2,522

Homeowners
1,202

1,193

1,138

Total Personal Lines [1]
3,873

3,806

3,660

Property & Casualty Other Operations
32

1

1

Group Benefits
 

 

 

Group disability
1,479

1,450

1,452

Group life
1,477

1,478

1,717

Other
180

167

161

Total Group Benefits
3,136

3,095

3,330

Mutual Funds
 

 

 

Mutual Fund
607

586

520

Talcott
116

137

148

Total Mutual Funds
723

723

668

Talcott Resolution
1,133

1,407

1,463

Corporate
8

11

11

Total earned premiums and fee income
15,416

15,332

15,336

Net investment income:
 

 

 

Securities available-for-sale and other
3,030

3,153

3,263

Equity securities, trading

1

1

Total net investment income
3,030

3,154

3,264

Net realized capital gains (loss)
(156
)
16

1,798

Other revenues
87

112

275

Total revenues
$
18,377

$
18,614

$
20,673

[1]
For 2015, 2014 and 2013, AARP members accounted for earned premiums of $3.2 billion, $3.0 billion and $2.9 billion, respectively.
The following table presents net income (loss) for each reporting segment, as well as the Corporate category.
 
For the years ended December 31,
Net income (loss)
2015
2014
2013
Commercial Lines
$
1,003

$
983

$
870

Personal Lines
187

207

229

Property & Casualty Other Operations
(53
)
(108
)
(2
)
Group Benefits
187

191

192

Mutual Funds
86

87

76

Talcott Resolution
430

(187
)
(634
)
Corporate
(158
)
(375
)
(555
)
Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176


F-21

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
3. Segment Information (continued)

 
For the years ended December 31,
Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs
2015
2014
2013
Commercial Lines
$
951

$
919

$
905

Personal Lines
359

348

332

Group Benefits
31

32

33

Mutual Funds
22

28

39

Talcott Resolution
139

402

485

Total amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs
$
1,502

$
1,729

$
1,794

 
For the years ended December 31,
Income tax expense (benefit)
2015
2014
2013
Commercial Lines
$
409

$
385

$
320

Personal Lines
82

92

100

Property & Casualty Other Operations
(47
)
(51
)
(20
)
Group Benefits
63

63

63

Mutual Funds
48

49

42

Talcott Resolution
(17
)
16

(7
)
Corporate
(233
)
(204
)
(252
)
Total income tax expense
$
305

$
350

$
246

 
As of December 31,
Assets
2015
2014
Commercial Lines
$
28,388

$
28,451

Personal Lines
6,147

5,983

Property & Casualty Other Operations
4,562

4,328

Group Benefits
9,666

9,686

Mutual Funds
449

443

Talcott Resolution
175,319

191,801

Corporate
3,817

4,321

Total assets
$
228,348

$
245,013



F-22

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements

Fair value is determined based on the "exit price" notion which is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. Financial instruments carried at fair value in the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements include fixed maturity and equity securities, AFS; fixed maturities and equity securities, FVO; short-term investments; freestanding and embedded derivatives; certain limited partnerships and other alternative investments; separate account assets and certain other liabilities. The Company's estimates of fair value for financial assets and financial liabilities are based on the framework established in the fair value accounting guidance. The framework is based on the inputs used in valuation, gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets and requires that observable inputs be used in the valuations when available. The Company categorizes its assets and liabilities measured at estimated fair value based on whether the significant inputs into the valuation are observable. The fair value hierarchy categorizes the inputs in the valuation techniques used to measure fair value into three broad Levels (Level 1, 2 or 3).
Level 1
Unadjusted quoted prices for identical assets, or liabilities, in active markets that the Company has the ability to access at the measurement date.
Level 2
Observable inputs, other than quoted prices included in Level 1, for the asset or liability, or prices for similar assets and liabilities.
Level 3
Valuations that are derived from techniques in which one or more of the significant inputs are unobservable (including assumptions about risk). Because Level 3 fair values, by their nature, contain one or more significant unobservable inputs, as there is little or no observable market for these assets and liabilities, considerable judgment is used to determine the Level 3 fair values. Level 3 fair values represent the Company’s best estimate of an amount that could be realized in a current market exchange absent actual market exchanges.
In many situations, inputs used to measure the fair value of an asset or liability position may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In these situations, the Company will determine the level in which the fair value falls based upon the lowest level input that is significant to the determination of the fair value. In most cases, both observable (e.g., changes in interest rates) and unobservable (e.g., changes in risk assumptions) inputs are used in the determination of fair values that the Company has classified within Level 3. Consequently, these values and the related gains and losses are based upon both observable and unobservable inputs. The Company’s fixed maturities included in Level 3 are classified as such because these securities are primarily within illiquid markets and/or priced by independent brokers.

F-23

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

The following tables present assets and (liabilities) carried at fair value by hierarchy level.
 
December 31, 2015
 
Total
Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
for Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
Assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
 
 
 
 
Fixed maturities, AFS
 
 
 
 
Asset backed securities ("ABS")
$
2,499

$

$
2,462

$
37

Collateralized debt obligations ("CDOs")
3,038


2,497

541

Commercial mortgage-backed securities ("CMBS")
4,717


4,567

150

Corporate
26,802


25,948

854

Foreign government/government agencies
1,308


1,248

60

Municipal
12,121


12,072

49

Residential mortgage-backed securities ("RMBS")
4,046


2,424

1,622

U.S. Treasuries
4,665

740

3,925


Total fixed maturities
59,196

740

55,143

3,313

Fixed maturities, FVO
503

2

485

16

Equity securities, trading [1]
11

11



Equity securities, AFS
1,121

874

154

93

Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives
21


21


Foreign exchange derivatives
15


15


Interest rate derivatives
(227
)

(227
)

GMWB hedging instruments
111


27

84

Macro hedge program
74



74

Other derivative contracts
7



7

Total derivative assets [2]
1


(164
)
165

Short-term investments
1,843

333

1,510


Limited partnerships and other alternative investments [3]
622


548

74

Reinsurance recoverable for GMWB
83



83

Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
79


79


Separate account assets [4]
118,174

78,110

39,559

505

Total assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
$
181,633

$
80,070

$
97,314

$
4,249

Liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
 

 

 

 

Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
 

 

 

 

GMWB
$
(262
)
$

$

$
(262
)
Equity linked notes
(26
)


(26
)
Total other policyholder funds and benefits payable
(288
)


(288
)
Derivative liabilities
 

 

 

 

Credit derivatives
(16
)

(16
)

Equity derivatives
41


41


Foreign exchange derivatives
(374
)

(374
)

Interest rate derivatives
(569
)

(547
)
(22
)
GMWB hedging instruments
47


(4
)
51

Macro hedge program
73



73

Total derivative liabilities [5]
(798
)

(900
)
102

Total liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
$
(1,086
)
$

$
(900
)
$
(186
)

F-24

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

 
December 31, 2014
 
Total
Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
for Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
Assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
 
 
 
 
Fixed maturities, AFS
 
 
 
 
ABS
$
2,472

$

$
2,350

$
122

CDOs
2,841


2,218

623

CMBS
4,415


4,131

284

Corporate
27,359


26,319

1,040

Foreign government/government agencies
1,636


1,577

59

Municipal
12,871


12,805

66

RMBS
3,918


2,637

1,281

U.S. Treasuries
3,872

106

3,766


Total fixed maturities
59,384

106

55,803

3,475

Fixed maturities, FVO
488


396

92

Equity securities, trading [1]
11

11



Equity securities, AFS
1,047

786

163

98

Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives
8


10

(2
)
Equity derivatives
3



3

Interest rate derivatives
129


113

16

GMWB hedging instruments
119


5

114

Macro hedge program
93



93

Other derivative contracts
12



12

Total derivative assets [2]
364


128

236

Short-term investments
4,883

349

4,534


Limited partnerships and other alternative investments [3]
770


581

189

Reinsurance recoverable for GMWB
56



56

Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
34


34


Separate account assets [4]
132,211

91,537

40,096

578

Total assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
$
199,248

$
92,789

$
101,735

$
4,724

Liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
 
 
 
 
Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
 
 
 
 
GMWB
$
(139
)
$

$

$
(139
)
Equity linked notes
(26
)


(26
)
Total other policyholder funds and benefits payable
(165
)


(165
)
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives
(16
)

(9
)
(7
)
Equity derivatives
28


25

3

Foreign exchange derivatives
(445
)

(445
)

Interest rate derivatives
(597
)

(574
)
(23
)
GMWB hedging instruments
55


(1
)
56

Macro hedge program
48



48

Total derivative liabilities [5]
(927
)

(1,004
)
77

Consumer notes [6]
(3
)


(3
)
Total liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
$
(1,095
)
$

$
(1,004
)
$
(91
)








F-25

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

[1]
Included in other investments on the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[2]
Includes OTC and OTC-cleared derivative instruments in a net positive fair value position after consideration of the accrued interest and impact of collateral posting requirements which may be imposed by agreements, clearing house rules and applicable law. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, $283 and $413, respectively, of cash collateral liability was netted against the derivative asset value in the Consolidated Balance Sheets and is excluded from the preceding table. See footnote 5 for derivative liabilities.
[3]
Represents hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value.
[4]
Approximately $1.8 billion and $2.5 billion of investment sales receivable, as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, are excluded from this disclosure requirement because they are trade receivables in the ordinary course of business where the carrying amount approximates fair value.
[5]
Includes OTC and OTC-cleared derivative instruments in a net negative fair market value position (derivative liability) after consideration of the accrued interest and impact of collateral posting requirements which may be imposed by agreements, clearing house rules and applicable law. In the following Level 3 roll-forward table in this Note 4, the derivative assets and liabilities are referred to as “freestanding derivatives” and are presented on a net basis.
[6]
Represents embedded derivatives associated with non-funding agreement-backed consumer equity linked notes.
Valuation Techniques, Procedures and Controls
The Company determines the fair values of certain financial assets and liabilities based on quoted market prices where available, and where prices represent a reasonable estimate of fair value. The Company also determines fair value based on future cash flows discounted at the appropriate current market rate. Fair values reflect adjustments for counterparty credit quality, the Company’s default spreads, liquidity, and where appropriate, risk margins on unobservable parameters.
The fair value process is monitored by the Valuation Committee, which is a cross-functional group of senior management within the Company that meets at least quarterly. The Valuation Committee is co-chaired by the Heads of Investment Operations and Accounting, and has representation from various investment sector professionals, accounting, operations, legal, compliance, and risk management. The purpose of the committee is to oversee the pricing policy and procedures by ensuring objective and reliable valuation practices and pricing of financial instruments, as well as addressing valuation issues and approving changes to valuation methodologies and pricing sources. There are also two working groups under the Valuation Committee, a Securities Fair Value Working Group (“Securities Working Group”) and a Derivatives Fair Value Working Group ("Derivatives Working Group"), which include various investment, operations, accounting and risk management professionals that meet monthly to review market data trends, pricing and trading statistics and results, and any proposed pricing methodology changes.
The Company also has an enterprise-wide Operational Risk Management function, led by the Chief Operational Risk Officer, which is responsible for establishing, maintaining and communicating the framework, principles and guidelines of the Company's operational risk management program. This includes model risk management which provides an independent review of the suitability, characteristics and reliability of model inputs, as well as an analysis of significant changes to current models.
Fixed Maturities, Equity Securities and Short-term Investments
The fair value of fixed maturities, equity securities, and short-term investments in an active and orderly market (e.g., not distressed or forced liquidation) are determined by management using a "waterfall" approach after considering the following pricing sources: quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities, prices from third-party pricing services, independent broker quotations, or internal matrix pricing processes. Typical inputs used by these pricing sources include, but are not limited to, benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, benchmark securities, bids, offers, and/or estimated cash flows, prepayment speeds, and default rates. Most fixed maturities do not trade daily. Based on the typical trading volumes and the lack of quoted market prices for fixed maturities, third-party pricing services utilize matrix pricing to derive security prices. Matrix pricing relies on securities' relationships to other benchmark quoted securities, which trade more frequently. Pricing services utilize recently reported trades of identical or similar securities making adjustments through the reporting date based on the preceding outlined available market observable information. If there are no recently reported trades, the third-party pricing services may develop a security price using expected future cash flows based upon collateral performance and discounted at an estimated market rate. Both matrix pricing and discounted cash flow techniques develop prices by factoring in the time value for cash flows and risk, including liquidity and credit.
Prices from third-party pricing services may be unavailable for securities that are rarely traded or are traded only in privately negotiated transactions. As a result, certain securities are priced via independent broker quotations which utilize inputs that may be difficult to corroborate with observable market based data. Additionally, the majority of these independent broker quotations are non-binding.
The Company utilizes an internally developed matrix pricing process for private placement securities for which the Company is unable to obtain a price from a third-party pricing service. The Company's process is similar to the third-party pricing services. The Company develops credit spreads each month using market based data for public securities adjusted for credit spread differentials between public and private securities which are obtained from a survey of multiple private placement brokers. The credit spreads determined through this survey approach are based upon the issuer’s financial strength and term to maturity, utilizing independent public security index and trade information and adjusting for the non-public nature of the securities. Credit spreads combined with risk-free rates are applied to contractual cash flows to develop a price.

F-26

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

The Securities Working Group performs ongoing analyses of the prices and credit spreads received from third parties to ensure that the prices represent a reasonable estimate of the fair value. This process involves quantitative and qualitative analysis and is overseen by investment and accounting professionals. As a part of these analyses, the Company considers trading volume, new issuance activity and other factors to determine whether the market activity is significantly different than normal activity in an active market, and if so, whether transactions may not be orderly considering the weight of available evidence. If the available evidence indicates that pricing is based upon transactions that are stale or not orderly, the Company places little, if any, weight on the transaction price and will estimate fair value utilizing an internal pricing model. In addition, the Company ensures that prices received from independent brokers represent a reasonable estimate of fair value through the use of internal and external cash flow models utilizing spreads, and when available, market indices. As a result of this analysis, if the Company determines that there is a more appropriate fair value based upon the available market data, the price received from the third party is adjusted accordingly and approved by the Valuation Committee.
The Company conducts other specific monitoring controls around pricing. Daily analyses identify price changes over 3% for fixed maturities and 5% for equity securities and trade prices for both debt and equity securities that differ over 3% to the current day's price. Weekly analyses identify prices that differ more than 5% from published bond prices of a corporate bond index. Monthly analyses identify price changes over 3%, prices that have not changed, and missing prices. Also on a monthly basis, a second source validation is performed on most sectors. Analyses are conducted by a dedicated pricing unit that follows up with trading and investment sector professionals and challenges prices with vendors when the estimated assumptions used differ from what the Company feels a market participant would use. Examples of other procedures performed include, but are not limited to, initial and on-going review of third-party pricing services’ methodologies, review of pricing statistics and trends, and back testing recent trades.
The Company has analyzed the third-party pricing services’ valuation methodologies and related inputs, and has also evaluated the various types of securities in its investment portfolio to determine an appropriate fair value hierarchy level based upon trading activity and the observability of market inputs. Most prices provided by third-party pricing services are classified into Level 2 because the inputs used in pricing the securities are observable. Due to the lack of transparency in the process that brokers use to develop prices, most valuations that are based on brokers’ prices are classified as Level 3. Some valuations may be classified as Level 2 if the price can be corroborated with observable market data.
Derivative Instruments, including Embedded Derivatives within Investments
Derivative instruments are fair valued using pricing valuation models for OTC derivatives that utilize independent market data inputs, quoted market prices for exchange-traded and OTC-cleared derivatives, or independent broker quotations. Excluding embedded and reinsurance related derivatives, as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, 96% and 96%, respectively, of derivatives, based upon notional values, were priced by valuation models, including discounted cash flow models and option-pricing models that utilize present value techniques, or quoted market prices. The remaining derivatives were priced by broker quotations.
The Derivatives Working Group performs ongoing analyses of the valuations, assumptions and methodologies used to ensure that the prices represent a reasonable estimate of the fair value. The Company performs various controls on derivative valuations which include both quantitative and qualitative analyses. Analyses are conducted by a dedicated derivative pricing team that works directly with investment sector professionals to analyze impacts of changes in the market environment and investigate variances. On a daily basis, market valuations are compared to counterparty valuations for OTC derivatives. There are monthly analyses to identify market value changes greater than pre-defined thresholds, stale prices, missing prices, and zero prices. Also on a monthly basis, a second source validation, typically to broker quotations, is performed for certain of the more complex derivatives and all new deals during the month. A model validation review is performed on any new models, which typically includes detailed documentation and validation to a second source. The model validation documentation and results of validation are presented to the Valuation Committee for approval. There is a monthly control to review changes in pricing sources to ensure that new models are not moved to production until formally approved.
The Company utilizes derivative instruments to manage the risk associated with certain assets and liabilities. However, the derivative instrument may not be classified with the same fair value hierarchy level as the associated assets and liabilities. Therefore, the realized and unrealized gains and losses on derivatives reported in the Level 3 rollforward may be offset by realized and unrealized gains and losses of the associated assets and liabilities in other line items of the financial statements.

F-27

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Limited Partnerships and Other Alternative Investments
The portion of limited partnerships and other alternative investments recorded at fair value includes hedge funds for which investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value. Fair value is determined for these funds using the NAV, as a practical expedient, calculated on a monthly basis, and is the amount at which a unit or shareholder may redeem their investment, if redemption is allowed. Certain impediments to redemption include, but are not limited to the following: 1) redemption notice periods vary and may be as long as 90 days, 2) redemption may be restricted (e.g. only be allowed on a quarter-end), 3) a holding period referred to as a lock-up may be imposed whereby an investor must hold their investment for a specified period of time before they can make a notice for redemption, 4) gating provisions may limit all redemptions in a given period to a percentage of the entities' equity interests, or may only allow an investor to redeem a portion of their investment at one time and 5) early redemption penalties may be imposed that are expressed as a percentage of the amount redeemed. The Company regularly assesses impediments to redemption and current market conditions that will restrict the redemption at the end of the notice period. Any funds that are subject to significant liquidity restrictions are reported in Level 3; all others are classified as Level 2.
Valuation Inputs for Investments
For Level 1 investments, which are comprised of on-the-run U.S. Treasuries, money market funds, exchange-traded equity securities, open-ended mutual funds, short-term investments, and exchange traded futures and option contracts, valuations are based on quoted prices for identical assets in active markets that the Company has the ability to access at the measurement date.
For the Company’s Level 2 and 3 debt securities, typical inputs used by pricing techniques include, but are not limited to, benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, benchmark securities, bids, offers, and/or estimated cash flows, prepayment speeds, and default rates. Derivative instruments are valued using mid-market inputs that are predominantly observable in the market.
A description of additional inputs used in the Company’s Level 2 and Level 3 measurements is included in the following discussion:
Level 2
The fair values of most of the Company’s Level 2 investments are determined by management after considering prices received from third party pricing services. These investments include most fixed maturities and preferred stocks, including those reported in separate account assets, as well as, certain hedge funds and derivative instruments.
ABS, CDOs, CMBS and RMBS – Primary inputs also include monthly payment information, collateral performance, which varies by vintage year and includes delinquency rates, collateral valuation loss severity rates, collateral refinancing assumptions, and credit default swap indices. ABS and RMBS prices also include estimates of the rate of future principal prepayments over the remaining life of the securities. These estimates are derived based on the characteristics of the underlying structure and prepayment speeds previously experienced at the interest rate levels projected for the underlying collateral.
Corporates, including investment grade private placements – Primary inputs also include observations of credit default swap curves related to the issuer.
Foreign government/government agencies – Primary inputs also include observations of credit default swap curves related to the issuer and political events in emerging market economies.
Municipals – Primary inputs also include Municipal Securities Rulemaking Board reported trades and material event notices, and issuer financial statements.
Short-term investments – Primary inputs also include material event notices and new issue money market rates.
Credit derivatives – Primary inputs include the swap yield curve and credit default swap curves.
Foreign exchange derivatives – Primary inputs include the swap yield curve, currency spot and forward rates, and cross currency basis curves.
Interest rate derivatives – Primary input is the swap yield curve.
Equity derivatives – Primary inputs include equity index levels.
Limited partnerships and other alternative investments – Primary inputs include a NAV for investment companies with no redemption restrictions as reported on their U.S. GAAP financial statements, which are generally on a one-month delay.

F-28

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Level 3
Most of the Company's securities classified as Level 3 include less liquid securities such as lower quality ABS, CMBS, commercial real estate ("CRE") CDOs and RMBS primarily backed by sub-prime loans. Also included in Level 3 are securities valued based on broker prices or broker spreads, without adjustments. Primary inputs for non-broker priced investments, including structured securities, are consistent with the typical inputs used in the preceding noted Level 2 measurements, but are Level 3 due to their less liquid markets. Additionally, certain long-dated securities are priced based on third party pricing services, including certain municipal securities, foreign government/government agency securities, and bank loans. Primary inputs for these long-dated securities are consistent with the typical inputs used in the preceding noted Level 1 and Level 2 measurements, but include benchmark interest rate or credit spread assumptions that are not observable in the marketplace. Significant inputs for Level 3 derivative contracts primarily include the typical inputs used in the preceding noted Level 1 and Level 2 measurements; but also include equity and interest rate volatility and swap yield curves beyond observable limits, and commodity price curves.
Level 3 investments also include hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value where the Company does not have the ability to redeem the investment in the near-term at the NAV. Also included in Level 3 are certain derivative instruments that either have significant unobservable inputs or are valued based on broker quotations.
Transfers between Levels
Transfers of securities among the levels occur at the beginning of the reporting period. The amount of transfers from Level 1 to Level 2 was $1.9 billion and $2.5 billion, for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, which represented previously on-the-run U.S. Treasury securities that are now off-the-run. For the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, there were no transfers from Level 2 to Level 1. See the fair value roll-forward tables for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, for the transfers into and out of Level 3.

F-29

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Significant Unobservable Inputs for Level 3 Assets Measured at Fair Value
The following tables present information about significant unobservable inputs used in Level 3 assets measured at fair value. The tables exclude ABS, CRE CDOs, index options and certain corporate securities for which fair values are predominately based on broker quotations.
 
As of December 31, 2015
Securities
 
 
 
Unobservable Inputs
 
Assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
Fair
Value
Predominant
Valuation
Technique
Significant Unobservable Input
Minimum
Maximum
Weighted Average [1]
Impact of
Increase in Input
on Fair Value [2]
CMBS [3]
$
122

Discounted cash flows
Spread (encompasses prepayment, default risk and loss severity)
31 bps
1,505 bps
266 bps
Decrease
Corporate [3]
339

Discounted cash flows
Spread
63 bps
800 bps
306 bps
Decrease
Municipal [3]
31

Discounted cash flows
Spread
193 bps
193 bps
193 bps
Decrease
RMBS
1,622

Discounted cash flows
Spread
30 bps
1,696 bps
178 bps
Decrease
 
 
 
Constant prepayment rate
—%
20.0%
2.0%
 Decrease [4]
 
 
 
Constant default rate
1.0%
10.0%
6.0%
Decrease
 
 
 
Loss severity
—%
100.0%
78.0%
Decrease
 
As of December 31, 2014
CMBS
$
284

Discounted cash flows
Spread (encompasses prepayment, default risk and loss severity)
46
 bps
2,475
 bps
284
 bps
Decrease
Corporate [3]
568

Discounted cash flows
Spread
123
 bps
765
 bps
279
 bps
Decrease
Municipal [3]
32

Discounted cash flows
Spread
212
 bps
212
 bps
212
 bps
Decrease
RMBS
1,281

Discounted cash flows
Spread
23
 bps
1,904
 bps
142
 bps
Decrease
 
 
 
Constant prepayment rate
—%
7.0%
2.0%
Decrease [4]
 
 
 
Constant default rate
1.0%
14.0%
7.0%
Decrease
 
 
 
Loss severity
—%
100.0%
78.0%
Decrease
[1]
The weighted average is determined based on the fair value of the securities.
[2]
Conversely, the impact of a decrease in input would have the opposite impact to the fair value as that presented in the table.
[3]
Level 3 CMBS, corporate and municipal securities excludes those for which the Company bases fair value on broker quotations as noted in the following discussion.
[4]
Decrease for above market rate coupons and increase for below market rate coupons.

F-30

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

 
As of December 31, 2015
Freestanding Derivatives
 
 
 
Unobservable Inputs
 
  
Fair
Value
Predominant Valuation
Technique
Significant
Unobservable Input
Minimum
Maximum
Impact of Increase in Input on Fair Value [1]
Interest rate derivative
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
(30
)
Discounted cash flows
Swap curve beyond 30 years
3
%
3
%
Decrease
Interest rate swaptions [2]
8

Option model
Interest rate volatility
1
%
2
%
Increase
GMWB hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity variance swaps
(31
)
Option model
Equity volatility
19
%
21
%
Increase
Equity options
35

Option model
Equity volatility
27
%
29
%
Increase
Customized swaps
131

Discounted cash flows
Equity volatility
10
%
40
%
Increase
Macro hedge program [3]
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity options
179

Option model
Equity volatility
14
%
28
%
Increase
 
As of December 31, 2014
Interest rate derivative
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
(29
)
Discounted cash flows
Swap curve beyond 30 years
3
%
3
%
Decrease
Interest rate swaptions
22

Option model
Interest rate volatility
1
%
1
%
Increase
GMWB hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity options
46

Option model
Equity volatility
22
%
34
%
Increase
Customized swaps
124

Discounted cash flows
Equity volatility
10
%
40
%
Increase
Macro hedge program
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity options
141

Option model
Equity volatility
27
%
28
%
Increase
[1]
Conversely, the impact of a decrease in input would have the opposite impact to the fair value as that presented in the table. Changes are based on long positions, unless otherwise noted. Changes in fair value will be inversely impacted for short positions.
[2]
The swaptions presented are purchased options that have the right to enter into a pay-fixed swap.
[3]
Level 3 macro hedge derivatives excludes those for which the Company bases fair value on broker quotations as noted in the following discussion.
Securities and derivatives for which the Company bases fair value on broker quotations predominately include ABS, CDOs, index options and corporate. Due to the lack of transparency in the process brokers use to develop prices for these investments, the Company does not have access to the significant unobservable inputs brokers use to price these securities and derivatives. The Company believes however, the types of inputs brokers may use would likely be similar to those used to price securities and derivatives for which inputs are available to the Company, and therefore may include but not be limited to, loss severity rates, constant prepayment rates, constant default rates and credit spreads. Therefore, similar to non broker priced securities and derivatives, generally, increases in these inputs would cause fair values to decrease. For the year ended December 31, 2015, no significant adjustments were made by the Company to broker prices received.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, excluded from the preceding tables are hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value which total $74 and $189, respectively, of Level 3 assets. The predominant valuation method uses a NAV calculated on a monthly basis and represents funds where the Company does not have the ability to redeem the investment in the near-term at that NAV, including an assessment of the investee's liquidity.

F-31

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Product Derivatives
The Company formerly offered certain variable annuity products with GMWB riders. The GMWB provides the policyholder with a guaranteed remaining balance ("GRB") which is generally equal to premiums less withdrawals. Certain contract provisions can increase the GRB at contractholder election or after the passage of time. If the policyholder’s account value is reduced to a specified level through a combination of market declines and withdrawals but the GRB still has value, the Company is obligated to continue to make annuity payments to the policyholder until the GRB is exhausted. The non-life contingent GMWB represents an embedded derivative in the variable annuity contract. When it is determined that (1) the embedded derivative possesses economic characteristics that are not clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the host contract, and (2) a separate instrument with the same terms would qualify as a derivative instrument, the embedded derivative is bifurcated from the host for measurement purposes. The embedded derivative is carried at fair value, with changes in fair value reported in net realized capital gains and losses. The Company’s non-life contingent GMWB liability is reported in other policyholder funds and benefits payable in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. The notional value of the embedded derivative is the GRB.
In valuing the embedded derivative, the Company attributes to the derivative a portion of the expected fees to be collected over the expected life of the contract from the contract holder equal to the present value of future GMWB claims. The excess of fees collected from the contract holder in the current period over the current period’s attributed fees are associated with the host variable annuity contract and reported in fee income.
GMWB Reinsurance Derivative
The Company has reinsurance arrangements in place to transfer a portion of its risk of loss due to GMWB. These arrangements are recognized as derivatives and carried at fair value in reinsurance recoverables. Changes in the fair value of the reinsurance agreements are reported in net realized capital gains and losses.
The fair value of the GMWB reinsurance derivative is calculated as an aggregation of the components described in the following Living Benefits Required to be Fair Valued discussion and is modeled using significant unobservable policyholder behavior inputs, identical to those used in calculating the underlying liability, such as lapses, fund selection, resets and withdrawal utilization and risk margins.
Living Benefits Required to be Fair Valued (in Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable)
Fair values for GMWBs classified as embedded derivatives are calculated using the income approach based upon internally developed models because active, observable markets do not exist for those items. The fair value of these GMWBs and the related reinsurance and customized freestanding derivatives are calculated as an aggregation of the following components: Best Estimate Claim Payments; Credit Standing Adjustment; and Margins. The resulting aggregation is reconciled or calibrated, if necessary, to market information that is, or may be, available to the Company, but may not be observable by other market participants, including reinsurance discussions and transactions. The Company believes the aggregation of these components, as necessary and as reconciled or calibrated to the market information available to the Company, results in an amount that the Company would be required to transfer to or receive from market participants in an active liquid market, if one existed, for those market participants to assume the risks associated with the guaranteed minimum benefits and the related reinsurance and customized derivatives. The fair value is likely to materially diverge from the ultimate settlement of the liability as the Company believes settlement will be based on our best estimate assumptions rather than those best estimate assumptions plus risk margins. In the absence of any transfer of the guaranteed benefit liability to a third party, the release of risk margins is likely to be reflected as realized gains in future periods’ net income. Each component described in the following discussion is unobservable in the marketplace and requires subjectivity by the Company in determining its value. Oversight of the Company's valuation policies and processes for product and GMWB reinsurance derivatives is performed by a multidisciplinary group comprised of finance, actuarial and risk management professionals. This multidisciplinary group reviews and approves changes and enhancements to the Company's valuation model as well as associated controls.
Best Estimate Claim Payments
The Best Estimate Claim Payments are calculated based on actuarial and capital market assumptions related to projected cash flows, including the present value of benefits and related contract charges, over the lives of the contracts, incorporating expectations concerning policyholder behavior such as lapses, fund selection, resets and withdrawal utilization. For the customized derivatives, policyholder behavior is prescribed in the derivative contract. Because of the dynamic and complex nature of these cash flows, best estimate assumptions and a Monte Carlo stochastic process is used in valuation. The Monte Carlo stochastic process involves the generation of thousands of scenarios that assume risk neutral returns consistent with swap rates and a blend of observable implied index volatility levels. Estimating these cash flows involves numerous estimates and subjective judgments regarding a number of variables. These variables include expected market rates of return, market volatility, correlations of market index returns to funds, fund performance, discount rates, and assumptions about policyholder behavior which emerge over time.

F-32

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

At each valuation date, the Company assumes expected returns based on:
risk-free rates as represented by the Eurodollar futures, LIBOR deposits and swap rates to derive forward curve rates;
market implied volatility assumptions for each underlying index based primarily on a blend of observed market implied volatility data;
correlations of historical returns across underlying well known market indices based on actual observed returns over the ten years preceding the valuation date; and
three years of history for fund indexes compared to separate account fund regression.
On a daily basis, the Company updates capital market assumptions used in the GMWB liability model such as interest rates, equity indices and the blend of implied equity index volatilities. The Company monitors various aspects of policyholder behavior and may modify certain of its assumptions, including living benefit lapses and withdrawal rates, if credible emerging data indicates that changes are warranted. In addition, the Company will continue to evaluate policyholder behavior assumptions should we implement initiatives to reduce the size of the variable annuity business. At a minimum, all policyholder behavior assumptions are reviewed and updated, as appropriate, in conjunction with the completion of the Company’s annual comprehensive study to refine its estimate of future gross profits.
Credit Standing Adjustment
This assumption makes an adjustment that market participants would make, in determining fair value, to reflect the risk that guaranteed benefit obligations, or the GMWB reinsurance recoverables will not be fulfilled. The Company incorporates a blend of observable Company and reinsurer credit default spreads from capital markets, adjusted for market recoverability. The credit standing adjustment assumption, net of reinsurance, resulted in pre-tax realized gains (losses) of $(2), $3 and $(13), for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the credit standing adjustment was $0 and $1, respectively.
Margins
The behavior risk margin adds a margin that market participants would require, in determining fair value, for the risk that the Company’s assumptions about policyholder behavior could differ from actual experience. The behavior risk margin is calculated by taking the difference between adverse policyholder behavior assumptions and best estimate assumptions.
Assumption updates, including policyholder behavior assumptions, affected best estimates and margins for total pre-tax realized gains (losses) of $(42), $31 and $75 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the behavior risk margin was $45 and $74, respectively.
In addition to the non-market-based update described in the preceding discussion, the Company recognized non-market-based updates driven by the relative outperformance (underperformance) of the underlying actively managed funds as compared to their respective indices resulting in pre-tax realized gains (losses) of approximately $(18), $5 and $33 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
The following table provides quantitative information about the significant unobservable inputs and is applicable to all of the GMWB embedded derivative and the GMWB reinsurance derivative for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014.
Significant Unobservable Input
Unobservable Inputs (Minimum)
Unobservable Inputs (Maximum)
Impact of Increase in Input
on Fair Value Measurement [1]
Withdrawal Utilization [2]
20%
100%
Increase
Withdrawal Rates [3]
—%
8%
Increase
Lapse Rates [4]
—%
75%
Decrease
Reset Elections [5]
20%
75%
Increase
Equity Volatility [6]
10%
40%
Increase
[1]
Conversely, the impact of a decrease in input would have the opposite impact to the fair value as that presented in the table.
[2]
Range represents assumed cumulative percentages of policyholders taking withdrawals.
[3]
Range represents assumed cumulative annual amount withdrawn by policyholders.
[4]
Range represents assumed annual percentages of full surrender of the underlying variable annuity contracts across all policy durations for in force business.
[5]
Range represents assumed cumulative percentages of policyholders that would elect to reset their guaranteed benefit base.
[6]
Range represents implied market volatilities for equity indices based on multiple pricing sources.

F-33

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Generally a change in withdrawal utilization assumptions would be accompanied by a directionally opposite change in lapse rate assumptions, as the behavior of policyholders that utilize GMWB riders is typically different from policyholders that do not utilize these riders.
Separate Account Assets
Separate account assets are primarily invested in mutual funds. Other separate account assets include fixed maturities, limited partnerships, equity securities, short-term investments, and derivatives that are valued in the same manner, and using the same pricing sources and inputs, as those investments held by the Company. Separate account assets classified as Level 3 primarily include limited partnerships in which fair value represents the separate account's share of the fair value of the equity in the investment ("net asset value") and are classified in Level 3, based on the Company's inability to redeem its investment.
Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
The following tables provide fair value roll-forwards for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, for the financial instruments classified as Level 3.
For the year ended December 31, 2015
 
Fixed Maturities, AFS
 
Assets
ABS
CDOs
CMBS
Corporate
Foreign
Govt./Govt.
Agencies
Municipal
RMBS
Total Fixed
Maturities,
AFS
Fixed
Maturities,
FVO
Fair value as of January 1, 2015
$
122

$
623

$
284

$
1,040

$
59

$
66

$
1,281

$
3,475

$
92

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
1

(5
)
1

(22
)

1

(3
)
(27
)
(8
)
Included in OCI [3]
(2
)
6

(14
)
(60
)
(5
)
(5
)
(7
)
(87
)
(1
)
Purchases
99


47

109

27


754

1,036

25

Settlements
(9
)
(36
)
(72
)
(74
)
(4
)
(13
)
(207
)
(415
)
(24
)
Sales
(16
)

(6
)
(111
)
(28
)

(172
)
(333
)
(54
)
Transfers into Level 3 [4]
1


7

233

11


47

299

1

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]
(159
)
(47
)
(97
)
(261
)


(71
)
(635
)
(15
)
Fair value as of December 31, 2015
$
37

$
541

$
150

$
854

$
60

$
49

$
1,622

$
3,313

$
16

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2015 [2] [7]
$
1

$
(5
)
$
1

$
(21
)
$

$
1

$
(3
)
$
(26
)
$
(4
)

F-34

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

 
 
Freestanding Derivatives [5]
Assets (Liabilities)
Equity
Securities,
AFS
Credit
Commodity
Equity
Interest
Rate
GMWB
Hedging
Macro
Hedge
Program
Other
Contracts
Total Free-
Standing
Derivatives [5]
Fair value as of January 1, 2015
$
98

$
(9
)
$

$
6

$
(7
)
$
170

$
141

$
12

$
313

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]

(1
)
(4
)
9

(10
)
(16
)
(41
)
(5
)
(68
)
Included in OCI [3]









Purchases
23

(13
)




47


34

Settlements


(6
)
(15
)
(5
)
(19
)


(45
)
Sales
(23
)








Transfers into Level 3 [4]


10






10

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]
(5
)
23







23

Fair value as of December 31, 2015
$
93

$

$

$

$
(22
)
$
135

$
147

$
7

$
267

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2015 [2] [7]
$

$

$

$

$
(3
)
$
(5
)
$
(34
)
$
(4
)
$
(46
)
Assets
Limited Partnerships and Other Alternative Investments
Reinsurance 
Recoverable
for GMWB
Separate Accounts
Fair value as of January 1, 2015
$
189

$
56

$
578

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
(19
)
9

12

Included in OCI [3]


(5
)
Purchases
55


394

Settlements

18

(19
)
Sales
(20
)

(265
)
Transfers into Level 3 [4]


12

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]
(131
)

(202
)
Fair value as of December 31, 2015
$
74

$
83

$
505

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2015 [2] [7]
$
(19
)
$
9

$
11


F-35

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

 
Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable
 
Liabilities
Guaranteed
Withdrawal
Benefits
Equity
Linked
Notes
Consumer
Notes
Fair value as of January 1, 2015
$
(139
)
$
(26
)
$
(3
)
Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
(59
)

3

Settlements
(64
)


Fair value as of December 31, 2015
$
(262
)
$
(26
)
$

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2015 [2] [7]
$
(59
)
$

$
3

For the year ended December 31, 2014
 
Fixed Maturities, AFS
 
Assets
ABS
CDOs
CMBS
Corporate
Foreign
Govt./Govt.
Agencies
Municipal
RMBS
Total Fixed
Maturities,
AFS
Fixed
Maturities,
FVO
Fair value as of January 1, 2014
$
147

$
664

$
663

$
1,274

$
65

$
69

$
1,272

$
4,154

$
193

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]

12

28

(24
)
(2
)

11

25

19

Included in OCI [3]
3

(4
)
(27
)
10

9

7

12

10


Purchases
72

48

126

145

15

16

494

916

16

Settlements
(3
)
(60
)
(253
)
(46
)
(4
)

(193
)
(559
)
(136
)
Sales
(18
)
(12
)
(123
)
(205
)
(24
)
(1
)
(260
)
(643
)
(4
)
Transfers into Level 3 [4]
75

72

17

255




419

6

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]
(154
)
(97
)
(147
)
(369
)

(25
)
(55
)
(847
)
(2
)
Fair value as of December 31, 2014
$
122

$
623

$
284

$
1,040

$
59

$
66

$
1,281

$
3,475

$
92

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2014 [2] [7]
$

$

$
(3
)
$
(15
)
$
(2
)
$

$
(1
)
$
(21
)
$
16


F-36

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

 
 
Freestanding Derivatives [5]
Assets (Liabilities)
Equity
Securities,
AFS
Credit
Foreign Exchange contracts
Equity
Interest
Rate
GMWB
Hedging
Macro
Hedge
Program
Intl.
Program
Hedging
Other
Contracts
Total Free-
Standing
Derivatives [5]
Fair value as of January 1, 2014
$
77

$
2

$

$
3

$
18

$
146

$
139

$
(29
)
$
17

$
296

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
3

(4
)
2

3

(42
)
13

(12
)
28

(5
)
(17
)
Included in OCI [3]
2










Purchases
30

(7
)


19

4

14

9


39

Settlements





7


(41
)

(34
)
Sales
(14
)









Transfers into Level 3 [4]


(2
)






(2
)
Transfers out of Level 3 [4]




(2
)


33


31

Fair value as of December 31, 2014
$
98

$
(9
)
$

$
6

$
(7
)
$
170

$
141

$

$
12

$
313

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2014 [2] [7]
$
(2
)
$
(4
)
$

$
1

$
(43
)
$
(1
)
$
(11
)
$
(18
)
$
(3
)
$
(79
)
Assets
Limited Partnerships and Other Alternative Investments
Reinsurance 
Recoverable
for GMWB
Separate Accounts
Fair value as of January 1, 2014
$
108

$
29

$
737

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
1

4

13

Purchases
130


339

Settlements

23

(3
)
Sales
(24
)

(201
)
Transfers into Level 3 [4]
53


37

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]
(79
)

(344
)
Fair value as of December 31, 2014
$
189

$
56

$
578

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2014 [2] [7]
$
1

$
4

$
8


F-37

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

 
Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable
 
Liabilities
Guaranteed
Withdrawal
Benefits
International
Guaranteed
Living
Benefits
International
Other Living
Benefits
Equity
Linked
Notes
Total Other
Policyholder
Funds and
Benefits
Payable
Consumer
Notes
Fair value as of January 1, 2014
$
(36
)
$
3

$
3

$
(18
)
$
(48
)
$
(2
)
Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
(2
)


(8
)
(10
)
(1
)
Settlements
(101
)
(3
)
(3
)

(107
)

Fair value as of December 31, 2014
$
(139
)
$

$

$
(26
)
$
(165
)
$
(3
)
Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2014 [2] [7]
$
(2
)
$

$

$
(8
)
$
(10
)
$
(1
)
[1]
The Company classifies gains and losses on GMWB reinsurance derivatives and GMWB embedded derivatives as unrealized gains (losses) for purposes of disclosure in this table because it is impracticable to track on a contract-by-contract basis the realized gains (losses) for these reinsurance derivatives and embedded derivatives.
[2]
All amounts in these rows are reported in net realized capital gains (losses). The realized/unrealized gains (losses) included in net income for separate account assets are offset by an equal amount for separate account liabilities, which results in a net zero impact on net income for the Company. All amounts are before income taxes and amortization of DAC.
[3]
All amounts are before income taxes and amortization of DAC.
[4]
Transfers in and/or (out) of Level 3 are primarily attributable to the availability of market observable information, the re-evaluation of the observability of pricing inputs and liquidity restrictions.
[5]
Derivative instruments are reported in this table on a net basis for asset (liability) positions and reported in the Consolidated Balance Sheets in other investments and other liabilities.
[6]
Includes both market and non-market impacts in deriving realized and unrealized gains (losses).
[7]
Amounts presented are for Level 3 only and therefore may not agree to other disclosures included herein.
Fair Value Option
FVO investments include certain securities that contain embedded credit derivatives with underlying credit risk primarily related to residential and commercial real estate, for which the company has elected the fair value option. The Company also classifies the underlying fixed maturities held in certain consolidated investment funds within the Fixed Maturities, FVO line on the Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company reports these consolidated investment companies at fair value with changes in the fair value of these securities recognized in net realized capital gains and losses, which is consistent with accounting requirements for investment companies. The investment funds hold fixed income securities in multiple sectors and the Company has management and control of the funds as well as a significant ownership interest.
The Company also elected the fair value option for certain equity securities in order to align the accounting with total return swap contracts that hedge the risk associated with the investments. The swaps do not qualify for hedge accounting and the change in value of both the equity securities and the total return swaps are recorded in net realized capital gains and losses. These equity securities are classified within equity securities, AFS on the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Income earned from FVO securities is recorded in net investment income and changes in fair value are recorded in net realized capital gains and losses.

F-38

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

The following table presents the changes in fair value of those assets and liabilities accounted for using the fair value option reported in net realized capital gains and losses in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Operations.
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
Assets
 
 
Fixed maturities, FVO
 
 
Corporate
$
(7
)
$
(3
)
CDOs
1

18

Foreign government
2


RMBS

(1
)
Total fixed maturities, FVO
$
(4
)
$
14

Equity, FVO
(12
)
(3
)
Total realized capital gains (losses)
$
(16
)
$
11

The following table presents the fair value of assets and liabilities accounted for using the fair value option included in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.
 
As of December 31,
 
2015
2014
Assets
 
 
Fixed maturities, FVO
 
 
ABS
$
13

$
15

CDOs
6

69

CMBS
24

22

Corporate
87

133

Foreign government
2

30

U.S. government
3

2

Municipals

2

RMBS
368

215

Total fixed maturities, FVO
$
503

$
488

Equity, FVO [1]
$
282

$
348

[1] Included in equity securities, AFS on the Consolidated Balance Sheets.

F-39

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Financial Instruments Not Carried at Fair Value
The following table presents carrying amounts and fair values of the Company’s financial instruments not carried at fair value.
 
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Fair Value Hierarchy Level
Carrying Amount
Fair Value
Carrying Amount
Fair Value
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
Policy loans
Level 3
$
1,447

$
1,447

$
1,431

$
1,431

Mortgage loans
Level 3
5,624

5,736

5,556

5,840

Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Other policyholder funds and benefits payable [1]
Level 3
$
6,706

$
6,898

$
7,304

$
7,522

Senior notes [2]
Level 2
4,259

4,811

5,009

5,837

Junior subordinated debentures [2]
Level 2
1,100

1,304

1,100

1,291

Consumer notes [3] [4]
Level 3
38

38

68

68

Assumed investment contracts [4]
Level 3
619

682

763

851

[1]
Excludes guarantees on variable annuities, group accident and health contracts and universal life insurance contracts, including corporate owned life insurance.
[2]
Included in long-term debt in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, except for current maturities, which are included in short-term debt.
[3]
Excludes amounts carried at fair value and included in preceding disclosures.
[4]
Included in other liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
Fair values for policy loans were determined using current loan coupon rates, which reflect the current rates available under the contracts. As a result, the fair value approximates the carrying value of the policy loans.
Fair values for mortgage loans were estimated using discounted cash flow calculations based on current lending rates for similar type loans. Current lending rates reflect changes in credit spreads and the remaining terms of the loans.
Fair values for other policyholder funds and benefits payable and assumed investment contracts, not carried at fair value, are estimated based on the cash surrender values of the underlying policies or by estimating future cash flows discounted at current interest rates adjusted for credit risk.
Fair values for senior notes and junior subordinated debentures are determined using the market approach based on reported trades, benchmark interest rates and issuer spread for the Company which may consider credit default swaps.
Fair values for consumer notes were estimated using discounted cash flow calculations using current interest rates adjusted for estimated loan durations.

F-40

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Reinsurance

The Company cedes insurance to affiliated and unaffiliated insurers to enable the Company to manage capital and risk exposure. Such arrangements do not relieve the Company of its primary liability to policyholders. Failure of reinsurers to honor their obligations could result in losses to the Company. The Company's procedures include careful initial selection of its reinsurers, structuring agreements to provide collateral funds where necessary, and regularly monitoring the financial condition and ratings of its reinsurers. The Company has ceded reinsurance in connection with the sales of its Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses in 2013 to MassMutual and Prudential, respectively.
Reinsurance Recoverables
Reinsurance recoverables include balances due from reinsurance companies and are presented net of an allowance for uncollectible reinsurance. Reinsurance recoverables include an estimate of the amount of gross losses and loss adjustment expense reserves that may be ceded under the terms of the reinsurance agreements, including incurred but not reported unpaid losses. The Company’s estimate of losses and loss adjustment expense reserves ceded to reinsurers is based on assumptions that are consistent with those used in establishing the gross reserves for business ceded to the reinsurance contracts. The Company calculates its ceded reinsurance projection based on the terms of any applicable facultative and treaty reinsurance, including an estimate of how incurred but not reported losses will ultimately be ceded under reinsurance agreements. Accordingly, the Company’s estimate of reinsurance recoverables is subject to similar risks and uncertainties as the estimate of the gross reserve for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses.
The Company's reinsurance recoverables are summarized as follows:
 
As of
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Property and Casualty Insurance Products:
 
 
Paid loss and loss adjustment expenses
$
119

$
133

Unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses
2,662

2,868

Gross reinsurance recoverables
2,781

3,001

Allowance for uncollectible reinsurance
(266
)
(271
)
Net reinsurance recoverables
$
2,515

$
2,730

Life Insurance Products:
 
 
Future policy benefits and unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses and other policyholder funds and benefits payable
 
 
Sold businesses (MassMutual and Prudential)
$
19,369

$
18,997

Other reinsurers
1,305

1,193

Net reinsurance recoverables [1]
$
20,674

$
20,190

Reinsurance recoverables, net
$
23,189

$
22,920

[1]
No allowance for uncollectible reinsurance is required as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.
As of December 31, 2015, the Company has reinsurance recoverables from MassMutual and Prudential of $8.6 billion and $10.8 billion, respectively. As of December 31, 2014, the Company had reinsurance recoverables from MassMutual and Prudential of $8.6 billion and $10.4 billion, respectively. The Company's obligations to its direct policyholders that have been reinsured to MassMutual and Prudential are secured by invested assets held in trust. Net of invested assets held in trust, as of December 31, 2015, the Company has no reinsurance-related concentrations of credit risk greater than 10% of the Company’s consolidated stockholders’ equity.
The allowance for uncollectible reinsurance reflects management’s best estimate of reinsurance cessions that may be uncollectible in the future due to reinsurers’ unwillingness or inability to pay. The Company analyzes recent developments in commutation activity between reinsurers and cedants, recent trends in arbitration and litigation outcomes in disputes between reinsurers and cedants and the overall credit quality of the Company’s reinsurers. Based on this analysis, the Company may adjust the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance or charge off reinsurer balances that are determined to be uncollectible. Where its contracts permit, the Company secures future claim obligations with various forms of collateral, including irrevocable letters of credit, secured trusts, funds held accounts and group-wide offsets.
Due to the inherent uncertainties as to collection and the length of time before reinsurance recoverables become due, it is possible that future adjustments to the Company’s reinsurance recoverables, net of the allowance, could be required, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated results of operations or cash flows in a particular quarter or annual period.

F-41

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Reinsurance (continued)

Insurance Revenues
The effect of reinsurance on property and casualty premiums written and earned is as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
Premiums Written
2015
2014
2013
Direct
$
10,861

$
10,571

$
10,564

Assumed
297

275

247

Ceded
(580
)
(602
)
(882
)
Net
$
10,578

$
10,244

$
9,929

Premiums Earned
 

 

 

Direct
$
10,704

$
10,531

$
10,494

Assumed
298

264

241

Ceded
(586
)
(699
)
(871
)
Net
$
10,416

$
10,096

$
9,864

The reduction in ceded premium for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014 were driven by the Company's decision to exit unprofitable programs, including captive programs where the Company ceded direct premiums to insured captive insurance companies. Ceded losses, which reduce losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred, were $336, $502, and $459 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, respectively.
The effect of reinsurance on life insurance earned premiums and fee income is as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Gross earned premiums, fees and other considerations
$
5,767

$
6,029

$
6,435

Reinsurance assumed
209

193

138

Reinsurance ceded
(1,707
)
(1,720
)
(1,780
)
Net earned premiums, fees and other considerations
$
4,269

$
4,502

$
4,793

The Company reinsures certain of its risks to other reinsurers under yearly renewable term, coinsurance, and modified coinsurance arrangements, and variations thereto. Yearly renewable term and coinsurance arrangements result in passing all or a portion of the risk to the reinsurer. Generally, the reinsurer receives a proportionate amount of the premiums less an allowance for commissions and expenses and is liable for a corresponding proportionate amount of all benefit payments. Modified coinsurance is similar to coinsurance except that the cash and investments that support the liabilities for contract benefits are not transferred to the assuming company, and settlements are made on a net basis between the companies.
The cost of reinsurance related to long-duration contracts is accounted for over the life of the underlying reinsured policies using assumptions consistent with those used to account for the underlying policies. Insurance recoveries on ceded reinsurance agreements, which reduce death and other benefits, were $1,111, $863, and $913 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, respectively.
In addition, the Company has reinsured a portion of the risk associated with variable annuities and the associated GMDB and GMWB riders.

F-42

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments

Net Investment Income (Loss)
 
For the years ended December 31,
(Before-tax)
2015
2014
2013
Fixed maturities [1]
$
2,409

$
2,420

$
2,552

Equity securities
25

38

30

Mortgage loans
267

265

260

Policy loans
82

80

83

Limited partnerships and other alternative investments
227

294

287

Other investments [2]
138

179

167

Investment expenses
(118
)
(122
)
(115
)
Total net investment income
$
3,030

$
3,154

$
3,264

[1]
Includes net investment income on short-term investments.
[2]
Includes income from derivatives that hedge fixed maturities and qualify for hedge accounting.
Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses)
 
For the years ended December 31,
(Before-tax)
2015
2014
2013
Gross gains on sales [1]
$
460

$
527

$
2,313

Gross losses on sales
(405
)
(250
)
(659
)
Net OTTI losses recognized in earnings
(102
)
(59
)
(73
)
Valuation allowances on mortgage loans
(5
)
(4
)
(1
)
Periodic net coupon settlements on credit derivatives
11

1

(8
)
Results of variable annuity hedge program
 
 


GMWB derivatives, net
(87
)
5

262

Macro hedge program
(46
)
(11
)
(234
)
Total results of variable annuity hedge program
(133
)
(6
)
28

Other, net [2]
18

(193
)
198

Net realized capital gains (losses)
$
(156
)
$
16

$
1,798

[1]
Includes $1.5 billion of gains relating to the sales of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses in the year ended December 31, 2013.
[2]
Primarily consists of changes in the value of non-qualifying derivatives, transactional foreign currency revaluation gains (losses) on yen denominated fixed payout annuity liabilities and gains (losses) on non-qualifying derivatives used to hedge the foreign currency exposure of the liabilities. For the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, gains (losses) from transactional foreign currency revaluation of the yen denominated fixed payout annuity liabilities were $4, $116, and $250, respectively. For the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, gains (losses) on instruments used to hedge the foreign currency exposure on the yen denominated fixed payout annuities were $(21), $(148), and $(268), respectively. Also includes gains of $71 relating to the sales of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses for the year ended December 31, 2013.
Net realized capital gains and losses from investment sales are reported as a component of revenues and are determined on a specific identification basis. Before tax, net gains and losses on sales and impairments previously reported as unrealized gains or losses in AOCI were $(32), $217, and $1.5 billion for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, respectively.

F-43

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Sales of Available-for-Sale Securities
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Fixed maturities, AFS
 
 
 
Sale proceeds
$
20,615

$
22,923

$
39,225

Gross gains [1]
372

456

2,143

Gross losses
(317
)
(182
)
(654
)
Equity securities, AFS
 
 
 
Sale proceeds
$
1,319

$
354

$
274

Gross gains
61

22

96

Gross losses
(46
)
(20
)
(20
)
[1]
Includes $1.5 billion of gross gains related to the sale of the Individual Life and Retirement Plans businesses for the year ended December 31, 2013.
Sales of AFS securities in 2015 were primarily a result of duration and liquidity management, as well as tactical changes to the portfolio as a result of changing market conditions.
Recognition and Presentation of Other-Than-Temporary Impairments
The Company deems bonds and certain equity securities with debt-like characteristics (collectively “debt securities”) to be other-than-temporarily impaired (“impaired”) if a security meets the following conditions: a) the Company intends to sell or it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before a recovery in value, or b) the Company does not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security. If the Company intends to sell or it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before a recovery in value, a charge is recorded in net realized capital losses equal to the difference between the fair value and amortized cost basis of the security. For those impaired debt securities which do not meet the first condition and for which the Company does not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis, the difference between the security’s amortized cost basis and the fair value is separated into the portion representing a credit OTTI, which is recorded in net realized capital losses, and the remaining non-credit impairment, which is recorded in OCI. Generally, the Company determines a security’s credit impairment as the difference between its amortized cost basis and its best estimate of expected future cash flows discounted at the security’s effective yield prior to impairment. The remaining non-credit impairment is the difference between the security’s fair value and the Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows discounted at the security’s effective yield prior to the impairment, which typically includes current market liquidity and risk premiums. The previous amortized cost basis less the impairment recognized in net realized capital losses becomes the security’s new cost basis. The Company accretes the new cost basis to the estimated future cash flows over the expected remaining life of the security by prospectively adjusting the security’s yield, if necessary.
The Company’s evaluation of whether a credit impairment exists for debt securities includes but is not limited to, the following factors: (a) changes in the financial condition of the security’s underlying collateral, (b) whether the issuer is current on contractually obligated interest and principal payments, (c) changes in the financial condition, credit rating and near-term prospects of the issuer, (d) the extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost of the security and (e) the payment structure of the security. The Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows used to determine the credit loss amount is a quantitative and qualitative process that incorporates information received from third-party sources along with certain internal assumptions and judgments regarding the future performance of the security. The Company’s best estimate of future cash flows involves assumptions including, but not limited to, various performance indicators, such as historical and projected default and recovery rates, credit ratings, current and projected delinquency rates, and loan-to-value ("LTV") ratios. In addition, for structured securities, the Company considers factors including, but not limited to, average cumulative collateral loss rates that vary by vintage year, commercial and residential property value declines that vary by property type and location and commercial real estate delinquency levels. These assumptions require the use of significant management judgment and include the probability of issuer default and estimates regarding timing and amount of expected recoveries which may include estimating the underlying collateral value. In addition, projections of expected future debt security cash flows may change based upon new information regarding the performance of the issuer and/or underlying collateral such as changes in the projections of the underlying property value estimates.

F-44

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


For equity securities where the decline in the fair value is deemed to be other-than-temporary, a charge is recorded in net realized capital losses equal to the difference between the fair value and cost basis of the security. The previous cost basis less the impairment becomes the security’s new cost basis. The Company asserts its intent and ability to retain those equity securities deemed to be temporarily impaired until the price recovers. Once identified, these securities are systematically restricted from trading unless approved by investment and accounting professionals. The investment and accounting professionals will only authorize the sale of these securities based on predefined criteria that relate to events that could not have been reasonably foreseen. Examples of the criteria include, but are not limited to, the deterioration in the issuer’s financial condition, security price declines, a change in regulatory requirements or a major business combination or major disposition.
The primary factors considered in evaluating whether an impairment exists for an equity security include, but are not limited to: (a) the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the cost of the security, (b) changes in the financial condition, credit rating and near-term prospects of the issuer, (c) whether the issuer is current on preferred stock dividends and (d) the intent and ability of the Company to retain the investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for recovery.
The following table presents the Company's impairments by impairment type.
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Intent-to-sell impairments
$
54

$
17

$
26

Credit impairments
29

37

32

Impairments on equity securities
16

2

15

Other impairments
3

3


Total impairments
$
102

$
59

$
73

The following table presents a roll-forward of the Company’s cumulative credit impairments on fixed maturities held.
 
For the years ended December 31,
(Before-tax)
2015
2014
2013
Balance as of beginning of period
$
(424
)
$
(552
)
$
(1,013
)
Additions for credit impairments recognized on [1]:
 
 
 
Securities not previously impaired
(15
)
(15
)
(19
)
Securities previously impaired
(14
)
(22
)
(13
)
Reductions for credit impairments previously recognized on:
 
 
 
Securities that matured or were sold during the period
68

138

469

Securities the Company made the decision to sell or more likely than not will be required to sell
2


2

Securities due to an increase in expected cash flows
59

27

22

Balance as of end of period
$
(324
)
$
(424
)
$
(552
)
[1]
These additions are included in the net OTTI losses recognized in earnings in the Consolidated Statements of Operations.

F-45

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Available-for-Sale Securities
The following table presents the Company’s AFS securities by type.
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Cost or
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Non-
Credit
OTTI [1]
Cost or
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Non-
Credit
OTTI [1]
ABS
$
2,520

$
24

$
(45
)
$
2,499

$

$
2,470

$
39

$
(37
)
$
2,472

$
(1
)
CDOs [2]
2,989

75

(23
)
3,038


2,776

98

(36
)
2,841


CMBS
4,668

105

(56
)
4,717

(8
)
4,235

196

(16
)
4,415

(6
)
Corporate
25,876

1,342

(416
)
26,802

(3
)
25,188

2,382

(211
)
27,359

(3
)
Foreign govt./govt. agencies
1,321

34

(47
)
1,308


1,592

73

(29
)
1,636


Municipal
11,124

1,008

(11
)
12,121


11,735

1,141

(5
)
12,871


RMBS
3,986

82

(22
)
4,046


3,815

122

(19
)
3,918

(1
)
U.S. Treasuries
4,481

222

(38
)
4,665


3,551

326

(5
)
3,872


Total fixed maturities, AFS
56,965

2,892

(658
)
59,196

(11
)
55,362

4,377

(358
)
59,384

(11
)
Equity securities, AFS [3]
842

38

(41
)
839


676

50

(27
)
699


Total AFS securities
$
57,807

$
2,930

$
(699
)
$
60,035

$
(11
)
$
56,038

$
4,427

$
(385
)
$
60,083

$
(11
)
[1]
Represents the amount of cumulative non-credit OTTI losses recognized in OCI on securities that also had credit impairments. These losses are included in gross unrealized losses as of December 31, 2015 and 2014.
[2]
Gross unrealized gains (losses) exclude the fair value of bifurcated embedded derivatives within certain securities. Subsequent changes in value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
[3]
Excludes equity securities, FVO with a cost and fair value of $293 and $282, respectively, as of December 31, 2015, and $351 and $348 as of December 31, 2014.
The following table presents the Company’s fixed maturities, AFS, by contractual maturity year.
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Contractual Maturity
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
One year or less
$
2,373

$
2,405

$
2,141

$
2,168

Over one year through five years
10,929

11,200

11,264

11,827

Over five years through ten years
9,322

9,497

8,802

9,226

Over ten years
20,178

21,794

19,859

22,517

Subtotal
42,802

44,896

42,066

45,738

Mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities
14,163

14,300

13,296

13,646

Total fixed maturities, AFS
$
56,965

$
59,196

$
55,362

$
59,384

Estimated maturities may differ from contractual maturities due to security call or prepayment provisions. Due to the potential for variability in payment speeds (i.e. prepayments or extensions), mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities are not categorized by contractual maturity.
Concentration of Credit Risk
The Company aims to maintain a diversified investment portfolio including issuer, sector and geographic stratification, where applicable, and has established certain exposure limits, diversification standards and review procedures to mitigate credit risk.

F-46

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


The Company had no investment exposure to any credit concentration risk of a single issuer greater than 10% of the Company's stockholders' equity, other than the U.S. government and certain U.S. government securities as of December 31, 2015 or December 31, 2014. As of December 31, 2015, other than U.S. government and certain U.S. government agencies, the Company’s three largest exposures by issuer were Morgan Stanley, the State of California, and JP Morgan Chase & Co. which each comprised less than 1% of total invested assets. As of December 31, 2014, other than U.S. government and certain U.S. government agencies, the Company’s three largest exposures by issuer were the State of Illinois, JP Morgan Chase &Co., and Goldman Sachs Group Inc. which each comprised less than 1% of total invested assets. The Company’s three largest exposures by sector as of December 31, 2015, were municipal securities, financial services, and CMBS which comprised approximately 17%, 9% and 6%, respectively, of total invested assets. The Company’s three largest exposures by sector as of December 31, 2014 were municipal investments, financial services, and utilities which comprised approximately 17%, 7% and 6%, respectively, of total invested assets.
Unrealized Losses on AFS Securities
The following tables present the Company’s unrealized loss aging for AFS securities by type and length of time the security was in a continuous unrealized loss position.
 
December 31, 2015
 
Less Than 12 Months
 
12 Months or More
 
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
ABS
$
1,619

$
1,609

$
(10
)
 
$
357

$
322

$
(35
)
 
$
1,976

$
1,931

$
(45
)
CDOs [1]
1,164

1,154

(10
)
 
1,243

1,227

(13
)
 
2,407

2,381

(23
)
CMBS
1,726

1,681

(45
)
 
189

178

(11
)
 
1,915

1,859

(56
)
Corporate
9,206

8,866

(340
)
 
656

580

(76
)
 
9,862

9,446

(416
)
Foreign govt./govt. agencies
679

646

(33
)
 
124

110

(14
)
 
803

756

(47
)
Municipal
440

430

(10
)
 
18

17

(1
)
 
458

447

(11
)
RMBS
1,349

1,340

(9
)
 
415

402

(13
)
 
1,764

1,742

(22
)
U.S. Treasuries
2,432

2,394

(38
)
 
8

8


 
2,440

2,402

(38
)
Total fixed maturities, AFS
18,615

18,120

(495
)
 
3,010

2,844

(163
)
 
21,625

20,964

(658
)
Equity securities, AFS [2]
480

449

(31
)
 
62

52

(10
)
 
542

501

(41
)
Total securities in an unrealized loss position
$
19,095

$
18,569

$
(526
)
 
$
3,072

$
2,896

$
(173
)
 
$
22,167

$
21,465

$
(699
)
 
December 31, 2014
 
Less Than 12 Months
 
12 Months or More
 
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
ABS
$
897

$
893

$
(4
)
 
$
473

$
440

$
(33
)
 
$
1,370

$
1,333

$
(37
)
CDOs [1]
748

743

(5
)
 
1,489

1,461

(31
)
 
2,237

2,204

(36
)
CMBS
230

227

(3
)
 
319

306

(13
)
 
549

533

(16
)
Corporate
3,082

2,980

(102
)
 
1,177

1,068

(109
)
 
4,259

4,048

(211
)
Foreign govt./govt. agencies
363

349

(14
)
 
227

212

(15
)
 
590

561

(29
)
Municipal
74

73

(1
)
 
86

82

(4
)
 
160

155

(5
)
RMBS
320

318

(2
)
 
433

416

(17
)
 
753

734

(19
)
U.S. Treasuries
432

431

(1
)
 
361

357

(4
)
 
793

788

(5
)
Total fixed maturities, AFS
6,146

6,014

(132
)
 
4,565

4,342

(226
)
 
10,711

10,356

(358
)
Equity securities, AFS [2]
172

160

(12
)
 
102

87

(15
)
 
274

247

(27
)
Total securities in an unrealized loss position
$
6,318

$
6,174

$
(144
)
 
$
4,667

$
4,429

$
(241
)
 
$
10,985

$
10,603

$
(385
)
[1]
Unrealized losses exclude the change in fair value of bifurcated embedded derivatives within certain securities, for which changes in fair value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
[2]
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, excludes equity securities, FVO which are included in equity securities, AFS on the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
As of December 31, 2015, AFS securities in an unrealized loss position consisted of 4,850 securities, primarily in the corporate sector, which were depressed primarily due to an increase in interest rates and/or widening of credit spreads since the securities were purchased. As of December 31, 2015, 91% of these securities were depressed less than 20% of cost or amortized cost. The increase in unrealized losses during 2015 was primarily attributable to wider credit spreads and an increase in interest rates.

F-47

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Most of the securities depressed for twelve months or more relate to corporate securities concentrated in the financial services and energy sectors, student loan ABS, and structured securities with exposure to commercial and residential real estate. Corporate financial services securities and student loan ABS were primarily depressed because the securities have floating-rate coupons and have long-dated maturities, and current credit spreads are wider than when these securities were purchased. Corporate securities within the energy sector are primarily depressed due to a decline in oil prices. For certain commercial and residential real estate securities, current market spreads are wider than spreads at the securities' respective purchase dates. The Company neither has an intention to sell nor does it expect to be required to sell the securities outlined in the preceding discussion.
Mortgage Loans
Mortgage Loan Valuation Allowances
The Company’s security monitoring process reviews mortgage loans on a quarterly basis to identify potential credit losses. Commercial mortgage loans are considered to be impaired when management estimates that, based upon current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect amounts due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Criteria used to determine if an impairment exists include, but are not limited to: current and projected macroeconomic factors, such as unemployment rates, and property-specific factors such as rental rates, occupancy levels, LTV ratios and debt service coverage ratios (“DSCR”). In addition, the Company considers historic, current and projected delinquency rates and property values. These assumptions require the use of significant management judgment and include the probability and timing of borrower default and loss severity estimates. In addition, projections of expected future cash flows may change based upon new information regarding the performance of the borrower and/or underlying collateral such as changes in the projections of the underlying property value estimates.
For mortgage loans that are deemed impaired, a valuation allowance is established for the difference between the carrying amount and the Company’s share of either (a) the present value of the expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, (b) the loan’s observable market price or, most frequently, (c) the fair value of the collateral. A valuation allowance has been established for either individual loans or as a projected loss contingency for loans with an LTV ratio of 90% or greater and after consideration of other credit quality factors, including DSCR. Changes in valuation allowances are recorded in net realized capital gains and losses. Interest income on impaired loans is accrued to the extent it is deemed collectible and the loans continue to perform under the original or restructured terms. Interest income ceases to accrue for loans when it is probable that the Company will not receive interest and principal payments according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Loans may resume accrual status when it is determined that sufficient collateral exists to satisfy the full amount of the loan and interest payments, as well as when it is probable cash will be received in the foreseeable future. Interest income on defaulted loans is recognized when received.

 
December 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost [1]
Valuation Allowance
Carrying Value
 
Amortized Cost [1]
Valuation Allowance
Carrying Value
Total commercial mortgage loans
$
5,647

$
(23
)
$
5,624

 
$
5,574

$
(18
)
$
5,556

[1]
Amortized cost represents carrying value prior to valuation allowances, if any.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the carrying value of mortgage loans associated with the valuation allowance was $82 and $140, respectively. There were no mortgage loans held-for-sale as of December 31, 2015, or December 31, 2014. As of December 31, 2015, loans within the Company’s mortgage loan portfolio that have had extensions or restructurings other than what is allowable under the original terms of the contract are immaterial.
The following table presents the activity within the Company’s valuation allowance for mortgage loans. These loans have been evaluated both individually and collectively for impairment. Loans evaluated collectively for impairment are immaterial.
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Balance as of January 1
$
(18
)
$
(67
)
$
(68
)
(Additions)/Reversals
(7
)
(4
)
(2
)
Deductions
2

53

3

Balance as of December 31
$
(23
)
$
(18
)
$
(67
)

F-48

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


The weighted-average LTV ratio of the Company’s commercial mortgage loan portfolio was 54% as of December 31, 2015, while the weighted-average LTV ratio at origination of these loans was 62%. LTV ratios compare the loan amount to the value of the underlying property collateralizing the loan. The loan values are updated no less than annually through property level reviews of the portfolio. Factors considered in the property valuation include, but are not limited to, actual and expected property cash flows, geographic market data and capitalization rates. DSCR compares a property’s net operating income to the borrower’s principal and interest payments. The weighted average DSCR of the Company’s commercial mortgage loan portfolio was 2.63x as of December 31, 2015. As of December 31, 2015, the Company held two delinquent commercial mortgage loans past due by 90 days or more. The loans had a total carrying value and valuation allowance of $17 and $20, respectively, and neither loan was accruing income. As of December 31, 2014, the Company held one delinquent commercial mortgage loan past due by 90 days or more. The loan had a total carrying value and valuation allowance of $7 and $0, respectively, and was not accruing income.
The following table presents the carrying value of the Company’s commercial mortgage loans by LTV and DSCR.
Commercial Mortgage Loans Credit Quality
 
December 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
Loan-to-value
Carrying Value
Avg. Debt-Service Coverage Ratio
 
Carrying Value
Avg. Debt-Service Coverage Ratio
Greater than 80%
$
24

0.81x
 
$
53

1.07x
65% - 80%
623

1.82x
 
789

1.75x
Less than 65%
4,977

2.75x
 
4,714

2.66x
Total commercial mortgage loans
$
5,624

2.63x
 
$
5,556

2.51x
The following tables present the carrying value of the Company’s mortgage loans by region and property type.
Mortgage Loans by Region
 
December 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Carrying Value
Percent of Total
 
Carrying Value
Percent of Total
East North Central
$
289

5.1
%
 
$
211

3.8
%
East South Central
14

0.2
%
 

%
Middle Atlantic
384

6.8
%
 
468

8.4
%
Mountain
32

0.6
%
 
88

1.6
%
New England
446

7.9
%
 
381

6.9
%
Pacific
1,669

29.7
%
 
1,607

29.0
%
South Atlantic
1,174

20.9
%
 
1,019

18.3
%
West North Central
29

0.5
%
 
44

0.8
%
West South Central
318

5.7
%
 
302

5.4
%
Other [1]
1,269

22.6
%
 
1,436

25.8
%
Total mortgage loans
$
5,624

100.0
%
 
$
5,556

100.0
%
[1]
Primarily represents loans collateralized by multiple properties in various regions.

F-49

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Mortgage Loans by Property Type
 
December 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Carrying Value
Percent of Total
 
Carrying Value
Percent of Total
Commercial
 
 
 
 
 
Agricultural
$
26

0.5
%
 
$
46

0.8
%
Industrial
1,422

25.3
%
 
1,476

26.6
%
Lodging
26

0.5
%
 
26

0.5
%
Multifamily
1,345

23.9
%
 
1,190

21.4
%
Office
1,547

27.5
%
 
1,517

27.3
%
Retail
1,109

19.7
%
 
1,147

20.6
%
Other
149

2.6
%
 
154

2.8
%
Total mortgage loans
$
5,624

100.0
%
 
$
5,556

100.0
%
Mortgage Servicing
The Company originates, sells and services commercial mortgage loans on behalf of third parties and recognizes servicing fees over the period that services are performed in fee income. As of December 31, 2015, under this program the Company serviced commercial mortgage loans with a total outstanding principal of $359, of which $129 was serviced on behalf of third parties and $230 was retained and reported on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets, including $54 in separate account assets. Servicing rights are carried at the lower of cost or fair value and were zero as of December 31, 2015, because servicing fees were market-level fees at origination and remain adequate to compensate the Company to administer the servicing. The Company did not have any mortgage servicing arrangements as of December 31, 2014.
Variable Interest Entities
The Company is involved with various special purpose entities and other entities that are deemed to be VIEs primarily as a collateral or investment manager and as an investor through normal investment activities, as well as a means of accessing capital through a contingent capital facility ("the facility"). For further information on the facility, see Note 11 - Debt of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
A VIE is an entity that either has investors that lack certain essential characteristics of a controlling financial interest or lacks sufficient funds to finance its own activities without financial support provided by other entities. The Company performs ongoing qualitative assessments of its VIEs to determine whether the Company has a controlling financial interest in the VIE and therefore is the primary beneficiary. The Company is deemed to have a controlling financial interest when it has both the ability to direct the activities that most significantly impact the economic performance of the VIE and the obligation to absorb losses or right to receive benefits from the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE. Based on the Company’s assessment, if it determines it is the primary beneficiary, the Company consolidates the VIE in the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-50

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Consolidated VIEs
The following table presents the carrying value of assets and liabilities and the maximum exposure to loss relating to the VIEs for which the Company is the primary beneficiary. Creditors have no recourse against the Company in the event of default by these VIEs nor does the Company have any implied or unfunded commitments to these VIEs. The Company’s financial or other support provided to these VIEs is limited to its collateral or investment management services and original investment.
 
December 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Total Assets
Total Liabilities [1]
Maximum Exposure to Loss [2]
 
Total Assets
Total Liabilities [1]
Maximum Exposure to Loss [2]
CDOs [3]
$
5

$
5

$

 
$
5

$
5

$

Investment funds [4]
159

7

151

 
238


243

Limited partnerships and other alternative investments
2


2

 
3

1

2

Total
$
166

$
12

$
153

 
$
246

$
6

$
245

[1]
Included in other liabilities in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[2]
The maximum exposure to loss represents the maximum loss amount that the Company could recognize as a reduction in net investment income or as a realized capital loss and is the cost basis of the Company’s investment.
[3]
Total assets included in cash in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[4]
Total assets included in fixed maturities, FVO, short-term investments, equity, AFS, and cash in the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets.
CDOs represent structured investment vehicles for which the Company has a controlling financial interest as it provides collateral management services, earns a fee for those services and also holds investments in the securities issued by these vehicles. Investment funds represent fixed income funds for which the Company has management and control of the investments, which is the activity that most significantly impacts its economic performance. Limited partnerships and other alternative impairments represent one hedge fund of funds in which the Company holds a majority interest in the fund as an investment.
Non-Consolidated VIEs
The Company, through normal investment activities, makes passive investments in structured securities issued by VIEs for which the Company is not the manager which are included in ABS, CDOs, CMBS and RMBS in the AFS securities table and fixed maturities, FVO, in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company has not provided financial or other support with respect to these investments other than its original investment. For these investments, the Company determined it is not the primary beneficiary due to the relative size of the Company’s investment in comparison to the principal amount of the structured securities issued by the VIEs, the level of credit subordination which reduces the Company’s obligation to absorb losses or right to receive benefits and the Company’s inability to direct the activities that most significantly impact the economic performance of the VIEs. The Company’s maximum exposure to loss on these investments is limited to the amount of the Company’s investment.
In addition, the Company holds a significant variable interest for one VIE for which it is not the primary beneficiary and, therefore, was not consolidated on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. This VIE represents the facility that has been held by the Company since February 2007 and for which the Company has no implied or unfunded commitments. Assets and liabilities recorded for the facility were $7 and $8, respectively, as of December 31, 2015, and $12 and $14, respectively, as of December 31, 2014. Additionally, the Company has a maximum exposure to loss of $3 and $3, respectively, as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, which represents the issuance costs that were incurred to establish the facility. The Company does not have a controlling financial interest as it does not manage the assets of the facility nor does it have the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the facility, as the asset manager has significant variable interest in the vehicle. The Company’s financial or other support provided to the facility is limited to providing ongoing support to cover the facility’s operating expenses. For further information on the facility, see Note 11 - Debt of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-51

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Securities Lending, Repurchase Agreements and Other Collateral Transactions
The Company participates in securities lending programs to generate additional income. Through these programs, certain fixed maturities within the corporate, foreign government/government agencies, and municipal sectors as well as equity securities are loaned from the Company’s portfolio to qualifying third-party borrowers in return for collateral in the form of cash or securities. Borrowers of these securities provide collateral of 102% and 105% of the fair value of the securities lent at the time of the loan for domestic and non-domestic securities, respectively. The borrower will return the securities to the Company for cash or securities collateral at maturity dates generally of 90 days or less. Security collateral on deposit from counterparties in connection with securities lending transactions may not be sold or re-pledged, except in the event of default, and is not reflected on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets. The fair value of the loaned securities is monitored and additional collateral is obtained if the fair value of the collateral falls below 100% of the fair value of the loaned securities. The agreements provide the counterparty the right to sell or re-pledge the securities transferred. If cash, rather than securities, is received as collateral, the cash is typically invested in short-term investments or fixed maturities and is reported as an asset on the consolidated balance sheets. Income associated with securities lending transactions is reported as a component of net investment income on the Company’s consolidated statements of operations. As of December 31, 2015, the fair value of securities on loan and the associated liability for cash collateral received was $67 and $68, respectively. The Company had no securities on loan as of December 31, 2014.
From time to time, the Company enters into repurchase agreements to manage liquidity or to earn incremental spread income. A repurchase agreement is a transaction in which one party (transferor) agrees to sell securities to another party (transferee) in return for cash (or securities), with a simultaneous agreement to repurchase the same securities at a specified price at a later date. A dollar roll is a type of repurchase agreement where a mortgage backed security is sold with an agreement to repurchase substantially the same security at a specified time in the future. These transactions generally have a contractual maturity of ninety days or less.
As part of repurchase agreements, the Company transfers collateral of U.S. government and government agency securities and receives cash. For repurchase agreements, the Company obtains cash in an amount equal to at least 95% of the fair value of the securities transferred. The agreements contain contractual provisions that require additional collateral to be transferred when necessary and provide the counterparty the right to sell or re-pledge the securities transferred. The cash received from the repurchase program is typically invested in short-term investments or fixed maturities. Repurchase agreements include master netting provisions that provide the counterparties the right to offset claims and apply securities held by them with respect to their obligations in the event of a default. Although the Company has the contractual right to offset claims, fixed maturities do not meet the specific conditions for net presentation under U.S. GAAP. The Company accounts for the repurchase agreements as collateralized borrowings. The securities transferred under repurchase agreements are included in fixed maturities, AFS with the obligation to repurchase those securities recorded in other liabilities on the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets.
As of December 31, 2015, the Company reported financial collateral pledged relating to repurchase agreements of $440 in fixed maturities, AFS and $5 in cash. The Company reported a corresponding obligation to repurchase the pledged securities of $445 in other liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company had no outstanding dollar roll transactions as of December 31, 2015. The Company had no outstanding repurchase agreements or dollar roll transactions as of December 31, 2014.
The Company is required by law to deposit securities with government agencies in certain states in which it conducts business. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the fair value of securities on deposit was approximately $2.5 billion and $2.5 billion, respectively.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company has pledged as collateral $35 and $34, respectively, of U.S. government securities and government agency securities or cash for letters of credit.
Refer to Derivative Collateral Arrangements section of this note for disclosure of collateral in support of derivative transactions.

F-52

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Equity Method Investments
The majority of the Company's investments in limited partnerships and other alternative investments, including hedge funds, real estate funds, and private equity and other funds (collectively, “limited partnerships”), are accounted for under the equity method of accounting. The remainder of investments in limited partnerships and other alternative investments consists primarily of wholly-owned fund of funds accounted for under investment fund accounting which are measured at fair value as discussed in Note 4 Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. For those limited partnerships and other alternative investments accounted for under the equity method, the Company’s maximum exposure to loss as of December 31, 2015 is limited to the total carrying value of $2.9 billion. In addition, the Company has outstanding commitments totaling $748 to fund limited partnership and other alternative investments as of December 31, 2015. The Company’s investments in limited partnerships are generally of a passive nature in that the Company does not take an active role in the management of the limited partnerships. In 2015, aggregate investment income from limited partnerships and other alternative investments exceeded 10% of the Company’s pre-tax consolidated net income. Accordingly, the Company is disclosing aggregated summarized financial data for the Company’s limited partnership investments. This aggregated summarized financial data does not represent the Company’s proportionate share of limited partnership assets or earnings. Aggregate total assets of the limited partnerships in which the Company invested totaled $95.5 billion and $85.8 billion as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Aggregate total liabilities of the limited partnerships in which the Company invested totaled $15.2 billion and $10.6 billion as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Aggregate net investment income of the limited partnerships in which the Company invested totaled $1.0 billion, $3.6 billion and $1.8 billion for the periods ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Aggregate net income of the limited partnerships in which the Company invested totaled $6.3 billion, $9.6 billion and $8.4 billion for the periods ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. As of, and for the period ended, December 31, 2015, the aggregated summarized financial data reflects the latest available financial information.
Derivative Instruments
The Company utilizes a variety of OTC, OTC-cleared and exchange traded derivative instruments as a part of its overall risk management strategy as well as to enter into replication transactions. Derivative instruments are used to manage risk associated with interest rate, equity market, commodity market, credit spread, issuer default, price, and currency exchange rate risk or volatility. Replication transactions are used as an economical means to synthetically replicate the characteristics and performance of assets that are permissible investments under the Company’s investment policies. The Company also may enter into and has previously issued financial instruments and products that either are accounted for as free-standing derivatives, such as certain reinsurance contracts, or may contain features that are deemed to be embedded derivative instruments, such as the GMWB rider included with certain variable annuity products.
Strategies that Qualify for Hedge Accounting
Certain derivatives the Company enters into satisfy the hedge accounting requirements as outlined in Note 1 of these financial statements. Typically, these hedge relationships include interest rate swaps and, to a lesser extent, foreign currency swaps where the terms or expected cash flows of the hedged item closely match the terms of the swap. The interest rate swaps are typically used to manage interest rate duration of certain fixed maturity securities or liability contracts. The hedge strategies by hedge accounting designation include:
Cash Flow Hedges
Interest rate swaps are predominantly used to manage portfolio duration and better match cash receipts from assets with cash disbursements required to fund liabilities. These derivatives primarily convert interest receipts on floating-rate fixed maturity securities to fixed rates. The Company also enters into forward starting swap agreements to hedge the interest rate exposure related to the purchase of fixed-rate securities, primarily to hedge interest rate risk inherent in the assumptions used to price certain liabilities.
Foreign currency swaps are used to convert foreign currency-denominated cash flows related to certain investment receipts and liability payments to U.S. dollars in order to reduce cash flow fluctuations due to changes in currency rates.
Fair Value Hedges
Interest rate swaps are used to hedge the changes in fair value of fixed maturity securities due to fluctuations in interest rates. These swaps are typically used to manage interest rate duration.

F-53

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Non-qualifying Strategies
Derivative relationships that do not qualify for hedge accounting (“non-qualifying strategies”) primarily include the hedge program for the Company's variable annuity products as well as the hedging and replication strategies that utilize credit default swaps. In addition, hedges of interest rate, foreign currency and equity risk of certain fixed maturities, equities and liabilities do not qualify for hedge accounting.
The non-qualifying strategies include:
Interest Rate Swaps, Swaptions and Futures
The Company may use interest rate swaps, swaptions, and futures to manage duration between assets and liabilities in certain investment portfolios. In addition, the Company enters into interest rate swaps to terminate existing swaps, thereby offsetting the changes in value of the original swap. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the notional amount of interest rate swaps in offsetting relationships was $12.9 billion and $13.1 billion, respectively.
Foreign Currency Swaps and Forwards
The Company enters into foreign currency swaps and forwards to convert the foreign currency exposures of certain foreign currency-denominated fixed maturity investments to U.S. dollars. During 2015, the Company entered into foreign currency forwards to hedge non-U.S. dollar denominated cash and equity securities, as well as the currency impacts on changes in equity of a P&C runoff entity in the United Kingdom.
Fixed Payout Annuity Hedge
The Company formerly offered certain variable annuity products with a guaranteed minimum income benefit ("GMIB") and continues to reinsure certain yen denominated fixed payout annuities. The Company invests in U.S. dollar denominated assets to support the reinsurance liability. The Company entered into pay U.S. dollar, receive yen swap contracts to hedge the currency and yen interest rate exposure between the U.S. dollar denominated assets and the yen denominated fixed liability reinsurance payments.
Credit Contracts
Credit default swaps are used to purchase credit protection on an individual entity or referenced index to economically hedge against default risk and credit-related changes in value of fixed maturity securities. Credit default swaps are also used to assume credit risk related to an individual entity or referenced index as a part of replication transactions. These contracts require the Company to pay or receive a periodic fee in exchange for compensation from the counterparty should the referenced security issuers experience a credit event, as defined in the contract. The Company is also exposed to credit risk related to certain structured fixed maturity securities that have embedded credit derivatives, which reference a standard index of corporate securities. In addition, the Company enters into credit default swaps to terminate existing credit default swaps, thereby offsetting the changes in value of the original swap going forward.
Equity Index Swaps and Options
The Company enters into total return swaps to hedge equity risk of specific common stock investments which are accounted for using fair value option in order to align the accounting treatment within net realized capital gains (losses). The Company may also use equity index options to hedge the impact of an adverse equity market environment on the investment portfolio. In addition, the Company formerly offered certain equity indexed products, a portion of which contain embedded derivatives that require bifurcation. The Company uses equity index swaps to economically hedge the equity volatility risk associated with the equity indexed products.
Commodity Contracts
During 2015, the Company purchased for $11 put option contracts on West Texas Intermediate oil futures with a strike of $35 dollars per barrel in order to partially offset potential losses related to certain fixed maturity securities that could arise if oil prices decline substantially. The Company has since reduced its exposure to the targeted fixed maturity securities and therefore, these options were terminated at the end of 2015.
GMWB Derivatives, net
The Company formerly offered certain variable annuity products with GMWB riders. The GMWB product is a bifurcated embedded derivative (“GMWB product derivatives”) that has a notional value equal to the GRB. The Company uses reinsurance contracts to transfer a portion of its risk of loss due to GMWB. The reinsurance contracts covering GMWB (“GMWB reinsurance contracts”) are accounted for as free-standing derivatives with a notional amount equal to the GRB amount.

F-54

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


The Company utilizes derivatives (“GMWB hedging instruments”) as part of an actively managed program designed to hedge a portion of the capital market risk exposures of the non-reinsured GMWB riders due to changes in interest rates, equity market levels, and equity volatility. These derivatives include customized swaps, interest rate swaps and futures, and equity swaps, options and futures, on certain indices including the S&P 500 index, EAFE index and NASDAQ index. The following table presents notional and fair value for GMWB hedging instruments.
 
Notional Amount
 
Fair Value
 
December 31,
2015
December 31,
2014
 
December 31,
2015
December 31,
2014
Customized swaps
$
5,877

$
7,041

 
$
131

$
124

Equity swaps, options, and futures
1,362

3,761

 
2

39

Interest rate swaps and futures
3,740

3,640

 
25

11

Total
$
10,979

$
14,442

 
$
158

$
174

Macro Hedge Program
The Company utilizes equity options, swaps, futures, and foreign currency options to partially hedge against a decline in the equity markets and the resulting statutory surplus and capital impact primarily arising from the guaranteed minimum death benefit ("GMDB") and GMWB obligations. The following table presents notional and fair value for the macro hedge program.
 
Notional Amount
 
Fair Value
 
December 31,
2015
December 31,
2014
 
December 31,
2015
December 31,
2014
Equity swaps, options, and futures
$
4,548

$
5,983

 
$
147

$
141

Foreign currency options

400

 


Total
$
4,548

$
6,383

 
$
147

$
141

Contingent Capital Facility Put Option
The Company entered into a put option agreement that provides the Company the right to require a third-party trust to purchase, at any time, The Hartford’s junior subordinated notes in a maximum aggregate principal amount of $500. Under the put option agreement, The Hartford will pay premiums on a periodic basis and will reimburse the trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses.
Modified Coinsurance Reinsurance Contracts
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company had approximately $895 and $1.0 billion, respectively, of invested assets supporting other policyholder funds and benefits payable reinsured under a modified coinsurance arrangement in connection with the sale of the Individual Life business, which was structured as a reinsurance transaction. The assets are primarily held in a trust established by the Company. The Company pays or receives cash quarterly to settle the results of the reinsured business, including the investment results. As a result of this modified coinsurance arrangement, the Company has an embedded derivative that transfers to the reinsurer certain unrealized changes in fair value due to interest rate and credit risks of these assets. The notional amount of the embedded derivative reinsurance contracts are the invested assets that are carried at fair value supporting the reinsured reserves.
Derivative Balance Sheet Classification
The following table summarizes the balance sheet classification of the Company’s derivative related net fair value amounts as well as the gross asset and liability fair value amounts. For reporting purposes, the Company has elected to offset within total assets or total liabilities based upon the net of the fair value amounts, income accruals, and related cash collateral receivables and payables of OTC derivative instruments executed in a legal entity and with the same counterparty under a master netting agreement, which provides the Company with the legal right of offset. The Company has also elected to offset within total assets or total liabilities based upon the net of the fair value amounts, income accruals and related cash collateral receivables and payables of OTC-cleared derivative instruments based on clearing house agreements. The following fair value amounts do not include income accruals or related cash collateral receivables and payables, which are netted with derivative fair value amounts to determine balance sheet presentation. Derivative fair value reported as liabilities after taking into account the master netting agreements was $1.1 billion as of December 31, 2015 and 2014. Derivatives in the Company’s separate accounts, where the associated gains and losses accrue directly to policyholders, are not included in the table below. The Company’s derivative instruments are held for risk management purposes, unless otherwise noted in the following table. The notional amount of derivative contracts represents the basis upon which pay or receive amounts are calculated and is presented in the table to quantify the volume of the Company’s derivative activity. Notional amounts are not necessarily reflective of credit risk. The following tables exclude investments that contain an embedded credit derivative for which the Company has elected the fair value option. For further discussion, see the Fair Value Option section in Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-55

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


 
Net Derivatives
Asset Derivatives
Liability Derivatives
 
Notional Amount
Fair Value
Fair Value
Fair Value
Hedge Designation/ Derivative Type
Dec 31, 2015
Dec 31, 2014
Dec 31, 2015
Dec 31, 2014
Dec 31, 2015
Dec 31, 2014
Dec 31, 2015
Dec 31, 2014
Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
3,527

$
3,999

$
17

$
44

$
50

$
52

$
(33
)
$
(8
)
Foreign currency swaps
143

143

(19
)
(19
)
7

3

(26
)
(22
)
Total cash flow hedges
3,670

4,142

(2
)
25

57

55

(59
)
(30
)
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
23

32







Total fair value hedges
23

32







Non-qualifying strategies
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps and futures
14,290

15,254

(814
)
(512
)
297

536

(1,111
)
(1,048
)
Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Foreign currency swaps and forwards
653

177

17

1

17

3


(2
)
Fixed payout annuity hedge
1,063

1,319

(357
)
(427
)


(357
)
(427
)
Credit contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives that purchase credit protection
423

595

18

(6
)
22

4

(4
)
(10
)
Credit derivatives that assume credit risk [1]
2,458

1,487

(13
)
3

9

14

(22
)
(11
)
Credit derivatives in offsetting positions
4,059

5,343

(2
)
(3
)
40

53

(42
)
(56
)
Equity contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity index swaps and options
419

635

15

2

41

31

(26
)
(29
)
Variable annuity hedge program
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GMWB product derivatives [2]
15,099

17,908

(262
)
(139
)


(262
)
(139
)
GMWB reinsurance contracts
3,106

3,659

83

56

83

56



GMWB hedging instruments
10,979

14,442

158

174

264

289

(106
)
(115
)
Macro hedge program
4,548

6,383

147

141

179

180

(32
)
(39
)
Other
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Contingent capital facility put option
500

500

7

12

7

12



Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
895

974

79

34

79

34



Total non-qualifying strategies
58,492

68,676

(924
)
(664
)
1,038

1,212

(1,962
)
(1,876
)
Total cash flow hedges, fair value hedges, and non-qualifying strategies
$
62,185

$
72,850

$
(926
)
$
(639
)
$
1,095

$
1,267

$
(2,021
)
$
(1,906
)
Balance Sheet Location
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
$
425

$
454

$
(3
)
$
2

$

$
2

$
(3
)
$

Other investments
23,253

23,014

1

364

409

624

(408
)
(260
)
Other liabilities
19,358

26,791

(798
)
(930
)
524

551

(1,322
)
(1,481
)
Reinsurance recoverables
4,000

4,633

162

90

162

90



Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
15,149

17,958

(288
)
(165
)


(288
)
(165
)
Total derivatives
$
62,185

$
72,850

$
(926
)
$
(639
)
$
1,095

$
1,267

$
(2,021
)
$
(1,906
)
[1]
The derivative instruments related to this strategy are held for other investment purposes.
[2]
These derivatives are embedded within liabilities and are not held for risk management purposes.

F-56

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Change in Notional Amount
The net decrease in notional amount of derivatives since December 31, 2014 was primarily due to the following:
The decline in notional amount related to the GMWB hedging instruments and the macro hedge program was primarily driven by portfolio re-positioning, a decline in equity markets, and the expiration of certain options. The decline in the GMWB product related notional amount was primarily driven by policyholder lapses and partial withdrawals.
The decline in notional amount associated with interest rate derivatives was primarily driven by maturities of the derivatives.
These declines were partially offset by an increase in notional amount related to credit derivatives that assume credit risk as a means to earn credit spread while re-balancing within certain fixed maturity sectors.
Additional increases in notional related to foreign currency swaps and forwards were primarily driven by the purchase of foreign currency forwards to hedge Japanese yen-denominated cash and equity securities. In addition, the Company purchased foreign currency forwards to hedge the currency impacts on changes in equity of a P&C runoff entity in the United Kingdom.
Change in Fair Value
The net improvement in the total fair value of derivative instruments since December 31, 2014 was primarily related to the following:
The decrease in fair value of non-qualifying interest rate derivatives was primarily due to the termination of offsetting swaps that were in a net gain position.
The decrease in fair value related to the combined GMWB hedging program, which includes the GMWB product, reinsurance, and hedging derivatives, was primarily driven by liability model assumption updates, and underperformance of the underlying actively managed funds compared to their respective indices.
The increase in fair value of fixed payout annuity hedges was primarily driven by the maturity of a currency swap, partially offset by an increase in U.S. interest rates.
The increase in the fair value associated with modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts, which are accounted for as embedded derivatives and transfer to the reinsurer the investment experience related to the assets supporting the reinsured policies, was primarily driven by widening credit spreads and an increase in interest rates.
Offsetting of Derivative Assets/Liabilities
The following tables present the gross fair value amounts, the amounts offset, and net position of derivative instruments eligible for offset in the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets. Amounts offset include fair value amounts, income accruals and related cash collateral receivables and payables associated with derivative instruments that are traded under a common master netting agreement, as described in the preceding discussion. Also included in the tables are financial collateral receivables and payables, which are contractually permitted to be offset upon an event of default, although are disallowed for offsetting under U.S. GAAP.
As of December 31, 2015
 
(i)
 
(ii)
 
(iii) = (i) - (ii)
(iv)
 
(v) = (iii) - (iv)
 
 
 
 
 
Net Amounts Presented in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Collateral Disallowed for Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
 
 
Gross Amounts of Recognized Assets
 
Gross Amounts Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Derivative Assets [1]
 
Accrued Interest and Cash Collateral Received [2]
 
Financial Collateral Received [4]
 
Net Amount
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments
$
933

 
$
756

 
$
1

 
$
176

 
$
100

 
$
77

 
Gross Amounts of Recognized Liabilities
 
Gross Amounts Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Derivative Liabilities [3]
 
Accrued Interest and Cash Collateral Pledged [3]
 
Financial Collateral Pledged [4]
 
Net Amount
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
$
(1,730
)
 
$
(818
)
 
$
(798
)
 
$
(114
)
 
$
(889
)
 
$
(23
)

F-57

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


As of December 31, 2014
 
(i)
 
(ii)
 
(iii) = (i) - (ii)
(iv)
 
(v) = (iii) - (iv)
 
 
 
 
 
Net Amounts Presented in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Collateral Disallowed for Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
 
 
Gross Amounts of Recognized Assets
 
Gross Amounts Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Derivative Assets [1]
 
Accrued Interest and Cash Collateral Received [2]
 
Financial Collateral Received [4]
 
Net Amount
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments
$
1,175

 
$
969

 
$
364

 
$
(158
)
 
$
109

 
$
97

 
Gross Amounts of Recognized Liabilities
 
Gross Amounts Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Derivative Liabilities [3]
 
Accrued Interest and Cash Collateral Pledged [3]
 
Financial Collateral Pledged [4]
 
Net Amount
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
$
(1,741
)
 
$
(799
)
 
$
(927
)
 
$
(15
)
 
$
(1,079
)
 
$
137

[1]
Included in other investments in the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[2]
Included in other assets in the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets and is limited to the net derivative receivable associated with each counterparty.
[3]
Included in other liabilities in the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets and is limited to the net derivative payable associated with each counterparty.
[4]
Excludes collateral associated with exchange-traded derivatives instruments.
Cash Flow Hedges
For derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges, the effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative is reported as a component of OCI and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affects earnings. Gains and losses on the derivative representing hedge ineffectiveness are recognized in current period earnings. All components of each derivative’s gain or loss were included in the assessment of hedge effectiveness.
The following table presents the components of the gain or loss on derivatives that qualify as cash flow hedges:
Derivatives in Cash Flow Hedging Relationships
 
Gain (Loss) Recognized in OCI on Derivative (Effective Portion)
Net Realized Capital Gains(Losses) Recognized in Income on Derivative (Ineffective Portion)
 
2015
2014
2013
2015
2014
2013
Interest rate swaps
$
28

$
150

$
(315
)
$

$
2

$
(3
)
Foreign currency swaps

(10
)
12




Total
$
28

$
140

$
(303
)
$

$
2

$
(3
)
Derivatives in Cash Flow Hedging Relationships
 
 
Gain (Loss) Reclassified from AOCI into Income (Effective Portion)
 
Location
2015
2014
2013
Interest rate swaps
Net realized capital gain/(loss)
$
4

$
(1
)
$
91

Interest rate swaps
Net investment income
64

87

97

Foreign currency swaps
Net realized capital gain/(loss)
(9
)
(13
)
4

Total
 
$
59

$
73

$
192


F-58

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


As of December 31, 2015, the before-tax deferred net gains on derivative instruments recorded in AOCI that are expected to be reclassified to earnings during the next twelve months are $54. This expectation is based on the anticipated interest payments on hedged investments in fixed maturity securities that will occur over the next twelve months, at which time the Company will recognize the deferred net gains (losses) as an adjustment to net investment income over the term of the investment cash flows. The maximum term over which the Company is hedging its exposure to the variability of future cash flows for forecasted transactions, excluding interest payments on existing variable-rate financial instruments, is approximately three years.
During the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, the Company had no net reclassifications from AOCI to earnings resulting from the discontinuance of cash-flow hedges due to forecasted transactions that were no longer probable of occurring.
Fair Value Hedges
For derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges, the gain or loss on the derivatives as well as the offsetting loss or gain on the hedged items attributable to the hedged risk are recognized in current earnings. The Company includes the gain or loss on the derivative in the same line item as the offsetting loss or gain on the hedged item. All components of each derivative’s gain or loss were included in the assessment of hedge effectiveness.
The Company recognized in income gains (losses) representing the ineffective portion of fair value hedges as follows:
Derivatives in Fair Value Hedging Relationships
 
Gain (Loss) Recognized in Income [1]
 
2015
2014
2013
 
Derivative
Hedged Item
Derivative
Hedged Item
Derivative
Hedged Item
Interest rate swaps
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net realized capital gains (losses)
$

$

$
(3
)
$
1

$
7

$
(12
)
Foreign currency swaps
 

 

 

 

 
 
Net realized capital gains (losses)




1

(1
)
Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses




(2
)
2

Total
$

$

$
(3
)
$
1

$
6

$
(11
)
[1]
The amounts presented do not include the periodic net coupon settlements of the derivative or the coupon income (expense) related to the hedged item. The net of the amounts presented represents the ineffective portion of the hedge.

F-59

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Non-qualifying Strategies
For non-qualifying strategies, including embedded derivatives that are required to be bifurcated from their host contracts and accounted for as derivatives, the gain or loss on the derivative is recognized currently in earnings within net realized capital gains (losses). The following table presents the gain or loss recognized in income on non-qualifying strategies:
Non-qualifying Strategies
Gain (Loss) Recognized within Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses)
 
December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Interest rate contracts
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps, caps, floors, and forwards
$
(15
)
$
(172
)
$
50

Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
Foreign currency swaps and forwards
18

6

5

Fixed payout annuity hedge [1]
(21
)
(148
)
(268
)
Credit contracts
 
 
 
Credit derivatives that purchase credit protection
8

(10
)
(38
)
Credit derivatives that assume credit risk
(11
)
16

71

Equity contracts
 
 
 
Equity index swaps and options
19

3

(33
)
Commodity contracts
 
 
 
Commodity options
(9
)


Variable annuity hedge program
 
 
 
GMWB product derivative
(59
)
(2
)
1,306

GMWB reinsurance contracts
17

4

(192
)
GMWB hedging instruments
(45
)
3

(852
)
Macro hedge program
(46
)
(11
)
(234
)
Other
 
 
 
Contingent capital facility put option
(6
)
(6
)
(7
)
Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
46

(34
)
67

Derivative instruments formerly associated with HLIKK [2]

(2
)

Total [3]
$
(104
)
$
(353
)
$
(125
)
[1]
The associated liability is adjusted for changes in spot rates through realized capital gains and was $4, $116 and $250 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively, which is not presented in this table
[2]
These amounts relate to the termination of the hedging program associated with the Japan variable annuity product due to the sale of HLIKK.
[3]
Excludes investments that contain an embedded credit derivative for which the Company has elected the fair value option. For further discussion, see the Fair Value Option section in Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements.
For the year ended December 31, 2015 the net realized capital gain (loss) related to derivatives used in non-qualifying strategies was primarily comprised of the following:
The net gain related to foreign currency swaps and forwards was primarily driven by foreign currency forwards used to hedge the currency impacts on changes in equity of a P&C runoff entity in the United Kingdom. Also included were gains on foreign currency forwards used to hedge Japanese yen-denominated cash and equity securities.
The net loss related to the yen denominated fixed payout annuity hedge was primarily driven by a decline in long term U.S. interest rates and a depreciation of the Japanese yen in relation to the U.S. dollar.
The net gain related to equity derivatives was primarily driven by a total return swap used to hedge equity securities that increased due to a decline in Japanese equity markets since inception. An offsetting change in value was recorded on the equity securities since the Company has elected the fair value option in order to align the accounting with the derivative, resulting in changes in value on both the equity securities and the derivative recorded in net realized capital gains and losses. For further discussion, see the Fair Value Option section in Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements.

F-60

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


The net loss related to the combined GMWB hedging program, which includes the GMWB product, reinsurance, and hedging derivatives, was primarily driven by liability model assumption updates, and underperformance of the underlying actively managed funds compared to their respective indices.
The net loss on the macro hedge program was primarily due to time decay on options.
The gain associated with modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts, which are accounted for as embedded derivatives and transfer to the reinsurer the investment experience related to the assets supporting the reinsured policies, was primarily driven by widening credit spreads and an increase in interest rates. The assets remain on the Company's books and the Company recorded an offsetting gain in AOCI as a result of the increase in market value of the bonds.
In addition, for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company recognized gains of $3 and $13, respectively, due to cash recovered on derivative receivables that were previously written-off related to the bankruptcy of Lehman Brothers Inc. The derivative receivables were the result of the contractual collateral threshold amounts and open collateral calls prior to the bankruptcy filing as well as interest rate and credit spread movements from the date of the last collateral call to the date of the bankruptcy filing. For the year ended December 31, 2013, there were no recognized gains due to derivative receivables that were previously written-off related to the bankruptcy of Lehman Brothers Inc.
For the year ended December 31, 2014 the net realized capital gain (loss) related to derivatives used in non-qualifying strategies was primarily comprised of the following:
The net loss related to interest rate derivatives was driven by a decline in U.S. interest rates.
The net loss related to the yen denominated fixed annuity payout hedge was primarily driven by a decline in U.S. interest rates and a depreciation of the Japanese yen in relation to the U.S. dollar.
The loss associated with modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts, which are accounted for as embedded derivatives and transfer to the reinsurer the investment experience related to the assets supporting the reinsured policies, was primarily driven by a decline in long-term interest rates, partially offset by credit spread widening. The assets remain on the Company's books and the Company recorded an offsetting gain in AOCI as a result of the increase in market value of the bonds.
For the year ended December 31, 2013 the net realized capital gain (loss) related to derivatives used in non-qualifying strategies was primarily due to the following:
The net loss related to the yen denominated fixed payout annuity hedge was primarily driven by a depreciation of the Japanese yen in relation to the U.S. dollar.
The net loss on the macro hedge program was primarily due to an improvement in domestic equity markets, and a decline in equity volatility.
The net gain related to the combined GMWB hedging program, which includes the GMWB product, reinsurance, and hedging derivatives, was primarily driven by revaluing the liability for living benefits resulting from favorable policyholder behavior largely related to increased full surrenders and liability model assumption updates for partial lapses and withdrawal rates.
Refer to Note 12 - Commitments and Contingencies for additional disclosures regarding contingent credit related features in derivative agreements.
Credit Risk Assumed through Credit Derivatives
The Company enters into credit default swaps that assume credit risk of a single entity or referenced index in order to synthetically replicate investment transactions that would be permissible under the Company's investment policies. The Company will receive periodic payments based on an agreed upon rate and notional amount and will only make a payment if there is a credit event. A credit event payment will typically be equal to the notional value of the swap contract less the value of the referenced security issuer’s debt obligation after the occurrence of the credit event. A credit event is generally defined as a default on contractually obligated interest or principal payments or bankruptcy of the referenced entity. The credit default swaps in which the Company assumes credit risk primarily reference investment grade single corporate issuers and baskets, which include standard diversified portfolios of corporate and CMBS issuers. The diversified portfolios of corporate issuers are established within sector concentration limits and may be divided into tranches that possess different credit ratings.

F-61

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


The following tables present the notional amount, fair value, weighted average years to maturity, underlying referenced credit obligation type and average credit ratings, and offsetting notional amounts and fair value for credit derivatives in which the Company is assuming credit risk as of December 31, 2015 and 2014.
As of December 31, 2015
 
 
 
 
Underlying Referenced Credit Obligation(s) [1]
 
 
Credit Derivative Type by Derivative Risk Exposure
Notional Amount [2]
Fair Value
Weighted Average Years to Maturity
Type
Average Credit Rating
Offsetting Notional Amount [3]
Offsetting Fair Value [3]
Single name credit default swaps
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
$
190

$
(1
)
1 year
Corporate Credit/
Foreign Gov.
BBB+
$
176

$
(1
)
Below investment grade risk exposure
77

(2
)
2 years
Corporate Credit
B
77

1

Basket credit default swaps [4]
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
3,036

22

4 years
Corporate Credit
BBB+
1,411

(13
)
Investment grade risk exposure
681

(19
)
6 years
CMBS Credit
AA+
212

1

Below investment grade risk exposure
153

(25
)
1 year
CMBS Credit
CCC
153

25

Embedded credit derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
350

346

1 year
Corporate Credit
A+


Total [5]
$
4,487

$
321

 
 
 
$
2,029

$
13

As of December 31, 2014
 
 
 
 
Unifying Referenced Credit Obligation(s) [1]
 
 
Credit Derivative Type by Derivative Risk Exposure
Notional Amount [2]
Fair Value
Weighted Average Years to Maturity
Type
Average Credit Rating
Offsetting Notional Amount [3]
Offsetting Fair Value [3]
Single name credit default swaps
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
$
320

$
5

2 years
Corporate Credit/
Foreign Gov.
BBB+
$
247

$
(5
)
Below investment grade risk exposure
29


2 years
Corporate Credit
BB
29

(1
)
Basket credit default swaps [4]
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
2,546

33

3 years
Corporate Credit
BBB
1,973

(25
)
Below investment grade risk exposure
38

(1
)
12 years
Corporate Credit
D


Investment grade risk exposure
722

(12
)
6 years
CMBS Credit
AA+
269

3

Below investment grade risk exposure
154

(22
)
2 years
CMBS Credit
CCC+
154

23

Embedded credit derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
350

342

2 years
Corporate Credit
A


Total [5]
$
4,159

$
345

 
 
 
$
2,672

$
(5
)
[1]
The average credit ratings are based on availability and the midpoint of the applicable ratings among Moody’s, S&P, Fitch and Morningstar. If no rating is available from a rating agency, then an internally developed rating is used.
[2]
Notional amount is equal to the maximum potential future loss amount. These derivatives are governed by agreements, clearing house rules and applicable law which include collateral posting requirements. There is no additional specific collateral related to these contracts or recourse provisions included in the contracts to offset losses.
[3]
The Company has entered into offsetting credit default swaps to terminate certain existing credit default swaps, thereby offsetting the future changes in value of, or losses paid related to, the original swap.
[4]
Includes $3.9 billion and $3.5 billion as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, of notional amount on swaps of standard market indices of diversified portfolios of corporate and CMBS issuers referenced through credit default swaps. These swaps are subsequently valued based upon the observable standard market index.
[5]
Excludes investments that contain an embedded credit derivative for which the Company has elected the fair value option. For further discussion, see the Fair Value Option section in Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements.

F-62

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)


Derivative Collateral Arrangements
The Company enters into various collateral arrangements in connection with its derivative instruments, which require both the pledging and accepting of collateral. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company pledged cash collateral associated with derivative instruments with a fair value of $488 and $120, respectively, for which the collateral receivable has been primarily included within other assets on the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company also pledged securities collateral associated with derivative instruments with a fair value of $1.1 billion and $1.1 billion, respectively, which have been included in fixed maturities on the Consolidated Balance Sheets. The counterparties have the right to sell or re-pledge these securities.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company accepted cash collateral associated with derivative instruments of $369 and $327, respectively, which was invested and recorded in the Consolidated Balance Sheets in fixed maturities and short-term investments with corresponding amounts recorded in other liabilities. The Company also accepted securities collateral as of December 31, 2015 and 2014 with a fair value of $100 and $109, respectively, of which the Company has the ability to sell or repledge $100 and $97, respectively. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company had no repledged securities and did not sell any securities. In addition, as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, non-cash collateral accepted was held in separate custodial accounts and was not included in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.
7. Deferred Policy Acquisition Costs
Changes in the DAC balance are as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Balance, beginning of period
$
1,823

$
2,161

$
5,725

Deferred costs
1,390

1,364

1,330

Amortization — DAC
(1,571
)
(1,593
)
(1,615
)
Amortization — Unlock benefit (charge), pre-tax [1]
69

(136
)
(1,086
)
Amortization — DAC related to business dispositions [2] [3]


(2,229
)
Adjustments to unrealized gains and losses on securities AFS and other
105

27

122

Effect of currency translation


(86
)
Balance, end of period
$
1,816

$
1,823

$
2,161

[1]
Includes Unlock charge of $887 related to elimination of future estimated gross profits on the HLIKK variable annuity block in 2013. As a result of the HLIKK annuity business sale completed in June 2014, this Unlock charge has been reclassified to discontinued operations. For further information regarding this transaction, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
[2]
Includes accelerated amortization of $352 and $2,374 recognized upon the sale of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses, respectively, in 2013. For further information, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
[3]
Includes previously unrealized gains on securities AFS of $148 and $349 recognized upon the sale of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses, respectively, in 2013.

F-63

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
8. Goodwill


The carrying value of goodwill allocated to reporting units as of December 31, 2015 and 2014 is as follows:
 
Gross
Accumulated Impairments
Carrying Value
Personal Lines
$
119

$

$
119

Mutual Funds
149


149

Corporate [1]
585

(355
)
230

Total
$
853

$
(355
)
$
498

[1]
Goodwill within Corporate is primarily attributed to the Company’s “buy-back” of Hartford Life, Inc. ("HLI") in 2000 and was allocated to each of Hartford Life’s reporting units based on the reporting unit’s fair value of in-force business at the buy-back date. Although this goodwill was allocated to each reporting unit, it is held in Corporate for segment reporting. Accumulated impairments relate to reporting units with no remaining goodwill. Carrying value as of December 31, 2015 and 2014 includes $138 and $92 for the Group Benefits and Mutual Funds reporting units, respectively.
Year ended December 31, 2015
The annual goodwill assessment for the Mutual Funds, Group Benefits, and Personal Lines reporting units was completed as of October 31, 2015, which resulted in no write-downs of goodwill for the year ended December 31, 2015. All reporting units passed the first step of their annual impairment test with a significant margin.
Year ended December 31, 2014
The annual goodwill assessment for the Group Benefits, Personal Lines, and Mutual Funds reporting units was completed as of October 31, 2014, which resulted in no write-downs of goodwill for the year ended December 31, 2014. The reporting units passed the first step of their annual impairment test with a significant margin with the exception of the Group Benefits reporting unit. Group Benefits passed the first step of its annual impairment test with less than a 10% margin. The fair value of the Group Benefits reporting unit is based on discounted cash flows using earnings projections on in force business and future business growth.
Year ended December 31, 2013
During the first quarter of 2013, the Company completed the sale of its Retirement Plans business to MassMutual. Accordingly, the carrying value of the reporting unit's goodwill of $156 was reduced and included in reinsurance loss on disposition in the Company's Consolidated Statements of Operations.
The annual goodwill assessment for the Mutual Funds, Group Benefits, and Personal Lines reporting units was completed as of October 31, 2013, which resulted in no write-downs of goodwill for the year ended December 31, 2013. All reporting units passed the first step of their annual impairment test with a significant margin.

F-64

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
9. Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features

U.S. GMDB/GMWB, International GMDB/GMIB, and Universal Life Secondary Guarantee Benefits
Changes in the gross U.S. GMDB/GMWB, International GMDB/GMIB, and universal life secondary guarantee benefits are as follows:
 
U.S. GMDB/GMWB [1]
Universal Life Secondary
Guarantees
Liability balance as of January 1, 2015
$
812

$
2,041

Incurred [2]
163

272

Paid
(112
)

Liability balance as of December 31, 2015
$
863

$
2,313

Reinsurance recoverable asset, as of January 1, 2015
$
481

$
2,041

Incurred [2]
131

272

Paid
(89
)

Reinsurance recoverable asset, as of December 31, 2015
$
523

$
2,313

 
U.S. GMDB/GMWB [1]
International
GMDB/GMIB
Universal Life Secondary
Guarantees
Liability balance as of January 1, 2014
$
849

$
272

$
1,802

Incurred [2]
73

(13
)
239

Paid
(110
)
(15
)

Impact of HLIKK business disposition

(254
)

Currency translation adjustment

10


Liability balance as of December 31, 2014
$
812

$

$
2,041

Reinsurance recoverable asset, as of January 1, 2014
$
533

$
23

$
1,802

Incurred [2]
33

7

239

Paid
(85
)
(4
)

Impact of HLIKK business disposition

(27
)

Currency translation adjustment

1


Reinsurance recoverable asset, as of December 31, 2014
$
481

$

$
2,041

[1]
These liability balances include all GMDB benefits, plus the life-contingent portion of GMWB benefits in excess of the return of the GRB. GMWB benefits up to the return of the GRB are embedded derivatives held at fair value and are excluded from these balances.
[2]
Includes the portion of assessments established as additions to reserves as well as changes in estimates affecting the reserves.

F-65

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
9. Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features (continued)

The following table provides details concerning GMDB/GMWB exposure as of December 31, 2015:
Account Value by GMDB/GMWB Type
Maximum Anniversary Value (“MAV”) [1]
Account
Value
(“AV”) [8]
Net Amount
at Risk
(“NAR”) [9]
Retained Net Amount at Risk (“RNAR”) [9]
Weighted Average
Attained Age of
Annuitant
MAV only
$
14,540

$
2,743

$
477

70
With 5% rollup [2]
1,257

227

77

71
With Earnings Protection Benefit Rider (“EPB”) [3]
3,697

490

77

69
With 5% rollup & EPB
487

107

23

72
Total MAV
19,981

3,567

654

 
Asset Protection Benefit (“APB”) [4]
11,707

519

346

69
Lifetime Income Benefit (“LIB”) – Death Benefit [5]
516

9

9

69
Reset [6] (5-7 years)
2,582

32

32

70
Return of Premium (“ROP”) [7]/Other
9,459

71

64

68
Subtotal Variable Annuity with GMDB/GMWB [10]
44,245

4,198

1,105

69
Less: General Account Value with GMDB/GMWB
3,822

 
 
 
Subtotal Separate Account Liabilities with GMDB
$
40,423

 
 
 
Separate Account Liabilities without GMDB
$
79,700

 
 
 
Total Separate Account Liabilities
$
120,123

 
 
 
[1]
MAV GMDB is the greatest of current AV, net premiums paid and the highest AV on any anniversary before age 80 years (adjusted for withdrawals).
[2]
Rollup GMDB is the greatest of the MAV, current AV, net premium paid and premiums (adjusted for withdrawals) accumulated at generally 5% simple interest up to the earlier of age 80 years or 100% of adjusted premiums.
[3]
EPB GMDB is the greatest of the MAV, current AV, or contract value plus a percentage of the contract’s growth. The contract’s growth is AV less premiums net of withdrawals, subject to a cap of 200% of premiums net of withdrawals.
[4]
APB GMDB is the greater of current AV or MAV, not to exceed current AV plus 25% times the greater of net premiums and MAV (each adjusted for premiums in the past 12 months).
[5]
LIB GMDB is the greatest of current AV; net premiums paid; or for certain contracts, a benefit amount generally based on market performance that ratchets over time.
[6]
Reset GMDB is the greatest of current AV, net premiums paid and the most recent five to seven year anniversary AV before age 80 years (adjusted for withdrawals).
[7]
ROP GMDB is the greater of current AV or net premiums paid.
[8]
AV includes the contract holder’s investment in the separate account and the general account.
[9]
NAR is defined as the guaranteed benefit in excess of the current AV. RNAR represents NAR reduced for reinsurance. NAR and RNAR are highly sensitive to equity markets movements and increase when equity markets decline.
[10]
Some variable annuity contracts with GMDB also have a life-contingent GMWB that may provide for benefits in excess of the return of the GRB. Such contracts included in this amount have $7.0 billion of total account value and weighted average attained age of 71 years. There is no NAR or retained NAR related to these contracts.
In the U.S., account balances of contracts with guarantees were invested in variable separate accounts as follows:
Asset Type
As of December 31, 2015
As of December 31, 2014
Equity securities (including mutual funds)
$
36,970

$
44,786

Cash and cash equivalents
3,453

4,066

Total
$
40,423

$
48,852

As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, approximately 17% of the equity securities (including mutual funds), in the preceding table were funds invested in fixed income securities and approximately 83% were funds invested in equity securities.
For further information on guaranteed living benefits that are accounted for at fair value, such as GMWB, see Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-66

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
10. Reserves for Future Policy Benefits and Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses


Property and Casualty Insurance Products Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
A roll-forward of liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
21,806

$
21,704

$
21,716

Reinsurance and other recoverables
3,041

3,028

3,027

Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
18,765

18,676

18,689

Provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
 

 

 

Current accident year
6,647

6,572

6,621

Prior accident year development
250

228

192

Total provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
6,897

6,800

6,813

Less: payments
 

 

 

Current accident year
2,653

2,639

2,552

Prior accident years
4,066

4,072

4,274

Total payments
6,719

6,711

6,826

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
18,943

18,765

18,676

Reinsurance and other recoverables [1]
2,882

3,041

3,028

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
21,825

$
21,806

$
21,704

[1]
Includes reinsurance recoverables of $2,515, $2,730 and $2,735 as of December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, property and casualty insurance products reserves were discounted by a total of $523 and $556, respectively. The current accident year benefit from discounting property and casualty insurance products reserves was $35 in 2015, $34 in 2014 and $46 in 2013. The reduction in the discount benefit in 2014 as compared to 2013 reflects lower claim volume and a shorter than expected payment pattern in 2014. Accretion of discounts for prior accident years totaled $38 in 2015, $31 in 2014, and $31 in 2013.
The reserves recorded for the Company’s property and casualty insurance products at December 31, 2015 represent the Company’s best estimate of its ultimate liability for losses and loss adjustment expenses related to losses covered by policies written by the Company. However, because of the significant uncertainties surrounding reserves, and particularly asbestos and environmental exposures, it is possible that management’s estimate of the ultimate liabilities for these claims may change and that the required adjustment to recorded reserves could exceed the currently recorded reserves by an amount that could be material to the Company’s results of operations or cash flows. For additional information, see Note 12 - Commitments and Contingencies, Guaranty Fund and Other Insurance-related Assessments.
Losses and loss adjustment expenses are also impacted by trends including frequency and severity as well as changes in the legislative and regulatory environment. In the case of the reserves for asbestos exposures, factors contributing to the high degree of uncertainty include inadequate loss development patterns, plaintiffs’ expanding theories of liability, the risks inherent in major litigation, and inconsistent emerging legal doctrines. In the case of the reserves for environmental exposures, factors contributing to the high degree of uncertainty include expanding theories of liabilities and damages, the risks inherent in major litigation, inconsistent decisions concerning the existence and scope of coverage for environmental claims, and uncertainty as to the monetary amount being sought by the claimant from the insured.

F-67

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
10. Reserves for Future Policy Benefits and Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses (continued)

The following table presents (favorable) unfavorable prior accident year development:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Auto liability
$
54

$
25

$
144

Homeowners
9

(7
)
(6
)
Professional liability
(36
)
(17
)
(29
)
Package business
28

3

2

General liability
8

(25
)
(75
)
Bond
(2
)
8

(8
)
Commercial property
(6
)
2

(7
)
Net asbestos reserves
146

212

130

Net environmental reserves
55

30

12

Uncollectible reinsurance


(25
)
Workers’ compensation
(37
)
(7
)
(2
)
Workers’ compensation - NY 25a Fund for Reopened Cases


80

Workers’ compensation discount accretion
29

30

30

Catastrophes
(18
)
(45
)
(63
)
Other reserve re-estimates, net
20

19

9

Total prior accident year development
$
250

$
228

$
192

Net unfavorable reserve development in 2015 primarily included the following:
an increase in commercial auto liability reserves, predominantly for accident years 2010 through 2013;
an increase in package business reserves driven by higher than expected severity on liability claims;
an increase in net asbestos and net environmental reserves driven by the annual ground-up asbestos and environmental reserve evaluations;
partially offset by a decrease in professional liability reserves, for accident years 2009 through 2012;
also offset by a decrease in and workers' compensation reserves, due to an improvement in claim closure rates resulting in a decrease in outstanding claims for permanently disabled claimants; and
also offset by a decrease in catastrophe reserves primarily for accident year 2014.
Net unfavorable reserve development in 2014 primarily included the following:
an increase in commercial auto liability reserves, for several accident years;
an increase in net asbestos reserves driven by the annual ground-up asbestos reserve evaluation;
partially offset by a decrease in general liability reserves due to lower frequency in late emerging claims; and
also offset by a decrease in professional liability reserves, for accident years 2010, 2012 and 2013; and
also offset by a decrease in catastrophe reserves primarily for accident year 2013.
Net unfavorable reserve development in 2013 primarily included the following:
an increase in commercial auto liability reserves, for accident years 2010 through 2012;
an increase related to the closing of the New York Section 25A Fund for Reopened Cases;
an increase in net asbestos reserves driven by the annual ground-up asbestos reserve evaluation;
partially offset by a decrease in general liability reserves, for accident years 2006 through 2011; and
also offset by a decrease in professional liability reserves, for accident years 2008 through 2012; and
also offset by a decrease in catastrophe reserves primarily related to Storm Sandy.

F-68

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
10. Reserves for Future Policy Benefits and Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses (continued)

Life Insurance, Disability and Accident Products Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
A roll-forward of liabilities for group life, disability and accident, for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
6,084

$
6,308

$
6,547

Reinsurance recoverables
271

267

252

Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
5,813

6,041

6,295

Provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
Current accident year
2,371

2,370

2,534

Prior accident year development
64

(11
)
(17
)
Total provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
2,435

2,359

2,517

Less: payments
 
 
 
Current accident year
1,214

1,161

1,207

Prior accident years
1,354

1,426

1,564

Total payments
2,568

2,587

2,771

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
5,680

5,813

6,041

Reinsurance recoverables
285

271

267

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
5,965

$
6,084

$
6,308

The liability for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses for group life, disability and accident contracts was discounted to present value using rates based on the Company’s earned investment yield estimated at the time the claims are incurred. The increase in the provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses is primarily due to higher claim severity on the long-term disability product.
The liability for future policy benefits and unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses is as follows:
 
As of December 31,
 
2015
2014
Group life term, disability and accident unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
$
5,965

$
6,084

Group life other unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
174

203

Individual life unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
257

171

Future policy benefits
13,351

13,180

Future policy benefits, unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
$
19,747

$
19,638


F-69

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
11. Debt


The Company’s long-term debt securities are issued by either HFSG Holding Company or HLI, and are unsecured obligations of HFSG Holding Company or HLI, and rank on a parity with all other unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness of HFSG Holding Company or HLI.
Debt is carried net of discount. Short-term and long-term debt by issuance are as follows:
 
As of December 31,
 
2015
2014
Revolving Credit Facilities
$

$

Senior Notes and Debentures
 

 

4.0% Notes, due 2015

289

7.3% Notes, due 2015

167

5.5% Notes, due 2016
275

275

5.375% Notes, due 2017
416

415

4.0% Notes, due 2017

295

6.3% Notes, due 2018
320

320

6.0% Notes, due 2019
413

413

5.5% Notes, due 2020
499

499

5.125% Notes, due 2022
797

797

7.65% Notes, due 2027
80

80

7.375% Notes, due 2031
63

63

5.95% Notes, due 2036
299

299

6.625% Notes, due 2040
295

295

6.1% Notes, due 2041
326

326

6.625% Notes, due 2042
178

178

4.3% Notes, due 2043
298

298

Junior Subordinated Debentures
 

 

7.875% Notes, due 2042
600

600

8.125% Notes, due 2068
500

500

Total Notes and Debentures
5,359

6,109

Less: Current maturities
275

456

Long-Term Debt
5,084

5,653

Total Debt
$
5,359

$
6,109

The effective interest rate on the 6.1% senior notes due 2041 is 7.9%. The effective interest rate on the remaining notes does not differ materially from the stated rate. The Company incurred interest expense of $357, $376 and $397 on long-term debt for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Collateralized Advances
Hartford Life Insurance Company (“HLIC”), an indirect wholly owned subsidiary, is a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston (“FHLBB”). Membership allows HLIC access to collateralized advances, which may be used to support various spread-based businesses and enhance liquidity management. FHLBB membership requires the company to own member stock and advances require the purchase of activity stock. The amount of advances that can be taken are dependent on the asset types pledged to secure the advances. The Connecticut Department of Insurance (“CTDOI”) will permit HLIC to pledge up to $1.2 billion in qualifying assets to secure FHLBB advances for 2016. The pledge limit is recalculated annually based on statutory admitted assets and capital and surplus. HLIC would need to seek the prior approval of the CTDOI in order to exceed these limits. As of December 31, 2015, HLIC had no advances outstanding under the FHLBB facility.
Senior Notes
On March 30, 2015, the Company repaid its $289, 4.0% senior notes at maturity. On May 27, 2015, the Company redeemed for cash the entire $296 aggregate principal amount outstanding of 4.0% senior notes due October 15, 2017 for $317 including a make-whole premium. On November 2, 2015, the Company repaid its $167, 7.3% senior notes at maturity. The Company funded the maturities of the 4.0% and 7.3% senior notes along with the redemption of the 4.0% senior notes with cash on hand.

F-70

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
11. Debt (continued)

Junior Subordinated Debentures
Issue
Face Value
Interest Rate [1]
Call Date
Interest Rate Subsequent to Call Date [2]
Final Maturity
7.875% Debentures
$
600

7.875
%
[2]
April 15, 2022
3 Month LIBOR + 5.596%
April 15, 2042
8.125% Debentures [3]
$
500

8.125
%
[4]
June 15, 2018
3 Month LIBOR + 4.6025%
June 15, 2068
[1]
Interest rate in effect until call date.
[2]
Payable quarterly in arrears.
[3]
The 8.125% debentures have a scheduled maturity date of June 15, 2038. The Company is required to use reasonable efforts to sell certain qualifying replacement securities in order to repay the debentures at the scheduled maturity date.
[4]
Payable semi-annually in arrears.
The debentures are unsecured, subordinated and junior in right of payment and upon liquidation to all of the Company’s existing and future senior indebtedness. In addition, the debentures are effectively subordinated to all of the Company’s subsidiaries’ existing and future indebtedness and other liabilities, including obligations to policyholders. The debentures do not limit the Company’s or the Company’s subsidiaries’ ability to incur additional debt, including debt that ranks senior in right of payment and upon liquidation to the debentures.
The Company has the right to defer interest payments for up to ten consecutive years without giving rise to an event of default. Deferred interest will continue to accrue and will accrue additional interest at the then applicable interest rate. If the Company defers interest payments, the Company generally may not make payments on or redeem or purchase any shares of its capital stock or any of its debt securities or guarantees that rank upon liquidation, dissolution or winding up equally with or junior to the debentures, subject to certain limited exceptions. If the Company defers interest on the 8.125% debentures for five consecutive years or, if earlier, pays current interest during a deferral period, the Company will be required to pay deferred interest from proceeds from the sale of certain qualifying securities.
The 7.875% and 8.125% debentures may be redeemed in whole prior to the call date upon certain tax or rating agency events, at a price equal to the greater of 100% of the principal amount being redeemed and the applicable make-whole amount plus any accrued and unpaid interest. The Company may elect to redeem the 8.125% debentures in whole or part at its option prior to the call date at a price equal to the greater of 100% of the principal amount being redeemed and the applicable make-whole amount plus any accrued and unpaid interest. The Company may elect to redeem the 7.875% and 8.125% debentures in whole or in part on or after the call date for the principal amount being redeemed plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.
In connection with the offering of the 8.125% debentures, the Company entered into a replacement capital covenant ("RCC") for the benefit of holders of one or more designated series of the Company's indebtedness, initially the Company’s 6.1% notes due 2041. Under the terms of the RCC, if the Company redeems the 8.125% debentures at any time prior to June 15, 2048 it can only do so with the proceeds from the sale of certain qualifying replacement securities.
Long-Term Debt Maturities
Long-term debt maturities (at par values), as of December 31, 2015 are summarized as follows:
2016
$
275

2017
416

2018
320

2019
413

2020
500

Thereafter
3,525

Shelf Registrations
On August 9, 2013, the Company filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) an automatic shelf registration statement (Registration No. 333-190506) for the potential offering and sale of debt and equity securities. The registration statement allows for the following types of securities to be offered: debt securities, junior subordinated debt securities, preferred stock, common stock, depositary shares, warrants, stock purchase contracts, and stock purchase units. In that The Hartford is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Act of 1933, the registration statement went effective immediately upon filing and The Hartford may offer and sell an unlimited amount of securities under the registration statement during the three-year life of the registration statement.

F-71

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
11. Debt (continued)

Contingent Capital Facility
The Company is party to a put option agreement that provides The Hartford with the right to require the Glen Meadow ABC Trust, a Delaware statutory trust, at any time and from time to time, to purchase The Hartford’s junior subordinated notes in a maximum aggregate principal amount not to exceed $500. Under the Put Option Agreement, The Hartford pays the Glen Meadow ABC Trust premiums on a periodic basis, calculated with respect to the aggregate principal amount of notes that The Hartford had the right to put to the Glen Meadow ABC Trust for such period. The Hartford has agreed to reimburse the Glen Meadow ABC Trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses. The Company holds a variable interest in the Glen Meadow ABC Trust where the Company is not the primary beneficiary. As a result, the Company did not consolidate the Glen Meadow ABC Trust. As of December 31, 2015, The Hartford has not exercised its right to require Glen Meadow ABC Trust to purchase the notes. As a result, the notes remain a source of capital for the HFSG Holding Company.
Revolving Credit Facilities
The Company has a senior unsecured five-year revolving credit facility (the “Credit Facility”) that provides for borrowing capacity up to$1.0 billion of unsecured credit through October 31, 2019 available in U.S. dollars, Euro, Sterling, Canadian dollars and Japanese Yen. As of December 31, 2015, no borrowings were outstanding under the Credit Facility. As of December 31, 2015, the Company was in compliance with all financial covenants within the Credit Facility.
Commercial Paper
The Hartford’s maximum borrowings available under its commercial paper program are $1.0 billion. The Company is dependent upon market conditions to access short-term financing through the issuance of commercial paper to investors. As of December 31, 2015, there was no commercial paper outstanding.

F-72

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
12. Commitments and Contingencies


Contingencies Relating to Corporate Litigation and Regulatory Matters
Management evaluates each contingent matter separately. A loss is recorded if probable and reasonably estimable. Management establishes liabilities for these contingencies at its “best estimate,” or, if no one number within the range of possible losses is more probable than any other, the Company records an estimated liability at the low end of the range of losses.
Litigation
The Hartford is involved in claims litigation arising in the ordinary course of business, both as a liability insurer defending or providing indemnity for third-party claims brought against insureds and as an insurer defending coverage claims brought against it. The Hartford accounts for such activity through the establishment of unpaid loss and loss adjustment expense reserves. Subject to the uncertainties in the following discussion under the caption “Asbestos and Environmental Claims,” management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such ordinary-course claims litigation, after consideration of provisions made for potential losses and costs of defense, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flows of The Hartford.
The Hartford is also involved in other kinds of legal actions, some of which assert claims for substantial amounts. These actions include, among others, and in addition to the matters in the following discussion, putative state and federal class actions seeking certification of a state or national class. Such putative class actions have alleged, for example, underpayment of claims or improper underwriting practices in connection with various kinds of insurance policies, such as personal and commercial automobile, property, disability, life and inland marine. The Hartford also is involved in individual actions in which punitive damages are sought, such as claims alleging bad faith in the handling of insurance claims or other allegedly unfair or improper business practices. Like many other insurers, The Hartford also has been joined in actions by asbestos plaintiffs asserting, among other things, that insurers had a duty to protect the public from the dangers of asbestos and that insurers committed unfair trade practices by asserting defenses on behalf of their policyholders in the underlying asbestos cases. Management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such lawsuits, after consideration of provisions made for estimated losses, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition of The Hartford. Nonetheless, given the large or indeterminate amounts sought in certain of these actions, and the inherent unpredictability of litigation, the outcome in certain matters could, from time to time, have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations or cash flows in particular quarterly or annual periods.
In addition to the inherent difficulty of predicting litigation outcomes, the Mutual Funds Litigation identified below purports to seek substantial damages for unsubstantiated conduct spanning a multi-year period based on novel applications of complex legal theories. The alleged damages are not quantified or factually supported in the complaint, and, in any event, the Company's experience shows that demands for damages often bear little relation to a reasonable estimate of potential loss. The court has made no substantive legal decisions defining the scope of the claims or the potentially available damages, and no legal precedent has been identified that would aid in determining a reasonable estimate of potential loss. Accordingly, management cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss or range of loss, if any.
Mutual Funds Litigation - In February 2011, a derivative action was brought on behalf of six Hartford retail mutual funds in the United States District Court for the District of New Jersey, alleging that Hartford Investment Financial Services, LLC (“HIFSCO”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company, received excessive advisory and distribution fees in violation of its statutory fiduciary duty under Section 36(b) of the Investment Company Act of 1940.  HIFSCO moved to dismiss and, in September 2011, the motion was granted in part and denied in part, with leave to amend the complaint. In November 2011, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint on behalf of The Hartford Global Health Fund, The Hartford Conservative Allocation Fund, The Hartford Growth Opportunities Fund, The Hartford Inflation Plus Fund, The Hartford Advisors Fund, and The Hartford Capital Appreciation Fund. Plaintiffs seek to rescind the investment management agreements and distribution plans between HIFSCO and these funds and to recover the total fees charged thereunder or, in the alternative, to recover any improper compensation HIFSCO received, in addition to lost earnings. HIFSCO filed a partial motion to dismiss the amended complaint and, in December 2012, the court dismissed without prejudice the claims regarding distribution fees and denied the motion with respect to the advisory fees claims. In March 2014, the plaintiffs filed a new complaint that, among other things, added as new plaintiffs The Hartford Floating Rate Fund and The Hartford Small Company Fund and named as a defendant Hartford Funds Management Company, LLC (“HFMC”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company which assumed the role as advisor to the funds as of January 2013. In March 2015, the plaintiffs filed a new complaint that, among other things, removed The Hartford Small Company Fund as a plaintiff. HFMC and HIFSCO dispute the allegations and moved for summary judgment in June 2015. At the same time, plaintiffs moved for partial summary judgment with respect to The Hartford Capital Appreciation Fund.

F-73

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
12. Commitments and Contingencies (continued)

Asbestos and Environmental Claims
The Company continues to receive asbestos and environmental claims. Asbestos claims relate primarily to bodily injuries asserted by people who came in contact with asbestos or products containing asbestos. Environmental claims relate primarily to pollution and related clean-up costs.
The Company wrote several different categories of insurance contracts that may cover asbestos and environmental claims. First, the Company wrote primary policies providing the first layer of coverage in an insured’s liability program. Second, the Company wrote excess policies providing higher layers of coverage for losses that exhaust the limits of underlying coverage. Third, the Company acted as a reinsurer assuming a portion of those risks assumed by other insurers writing primary, excess and reinsurance coverages. Fourth, subsidiaries of the Company participated in the London Market, writing both direct insurance and assumed reinsurance business.
Significant uncertainty limits the ability of insurers and reinsurers to estimate the ultimate reserves necessary for unpaid losses and expenses related to environmental and particularly asbestos claims. The degree of variability of reserve estimates for these exposures is significantly greater than for other more traditional exposures.
In the case of the reserves for asbestos exposures, factors contributing to the high degree of uncertainty include inadequate loss development patterns, plaintiffs’ expanding theories of liability, the risks inherent in major litigation, and inconsistent emerging legal doctrines. Furthermore, over time, insurers, including the Company, have experienced significant changes in the rate at which asbestos claims are brought, the claims experience of particular insureds, and the value of claims, making predictions of future exposure from past experience uncertain. Plaintiffs and insureds also have sought to use bankruptcy proceedings, including “pre-packaged” bankruptcies, to accelerate and increase loss payments by insurers. In addition, some policyholders have asserted new classes of claims for coverages to which an aggregate limit of liability may not apply. Further uncertainties include insolvencies of other carriers and unanticipated developments pertaining to the Company’s ability to recover reinsurance for asbestos and environmental claims. Management believes these issues are not likely to be resolved in the near future.
In the case of the reserves for environmental exposures, factors contributing to the high degree of uncertainty include expanding theories of liability and damages, the risks inherent in major litigation, inconsistent decisions concerning the existence and scope of coverage for environmental claims, and uncertainty as to the monetary amount being sought by the claimant from the insured.
The reporting pattern for assumed reinsurance claims, including those related to asbestos and environmental claims, is much longer than for direct claims. In many instances, it takes months or years to determine that the policyholder’s own obligations have been met and how the reinsurance in question may apply to such claims. The delay in reporting reinsurance claims and exposures adds to the uncertainty of estimating the related reserves.
It is also not possible to predict changes in the legal and legislative environment and their effect on the future development of asbestos and environmental claims.
Given the factors described above, the Company believes the actuarial tools and other techniques it employs to estimate the ultimate cost of claims for more traditional kinds of insurance exposure are less precise in estimating reserves for asbestos and environmental exposures. For this reason, the Company principally relies on exposure-based analysis to estimate the ultimate costs of these claims and regularly evaluates new account information in assessing its potential asbestos and environmental exposures. The Company supplements this exposure-based analysis with evaluations of the Company’s historical direct net loss and expense paid and reported experience, and net loss and expense paid and reported experience by calendar and/or report year, to assess any emerging trends, fluctuations or characteristics suggested by the aggregate paid and reported activity.
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company reported $1.7 billion of net asbestos reserves and $256 and $247 of net environmental reserves, respectively. The Company believes that its current asbestos and environmental reserves are appropriate. However, analyses of future developments could cause The Hartford to change its estimates and ranges of its asbestos and environmental reserves, and the effect of these changes could be material to the Company’s consolidated operating results and liquidity.
Lease Commitments
The total rental expense on operating leases was $60, $62, and $79 in 2015, 2014, and 2013, respectively, which excludes sublease rental income of $3, $4, and $8 in 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

F-74

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
12. Commitments and Contingencies (continued)

Future minimum lease commitments as of December 31, 2015 are as follows:
 
Operating Leases
2016
$
39

2017
33

2018
27

2019
19

2020
12

Thereafter
13

Total minimum lease payments [1]
$
143

[1]
Excludes expected future minimum sublease income of approximately $3, $2, $2, $2, $2 and $0 in 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 and thereafter respectively.
The Company’s lease commitments consist primarily of lease agreements for office space, data processing, furniture and fixtures, office equipment, and transportation equipment that expire at various dates. Capital lease assets are included in property and equipment.
Unfunded Commitments
As of December 31, 2015, the Company has outstanding commitments totaling $1.0 billion, of which $748 is committed to fund limited partnership and other alternative investments, which may be called by the partnership during the commitment period to fund the purchase of new investments and partnership expenses. Additionally, $236 of the outstanding commitments relate to various funding obligations associated with private placement securities. The remaining outstanding commitments of $31 relate to mortgage loans the Company is expecting to fund in the first half of 2016.
Guaranty Funds and Other Insurance-related Assessments
In all states, insurers licensed to transact certain classes of insurance are required to become members of a guaranty fund. In most states, in the event of the insolvency of an insurer writing any such class of insurance in the state, members of the funds are assessed to pay certain claims of the insolvent insurers. A particular state’s fund assesses its members based on their respective written premiums in the state for the classes of insurance in which the insolvent insurer was engaged. Assessments are generally limited for any year to one or two percent of the premiums written per year depending on the state.
Liabilities for guaranty fund and other insurance-related assessments are accrued when an assessment is probable, when it can be reasonably estimated, and when the event obligating the Company to pay an imposed or probable assessment has occurred. Liabilities for guaranty funds and other insurance-related assessments are not discounted and are included as part of other liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014 the liability balance was $138 and $131, respectively. As of December 31, 2015 and 2014 amounts related to premium tax offsets of $44 and $42, respectively, were included in other assets.
Derivative Commitments
Certain of the Company’s derivative agreements contain provisions that are tied to the financial strength ratings, as set by nationally recognized statistical agencies, of the individual legal entity that entered into the derivative agreement. If the legal entity’s financial strength were to fall below certain ratings, the counterparties to the derivative agreements could demand immediate and ongoing full collateralization and in certain instances demand immediate settlement of all outstanding derivative positions traded under each impacted bilateral agreement. The settlement amount is determined by netting the derivative positions transacted under each agreement. If the termination rights were to be exercised by the counterparties, it could impact the legal entity’s ability to conduct hedging activities by increasing the associated costs and decreasing the willingness of counterparties to transact with the legal entity. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a net liability position as of December 31, 2015 was $1.3 billion. Of this $1.3 billion the legal entities have posted collateral of $1.5 billion in the normal course of business. In addition, the Company has posted collateral of $34 associated with a customized GMWB derivative. Based on derivative market values as of December 31, 2015, a downgrade of one or two levels below the current financial strength ratings by either Moody’s or S&P would not require additional assets to be posted as collateral. These collateral amounts could change as derivative market values change, as a result of changes in our hedging activities or to the extent changes in contractual terms are negotiated. The nature of the collateral that we would post, if required, would be primarily in the form of U.S. Treasury bills, U.S. Treasury notes and government agency securities.

F-75

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
12. Commitments and Contingencies (continued)

Guarantees
In the ordinary course of selling businesses or entities to third parties, the Company has agreed to indemnify purchasers for losses arising out of breaches of representations and warranties with respect to the business or entities being sold, covenants and obligations of the Company and/or its subsidiaries following the closing. These obligations are typically subject to various time limitations, defined by the contract or by operation of law, such as statutes of limitation. In some cases, the maximum potential obligation is subject to contractual limitations, while in other cases such limitations are not specified or applicable. The Company does not expect to make any payments on these guarantees and is not carrying any liabilities associated with these guarantees.

F-76

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
13. Equity


Series F Preferred Stock
In 2010, the Company issued 23 million depositary shares, each representing a 1/40th interest in the Company's 7.25% Series F mandatory convertible preferred stock at a price of $25 per depositary share and received net proceeds of approximately $556. Cumulative dividends on each share of the Series F mandatory convertible preferred stock were payable at a rate of 7.25% per annum on the initial liquidation preference of $1,000 per share. The Series F mandatory convertible preferred stock was converted to 21.2 million shares of common stock on April 1, 2013.
Capital Purchase Program ("CPP") Warrants
As of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, the Company has 4.4 million and 7.2 million CPP warrants outstanding and exercisable. The CPP warrants were issued in 2009 as part of a program established by the U.S. Department of the Treasury under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008. The CPP warrants expire in 2019.
CPP warrant exercises were 2.8 million, 25.2 million and 18.1 million during the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company also repurchased 1.6 million CPP warrants for $33 under the Company's authorized equity repurchase program.
The declaration of common stock dividends by the Company in excess of a threshold triggers a provision in the Company's warrant agreement with The Bank of New York Mellon resulting in adjustments to the CPP warrant exercise price. Accordingly, the CPP warrant exercise price was $9.264, $9.388 and $9.504 as of December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The exercise price will be settled by the Company's withholding the number of common shares issuable upon exercise of the warrants equal to the value of the aggregate exercise price of the warrants so exercised determined by reference to the closing price of the Company's common stock on the trading day on which the warrants are exercised and notice is delivered to the warrant agent.
Equity Repurchase Program
In July 2015, the Board of Directors approved a $1.6 billion increase in and extension of the Company's authorized equity repurchase program, bringing the total authorization for equity repurchases to $4.375 billion for the period January 1, 2014 through December 31, 2016, with $1.3 billion remaining as of December 31, 2015. Any repurchase of shares under the equity repurchase program is dependent on market conditions and other factors.
During the period January 1, 2016 through February 24, 2016, the Company repurchased 5.3 million common shares for $211.
Statutory Results
The domestic insurance subsidiaries of The Hartford prepare their statutory financial statements in conformity with statutory accounting practices prescribed or permitted by the applicable state insurance department which vary materially from U.S. GAAP. Prescribed statutory accounting practices include publications of the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (“NAIC”), as well as state laws, regulations and general administrative rules. The differences between statutory financial statements and financial statements prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP vary between domestic and foreign jurisdictions. The principal differences are that statutory financial statements do not reflect deferred policy acquisition costs and limit deferred income taxes, predominately use interest rate and mortality assumptions prescribed by the NAIC for life benefit reserves, generally carry bonds at amortized cost, and present reinsurance assets and liabilities net of reinsurance. For reporting purposes, statutory capital and surplus is referred to collectively as "statutory capital".
Statutory net income and statutory capital are as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
Statutory Net Income
2015
2014
2013
Life insurance subsidiaries
$
539

$
415

$
2,144

Property and casualty insurance subsidiaries
1,486

1,228

1,217

Total
$
2,025

$
1,643

$
3,361

 
As of December 31,
Statutory Capital
2015
2014
Life insurance subsidiaries
$
6,591

$
7,157

Property and casualty insurance subsidiaries
8,563

8,069

Total
$
15,154

$
15,226


F-77

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
13. Equity (continued)


Regulatory Capital Requirements
The Company's U.S. insurance companies' states of domicile impose risk-based capital (“RBC”) requirements. The requirements provide a means of measuring the minimum amount of statutory capital appropriate for an insurance company to support its overall business operations based on its size and risk profile. Regulatory compliance is determined by a ratio of a company's total adjusted capital (“TAC”) to its authorized control level RBC (“ACL RBC”). Companies below specific trigger points or ratios are classified within certain levels, each of which requires specified corrective action. The minimum level of TAC before corrective action commences (“Company Action Level”) is two times the ACL RBC. The adequacy of a company's capital is determined by the ratio of a company's TAC to its Company Action Level, known as the "RBC ratio". All of the Company's operating insurance subsidiaries had RBC ratios in excess of the minimum levels required by the applicable insurance regulations. On an aggregate basis, the Company's U.S. property and casualty insurance companies' RBC ratio was in excess of 200% of its Company Action Level as of December 31, 2015 and 2014. The RBC ratios for the Company's principal life insurance operating subsidiaries were all in excess of 400% of their Company Action Levels as of December 31, 2015 and 2014. The reporting of RBC ratios is not intended for the purpose of ranking any insurance company, or for use in connection with any marketing, advertising, or promotional activities.
Similar to the RBC ratios that are employed by U.S. insurance regulators, regulatory authorities in the international jurisdictions in which the Company operates generally establish minimum solvency requirements for insurance companies. All of the Company's international insurance subsidiaries have solvency margins in excess of the minimum levels required by the applicable regulatory authorities.
Dividend Restrictions
Dividends to the HFSG Holding Company from its insurance subsidiaries are restricted by insurance regulation. The payment of dividends by Connecticut-domiciled insurers is limited under the insurance holding company laws of Connecticut. These laws require notice to and approval by the state insurance commissioner for the declaration or payment of any dividend, which, together with other dividends or distributions made within the preceding twelve months, exceeds the greater of (i) 10% of the insurer’s policyholder surplus as of December 31 of the preceding year or (ii) net income (or net gain from operations, if such company is a life insurance company) for the twelve-month period ending on the thirty-first day of December last preceding, in each case determined under statutory insurance accounting principles. In addition, if any dividend of a Connecticut-domiciled insurer exceeds the insurer’s earned surplus, it requires the prior approval of the Connecticut Insurance Commissioner. The insurance holding company laws of the other jurisdictions in which The Hartford’s insurance subsidiaries are incorporated (or deemed commercially domiciled) generally contain similar (although in certain instances somewhat more restrictive) limitations on the payment of dividends. Dividends paid to HFSG Holding Company by its life insurance subsidiaries are further dependent on cash requirements of HLI and other factors. In addition to statutory limitations on paying dividends, the Company also takes other items into consideration when determining dividends from subsidiaries. These considerations include, but are not limited to, expected earnings and capitalization of the subsidiary, regulatory capital requirements and liquidity requirements of the individual operating company.
During 2015, HFSG Holding Company received approximately $900 of dividends from its property and casualty insurance subsidiaries including approximately $200 which was subsequently contributed to a U.K subsidiary to effect the consolidation of certain property and casualty run-off entities in the U.K. In addition to the property-casualty insurance subsidiaries dividends, HFSG Holding Company received approximately $1.1 billion through a series of transactions with HLI’s life insurance subsidiaries.
In 2016, The Company’s property and casualty insurance subsidiaries are permitted to pay up to a maximum of approximately $1.6 billion in dividends to HFSG Holding Company without prior approval from the applicable insurance commissioner. In 2016, HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving net dividends of approximately $800 from its property-casualty insurance subsidiaries.
In 2016, Hartford Life and Accident Insurance Company ("HLA") is permitted to pay up to a maximum of $165 in dividends without prior approval from the insurance commissioner. In 2016, HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving dividends of approximately $240 from HLA, subject to regulatory approval.
On January 29, 2016 HLIC paid an extraordinary dividend of $500, based on approval received from the CTDOI. As a result of this dividend, HLIC has no ordinary dividend capacity for the remainder of 2016. HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving an additional $250 of extraordinary dividends from HLIC during 2016, subject to regulatory approval.
There are no current restrictions on the HFSG Holding Company's ability to pay dividends to its shareholders.
Restricted Net Assets
The Company's insurance subsidiaries had net assets of $19 billion, determined in accordance with U.S. GAAP, that were restricted from payment to the HFSG Holding Company, without prior regulatory approval at December 31, 2015.

F-78

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
14. Income Taxes


The Company and its subsidiaries file income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction, and various state and foreign jurisdictions, as applicable. Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes included income from domestic operations of $2,017, $1,736 and $1,473 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, and losses from foreign operations of $(39), $(37) and $(2) for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013.
The provision (benefit) for income taxes consists of the following:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Income Tax Expense (Benefit)
 
 
 
Current - U.S. Federal
$
(55
)
$
(62
)
$
219

     International
3

2


Total current
(52
)
(60
)
219

Deferred - U.S. Federal
357

410

27

Total income tax expense
$
305

$
350

$
246

Deferred tax assets and liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets represent the tax consequences of differences between the financial reporting and tax basis of assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets (liabilities) include the following:
 
As of December 31,
Deferred Tax Assets
2015
2014
Tax discount on loss reserves
$
524

$
573

Tax basis deferred policy acquisition costs
162

163

Unearned premium reserve and other underwriting related reserves
377

456

Investment-related items
831

1,020

Insurance product derivatives
90

44

Employee benefits
655

677

Alternative minimum tax credit
639

652

Net operating loss carryover
1,831

1,936

Foreign tax credit carryover
154

178

Capital loss carryover
78

172

Total Deferred Tax Assets
5,341

5,871

Valuation Allowance
(79
)
(181
)
Deferred Tax Assets, Net of Valuation Allowance
5,262

5,690

Deferred Tax Liabilities
 
 
Financial statement deferred policy acquisition costs and reserves
(943
)
(1,040
)
Net unrealized gains on investments
(842
)
(1,489
)
Other depreciable and amortizable assets
(229
)
(217
)
Other
(42
)
(47
)
Total Deferred Tax Liabilities
(2,056
)
(2,793
)
Net Deferred Tax Asset
$
3,206

$
2,897

The Company has recorded a deferred tax asset valuation allowance that is adequate to reduce the total deferred tax asset to an amount that will more likely than not be realized. In assessing the need for a valuation allowance, management considered future taxable temporary difference reversals, future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryovers, taxable income in open carry back years and other tax planning strategies. From time to time, tax planning strategies could include holding a portion of debt securities with market value losses until recovery, altering the level of tax exempt securities held, making investments which have specific tax characteristics, and business considerations such as asset-liability matching. Management views such tax planning strategies as prudent and feasible and would implement them, if necessary, to realize the deferred tax assets.

F-79

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
14. Income Taxes (continued)

As shown in the deferred tax assets (liabilities) table above, included in net deferred income taxes are the future tax benefits associated with the net operating loss carryover, foreign tax credit carryover, capital loss carryover, and alternative minimum tax credit carryover as follows:
 
As of
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Expiration
 
Carryover amount
Expected tax benefit, gross
Carryover amount
Expected tax benefit, gross
Dates
Amount
Net operating loss carryover - U.S.
$
5,182

$
1,814

$
5,508

$
1,928

2016
-
2020
$
4

 
 
 
 
 
2023
-
2033
$
5,178

Net operating loss carryover - foreign
$
89

$
17

$
39

$
8

No expiration
$
89

Foreign tax credit carryover
$
154

$
154

$
178

$
178

2019
-
2024
$
154

Capital loss carryover
$
222

$
78

$
491

$
172

2019
$
222

Alternative minimum tax credit carryover
$
639

$
639

$
652

$
652

No expiration
$
639

Net Operating Loss Carryover
Due to limitations on the use of certain losses, a valuation allowance of $1 and $9 has been established as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively, in order to recognize only the portion of net operating losses that will more likely than not be realized. The Company's effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2015 reflects an $8 benefit from the partial reduction of the deferred tax asset valuation allowance on the net operating loss carryover.
Utilization of these loss carryovers is dependent upon the generation of sufficient future taxable income. Most of the net operating loss carryover originated from the Company's U.S. and international annuity business, including from the hedging program. Given the sale of the HLIKK subsidiary in 2014, and continued runoff of the U.S. fixed and variable annuity business, the exposure to taxable losses from the Talcott Resolution business is significantly lessened. Given the expected earnings of its property and casualty, group benefits and mutual fund businesses, the Company expects to generate sufficient taxable income in the future to utilize its net operating loss carryover net of the recorded valuation allowance. Although the Company projects there will be sufficient future taxable income to fully recover the remainder of the loss carryover, the Company's estimate of the likely realization may change over time.
Alternative Minimum Tax Credit and Foreign Tax Credit Carryover
These credit carryovers are available to offset regular federal income taxes from future taxable income and although the Company believes there will be sufficient future regular federal taxable income, there can be no certainty that future events will not affect the ability to utilize the credits. Additionally, the use of the foreign tax credits generally depends on the generation of sufficient taxable income to first utilize all U.S. net operating loss carryover. However, the Company has identified and began to purchase certain investments which allow for utilization of the foreign tax credits without first using the net operating loss carryover. Consequently, the Company believes it is more likely than not the foreign tax credit carryover will be fully realized. Accordingly, no valuation allowance has been provided on either the alternative minimum tax carryover or foreign tax credit carryover.
Capital Loss Carryover
As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the net deferred tax asset before valuation allowance included the expected tax benefit attributable to the capital loss carryover. The capital loss carryover is largely due to the loss on sale of HLIKK in 2014. As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the associated deferred tax asset valuation allowance was $78 and $172, respectively. Utilization of the capital loss carryover requires the Company to realize taxable capital gains. The Company's effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2015 reflects a $94 benefit from the partial reduction of the deferred tax asset valuation on the capital loss carryover due to taxable gains on the termination of certain derivatives. The Company concluded that it is more likely than not that the remaining capital loss carryovers will not be realized.

F-80

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
14. Income Taxes (continued)

A reconciliation of the tax provision at the U.S. federal statutory rate to the provision (benefit) for income taxes is as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Tax provision at U.S. federal statutory rate
$
692

$
595

$
515

Tax-exempt interest
(132
)
(138
)
(138
)
Dividends received deduction
(156
)
(114
)
(139
)
Increase (decrease) in valuation allowance
(102
)
5

(2
)
Other
3

2

10

Provision for income taxes
$
305

$
350

$
246

The Company’s effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2015 reflects a $36 net reduction in the provision for income taxes related to the release of reserves due to the resolution of uncertain tax positions consisting of a $48 reduction in the provision upon conclusion of the Internal Revenue Service audit of the Company's 2007-2011 federal consolidated corporate income tax returns, offset by a $12 increase in the provision due to the filing of the Company's 2014 federal consolidated income tax return.
A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits is as follows:
 
For the year ended December 31,
 
2015
Balance, beginning of period
$
48

Gross increases - tax positions in prior period
12

Gross decreases - tax positions in prior period
(48
)
Balance, end of period
$
12

The Company’s unrecognized tax benefits were unchanged during the years ended December 31, 2014, and 2013 remaining at $48 as of December 31, 2014, and 2013. The entire amount of unrecognized tax benefits, if recognized, would affect the effective tax rate in the period of the release.
As of December 31, 2015, the Company had a current income tax payable of $5.
The federal audit of the years 2012 and 2013 began in March 2015 and is expected to be completed in 2016. Management believes that adequate provision has been made in the financial statements for any potential adjustments that may result from tax examinations and other tax-related matters for all open tax years.
The Company classifies interest and penalties (if applicable) as income tax expense in the consolidated financial statements. The Company recognized interest expense of $0, $0, and $5 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Company had approximately $0 and $1 of interest payable as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The Company does not believe it would be subject to any penalties in any open tax years and, therefore, has not recorded any accrual for penalties.

F-81

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
15. Changes in and Reclassifications From Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

Changes in AOCI, net of tax, by component consist of the following:
For the year ended December 31, 2015
 
Changes in
 
Net Unrealized Gain on Securities
OTTI
Losses in
OCI
Net Gain on Cash Flow Hedging Instruments
Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments
Pension and Other Postretirement Plan Adjustments
AOCI,
net of tax
Beginning balance
$
2,370

$
(5
)
$
150

$
(8
)
$
(1,579
)
$
928

OCI before reclassifications
(1,112
)
(3
)
18

(47
)
(135
)
(1,279
)
Amounts reclassified from AOCI
21

1

(38
)

38

22

OCI, net of tax
(1,091
)
(2
)
(20
)
(47
)
(97
)
(1,257
)
Ending balance
$
1,279

$
(7
)
$
130

$
(55
)
$
(1,676
)
$
(329
)
For the year ended December 31, 2014
 
Changes in
 
Net Unrealized Gain on Securities
OTTI
Losses in
OCI
Net Gain on Cash Flow Hedging Instruments
Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments
Pension and Other Postretirement Plan Adjustments
AOCI,
net of tax
Beginning balance
$
987

$
(12
)
$
108

$
91

$
(1,253
)
$
(79
)
OCI before reclassifications
1,474

3

89

13

(437
)
1,142

Amounts reclassified from AOCI
(91
)
4

(47
)
(112
)
111

(135
)
OCI, net of tax
1,383

7

42

(99
)
(326
)
1,007

Ending balance
$
2,370

$
(5
)
$
150

$
(8
)
$
(1,579
)
$
928

For the year ended December 31, 2013
 
Changes in
 
Net Unrealized Gain on Securities
OTTI
Losses in
OCI
Net Gain on Cash Flow Hedging Instruments
Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments
Pension and Other Postretirement Plan Adjustments
AOCI,
net of tax
Beginning balance
$
3,418

$
(47
)
$
428

$
406

$
(1,362
)
$
2,843

OCI before reclassifications
(1,416
)
51

(195
)
(337
)
74

(1,823
)
Amounts reclassified from AOCI
(1,015
)
(16
)
(125
)
22

35

(1,099
)
OCI, net of tax
(2,431
)
35

(320
)
(315
)
109

(2,922
)
Ending balance
$
987

$
(12
)
$
108

$
91

$
(1,253
)
$
(79
)

F-82

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
15. Changes in and Reclassifications From Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) (continued)

Reclassifications from AOCI consist of the following:
AOCI
Amount Reclassified from AOCI
Affected Line Item in the Consolidated Statement of Operations
 
For the year ended December 31, 2015
For the year ended December 31, 2014
For the year ended December 31, 2013
 
Net Unrealized Gain on Securities
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities [1]
$
(32
)
$
217

$
1,515

Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
(32
)
217

1,515

Total before tax
 
(11
)
76

531

Income tax expense
 

50

31

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
 
$
(21
)
$
91

$
1,015

Net income
OTTI Losses in OCI
 
 
 
 
Other than temporary impairments
$
(2
)
$
(6
)
$
25

Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
(2
)
(6
)
25

Total before tax
 
(1
)
(2
)
9

Income tax expense
 
(1
)
(4
)
16

Net income
Net Gain on Cash Flow Hedging Instruments
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps [2]
$
4

$
(1
)
$
91

Net realized capital gains (losses)
Interest rate swaps
64

87

97

Net investment income
Foreign currency swaps
(9
)
(13
)
4

Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
59

73

192

Total before tax
 
21

26

67

Income tax expense
 
$
38

$
47

$
125

Net income
Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments
 
 
 
 
Currency translation adjustments [3]
$

$
172

$
(34
)
Net realized capital gains (losses)
 

172

(34
)
Total before tax
 

60

(12
)
Income tax expense
 
$

$
112

$
(22
)
Net income
Pension and Other Postretirement Plan Adjustments
 
 
 
 
Amortization of prior service credit
$
7

$
7

$
7

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
Amortization of actuarial loss
(65
)
(50
)
(61
)
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
Settlement loss

(128
)

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
 
(58
)
(171
)
(54
)
Total before tax
 
(20
)
(60
)
(19
)
Income tax expense
 
(38
)
(111
)
(35
)
Net income
Total amounts reclassified from AOCI
$
(22
)
$
135

$
1,099

Net income
[1]
The December 31, 2013 amount includes $1.5 billion of net unrealized gains on securities relating to the sales of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses.
[2]
The December 31, 2013 amount includes $71 of net gains on cash flow hedging instruments relating to the sales of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses.
[3]
The December 31, 2014 amount relates to the sale of the HLIKK variable and fixed annuity business and the December 31, 2013 amount relates to the sale of the UK variable annuity business.

F-83

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans

Investment and Savings Plan
Substantially all U.S. employees of the Company are eligible to participate in The Hartford Investment and Savings Plan under which designated contributions may be invested in a variety of investments, including up to 10% in common stock of The Hartford. The Company's contributions include a non-elective contribution of 2.0% of eligible compensation and a dollar-for-dollar matching contribution of up to 6.0% of eligible compensation contributed by the employee each pay period. The Company also maintains a non-qualified savings plan, The Hartford Excess Savings Plan, with the same level of Company matching contributions, with respect to employee compensation in excess of the limit that can be recognized under the tax-qualified Investment and Savings Plan. The Company discontinued non-elective contributions to the Excess Savings Plan effective December 31, 2013. Eligible compensation includes overtime and bonuses but is limited to a total, for the Investment and Savings Plan and Excess Savings Plan combined, of $1 annually. The total cost to The Hartford for these plans was approximately $117, $113 and $123 for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Additionally, The Hartford has established defined contribution pension plans for certain employees of the Company’s international subsidiaries. The cost to The Hartford for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013 for these plans was immaterial.
As of December 31, 2015, Investment and Savings Plan assets totaling $376 were invested in the separate accounts of HLIC.
Defined Benefit Pension Plan
The Company maintains The Hartford Retirement Plan for U.S. Employees, a U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan (the “Plan”) that covers substantially all U.S. employees hired prior to January 1, 2013. The Company also maintains non-qualified pension plans to provide retirement benefits previously accrued that are in excess of Internal Revenue Code limitations.
The Plan includes two benefit formulas, both of which are frozen: a final average pay formula (for which all accruals ceased as of December 31, 2008) and a cash balance formula for which benefit accruals ceased as of December 31, 2012, although interest will continue to accrue to existing cash balance formula account balances. Participants as of December 31, 2012 continue to earn vesting credit with respect to their frozen accrued benefits if they continue to work. The Hartford Excess Pension Plan II, the Company's non-qualified excess pension benefit plan for certain highly compensated employees, is also frozen.
The Company provides certain health care and life insurance benefits for eligible retired employees. The Company’s contribution for health care benefits will depend upon the retiree’s date of retirement and years of service. In addition, the plan has a defined dollar cap for certain retirees which limits average Company contributions. The Hartford has prefunded a portion of the health care obligations through a trust fund where such prefunding can be accomplished on a tax effective basis. Effective January 1, 2002, Company-subsidized retiree medical, retiree dental and retiree life insurance benefits were eliminated for employees with original hire dates with the Company on or after January 1, 2002. The Company also amended its postretirement medical, dental and life insurance coverage plans to no longer provide subsidized coverage for employees who retire on or after January 1, 2014.
Assumptions
Pursuant to accounting principles related to the Company’s pension and other postretirement obligations to employees under its various benefit plans, the Company is required to make a significant number of assumptions in order to calculate the related liabilities and expenses each period. The two economic assumptions that have the most impact on pension and other postretirement expense are the discount rate and the expected long-term rate of return on plan assets. In determining the discount rate assumption, the Company utilizes a discounted cash flow analysis of the Company’s pension and other postretirement obligations and currently available market and industry data. The yield curve utilized in the cash flow analysis reflects high-quality fixed income investments consistent with the maturity profile of the expected liability cash flows. Based on all available information, it was determined that 4.25% and 4.00% were the appropriate discount rates as of December 31, 2015 to calculate the Company’s pension and other postretirement obligations, respectively.
The Company determines the expected long-term rate of return assumption based on an analysis of actual compound rates of return earned over various historical time periods. The Company also considers the investment volatility, duration and total returns for various time periods related to the characteristics of the pension obligation, which are influenced by the Company's workforce demographics.In addition, the Company considers long-term market return expectations for an investment mix that generally anticipates 60% fixed income securities and 40% non fixed income securities (global equities, hedge funds and private market alternatives) to derive an expected long-term rate of return. Based upon these analyses, management determined the long-term rate of return assumption to be 6.90% and 7.10% for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. To determine the Company's 2016 expense, the Company is currently assuming an expected long-term rate of return on plan assets of 6.70%.

F-84

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

Weighted average assumptions used in calculating the Company's benefit obligations and the net amount recognized were as follows:
 
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2015
2014
Discount rate
4.25
%
4.00
%
4.00
%
3.75
%
Weighted average assumptions used in calculating the net periodic benefit cost for the Company’s pension plans were as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Discount rate
4.00
%
4.75
%
4.00
%
Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets
6.90
%
7.10
%
7.10
%
Rate of increase in compensation levels
%
%
3.75
%
Weighted average assumptions used in calculating the net periodic benefit cost for the Company’s other postretirement plans were as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Discount rate
3.75
%
4.25
%
3.50
%
Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets
6.90
%
7.10
%
7.10
%
Assumed health care cost trend rates were as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Pre-65 health care cost trend rate
7.30
%
7.70
%
8.05
%
Post-65 health care cost trend rate
5.50
%
5.60
%
5.70
%
Rate to which the cost trend rate is assumed to decline (the ultimate trend rate)
5.00
%
5.00
%
5.00
%
Year that the rate reaches the ultimate trend rate
2023

2023

2021

A one-percentage point change in assumed health care cost trend rates would have an insignificant effect on the amounts reported for other postretirement plans.
Obligations and Funded Status
The following tables set forth a reconciliation of beginning and ending balances of the benefit obligation and fair value of plan assets,
as well as the funded status of the Company's defined benefit pension and postretirement health care and life insurance benefit plans. International plans represent an immaterial percentage of total pension assets, liabilities and expense and, for reporting purposes, are combined with domestic plans.

F-85

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

 
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
 
For the years ended December 31,
Change in Benefit Obligation
2015
2014
2015
2014
Benefit obligation — beginning of year
$
6,025

$
5,516

$
338

$
312

Service cost
2

2



Interest cost
235

258

12

14

Plan participants’ contributions


25

26

Actuarial loss (gain)
18

(8
)

38

Settlements

(319
)


Changes in assumptions
(236
)
846

(8
)
16

Benefits paid
(307
)
(268
)
(68
)
(70
)
Retiree drug subsidy


2

2

Foreign exchange adjustment
(3
)
(2
)


Benefit obligation — end of year
$
5,734

$
6,025

$
301

$
338

Settlements in 2014 were primarily the result of the Company's extension of a limited time voluntary lump sum offer to approximately 13,500 vested participants in the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan who had separated from service, but who had not yet commenced annuity benefits. The Company made lump sum benefit payments totaling $274 to approximately 5,600 vested participants. The Company also made lump sum payments of $45 to eligible cash balance participants independent of the voluntary lump sum offer.
Changes in assumptions in 2015 primarily included the effect of an increase in the discount rate. Changes in assumptions in 2014 included an increase of $279 related to the Company's use of updated mortality rates reflecting improved life expectancy and an increase of $567 related to a reduction in the discount rate.
 
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
 
For the years ended December 31,
Change in Plan Assets
2015
2014
2015
2014
Fair value of plan assets — beginning of year
$
4,707

$
4,630

$
196

$
213

Actual return on plan assets
(72
)
565

2

16

Employer contributions
101

101



Benefits paid [1]
(282
)
(245
)
(36
)
(33
)
Expenses paid
(21
)
(24
)


Settlements

(319
)


Foreign exchange adjustment
(3
)
(1
)


Fair value of plan assets — end of year
$
4,430

$
4,707

$
162

$
196

Funded status — end of year
$
(1,304
)
$
(1,318
)
$
(139
)
$
(142
)
[1]
Other postretirement benefits paid represent non-key employee postretirement medical benefits paid from the Company's prefunded trust fund.
The fair value of assets for pension benefits, and hence the funded status, presented in the table above excludes assets of $127 and $129 as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, held in rabbi trusts and designated for the non-qualified pension plans. The assets do not qualify as plan assets; however, the assets are available to pay benefits for certain retired, terminated and active participants. Such assets are available to the Company’s general creditors in the event of insolvency. The rabbi trust assets consist of equity and fixed income investments. To the extent the fair value of these rabbi trusts were included in the table above, pension plan assets would have been $4,557 and $4,836 as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, and the funded status of pension benefits would have been $(1,177) and $(1,189) as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

F-86

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

The following table provides information for the Company's defined benefit pension plans with an accumulated benefit obligation in excess of plan assets.
 
As of December 31,
 
2015
2014
Projected benefit obligation
$
5,734

$
6,025

Accumulated benefit obligation
5,732

6,024

Fair value of plan assets
4,430

4,707

As of December 31, 2015, pension and other postretirement benefits plan assets totaling $4.6 billion were invested in the separate accounts of HLIC.
Amounts recognized in the Company's Consolidated Balance Sheets consist of:
 
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
 
As of December 31,
 
2015
2014
2015
2014
Other liabilities
$
1,304

$
1,318

$
139

$
142

Components of Net Periodic Benefit Cost (Benefit) and Other Amounts Recognized in Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Net periodic benefit cost (benefit) includes the following components:
 
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
2015
2014
2013
Service cost
$
2

$
2

$
1

$

$

$

Interest cost
235

258

238

12

14

11

Expected return on plan assets
(311
)
(325
)
(315
)
(12
)
(14
)
(14
)
Amortization of prior service credit



(7
)
(7
)
(7
)
Amortization of actuarial loss
60

45

59

5

5

2

Settlements

128





Net periodic benefit cost (benefit)
$
(14
)
$
108

$
(17
)
$
(2
)
$
(2
)
$
(8
)
Amounts recognized in other comprehensive income (loss) were as follows:
 
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2015
2014
Amortization of actuarial loss
$
60

$
45

$
5

$
5

Settlement loss

128



Amortization of prior service credit


(7
)
(7
)
Net loss arising during the year
(185
)
(622
)
(3
)
(51
)
Total
$
(125
)
$
(449
)
$
(5
)
$
(53
)

F-87

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

Amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) on a before tax basis that have not yet been recognized as components of net periodic benefit cost consist of:
 
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
 
As of December 31,
 
2015
2014
2015
2014
Net loss
$
(2,553
)
$
(2,428
)
$
(123
)
$
(124
)
Prior service credit


91

97

Total
$
(2,553
)
$
(2,428
)
$
(32
)
$
(27
)
The estimated net loss for the defined benefit pension plans that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) into net periodic benefit cost during 2016 is $55. The estimated prior service cost for the other postretirement benefit plans that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) into net periodic benefit cost during 2016 is $(7). The estimated net loss for the other postretirement plans that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income into net periodic benefit cost during 2016 is $5.
Plan Assets
Investment Strategy and Target Allocation
The overall investment strategy of the Plan is to maximize total investment returns to provide sufficient funding for present and anticipated future benefit obligations within the constraints of a prudent level of portfolio risk and diversification. With respect to asset management, the oversight responsibility of the Plan rests with The Hartford’s Pension Fund Trust and Investment Committee composed of individuals whose responsibilities include establishing overall objectives and the setting of investment policy; selecting appropriate investment options and ranges; reviewing the asset allocation mix and asset allocation targets on a regular basis; and monitoring performance to determine whether or not the rate of return objectives are being met and that policy and guidelines are being followed. The Company believes that the asset allocation decision will be the single most important factor determining the long-term performance of the Plan.
The Company’s pension plan and other postretirement benefit plans’ target allocation by asset category is presented in the table below.
 
Target Asset Allocation
 
Pension Plans
Other Postretirement Plans
 
(minimum)
(maximum)
(minimum)
(maximum)
Equity securities
5
%
20
%
15
%
45
%
Fixed income securities
50
%
70
%
55
%
85
%
Alternative assets
10
%
45
%
%
%
Divergent market performance among different asset classes may, from time to time, cause the asset allocation to deviate from the desired asset allocation ranges. The asset allocation mix is reviewed on a periodic basis. If it is determined that an asset allocation mix rebalancing is required, future portfolio additions and withdrawals will be used, as necessary, to bring the allocation within tactical ranges.
The Company’s pension plan and other postretirement benefit plans’ weighted average asset allocation is presented in the table below.
 
Pension Plans
Other Postretirement Plans
 
Percentage of Assets
Percentage of Assets
 
at Fair Value
at Fair Value
 
As of December 31,
 
2015
2014
2015
2014
Equity securities
20
%
21
%
25
%
25
%
Fixed income securities
66
%
62
%
75
%
75
%
Alternative assets
14
%
17
%
%
%
Total
100
%
100
%
100
%
100
%

F-88

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

The majority of the Plan assets are invested in separate accounts managed by HIMCO, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. The Plan invests in commingled funds and partnerships managed by unaffiliated managers for emerging markets, equity, hedge funds and other alternative investments. These portfolios encompass multiple asset classes reflecting the current needs of the Plan, the investment preferences and risk tolerance of the Plan and the desired degree of diversification. These asset classes include publicly traded equities, bonds and alternative investments and are made up of individual investments in cash and cash equivalents, equity securities, debt securities, asset-backed securities and hedge funds. Hedge fund investments represent a diversified portfolio of partnership investments in absolute-return investment strategies.
In addition, the Company uses U.S. Treasury bond futures contracts and U.S. Treasury STRIPS in a duration overlay program to adjust the duration of Plan assets to better match the duration of the benefit obligation.
Investment Valuation
For further discussion of the valuation of investments, see Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Pension Plan Assets
The fair values of the Company’s pension plan assets by asset category are as follows:
 
Pension Plan Assets at Fair Value as of December 31, 2015
Asset Category
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
Short-term investments:
$
7

$
274

$

$
281

Fixed Income Securities:
 
 
 
 
Corporate

922

19

941

RMBS

242

24

266

U.S. Treasuries
16

1,029

3

1,048

Foreign government

49

5

54

CMBS

183


183

Other fixed income [1]

105

1

106

  Mortgage Loans


54

54

Equity Securities:
 
 
 
 
Large-cap domestic
500

11

1

512

International
298

87


385

Other investments:
 
 
 
 
Hedge funds

566

54

620

Private Market Alternatives


20

20

Total pension plan assets at fair value [2]
$
821

$
3,468

$
181

$
4,470

[1]
Includes ABS, municipal bonds, and foreign bonds.
[2]
Excludes approximately $67 of investment payables net of investment receivables that are excluded from this disclosure requirement because they are trade receivables in the ordinary course of business where the carrying amount approximates fair value. Also excludes approximately $27 of interest receivable.

F-89

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

The fair values of the Company’s pension plan assets by asset category are as follows:
 
Pension Plan Assets at Fair Value as of December 31, 2014
Asset Category
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
Short-term investments:
$
56

$
252

$

$
308

Fixed Income Securities:
 
 
 
 
Corporate

919

34

953

RMBS

181

28

209

U.S. Treasuries
24

1,198

5

1,227

Foreign government

65

5

70

CMBS

156


156

Other fixed income [1]

93

4

97

Equity Securities:
 
 
 
 
Large-cap domestic
526



526

Mid-cap domestic




Small-cap domestic




International
435

3


438

Other investments:
 
 
 
 
Hedge funds

562

181

743

Total pension plan assets at fair value [2]
$
1,041

$
3,429

$
257

$
4,727

[1]
Includes ABS and municipal bonds.
[2]
Excludes approximately $42 of investment payables net of investment receivables that are excluded from this disclosure requirement because they are trade receivables in the ordinary course of business where the carrying amount approximates fair value. Also excludes approximately $22 of interest receivable.
The tables below provide fair value level 3 rollforwards for the Pension Plan Assets for which significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) are used in the fair value measurement on a recurring basis. The Plan classifies the fair value of financial instruments within Level 3 if there are no observable markets for the instruments or, in the absence of active markets, if one or more of the significant inputs used to determine fair value are based on the Plan’s own assumptions. Therefore, the gains and losses in the tables below include changes in fair value due to both observable and unobservable factors.
Pension Plan Asset Fair Value Measurements Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
Assets
Corporate
RMBS
Foreign government
Mortgage loans
Other [1]
Hedge funds
Private Market Alternatives
Totals
Fair Value as of January 1, 2015
$
34

$
28

$
5

$

$
9

$
181

$

$
257

Realized gains (losses), net








Changes in unrealized gains (losses), net
(2
)

(1
)

(1
)

3

(1
)
Purchases
12

14

1

54

3

2

17

103

Settlements

(14
)


(3
)


(17
)
Sales
(11
)
(2
)


(1
)
(24
)

(38
)
Transfers into Level 3

4



1



5

Transfers out of Level 3
(14
)
(6
)


(3
)
(105
)

(128
)
Fair Value as of December 31, 2015
$
19

$
24

$
5

$
54

$
5

$
54

$
20

$
181

[1]
"Other" includes U.S. Treasuries, Other fixed income and Large-cap domestic equities investments.
During the year ended December 31, 2015, transfers into and (out) of Level 3 are primarily attributable to the appearance of or lack thereof of market observable information and the re-evaluation of the observability of pricing inputs.

F-90

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

Pension Plan Asset Fair Value Measurements Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
Assets
Corporate
RMBS
Foreign government
Other fixed income
Hedge funds
Totals
Fair Value as of January 1, 2014
$
12

$
2

$
4

$
12

$
361

$
391

Realized gains (losses), net




4

4

Changes in unrealized gains (losses), net

7

1

(5
)
4

7

Purchases
12

3

2

6

219

242

Sales
(5
)
(1
)
(2
)
(2
)
(183
)
(193
)
Transfers into Level 3
20

17


7


44

Transfers out of Level 3
(5
)


(9
)
(224
)
(238
)
Fair Value as of December 31, 2014
$
34

$
28

$
5

$
9

$
181

$
257

During the year ended December 31, 2014, transfers in and/or (out) of Level 3 are primarily attributable to the availability of market observable information and the re-evaluation of the observability of pricing inputs.
There was no Company common stock included in the Plan’s assets as of December 31, 2015 and 2014.
The fair value of the Company’s other postretirement plan assets by asset category are as follows:
 
Other Postretirement Plan Assets
at Fair Value as of December 31, 2015
Asset Category
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
Short-term investments
$

$
16

$

$
16

Fixed Income Securities:
 
 
 
 
Corporate

36

2

38

RMBS

27

3

30

U.S. Treasuries

23


23

Foreign government

2


2

CMBS

14


14

Other fixed income

7


7

Equity Securities:
 
 
 
 
Large-cap
41



41

Total other postretirement plan assets at fair value [1]
$
41

$
125

$
5

$
171

[1]
Excludes approximately $10 of investment payables net of investment receivables that are excluded from this disclosure requirement because they are trade receivables in the ordinary course of business where the carrying amount approximates fair value. Also excludes approximately $1 of interest receivable.

F-91

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

The fair value of the Company’s other postretirement plan assets by asset category are as follows:
 
Other Postretirement Plan Assets
at Fair Value as of December 31, 2014
Asset Category
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
Short-term investments
$
8

$
5

$

$
13

Fixed Income Securities:
 
 
 
 
Corporate

41

3

44

RMBS

22

3

25

U.S. Treasuries
1

44


45

Foreign government

2


2

CMBS

15


15

Other fixed income

7


7

Equity Securities:
 
 
 
 
Large-cap
49



49

Total other postretirement plan assets at fair value [1]
$
58

$
136

$
6

$
200

[1]
Excludes approximately $5 of investment payables net of investment receivables that are not carried at fair value and approximately $1 of interest receivable carried at fair value.
Other Postretirement Plan Asset Fair Value Measurements Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
Assets
Corporate
RMBS
Foreign Government
Other Fixed Income
Totals
Fair Value as of January 1, 2015
$
3

$
3

$

$

$
6

Changes in unrealized gains (losses), net





Purchases
1

1



2

Settlements

(1
)


(1
)
Sales
(1
)



(1
)
Transfers into Level 3





Transfers out of Level 3
(1
)



(1
)
Fair Value as of December 31, 2015
$
2

$
3

$

$

$
5

Other Postretirement Plan Asset Fair Value Measurements Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
Assets
Corporate
RMBS
Foreign Government
Other Fixed Income
Totals
Fair Value as of January 1, 2014
$

$

$

$

$

Realized gains (losses), net





Changes in unrealized gains (losses), net





Purchases
3

3



6

Sales





Transfers into Level 3





Transfers out of Level 3





Fair Value as of December 31, 2014
$
3

$
3

$

$

$
6

There was no Company common stock included in the other postretirement benefit plan assets as of December 31, 2015 and 2014.
Concentration of Risk
In order to minimize risk, the Plan maintains a listing of permissible and prohibited investments. In addition, the Plan has certain concentration limits and investment quality requirements imposed on permissible investment options. Permissible investments include U.S. equity, international equity, alternative asset and fixed income investments including derivative instruments. Derivative instruments include future contracts, options, swaps, currency forwards, caps or floors and will be used to control risk or enhance return but will not be used for leverage purposes.

F-92

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
16. Employee Benefit Plans (continued)

Securities specifically prohibited from purchase include, but are not limited to: shares or fixed income instruments issued by The Hartford, short sales of any type within long-only portfolios, non-derivative securities involving the use of margin, leveraged floaters and inverse floaters, including money market obligations, natural resource real properties such as oil, gas or timber and precious metals.
Other than U.S. government and certain U.S. government agencies backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government, the Plan does not have any material exposure to any concentration risk of a single issuer.
Cash Flows
The following table illustrates the Company’s contributions.
Employer Contributions
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
2015
$
101

$

2014
$
101

$

In 2015, the Company, at its discretion, made $100 in contributions to the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan. The Company does not have a 2016 required minimum funding contribution for the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan. The Company has not determined whether, and to what extent, contributions may be made to the U. S. qualified defined benefit pension plan in 2016. The Company will monitor the funded status of the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan during 2016 to make this determination.
Employer contributions in 2015 and 2014 were made in cash and did not include contributions of the Company’s common stock.
Benefit Payments
The following table sets forth amounts of benefits expected to be paid over the next ten years from the Company’s pension and other postretirement plans as of December 31, 2015:
 
Pension Benefits
Other Postretirement Benefits
2016
$
327

$
40

2017
332

38

2018
338

35

2019
345

32

2020
346

29

2021 - 2025
1,738

113

Total
$
3,426

$
287

In addition, the following table sets forth amounts of other postretirement benefits expected to be received under the Medicare Part D Subsidy over the next ten years as of December 31, 2015:
2016
$
3

2017
3

2018
3

2019
3

2020
3

2021 - 2025
18

Total
$
33


F-93

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
17. Stock Compensation Plans

The Company's stock-based compensation plans are described below. Shares issued in satisfaction of stock-based compensation may be made available from authorized but unissued shares, shares held by the Company in treasury or from shares purchased in the open market. In 2015, 2014 and 2013, the Company issued shares from treasury in satisfaction of stock-based compensation.
The Company recognized stock-based compensation expense as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Stock-based compensation plans expense
$
78

$
98

$
69

Income tax benefit
(27
)
(34
)
(24
)
Total stock-based compensation plans expense, after-tax
$
51

$
64

$
45

In 2014, the Company modified a former executive’s awards to receive retirement treatment. The incremental compensation cost resulting from the modifications totaled $16 of which $11 was recognized at the modification date. The remainder is recognized over the remaining service period.
The Company did not capitalize any cost of stock-based compensation. As of December 31, 2015, the total compensation cost related to non-vested awards not yet recognized was $90, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.8 years.
Stock Plan
On May 21, 2014, at the Company’s Annual Meeting of Shareholders, the shareholders approved The Hartford 2014 Incentive Stock Plan (the “Incentive Stock Plan”) which supersedes and replaces earlier incentive stock plans and as a result is currently the only plan pursuant to which future stock-based awards may be granted (other than the Subsidiary Stock Plan and the Employee Stock Purchase Plan described below). The terms of the Incentive Stock Plan are substantially similar to the terms of the earlier incentive stock plans, with changes primarily to ensure alignment with market practices and simplify administration. These changes did not result in incremental compensation cost for outstanding awards. The Incentive Stock Plan provides for awards to be granted in the form of non-qualified or incentive stock options qualifying under Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code, stock appreciation rights, performance shares, restricted stock or restricted stock units, or any other form of stock-based award. The maximum number of shares, subject to adjustments set forth in the Incentive Stock Plan, that may be issued to Company employees and third party service providers during the 10-year duration of the Incentive Stock Plan is 12,000,000 shares. If any award under an earlier incentive stock plan is forfeited, terminated, surrendered, exchanged, expires unexercised, or is settled in cash in lieu of stock (including to effect tax withholding) or for the net issuance of a lesser number of shares than the number subject to the award, the shares of stock subject to such award (or the relevant portion thereof) shall be available for awards under the Incentive Stock Plan and such shares shall be added to the maximum limit. As of December 31, 2015, there were 12,086,260 shares available for future issuance.
The fair values of awards granted under the Incentive Stock Plan are measured as of the grant date and expensed ratably over the awards’ vesting periods, generally 3 years. For stock option awards to retirement-eligible employees the Company recognizes the expense over a period shorter than the stated vesting period because the employees receive accelerated vesting upon retirement and therefore the vesting period is considered non-substantive.
Stock Option Awards
Under the Incentive Stock Plan, options granted have an exercise price at least equal to the market price of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant, and an option’s maximum term is not to exceed 10 years. Options generally become exercisable over a three year period commencing one year from the date of grant. Certain other options become exercisable at the later of three years from the date of grant or upon specified market appreciation of the Company's common shares.
The Company uses a hybrid lattice/Monte-Carlo based option valuation model (the “valuation model”) that incorporates the possibility of early exercise of options into the valuation. The valuation model also incorporates the Company’s historical termination and exercise experience to determine the option value.
The valuation model incorporates ranges of assumptions for inputs, and those ranges are disclosed below. The term structure of volatility is generally constructed utilizing implied volatilities from exchange-traded options, CPP warrants related to the Company’s stock, historical volatility of the Company’s stock and other factors. The Company uses historical data to estimate option exercise and employee termination within the valuation model, and accommodates variations in employee preference and risk-tolerance by segregating the grantee pool into a series of behavioral cohorts and conducting a fair valuation for each cohort individually. The expected term of options granted is derived from the output of the option valuation model and represents, in a mathematical sense, the period of time that options are expected to be outstanding. The risk-free rate for periods within the contractual life of the option is based on the U.S. Constant Maturity Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant.

F-94

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
17. Stock Compensation Plans (continued)

 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Expected dividend yield
1.8%
1.7%
1.7%
Expected annualized spot volatility
22.1
%
-
39.4%
25.9
%
-
57.8%
31.1
%
-
48.1%
Weighted average annualized volatility
32.7%
35.1%
47.3%
Risk-free spot rate
%
-
2.6%
0.1
%
-
2.8%
0.1
%
-
1.9%
Expected term
5.0 years
5.0 years
5.0 years
A summary of non-qualified stock option activity under the Company’s Incentive Stock Plan is presented below.
 
Number of Options
(in thousands)
Weighted
Average
Exercise Price
Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term
Aggregate
Intrinsic Value
 
For the year ended December 31, 2015
Outstanding at beginning of year
3,745

$
29.64




Granted
862

$
41.25

 
 
Exercised
(754
)
$
22.18

 
 
Forfeited

$

 
 
Expired
(53
)
$
76.80

 
 
Outstanding at end of year
3,800

$
33.09

6.5 years
$
45

Outstanding, fully vested and expected to vest
3,749

$
33.53

6.5 years
$
42

Exercisable at end of year
2,351

$
30.34

5.2 years
$
36

Aggregate intrinsic value represents the value of the Company's closing stock price on the last trading day of the period in excess of the exercise price multiplied by the number of options outstanding or exercisable. The aggregate intrinsic value excludes the effect of stock options that have a zero or negative intrinsic value. The weighted average grant-date fair value per share of options granted during the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013 was $10.60, $10.59 and $7.78, respectively. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 was $16, $10, and $5, respectively.
Share Awards
Share awards granted under the Incentive Stock Plan and outstanding include restricted stock units, restricted stock and performance shares.
Restricted Stock and Restricted Stock Units
Restricted stock units are share equivalents that are credited with dividend equivalents. Dividend equivalents are accumulated and paid in incremental shares when the underlying units vest. Restricted stock are shares of The Hartford's common stock with restrictions as to transferability until vested. Restricted stock units and restricted stock awards are valued equal to the market price of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant. Generally, restricted stock units vest at the end of or over three years; certain restricted stock units vest at the end of 5 years. Equity awards granted to non-employee directors generally vest in one year and were made in the form of restricted stock in 2014 and restricted stock units in 2015.
Performance Shares
Performance shares become payable within a range of 0% to 200% of the number of shares initially granted based upon the attainment of specific performance goals achieved at the end of or over three years. While most performance shares vest at the end of or over three years, certain performance shares vest at the end of five years.
Performance share awards that are not dependent on market conditions are valued equal to the market price of the Company's common stock on the date of grant less a discount for the absence of dividends. Stock-compensation expense for these performance share awards without market conditions is based on a current estimate of the number of awards expected to vest and, therefore, may change during the performance period as new estimates of performance are available.

F-95

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
17. Stock Compensation Plans (continued)

Other performance share awards or portions thereof have a market condition based upon the Company's total shareholder return relative to a group of peer companies within a three year period. Stock compensation expense for these performance share awards is based on the number of awards expected to vest as estimated at the grant date and therefore does not change for changes in estimated performance. The Company uses a risk neutral Monte-Carlo valuation model that incorporates time to maturity, implied volatilities of the Company and the peer companies, and correlations between the Company and the peer companies and interest rates. The range for assumptions of inputs are disclosed below.
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Volatility of common stock
21.4%
31.6%
42.8%
Average volatility of peer companies
14.0
%
-
24.0%
17.0
%
-
29.0%
20.0
%
-
36.0%
Average correlation coefficient of peer companies
54.0%
62.0%
76.0%
Risk-free spot rate
1.1%
0.7%
0.4%
Term
3.0 years
3.0 years
3.0 years
Total Share Awards
A summary of non-vested share award activity under the Company's Incentive Stock Plan is presented below.
 
Restricted Stock and
Restricted Stock Units
Performance Shares
 
Number of Shares
(in thousands)
Weighted-Average
Grant-Date
Fair Value
Number of Shares
(in thousands)
Weighted-Average
Grant date
Fair Value
Non-vested shares
For the year ended December 31, 2015
Non-vested at beginning of year
7,232

$
26.59

1,063

$
30.55

Granted
1,603

$
42.25

398

$
42.40

Performance based adjustment
 
 
407

$
24.15

Vested
(2,708
)
$
20.95

(814
)
$
24.15

Forfeited
(259
)
$
36.90

(279
)
$
33.47

Non-vested at end of year
5,868

$
33.12

775

$
37.35

The weighted average grant-date fair value per share of restricted stock units and restricted stock granted during the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013 was $42.25, $35.74 and $27.72, respectively. The weighted average grant-date fair value per share of performance shares granted during the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013 was $42.40, $36.45 and $27.92, respectively.
The total fair value of shares vested during the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 was $144, $75 and $42, respectively, based on actual or estimated performance factors. The Company did not make cash payments in settlement of stock compensation during the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013.
Subsidiary Stock Plan
In 2013 the Company established a subsidiary stock-based compensation plan similar to The Hartford Incentive Stock Plan except that it awards non-public subsidiary stock as compensation. The Company recognized stock-based compensation plans expense of $7, $4 and $1 in the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively, for the subsidiary stock plan. Upon employee vesting of subsidiary stock, the Company will recognize a noncontrolling equity interest. Employees will be restricted from selling vested subsidiary stock to other than the Company and the Company will have discretion on the amount of stock to repurchase. Therefore the subsidiary stock is classified as equity because it is not mandatorily redeemable.
Employee Stock Purchase Plan
The Company sponsors The Hartford Employee Stock Purchase Plan (“ESPP”). Under this plan, eligible employees of The Hartford purchase common stock of the Company at a discount rate of 5% of the market price per share on the last trading day of the offering period. Accordingly, the plan is a noncompensatory plan. Employees purchase a variable number of shares of stock through payroll deductions elected as of the beginning of the offering period. The Company may sell up to 15,400,000 shares of stock to eligible employees under the ESPP. As of December 31, 2015, there were 4,944,278 shares available for future issuance. During the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, 249,344 shares, 258,609 shares, and 321,723 shares were sold, respectively. The weighted average per share fair value of the discount under the ESPP was $2.15, $1.70 and $1.00 during the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The fair value is estimated based on the 5% discount off the market price per share on the last trading day of the offering period.

F-96

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
18. Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions

Discontinued Operations
On June 30, 2014, the Company completed the sale of all of the issued and outstanding equity of HLIKK to ORIX Life Insurance Corporation ("Buyer"), a subsidiary of ORIX Corporation, a Japanese company for cash proceeds of $963. The sale transaction resulted in an after-tax loss on disposition of $659 in the year ended December 31, 2014. The operations of the Company's HLIKK business meet the criteria for reporting as discontinued operations. The Company's HLIKK business is included in the Talcott Resolution reporting segment.
Concurrently with the sale, HLIKK recaptured certain risks that had been reinsured to the Company’s U.S. subsidiaries, Hartford Life and Annuity Insurance Company ("HLAI") and HLIC by terminating intercompany agreements. Upon closing, the Buyer became responsible for all liabilities for the recaptured business. The Company has, however, continued to provide reinsurance for yen denominated fixed payout annuities of approximately $619 as of December 31, 2015.
The following table summarizes the major classes of assets and liabilities transferred by the Company in connection with the sale.
 
Carrying Value
as of Closing
Assets
 
Cash and investments
$
18,733

Reinsurance recoverables
$
46

Property and equipment, net
$
18

Other assets
$
988

Liabilities
 
Reserve for future policy benefits and unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses
$
320

Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
$
2,265

Other policyholder funds and benefits payable - international variable annuities
$
16,465

Short-term debt
$
247

Other liabilities
$
102

Sale of Hartford Life International Limited
On December 12, 2013, the Company completed the sale of all of the issued and outstanding equity of HLIL in a cash transaction to Columbia Insurance Company, a Berkshire Hathaway company, for approximately $285. At closing, HLIL’s sole asset was its subsidiary, Hartford Life Limited, a Dublin-based company that sold variable annuities in the U.K. from 2005 to 2009. The sale transaction resulted in an after-tax loss of $102 upon disposition in the year ended December 31, 2013. The operations of the Company's U.K. variable annuity business meet the criteria for reporting as discontinued operations. The Company's U.K. variable annuities business is included in the Talcott Resolution reporting segment.

F-97

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
18. Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions (continued)

The Consolidated Statements of Operations include a net realized gain on disposal of $9 for the year ended December 31, 2015 related to discontinued operations. Amounts related to discontinued operations included in the Consolidated Statements of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 are summarized in the following table.
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2014
2013
Revenues
 
 
Earned premiums
$
(1
)
$
(1
)
Fee income and other
239

713

Net investment income
 
 
  Securities available-for-sale and other
18

96

  Equity securities, trading
134

6,200

Total net investment income
152

6,296

Net realized capital losses
(157
)
(1,340
)
Total revenues
233

5,668

Benefits, losses and expenses
 

 

Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
7

(98
)
Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses - returns credited on international variable annuities
134

6,200

Amortization of DAC

907

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
23

127

Total benefits, losses and expenses
164

7,136

Income (loss) before income taxes
69

(1,468
)
Income tax benefit
(2
)
(521
)
Income (loss) from operations of discontinued operations, net of tax
71

(947
)
Net realized capital loss on disposal, net of tax [1]
(622
)
(102
)
Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax
$
(551
)
$
(1,049
)
[1]
Includes income tax benefits of $265 on the sale of HLIKK and $219 on the sale of HLIL for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Business Dispositions
Sale of Retirement Plans
On January 1, 2013, the Company completed the sale of its Retirement Plans business to MassMutual for a ceding commission of $355. The business sold included products and services provided to corporations pursuant to Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), and products and services provided to municipalities and not-for-profit organizations under Sections 457 and 403(b) of the Code, collectively referred to as government plans. The sale was structured as a reinsurance transaction and resulted in an after-tax loss of $24 for the year ended December 31, 2013. The after-tax loss is primarily driven by the reduction in goodwill that is non-deductible for income tax purposes. The Company recognized a reinsurance loss on disposition of $634 offset by $634 in net realized capital gains for the year ended December 31, 2013.
Upon closing, the Company reinsured $9.2 billion of policyholder liabilities and $26.3 billion of separate account liabilities under an indemnity reinsurance arrangement. The reinsurance transaction does not extinguish the Company's primary liability on the insurance policies issued under the Retirement Plans business. The Company also transferred invested assets with a carrying value of $9.3 billion, net of the ceding commission, to MassMutual and recognized other non-cash decreases in assets totaling $200 relating to deferred acquisition costs, deferred income taxes, goodwill, property and equipment and other assets associated with the disposition. The Company continued to sell retirement plans during the transition period which ended on June 30, 2014. MassMutual has assumed all expenses and risks for these sales through the reinsurance agreement.

F-98

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
18. Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions (continued)

Sale of Individual Life
On January 2, 2013, the Company completed the sale of its Individual Life insurance business to Prudential for consideration of $615 consisting primarily of a ceding commission. The business sold included variable universal life, universal life, and term life insurance. The sale was structured as a reinsurance transaction and resulted in a loss on business disposition consisting of a reinsurance loss partially offset by realized capital gains. The Company recognized a reinsurance loss on business disposition of $533, pre-tax, which included a goodwill impairment charge of $342 and a loss accrual for premium deficiency of $191, for the year ended December 31, 2012.
Upon closing the Company recognized an additional $940 in reinsurance loss on disposition offset by $940 in realized capital gains for a $0 impact on income, pre-tax, for the year ended December 31, 2013. In addition, the Company reinsured $8.7 billion of policyholder liabilities and $5.3 billion of separate account liabilities under indemnity reinsurance arrangements. The reinsurance transaction does not extinguish the Company's primary liability on the insurance policies issued under the Individual Life business. The Company also transferred invested assets with a carrying value of $8.0 billion, exclusive of $1.4 billion of assets supporting the modified coinsurance agreement, net of cash transferred in place of short-term investments, to Prudential and recognized other non-cash decreases in assets totaling $1.8 billion relating to deferred acquisition costs, deferred income taxes, property and equipment and other assets and other non-cash decreases in liabilities totaling $1.5 billion relating to other liabilities including the $191 loss accrual for premium deficiency, associated with the disposition. The Company continued to sell life insurance products and riders during the transition period which ended on June 30, 2014. Prudential has assumed all expenses and risk for these sales through the reinsurance agreement.
Composition of Invested Assets Transferred
The following table summarizes invested assets transferred by the Company in 2013 in connection with the sale of the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses.
 
Carrying Value
 
As of December 31, 2012
Fixed maturities, at fair value (amortized cost of $13,916) [1]
$
15,349

Equity securities, AFS, at fair value (cost of $35) [2]
37

Fixed maturities, at fair value using the FVO [3]
16

Mortgage loans (net of allowances for loan losses of $1)
1,364

Policy loans, at outstanding balance
582

Total invested assets transferred
$
17,348

[1]
Includes $14.7 billion and $670 of securities in level 2 and 3 of the fair value hierarchy, respectively.
[2]
All equity securities transferred are included in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
[3]
All FVO securities transferred are included in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

F-99

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
19. Restructuring and Other Costs

The company has completed the restructuring activities initiated in 2011 and 2012. Termination benefits related to workforce reductions and lease and other contract terminations have been accrued through December 31, 2015. For related discussion of the Company's business disposition transactions, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
The Company has completed substantially all of its restructuring activities related to consolidation of its real estate operations initiated in 2013 consistent with the Company's strategic business realignment.
Restructuring and other costs, including costs incurred to date, as of December 31, 2015 were as follows:
Commercial Lines
$
6

Personal Lines
3

Group Benefits
1

Mutual Funds
4

Talcott Resolution
69

Corporate
299

Total restructuring and other costs
$
382

Restructuring and other costs, pre-tax incurred in connection with these activities were as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Severance benefits
$
6

$
16

$
22

Professional fees

1

19

Asset impairment charges
17

42

20

Contract termination and other charges
(3
)
12

6

Total restructuring and other costs
$
20

$
71

$
67

Restructuring and other costs costs, included in insurance operating costs and other expenses in the Consolidated Statements of Operations for each reporting segment, as well as the Corporate category are as follows:
 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2015
2014
2013
Commercial Lines
$

$

$
1

Personal Lines



Group Benefits



Mutual Funds


1

Talcott Resolution


1

Corporate
20

71

64

Total restructuring and other costs
$
20

$
71

$
67


F-100

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
19. Restructuring and Other Costs (continued)

The tables below provide roll-forwards for accrued restructuring and other costs included in other liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.

For the year ended December 31, 2015

Severance Benefits and Related Costs
Professional Fees
Asset impairment charges
Contract Termination and Other Charges
Total Restructuring and Other Costs
Balance, beginning of period
$
10

$

$

$
6

$
16

Accruals/provisions
6


17

(3
)
20

Payments/write-offs
(11
)

(17
)
(3
)
(31
)
Balance, end of period
$
5

$

$

$

$
5

 
For the year ended December 31, 2014
 
Severance Benefits and Related Costs
Professional Fees
Asset impairment charges
Contract Termination and Other Charges
Total Restructuring and Other Costs
Balance, beginning of period
$
22

$

$

$
6

$
28

Accruals/provisions
16


43

12

71

Payments/write-offs
(28
)

(43
)
(12
)
(83
)
Balance, end of period
$
10

$

$

$
6

$
16

20. Quarterly Results (Unaudited)
 
Three months ended
 
March 31,
June 30,
September 30,
December 31,
 
2015
2014
2015
2014
2015
2014
2015
2014
Revenues
$
4,617

$
4,612

$
4,685

$
4,616

$
4,562

$
4,769

$
4,513

$
4,617

Benefits, losses and expenses
3,992

4,003

4,215

4,466

4,183

4,273

4,009

4,173

Income from continuing operations, net of tax
467

466

413

150

372

388

421

345

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

29


(617
)
9



37

Net income (loss)
467

495

413

(467
)
381

388

421

382

Basic earnings (losses) per common share
$
1.11

$
1.10

$
0.99

$
(1.04
)
$
0.92

$
0.89

$
1.03

$
0.89

Diluted earnings (losses) per common share
$
1.08

$
1.03

$
0.96

$
(1.00
)
$
0.90

$
0.86

$
1.01

$
0.86

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic
422.6

449.8

418.7

450.6

413.8

437.2

406.9

429.6

Weighted average shares outstanding and dilutive potential common shares
433.7

478.6

428.1

467.9

423.0

450.8

415.9

442.6


F-101



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
SCHEDULE I
SUMMARY OF INVESTMENTS — OTHER THAN INVESTMENTS IN AFFILIATES
(In millions)
 
As of December 31, 2015
Type of Investment
Cost
Fair Value
Amount at
which shown on Balance Sheet
Fixed Maturities
 
 
 
Bonds and notes
 
 
 
U.S. government and government agencies and authorities (guaranteed and sponsored)
$
7,911

$
8,179

$
8,179

States, municipalities and political subdivisions
11,124

12,121

12,121

Foreign governments
1,321

1,308

1,308

Public utilities
4,395

4,634

4,634

All other corporate bonds
21,481

22,168

22,168

All other mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities
10,733

10,786

10,786

Total fixed maturities, available-for-sale
56,965

59,196

59,196

Fixed maturities, at fair value using fair value option
510

503

503

Total fixed maturities
57,475

59,699

59,699

Equity Securities
 
 
 
Common stocks
 
 
 
Industrial, miscellaneous and all other
969

956

956

Non-redeemable preferred stocks
166

165

165

Total equity securities, available-for-sale
1,135

1,121

1,121

Equity securities, trading
10

11

11

Total equity securities
1,145

1,132

1,132

Mortgage loans
5,624

5,736

5,624

Policy loans
1,447

1,447

1,447

Futures, options and miscellaneous
588

109

109

Short-term investments
1,843

1,843

1,843

Investments in partnerships and trusts
2,874



2,874

Total investments
$
70,996

 
$
72,728


S-1



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
SCHEDULE II
CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
(Registrant)
(In millions)
 
As of December 31,
Condensed Balance Sheets
2015
2014
Assets
 
 
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale, at fair value
$
1,361

$
1,093

Other investments
7

12

Short-term investments
350

961

Investment in affiliates
22,601

23,800

Deferred income taxes
1,450

1,582

Unamortized issue costs
43

49

Other assets
37

36

Total assets
$
25,849

$
27,533

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
 

 

Net payable to affiliates
$
1,355

$
1,218

Short-term debt (includes current maturities of long-term debt)
275

456

Long-term debt
4,941

5,510

Other liabilities
1,636

1,629

Total liabilities
8,207

8,813

Total stockholders’ equity
17,642

18,720

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
25,849

$
27,533

 
For the years ended December 31,
Condensed Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income
2015
2014
2013
Net investment income
$
14

$
11

$
10

Net realized capital losses
(6
)
(6
)
(7
)
Total revenues
8

5

3

Interest expense
346

365

384

Other expenses
35

134

178

Total expenses
381

499

562

Loss before income taxes and earnings of subsidiaries
(373
)
(494
)
(559
)
Income tax benefit
(131
)
(172
)
(187
)
Loss before earnings of subsidiaries
(242
)
(322
)
(372
)
Earnings of subsidiaries
1,924

1,120

548

Net income (loss)
1,682

798

176

Other comprehensive income (loss) - parent company:
 
 
 
Change in net gain/loss on cash-flow hedging instruments


(11
)
Change in net unrealized gain/loss on securities
(1
)
10

(13
)
Change in pension and other postretirement plan adjustments
(82
)
(292
)
127

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes before other comprehensive income of subsidiaries
(83
)
(282
)
103

Other comprehensive income of subsidiaries
(1,174
)
1,289

(3,025
)
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
(1,257
)
1,007

(2,922
)
Total comprehensive income (loss)
$
425

$
1,805

$
(2,746
)


S-2




THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
SCHEDULE II
CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC. (continued)
(Registrant)
(In millions)
 
For the years ended December 31,
Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
2015
2014
2013
Operating Activities
 
 
 
Net income
$
1,682

$
798

$
176

Loss on extinguishment of debt
21


176

Undistributed earnings of subsidiaries
(1,924
)
(1,120
)
(549
)
Change in operating assets and liabilities
1,167

3,376

1,170

Cash provided by operating activities
946

3,054

973

Investing Activities
 
 
 
Net sales of short-term investments
609

(212
)
(454
)
Capital contributions to subsidiaries
742

(585
)
1,211

Cash provided by (used for) investing activities
1,351

(797
)
757

Financing Activities
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt


295

Repurchase of warrants


(33
)
Repayments of long-term debt
(773
)
(200
)
(1,190
)
Treasury stock acquired
(1,250
)
(1,796
)
(600
)
Proceeds from net issuances of common shares under incentive and stock compensation plans and excess tax benefits
42

21

20

Dividends paid — Preferred shares


(21
)
Dividends paid — Common Shares
(316
)
(282
)
(201
)
Cash used for financing activities
(2,297
)
(2,257
)
(1,730
)
Net change in cash



Cash — beginning of year



Cash — end of year
$

$

$

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information
 
 
 
Interest Paid
$
351

$
366

$
366

Dividends Received from Subsidiaries
$
1,127

$
2,589

$
1,096



S-3



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
SCHEDULE III
SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION
(In millions)
 
Segment
Deferred Policy
Acquisition Costs
Future Policy Benefits,
Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Unearned Premiums
Other
Policyholder
Funds and Benefits Payable
 
 
As of December 31, 2015
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial Lines
$
435

$
16,559

$
3,271

$

 
Personal Lines
155

1,845

1,959


 
Property & Casualty Other Operations

3,421

3


 
Group Benefits
35

6,379

43

495

 
Mutual Funds
11




 
Talcott Resolution
1,180

13,368

109

31,175

 
Corporate




 
Consolidated
$
1,816

$
41,572

$
5,385

$
31,670

 
As of December 31, 2014
 

 

 

 

 
Commercial Lines
$
421

$
16,505

3,184


 
Personal Lines
155

1,874

1,914


 
Property & Casualty Other Operations

3,427

1


 
Group Benefits
36

6,540

45

518

 
Mutual Funds
11




 
Talcott Resolution
1,200

13,098

111

32,014

 
Corporate




 
Consolidated
$
1,823

$
41,444

$
5,255

$
32,532


S-4


THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
SCHEDULE III
SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION (continued)


(In millions)

Segment
Earned
Premiums,
Fee Income and Other
Net
Investment Income (Loss)
Benefits, Losses
and Loss
Adjustment Expenses
Amortization of
Deferred Policy
Acquisition Costs
Insurance
Operating
Costs and
Other
Expenses [1]
Net Written Premiums [2]
For the year ended December 31, 2015
 
Commercial Lines
$
6,598

$
910

$
3,886

$
951

$
1,260

$
6,625

Personal Lines
3,873

128

2,768

359

609

3,918

Property & Casualty Other Operations
32

133

243


25

35

Group Benefits
3,136

371

2,427

31

788


Mutual Funds
723

1


22

568


Talcott Resolution
1,133

1,470

1,451

139

441


Corporate
8

17



431


Consolidated
$
15,503

$
3,030

$
10,775

$
1,502

$
4,122

$
10,578

For the year ended December 31, 2014
 
Commercial Lines
$
6,402

$
958

$
3,855

$
919

$
1,194

$
6,381

Personal Lines
3,806

129

2,684

348

599

3,861

Property & Casualty Other Operations
1

129

261


31

2

Group Benefits
3,095

374

2,362

32

836


Mutual Funds
723



28

559


Talcott Resolution
1,407

1,542

1,643

402

544


Corporate
10

22



618


Consolidated
$
15,444

$
3,154

$
10,805

$
1,729

$
4,381

$
10,244

For the year ended December 31, 2013
 
Commercial Lines
$
6,315

$
984

$
4,085

$
905

$
1,190

$
6,208

Personal Lines
3,823

145

2,580

332

761

3,719

Property & Casualty Other Operations

141

148


27

2

Group Benefits
3,330

390

2,518

33

964


Mutual Funds
668



39

511


Talcott Resolution [3]
1,463

1,577

1,717

485

2,150


Corporate
12

27



757


Consolidated
$
15,611

$
3,264

$
11,048

$
1,794

$
6,360

$
9,929

[1]
Includes interest expense, goodwill impairment, loss on extinguishment of debt, restructuring and other costs, and reinsurance loss on disposition.
[2]
Excludes life insurance pursuant to Regulation S-X.
[3]
For the year ended, December 31, 2013, Talcott Resolution was recast to reflect the impact of the sale of HLIKK. For further information regarding this transaction, see Note 18 - Discontinued Operations and Business Dispositions of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

S-5



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
SCHEDULE IV
REINSURANCE
(In millions)
 
Gross
Amount
Ceded to Other
Companies
Assumed
From Other
Companies
Net
Amount
Percentage
of Amount
Assumed
to Net
For the year ended December 31, 2015
 
 
 
 
 
Life insurance in-force
$
619,722

$
4,880

$
21,406

$
636,248

3
%
Insurance revenues
 
 
 
 
 
Property and casualty insurance
$
10,704

$
586

$
298

$
10,416

3
%
Life insurance and annuities
4,099

1,650

161

2,610

6
%
Accident and health insurance
1,668

57

48

1,659

3
%
Total insurance revenues
$
16,471

$
2,293

$
507

$
14,685

3
%
For the year ended December 31, 2014
 

 

 

 

 

Life insurance in-force
$
875,229

$
240,285

$
21,987

$
656,931

3
%
Insurance revenues
 
 
 
 
 
Property and casualty insurance
$
10,531

$
699

$
264

$
10,096

3
%
Life insurance and annuities
4,414

1,666

137

2,885

5
%
Accident and health insurance
1,615

54

56

1,617

3
%
Total insurance revenues
$
16,560

$
2,419

$
457

$
14,598

3
%
For the year ended December 31, 2013
 

 

 

 

 

Life insurance in-force
$
883,387

$
278,059

$
49,789

$
655,117

8
%
Insurance revenues
 
 
 
 
 
Property and casualty insurance
$
10,494

$
871

$
241

$
9,864

2
%
Life insurance and annuities
4,819

1,718

80

3,181

3
%
Accident and health insurance
1,616

62

58

1,612

4
%
Total insurance revenues
$
16,929

$
2,651

$
379

$
14,657

3
%

S-6



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
SCHEDULE V
VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
(In millions)
 
Balance
January 1,
Increase (decrease) in
Costs and
Expenses
Translation
Adjustment
Write-offs/
Payments/
Other
Balance
December 31,
2015
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for doubtful accounts and other
$
131

$
44

$

$
(41
)
$
134

Allowance for uncollectible reinsurance
271

12


(17
)
266

Valuation allowance on mortgage loans
18

7


(2
)
23

Valuation allowance for deferred taxes
181

(102
)


79

2014
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for doubtful accounts and other
$
125

$
50

$

$
(44
)
$
131

Allowance for uncollectible reinsurance
244

30


(3
)
271

Valuation allowance on mortgage loans
67

4


(53
)
18

Valuation allowance for deferred taxes
4

5


172

181

2013
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for doubtful accounts and other
$
117

$
56

$

$
(48
)
$
125

Allowance for uncollectible reinsurance
268

(1
)
2

(25
)
244

Valuation allowance on mortgage loans
68

2


(3
)
67

Valuation allowance for deferred taxes
58

(2
)

(52
)
4


S-7



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
SCHEDULE VI
SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION CONCERNING
PROPERTY AND CASUALTY INSURANCE OPERATIONS
(In millions)
 
Discount
Deducted From Liabilities [1]
Losses and Loss Adjustment
Expenses Incurred Related to:
Paid Losses and
Loss Adjustment Expenses
 
Current Year
Prior Year
Years ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
2015
$
523

$
6,647

$
250

$
6,719

2014
$
556

$
6,572

$
228

$
6,711

2013
$
553

$
6,621

$
192

$
6,826

[1]
Reserves for permanently disabled claimants have been discounted using the weighted average interest rates of 3.24%, 3.50%, and 3.50% for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013, respectively.

S-8



SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC. 
 
 
By:  
/s/ Scott R. Lewis
 
 
 
Scott R. Lewis
 
 
 
Senior Vice President and Controller
 
 
 
(Chief accounting officer and duly
authorized signatory)
 
Date: February 26, 2016

II-1



Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
 
 
Signature
 
Title
 
Date
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Christopher J. Swift
 
Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Christopher J. Swift
 
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Beth A. Bombara
 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Beth A. Bombara
 
(Principal Financial Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Scott R. Lewis
Senior Vice President and Controller
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Scott R. Lewis
(Principal Accounting Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Robert B. Allardice III
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trevor Fetter
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Kathryn A. Mikells
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Michael G. Morris
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Thomas A. Renyi
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Julie G. Richardson
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Teresa W. Roseborough
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Virginia P. Ruesterholz
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charles B. Strauss
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
 
February 26, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
H. Patrick Swygert
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*By: 
 
/s/ David C. Robinson
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
David C. Robinson
 
 
 
 
 
 
As Attorney-in-Fact
 
 
 
 

II-2



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2015
FORM 10-K
EXHIBITS INDEX
The exhibits attached to this Form 10-K are those that are required by Item 601 of Regulation S-K.
 
 
Incorporated by Reference
Exhibit No.
Description
Form
File No.
Exhibit No.
Filing Date
2.01
Purchase and Sale Agreement by and among Massachusetts Mutual Life Insurance Company, Hartford Life, Inc. and The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. ("The Hartford") dated as of September 4, 2012.
10-Q
001-13958
2.01
11/01/2012
2.02
Purchase and Sale Agreement by and among Hartford Life, Inc., Prudential Financial, Inc. and The Hartford dated as of September 27, 2012.
10-Q
001-13958
2.02
11/01/2012
2.03
Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of April 28, 2014, between Hartford Life, Inc., a subsidiary of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc., and ORIX Life Insurance Corporation, a subsidiary of ORIX Corporation.
8-K
001-13958
2.1
04/28/2014
3.01
Restated Certificate of Incorporation of The Hartford, as filed with the Delaware Secretary of State on October 20, 2014.
8-K
001-13958
3.01
10/20/2014
3.02
Amended and Restated By-Laws of The Hartford, amended effective December 17, 2015.
8-K
001-13958
3.1
12/17/2015
4.01
Restated Certificate of Incorporation of The Hartford, as filed with the Delaware Secretary of State on October 20, 2014.
8-K
001-13958
4.1
10/20/2014
4.02
Amended and Restated By-Laws of The Hartford, amended effective December 17, 2015.
8-K
001-13958
3.1
12/17/2015
4.03
Senior Indenture, dated as of March 9, 2004, between The Hartford and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Trustee.
8-K
001-13958
4.1
03/12/2004
4.04
Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of February 12, 2007, between The Hartford and LaSalle Bank, N.A., as Trustee.
8-K
001-13958
4.1
02/16/2007
4.05
Senior Indenture, dated as of April 11, 2007, between The Hartford and The Bank of New York Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee.
S-3ASR
333-142044
4.03
04/11/2007
4.06
Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of June 6, 2008, between The Hartford and The Bank of New York Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee.
8-K
001-13958
4.1
06/06/2008
4.07
First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of June 6, 2008, between The Hartford and The Bank of New York Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee.
8-K
001-13958
4.2
06/06/2008
4.08
Third Supplemental Indenture, dated as of April 5, 2012, between The Hartford and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee.
8-K/A
001-13958
4.3
04/06/2012
4.09
First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of August 9, 2013, between The Hartford and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee.
S-3ASR
001-13958
4.7
08/09/2013
4.10
Replacement Capital Covenant, dated as of June 6, 2008.
8-K
001-13958
4.4
06/06/2008

II-3



 
 
Incorporated by Reference
Exhibit No.
Description
Form
File No.
Exhibit No.
Filing Date
4.11
Warrant to Purchase Shares of Common Stock of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc., dated June 26, 2009.
8-K
001-13958
4.1
06/26/2009
10.01
Five-Year Revolving Credit Facility Agreement dated October 31, 2014, among The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc., Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. Citibank, N.A., U.S. Bank National Association and Wells Fargo, National Association as syndication agents, and the lenders referred to therein.
8-K
001-13958
10.1
11/03/2014
10.02
Form of Commercial Paper Dealer Agreement between The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. as Issuer, and the Dealer party thereto

8-K
001-13958
10.1
12/29/2014
*10.03
The Hartford Senior Executive Officer Severance Pay Plan, as amended and restated, effective October 1, 2014.

10-K
001-13958
10.04
02/27/2015
*10.04
The Hartford Senior Executive Severance Pay Plan, as amended and restated, effective October 1, 2014.
 
10-K
001-13958
10.05
02/27/2015
*10.05
The Hartford 2014 Incentive Stock Plan Administrative Rules Relating to Awards for Non-Employee Directors.

10-K
001-13958
10.06
02/27/2015
*10.06
The Hartford 2010 Incentive Stock Plan, as amended and restated, effective February 25, 2014.
10-K
001-13958
10.05
02/28/2014
*10.07
The Hartford 2014 Incentive Stock Plan, effective May 21, 2014.
10-Q
333-197671
10.02
07/30/2014
*10.08
The Hartford Protection Agreement between The Hartford and Christopher Swift, effective June 9, 2014.
10-Q
001-13958
10.03
07/30/2014
*10.09
The Hartford 2014 Incentive Stock Plan Forms of Individual Award Agreements.
10-Q
001-13958
10.05
07/30/2014
*10.10
The Hartford 2014 Incentive Stock Plan Form of Non-Employee Directors Award Agreement.
10-Q
001-13958
10.01
07/27/2015
*10.11
Summary of Annual Executive Bonus Program.
10-Q
001-13958
10.07
07/30/2014
*10.12
The Hartford 2010 Incentive Stock Plan Administrative Rules Related to Awards for Key Employees, as amended effective December 15, 2010.
10-K
001-13958
10.10
02/25/2011
*10.13
The Hartford 2010 Incentive Stock Plan Forms of Individual Award Agreements.
10-Q
001-13958
10.04
08/04/2010
*10.14
The Hartford 2005 Incentive Stock Plan, as amended for the fiscal year ended 2009.
10-K
001-13958
10.10
02/23/2010
*10.15
The Hartford 2005 Incentive Stock Plan Forms of Individual Award Agreements.
8-K
001-13958
10.2
05/24/2005
*10.16
Form of Key Executive Employment Protection Agreement between The Hartford and certain executive officers of The Hartford, as amended.


10-K
001-13958
10.06
02/12/2009

II-4



 
 
Incorporated by Reference
Exhibit No.
Description
Form
File No.
Exhibit No.
Filing Date
*10.17
The Hartford Deferred Restricted Stock Unit Plan, as amended.
10-K
001-13958
10.12
02/24/2006
*10.18
The Hartford Deferred Compensation Plan, as amended December 20, 2012.
10-K
001-13958
10.18
03/01/2013
*10.19
The Hartford Excess Pension Plan II, as amended January 1, 2013.
10-K
001-13958
10.19
03/01/2013
*10.20
The Hartford Excess Savings Plan IA, as amended effective May 28, 2013.
10-Q
001-13958
10.01
07/29/2013
10.21
Put Option Agreement, dated February 12, 2007, among The Hartford, Glen Meadow ABC Trust and LaSalle Bank, N.A.
8-K
001-13958
10.1
02/16/2007
12.01
Statement Re: Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges. **
 
 
 
 
21.01
Subsidiaries of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. **
 
 
 
 
23.01
Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP to the incorporation by reference into The Hartford’s Registration Statements on Form S-8 and Form S-3 of the report of Deloitte & Touche LLP contained in this Form 10-K regarding the audited financial statements is filed herewith. **
 
 
 
 
24.01
Power of Attorney. **
 
 
 
 
31.01
Certification of Christopher J. Swift pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. **
 
 
 
 
31.02
Certification of Beth A. Bombara pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. **
 
 
 
 
32.01
Certification of Christopher J. Swift pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. **
 
 
 
 
32.02
Certification of Beth A. Bombara pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. **
 
 
 
 
101.INS
XBRL Instance Document.
 
 
 
 
101.SCH
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema.
 
 
 
 
101.CAL
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase.
 
 
 
 
101.DEF
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase.
 
 
 
 
101.LAB
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase.
 
 
 
 
101.PRE
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase.
 
 
 
 

II-5



 
 
Incorporated by Reference
Exhibit No.
Description
Form
File No.
Exhibit No.
Filing Date
*
 
Management contract, compensatory plan or arrangement.
 
 
 
**
 
Filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission as an exhibit to this report.
 
 
 
 

II-6